



Produced by Giovanni Fini, Markus Brenner, Irma Spehar and
the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at
http://www.pgdp.net (This file was produced from images
generously made available by The Internet Archive/Canadian
Libraries)









                         TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES:

—Obvious print and punctuation errors were corrected.

—Bold text has been rendered as =bold text=.

—Spaced out text (gesperrt) has been rendered as ~spaced text~.

—Superscript letters have been rendered as a^b and a^{bc}.




                                   A
                                ~VIEW~
                                 ~OF~
                        Sir ~_ISAAC NEWTON_~’s
                              PHILOSOPHY.

[Illustration]

                             ~_LONDON_~:

                     Printed by _S. PALMER_, 1728.

[Illustration]

  To the Noble and Right Honourable
  SIR _ROBERT WALPOLE._

_SIR,_

I Take the liberty to send you this view of Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON’S~
philosophy, which, if it were performed suitable to the dignity of the
subject, might not be a present unworthy the acceptance of the greatest
person. For his philosophy operations of nature, which for so many
ages had imployed the curiosity of mankind; though no one before him
was furnished with the strength of mind necessary to go any depth in
this difficult search. However, I am encouraged to hope, that this
attempt, imperfect as it is, to give our countrymen in general some
conception of the labours of a person, who shall always be the boast
of this nation, may be received with indulgence by one, under whose
influence these kingdoms enjoy so much happiness. Indeed my admiration
at the surprizing inventions of this great man, carries me to conceive
of him as a person, who not only must raise the glory of the country,
which gave him birth; but that he has even done honour to human nature,
by having extended the greatest and most noble of our faculties,
reason, to subjects, which, till he attempted them, appeared to be
wholly beyond the reach of our limited capacities. And what can give us
a more pleasing prospect of our own condition, than to see so exalted
a proof of the strength of that faculty, whereon the conduct of our
lives, and our happiness depends; our passions and all our motives to
action being in such manner guided by our opinions, that where these
are just, our whole behaviour will be praise-worthy? But why do I
presume to detain you, SIR, with such reflections as these, who must
have the fullest experience within your own mind, of the effects of
right reason? For to what other source can be ascribed that amiable
frankness and unreserved condescension among your friends, or that
masculine perspicuity and strength of argument, whereby you draw the
admiration of the publick, while you are engaged in the most important
of all causes, the liberties of mankind?

       *       *       *       *       *

I humbly crave leave to make the only acknowledgement within my power,
for the benefits, which I receive in common with the rest of my
countrymen from these high talents, by subscribing my self

  ~_SIR_~,
  _Your most faithful_,
  _and_
  _Most humble Servant_,

  ~HENRY PEMBERTON~.




~PREFACE~.


I _Drew up the following papers many years ago at the desire of some
friends, who, upon my taking care of the late edition of Sir_ ~ISAAC
NEWTON’S~ _Principia, perswaded me to make them publick. I laid hold
of that opportunity, when my thoughts were afresh employed on this
subject, to revise what I had formerly written. And I now send it
abroad not without some hopes of answering these two ends. My first
intention was to convey to such, as are not used to mathematical
reasoning, some idea of the philosophy of a person, who has acquired
an universal reputation, and rendered our nation famous for these
speculations in the learned world. To which purpose I have avoided
using terms of art as much as possible, and taken care to define such
as I was obliged to use. Though this caution was the less necessary at
present, since many of them are become familiar words to our language,
from the great number of books wrote in it upon philosophical subjects,
and the courses of experiments, that have of late years been given by
several ingenious men. The other view I had, was to encourage such
young gentlemen as have a turn for the mathematical sciences, to pursue
those studies the more chearfully, in order to understand in our
author himself the demonstrations of the things I here declare. And to
facilitate their progress herein, I intend to proceed still farther in
the explanation of Sir_ ~ISAAC NEWTON’S~ _philosophy. For as I have
received very much pleasure from perusing his writings, I hope it is
no illaudable ambition to endeavour the rendering them more easily
understood, that greater numbers may enjoy the same satisfaction._

_It will perhaps be expected, that I should say something particular
of a person, to whom I must always acknowledge my self to be much
obliged. What I have to declare on this head will be but short; for
it was in the very last years of Sir_ ~ISAAC~_’s life, that I had the
honour of his acquaintance. This happened on the following occasion.
Mr._ Polenus, _a Professor in the University of_ Padua, _from a
new experiment of his, thought the common opinion about the force
of moving bodies was overturned, and the truth of Mr._ Libnitz_’s
notion in that matter fully proved. The contrary of what Polenus had
asserted I demonstrated in a paper, which Dr._ ~MEAD~, _who takes all
opportunities of obliging his friends, was pleased to shew Sir_ ~ISAAC
NEWTON~ _This was so well approved of by him, that he did me the honour
to become a fellow-writer with me, by annexing to what I had written,
a demonstration of his own drawn from another consideration. When I
printed my discourse in the philosophical transactions, I put what Sir_
~ISAAC~ _had written in a scholium by it self, that I might not seem to
usurp what did not belong to me. But I concealed his name, not being
then sufficiently acquainted with him to ask whether he was willing
I might make use of it or not. In a little time after he engaged me
to take care of the new edition he was about making if his Principia.
This obliged me to be very frequently with him, and as he lived at some
distance from me, a great number of letters passed between us on this
account. When I had the honour of his conversation, I endeavoured to
learn his thoughts upon mathematical subjects, and something historical
concerning his inventions, that I had not been before acquainted
with. I found, he had read fewer of the modern mathematicians, than
one could have expected; but his own prodigious invention readily
supplied him with what he might have an occasion for in the pursuit of
any subject he undertook. I have often heard him censure the handling
geometrical subjects by algebraic calculations; and his book of Algebra
he called by the name of Universal Arithmetic, in opposition to the
injudicious title of Geometry, which_ Des Cartes _had given to the
treatise, wherein he shews, how the geometer may assist his invention
by such kind of computations. He frequently praised_ Slusius, Barrow
_and_ Huygens _for not being influenced by the false taste, which then
began to prevail. He used to commend the laudable attempt of_ Hugo
de Omerique _to restore the ancient analysis, and very much esteemed
Apollonius’s book De sectione rationis for giving us a clearer notion
of that analysis than we had before. Dr._ Barrow _may be esteemed as
having shewn a compass of invention equal, if not superior to any of
the moderns, our author only excepted; but Sir_ ~ISAAC NEWTON~ _has
several times particularly recommended to me_ Huygens_’s stile and
manner. He thought him the most elegant of any mathematical writer of
modern times, and the most just imitator of the antients. Of their
taste, and form of demonstration Sir_ ~ISAAC~ _always professed
himself a great admirer: I have heard him even censure himself for
not following them yet more closely than he did; and speak with
regret of his mistake at the beginning of his mathematical studies,
in applying himself to the works of_ Des Cartes _and other algebraic
writers, before he had considered the elements of_ Euclide _with that
attention, which so excellent a writer deserves. As to the history
of his inventions, what relates to his discoveries of the methods of
series and fluxions, and of his theory of light and colours, the world
has been sufficiently informed of already. The first thoughts, which
gave rise to his Principia, he had, when he retired from_ Cambridge
_in 1666 on account of the plague. As he sat alone in a garden, he
fell into a speculation on the power of gravity: that as this power
is not found sensibly diminished at the remotest distance from the
center of the earth, to which we can rise, neither at the tops of the
loftiest buildings, nor even on the summits of the highest mountains;
it appeared to him reasonable to conclude, that this power must extend
much farther than was usually thought; why not as high as the moon,
said he to himself? and if so, her motion must be influenced by it;
perhaps she is retained in her orbit thereby. However, though the power
of gravity is not sensibly weakened in the little change of distance,
at which we can place our selves from the center of the earth; yet it
is very possible, that so high as the moon this power may differ much
in strength from what it is here. To make an estimate, what might be
the degree of this diminution, he considered with himself, that if the
moon be retained in her orbit by the force of gravity, no doubt the
primary planets are carried round the sun by the like power. And by
comparing the periods of the several planets with their distances from
the sun, he found, that if any power like gravity held them in their
courses, its strength must decrease in the duplicate proportion of the
increase of distance. This be concluded by supposing them to move in
perfect circles concentrical to the sun, from which the orbits of the
greatest part of them do not much differ. Supposing therefore the power
of gravity, when extended to the moon, to decrease in the same manner,
he computed whether that force would be sufficient to keep the moon
in her orbit. In this computation, being absent from books, he took
the common estimate in use among geographers and our seamen, before_
Norwood _had measured the earth, that 60 English miles were contained
in one degree of latitude on the surface of the earth. But as this is
a very faulty supposition, each degree containing about 69½ of our
miles, his computation did not answer expectation; whence he concluded,
that some other cause must at least join with the action of the power
of gravity on the moon. On this account he laid aside for that time
any farther thoughts upon this matter. But some years after, a letter
which he received from Dr._ Hook, _put him on inquiring what was the
real figure, in which a body let fall from any high place descends,
taking the motion of the earth round its axis into consideration.
Such a body, having the same motion, which by the revolution of the
earth the place has whence it falls, is to be considered as projected
forward and at the same time drawn down to the center of the earth.
This gave occasion to his resuming his former thoughts concerning the
moon; and_ Picart _in_ France _having lately measured the earth, by
using his measures the moon appeared to be kept in her orbit purely by
the power of gravity; and consequently, that this power decreases as
you recede from the center of the earth in the manner our author had
formerly conjectured. Upon this principle he found the line described
by a falling body to be an ellipsis, the center of the earth being one
focus. And the primary planets moving in such orbits round the sun, he
had the satisfaction to see, that this inquiry, which he had undertaken
merely out of curiosity, could be applied to the greatest purposes.
Hereupon he composed near a dozen propositions relating to the motion
of the primary planets about the sun. Several years after this, some
discourse he had with Dr._ Halley, _who at Cambridge made him a
visit, engaged Sir_ ~ISAAC NEWTON~ _to resume again the consideration
of this subject; and gave occasion to his writing the treatise
which he published under the title of mathematical principles of
natural philosophy. This treatise, full of such a variety of profound
inventions, was composed by him from scarce any other materials than
the few propositions before mentioned, in the space of one year and an
half._

_Though his memory was much decayed, I found he perfectly understood
his own writings, contrary to what I had frequently heard in discourse
from many persons. This opinion of theirs might arise perhaps from his
not being always ready at speaking on these subjects, when it might
be expected he should. But as to this, it may be observed, that great
genius’s are frequently liable to be absent, not only in relation to
common life, but with regard to some of the parts of science they are
the best informed of. Inventors seem to treasure up in their minds,
what they have found out, after another manner than those do the same
things, who have not this inventive faculty. The former, when they
have occasion to produce their knowledge, are in some measure obliged
immediately to investigate part of what they want. For this they are
not equally fit at all times: so it has often happened, that such as
retain things chiefly by means of a very strong memory, have appeared
off hand more expert than the discoverers themselves._

_As to the moral endowments of his mind, they were as much to be
admired as his other talents. But this is a field I leave others to
exspatiate in. I only touch upon what I experienced myself during
the few years I was happy in his friendship. But this I immediately
discovered in him, which at once both surprized and charmed me: Neither
his extreme great age, nor his universal reputation had rendred him
stiff in opinion, or in any degree elated. Of this I had occasion
to have almost daily experience. The Remarks I continually sent him
by letters on his Principia were received with the utmost goodness.
These were so far from being any ways displeasing to him, that on
the contrary it occasioned him to speak many kind things of me to my
friends, and to honour me with a publick testimony of his good opinion.
He also approved of the following treatise, a great part of which we
read together. As many alterations were made in the late edition of
his Principia, so there would have been many more if there had been
a sufficient time. But whatever of this kind may be thought wanting,
I shall endeavour to supply in my comment on that book. I had reason
to believe he expected such a thing from me, and I intended to have
published it in his life time, after I had printed the following
discourse, and a mathematical treatise Sir_ ~ISAAC NEWTON~ _had written
a long while ago, containing the first principles of fluxions, for I
had prevailed on him to let that piece go abroad. I had examined all
the calculations, and prepared part of the figures; but as the latter
part of the treatise had never been finished, he was about letting me
have other papers, in order to supply what was wanting. But his death
put a stop to that design. As to my comment on the Principia, I intend
there to demonstrate whatever Sir_ ~ISAAC NEWTON~ _has set down without
express proof, and to explain all such expressions in his book, as
I shall judge necessary. This comment I shall forthwith put to the
press, joined to an english translation of his Principia, which I have
had some time by me. A more particular account of my whole design has
already been published in the new memoirs of literature for the month
of march 1727._

_I have presented my readers with a copy of verses on Sir_ ~ISAAC
NEWTON~, _which I have just received from a young Gentleman, whom I am
proud to reckon among the number of my dearest friends. If I had any
apprehension that this piece of poetry stood in need of an apology,
I should be desirous the reader might know, that the author is but
sixteen years old, and was obliged to finish his composition in a very
short space of time. But I shall only take the liberty to observe, that
the boldness of the digressions will be best judged of by those who are
acquainted with_ ~PINDAR~.




                                   A
                                ~POEM~
                                  ON
                         Sir ~_ISAAC NEWTON_~.


  TO ~NEWTON~’s genius, and immortal fame
  Th’ advent’rous muse with trembling pinion soars.
  Thou, heav’nly truth, from thy seraphick throne
  Look favourable down, do thou assist
  My lab’ring thought, do thou inspire my song.
  NEWTON, who first th’ almighty’s works display’d,
  And smooth’d that mirror, in whose polish’d face
  The great creator now conspicuous shines;
  Who open’d nature’s adamantine gates,
  And to our minds her secret powers expos’d;
  NEWTON demands the muse; his sacred hand
  Shall guide her infant steps; his sacred hand
  Shall raise her to the Heliconian height,
  Where, on its lofty top inthron’d, her head
  Shall mingle with the Stars. Hail nature, hail,
  O Goddess, handmaid of th’ ethereal power,
  Now lift thy head, and to th’ admiring world
  Shew thy long hidden beauty. Thee the wise
  Of ancient fame, immortal ~PLATO~’s self,
  The Stagyrite, and Syracusian sage,
  From black obscurity’s abyss to raise,
  (Drooping and mourning o’er thy wondrous works)
  With vain inquiry sought. Like meteors these
  In their dark age bright sons of wisdom shone:
  But at thy ~NEWTON~ all their laurels fade,
  They shrink from all the honours of their names.
  So glimm’ring stars contract their feeble rays,
  When the swift lustre of ~AURORA~’s face
  Flows o’er the skies, and wraps the heav’ns in light.

  THE Deity’s omnipotence, the cause,
  Th’ original of things long lay unknown.
  Alone the beauties prominent to sight
  (Of the celestial power the outward form)
  Drew praise and wonder from the gazing world.
  As when the deluge overspread the earth,
  Whilst yet the mountains only rear’d their heads
  Above the surface of the wild expanse,
  Whelm’d deep below the great foundations lay,
  Till some kind angel at heav’n’s high command
  Roul’d back the rising tides, and haughty floods,
  And to the ocean thunder’d out his voice:
  Quick all the swelling and imperious waves,
  The foaming billows and obscuring surge,
  Back to their channels and their ancient seats
  Recoil affrighted: from the darksome main
  Earth raises smiling, as new-born, her head,
  And with fresh charms her lovely face arrays.
  So his extensive thought accomplish’d first
  The mighty task to drive th’ obstructing mists
  Of ignorance away, beneath whose gloom
  Th’ inshrouded majesty of Nature lay.
  He drew the veil and swell’d the spreading scene.
  How had the moon around th’ ethereal void
  Rang’d, and eluded lab’ring mortals care,
  Till his invention trac’d her secret steps,
  While she inconstant with unsteady rein
  Through endless mazes and meanders guides
  In its unequal course her changing carr:
  Whether behind the sun’s superior light
  She hides the beauties of her radiant face,
  Or, when conspicuous, smiles upon mankind,
  Unveiling all her night-rejoicing charms.
  When thus the silver-tressed moon dispels
  The frowning horrors from the brow of night,
  And with her splendors chears the sullen gloom,
  While sable-mantled darkness with his veil
  The visage of the fair horizon shades,
  And over nature spreads his raven wings;
  Let me upon some unfrequented green
  While sleep sits heavy on the drowsy world,
  Seek out some solitary peaceful cell,
  Where darksome woods around their gloomy brows
  Bow low, and ev’ry hill’s protended shade
  Obscures the dusky vale, there silent dwell,
  Where contemplation holds its still abode,
  There trace the wide and pathless void of heav’n,
  And count the stars that sparkle on its robe.
  Or else in fancy’s wild’ring mazes lost
  Upon the verdure see the fairy elves
  Dance o’er their magick circles, or behold,
  In thought enraptur’d with the ancient bards,
  Medea’s baleful incantations draw
  Down from her orb the paly queen of night.
  But chiefly ~NEWTON~ let me soar with thee,
  And while surveying all yon starry vault
  With admiration I attentive gaze,
  Thou shalt descend from thy celestial seat,
  And waft aloft my high-aspiring mind,
  Shalt shew me there how nature has ordain’d
  Her fundamental laws, shalt lead my thought
  Through all the wand’rings of th’ uncertain moon,
  And teach me all her operating powers.
  She and the sun with influence conjoint
  Wield the huge axle of the whirling earth,
  And from their just direction turn the poles,
  Slow urging on the progress of the years.
  The constellations seem to leave their seats,
  And o’er the skies with solemn pace to move.
  You, splendid rulers of the day and night,
  The seas obey, at your resistless sway
  Now they contract their waters, and expose
  The dreary desart of old ocean’s reign.
  The craggy rocks their horrid sides disclose;
  Trembling the sailor views the dreadful scene,
  And cautiously the threat’ning ruin shuns.
  But where the shallow waters hide the sands,
  There ravenous destruction lurks conceal’d,
  There the ill-guided vessel falls a prey,
  And all her numbers gorge his greedy jaws.
  But quick returning see th’ impetuous tides
  Back to th’ abandon’d shores impell the main.
  Again the foaming seas extend their waves,
  Again the rouling floods embrace the shoars,
  And veil the horrours of the empty deep.
  Thus the obsequious seas your power confess,
  While from the surface healthful vapours rise
  Plenteous throughout the atmosphere diffus’d,
  Or to supply the mountain’s heads with springs,
  Or fill the hanging clouds with needful rains,
  That friendly streams, and kind refreshing show’rs
  May gently lave the sun-burnt thirsty plains,
  Or to replenish all the empty air
  With wholsome moisture to increase the fruits
  Of earth, and bless the labours of mankind.
  O ~NEWTON~, whether flies thy mighty soul,
  How shall the feeble muse pursue through all
  The vast extent of thy unbounded thought,
  That even seeks th’ unseen recesses dark
  To penetrate of providence immense.
  And thou the great dispenser of the world
  Propitious, who with inspiration taught’st
  Our greatest bard to send thy praises forth;
  Thou, who gav’st ~NEWTON~ thought; who smil’dst serene,
  When to its bounds he stretch’d his swelling soul;
  Who still benignant ever blest his toil,
  And deign’d to his enlight’ned mind t’ appear
  Confess’d around th’ interminated world:
  To me O thy divine infusion grant
  (O thou in all so infinitely good)
  That I may sing thy everlasting works,
  Thy inexhausted store of providence,
  In thought effulgent and resounding verse.
  O could I spread the wond’rous theme around,
  Where the wind cools the oriental world,
  To the calm breezes of the Zephir’s breath,
  To where the frozen hyperborean blasts.
  To where the boist’rous tempest-leading south
  From their deep hollow caves send forth their storms.
  Thou still indulgent parent of mankind,
  Left humid emanations should no more
  Flow from the ocean, but dissolve away
  Through the long series of revolving time;
  And left the vital principle decay,
  By which the air supplies the springs of life;
  Thou hast the fiery visag’d comets form’d
  With vivifying spirits all replete,
  Which they abundant breathe about the void,
  Renewing the prolifick soul of things.
  No longer now on thee amaz’d we call,
  No longer tremble at imagin’d ills,
  When comets blaze tremendous from on high,
  Or when extending wide their flaming trains
  With hideous grasp the skies engirdle round,
  And spread the terrors of their burning locks.
  For these through orbits in the length’ning space
  Of many tedious rouling years compleat
  Around the sun move regularly on;
  And with the planets in harmonious orbs,
  And mystick periods their obeysance pay
  To him majestick ruler of the skies
  Upon his throne of circled glory fixt.
  He or some god conspicuous to the view,
  Or else the substitute of nature seems,
  Guiding the courses of revolving worlds.
  He taught great ~NEWTON~ the all-potent laws
  Of gravitation, by whose simple power
  The universe exists. Nor here the sage
  Big with invention still renewing staid.
  But O bright angel of the lamp of day,
  How shall the muse display his greatest toil?
  Let her plunge deep in Aganippe’s waves,
  Or in Castalia’s ever-flowing stream,
  That re-inspired she may sing to thee,
  How ~NEWTON~ dar’d advent’rous to unbraid
  The yellow tresses of thy shining hair.
  Or didst thou gracious leave thy radiant sphere,
  And to his hand thy lucid splendours give,
  T’ unweave the light-diffusing wreath, and part
  The blended glories of thy golden plumes?
  He with laborious, and unerring care,
  How different and imbodied colours form
  Thy piercing light, with just distinction found.
  He with quick sight pursu’d thy darting rays,
  When penetrating to th’ obscure recess
  Of solid matter, there perspicuous saw,
  How in the texture of each body lay
  The power that separates the different beams.
  Hence over nature’s unadorned face
  Thy bright diversifying rays dilate
  Their various hues: and hence when vernal rains
  Descending swift have burst the low’ring clouds,
  Thy splendors through the dissipating mists
  In its fair vesture of unnumber’d hues
  Array the show’ry bow. At thy approach
  The morning risen from her pearly couch
  With rosy blushes decks her virgin cheek;
  The ev’ning on the frontispiece of heav’n
  His mantle spreads with many colours gay;
  The mid-day skies in radiant azure clad,
  The shining clouds, and silver vapours rob’d
  In white transparent intermixt with gold,
  With bright variety of splendor cloath
  All the illuminated face above.
  When hoary-headed winter back retires
  To the chill’d pole, there solitary sits
  Encompass’d round with winds and tempests bleak
  In caverns of impenetrable ice,
  And from behind the dissipated gloom
  Like a new Venus from the parting surge
  The gay-apparell’d spring advances on;
  When thou in thy meridian brightness sitt’st,
  And from thy throne pure emanations flow
  Of glory bursting o’er the radiant skies:
  Then let the muse Olympus’ top ascend,
  And o’er Thessalia’s plain extend her view,
  And count, O Tempe, all thy beauties o’er.
  Mountains, whose summits grasp the pendant clouds,
  Between their wood-invelop’d <DW72>s embrace
  The green-attired vallies. Every flow’r
  Here in the pride of bounteous nature clad
  Smiles on the bosom of th’ enamell’d meads.
  Over the smiling lawn the silver floods
  Of fair Peneus gently roul along,
  While the reflected colours from the flow’rs,
  And verdant borders pierce the lympid waves,
  And paint with all their variegated hue
  The yellow sands beneath. Smooth gliding on
  The waters hasten to the neighbouring sea.
  Still the pleas’d eye the floating plain pursues;
  At length, in Neptune’s wide dominion lost,
  Surveys the shining billows, that arise
  Apparell’d each in Phœbus’ bright attire:
  Or from a far some tall majestick ship,
  Or the long hostile lines of threat’ning fleets,
  Which o’er the bright uneven mirror sweep,
  In dazling gold and waving purple deckt;
  Such as of old, when haughty Athens power
  Their hideous front, and terrible array
  Against Pallene’s coast extended wide,
  And with tremendous war and battel stern
  The trembling walls of Potidæa shook.
  Crested with pendants curling with the breeze
  The upright masts high bristle in the air,
  Aloft exalting proud their gilded heads.
  The silver waves against the painted prows
  Raise their resplendent bosoms, and impearl
  The fair vermillion with their glist’ring drops:
  And from on board the iron-cloathed host
  Around the main a gleaming horrour casts;
  Each flaming buckler like the mid-day sun,
  Each plumed helmet like the silver moon,
  Each moving gauntlet like the light’ning’s blaze,
  And like a star each brazen pointed spear.
  But lo the sacred high-erected fanes,
  Fair citadels, and marble-crowned towers,
  And sumptuous palaces of stately towns
  Magnificent arise, upon their heads
  Bearing on high a wreath of silver light.
  But see my muse the high Pierian hill,
  Behold its shaggy locks and airy top,
  Up to the skies th’ imperious mountain heaves
  The shining verdure of the nodding woods.
  See where the silver Hippocrene flows,
  Behold each glitt’ring rivulet, and rill
  Through mazes wander down the green descent,
  And sparkle through the interwoven trees.
  Here rest a while and humble homage pay,
  Here, where the sacred genius, that inspir’d
  Sublime ~MÆONIDES~ and ~PINDAR’S~ breast,
  His habitation once was fam’d to hold.
  Here thou, O ~HOMER~, offer’dst up thy vows,
  Thee, the kind muse ~CALLIOPÆA~ heard,
  And led thee to the empyrean feats,
  There manifested to thy hallow’d eyes
  The deeds of gods; thee wise ~MINERVA~ taught
  The wondrous art of knowing human kind;
  Harmonious ~PHŒBUS~ tun’d thy heav’nly mind,
  And swell’d to rapture each exalted sense;
  Even ~MARS~ the dreadful battle-ruling god,
  ~MARS~ taught thee war, and with his bloody hand
  Instructed thine, when in thy sounding lines
  We hear the rattling of Bellona’s carr,
  The yell of discord, and the din of arms.
  ~PINDAR~, when mounted on his fiery steed,
  Soars to the sun, opposing eagle like
  His eyes undazled to the fiercest rays.
  He firmly seated, not like ~GLAUCUS’~ son,
  Strides his swift-winged and fire-breathing horse,
  And born aloft strikes with his ringing hoofs
  The brazen vault of heav’n, superior there
  Looks down upon the stars, whose radiant light
  Illuminates innumerable worlds,
  That through eternal orbits roul beneath.
  But thou all hail immortalized son
  Of harmony, all hail thou Thracian bard,
  To whom ~APOLLO~ gave his tuneful lyre.
  O might’st thou, ~ORPHEUS~, now again revive,
  And ~NEWTON~ should inform thy list’ning ear
  How the soft notes, and soul-inchanting strains
  Of thy own lyre were on the wind convey’d.
  He taught the muse, how sound progressive floats
  Upon the waving particles of air,
  When harmony in ever-pleasing strains,
  Melodious melting at each lulling fall,
  With soft alluring penetration steals
  Through the enraptur’d ear to inmost thought,
  And folds the senses in its silken bands.
  So the sweet musick, which from ~ORPHEUS~’ touch
  And fam’d ~AMPHION’S~, on the sounding string
  Arose harmonious, gliding on the air,
  Pierc’d the tough-bark’d and knotty-ribbed woods,
  Into their saps soft inspiration breath’d
  And taught attention to the stubborn oak.
  Thus when great ~HENRY~, and brave ~MARLB’ROUGH~ led
  Th’ imbattled numbers of ~BRITANNIA’S~ sons,
  The trump, that swells th’ expanded cheek of fame,
  That adds new vigour to the gen’rous youth,
  And rouzes sluggish cowardize it self,
  The trumpet with its Mars-inciting voice,
  The winds broad breast impetuous sweeping o’er
  Fill’d the big note of war. Th’ inspired host
  With new-born ardor press the trembling ~GAUL~;
  Nor greater throngs had reach’d eternal night,
  Not if the fields of Agencourt had yawn’d
  Exposing horrible the gulf of fate;
  Or roaring Danube spread his arms abroad,
  And overwhelm’d their legions with his floods.
  But let the wand’ring muse at length return;
  Nor yet, angelick genius of the sun,
  In worthy lays her high-attempting song
  Has blazon’d forth thy venerated name.
  Then let her sweep the loud-resounding lyre
  Again, again o’er each melodious string
  Teach harmony to tremble with thy praise.
  And still thine ear O favourable grant,
  And she shall tell thee, that whatever charms,
  Whatever beauties bloom on nature’s face,
  Proceed from thy all-influencing light.
  That when arising with tempestuous rage,
  The North impetuous rides upon the clouds
  Dispersing round the heav’ns obstructive gloom,
  And with his dreaded prohibition stays
  The kind effusion of thy genial beams;
  Pale are the rubies on ~AURORA’S~ lips,
  No more the roses blush upon her cheeks,
  Black are Peneus’ streams and golden sands
  In Tempe’s vale dull melancholy sits,
  And every flower reclines its languid head.
  By what high name shall I invoke thee, say,
  Thou life-infusing deity, on thee
  I call, and look propitious from on high,
  While now to thee I offer up my prayer.
  O had great ~NEWTON~, as he found the cause,
  By which sound rouls thro’ th’ undulating air,
  O had he, baffling times resistless power,
  Discover’d what that subtle spirit is,
  Or whatsoe’er diffusive else is spread
  Over the wide-extended universe,
  Which causes bodies to reflect the light,
  And from their straight direction to divert
  The rapid beams, that through their surface pierce.
  But since embrac’d by th’ icy arms of age,
  And his quick thought by times cold hand congeal’d,
  Ev’n ~NEWTON~ left unknown this hidden power;
  Thou from the race of human kind select
  Some other worthy of an angel’s care,
  With inspiration animate his breast,
  And him instruct in these thy secret laws.
  O let not ~NEWTON~, to whose spacious view,
  Now unobstructed, all th’ extensive scenes
  Of the ethereal ruler’s works arise;
  When he beholds this earth he late adorn’d,
  Let him not see philosophy in tears,
  Like a fond mother solitary sit,
  Lamenting him her dear, and only child.
  But as the wise ~PYTHAGORAS~, and he,
  Whose birth with pride the fam’d Abdera boasts,
  With expectation having long survey’d
  This spot their ancient seat, with joy beheld
  Divine philosophy at length appear
  In all her charms majestically fair,
  Conducted by immortal ~NEWTON’S~ hand.
  So may he see another sage arise,
  That shall maintain her empire: then no more
  Imperious ignorance with haughty sway
  Shall stalk rapacious o’er the ravag’d globe:
  Then thou, O ~NEWTON~, shalt protect these lines.
  The humble tribute of the grateful muse;
  Ne’er shall the sacrilegious hand despoil
  Her laurel’d temples, whom his name preserves:
  And were she equal to the mighty theme,
  Futurity should wonder at her song;
  Time should receive her with extended arms,
  Seat her conspicuous in his rouling carr,
  And bear her down to his extreamest bound.

  ~FABLES~ with wonder tell how Terra’s sons
  With iron force unloos’d the stubborn nerves
  Of hills, and on the cloud-inshrouded top
  Of Pelion Ossa pil’d. But if the vast
  Gigantick deeds of savage strength demand
  Astonishment from men, what then shalt thou,
  O what expressive rapture of the soul,
  When thou before us, ~NEWTON~, dost display
  The labours of thy great excelling mind;
  When thou unveilest all the wondrous scene,
  The vast idea of th’ eternal king,
  Not dreadful bearing in his angry arm
  The thunder hanging o’er our trembling heads;
  But with th’ effulgency of love replete,
  And clad with power, which form’d th’ extensive heavens.
  O happy he, whose enterprizing hand
  Unbars the golden and relucid gates
  Of th’ empyrean dome, where thou enthron’d
  Philosophy art seated. Thou sustain’d
  By the firm hand of everlasting truth
  Despisest all the injuries of time;
  Thou never know’st decay when all around,
  Antiquity obscures her head. Behold
  Th’ Egyptian towers, the Babylonian walls,
  And Thebes with all her hundred gates of brass,
  Behold them scatter’d like the dust abroad.
  Whatever now is flourishing and proud,
  Whatever shall, must know devouring age.
  Euphrates’ stream, and seven-mouthed Nile,
  And Danube, thou that from Germania’s soil
  To the black Euxine’s far remoted shore,
  O’er the wide bounds of mighty nations sweep’st
  In thunder loud thy rapid floods along.
  Ev’n you shall feel inexorable time;
  To you the fatal day shall come; no more
  Your torrents then shall shake the trembling ground,
  No longer then to inundations swol’n
  Th’ imperious waves the fertile pastures drench,
  But shrunk within a narrow channel glide;
  Or through the year’s reiterated course
  When time himself grows old, your wond’rous streams
  Lost ev’n to memory shall lie unknown
  Beneath obscurity, and Chaos whelm’d,
  But still thou sun illuminatest all
  The azure regions round, thou guidest still
  The orbits of the planetary spheres;
  The moon still wanders o’er her changing course,
  And still, O ~NEWTON~, shall thy name survive:
  As long as nature’s hand directs the world,
  When ev’ry dark obstruction shall retire,
  And ev’ry secret yield its hidden store,
  Which thee dim-sighted age forbad to see
  Age that alone could stay thy rising soul.
  And could mankind among the fixed stars,
  E’en to th’ extremest bounds of knowledge reach,
  To those unknown innumerable suns,
  Whose light but glimmers from those distant worlds,
  Ev’n to those utmost boundaries, those bars
  That shut the entrance of th’ illumin’d space
  Where angels only tread the vast unknown,
  Thou ever should’st be seen immortal there:
  In each new sphere, each new-appearing sun,
  In farthest regions at the very verge
  Of the wide universe should’st thou be seen.
  And lo, th’ all-potent goddess ~NATURE~ takes
  With her own hand thy great, thy just reward
  Of immortality; aloft in air
  See she displays, and with eternal grasp
  Uprears the trophies of great ~NEWTON~’s fame.

  R. GLOVER.

  THE
  ~CONTENTS.~

  _INTRODUCTION concerning Sir_ ~ISAAC NEWTON~’_s
  method of reasoning in philosophy_                      pag.    1


  BOOK I.

  ~CHAP. 1.~ _Of the laws of motion_
  _The first law of motion proved_                           p.  29
  _The second law of motion proved_                          p.  29
  _The third law of motion proved_                           p.  31

  ~CHAP. 2.~ _Further proofs of the laws of motion_
  _The effects of percussion_                                p.  49
  _The perpendicular descent of bodies_                      p.  55
  _The oblique descent of bodies in a straight line_         p.  57
  _The curvilinear descent of bodies_                        p.  58
  _The perpendicular ascent of bodies_                       ibid.
  _The oblique ascent of bodies_                             p.  59
  _The power of gravity proportional to the quantity of
      matter in each body_                                   p.  60
  _The centre of gravity of bodies_                          p.  62
  _The mechanical powers_                                    p.  69
      _The lever_                                            p.  71
      _The wheel and axis_                                   p.  77
      _The pulley_                                           p.  80
      _The wedge_                                            p.  83
      _The screw_                                            ibid.
      _The inclined plain_                                   p.  84
    _The pendulum_                                           p.  86
      _Vibrating in a circle_                                ibid.
      _Vibrating in a cycloid_                               p.  91
    _The line of swiftest descent_                           p.  93
    _The centre of oscillation_                              p.  94
    _Experiments upon the percussion of bodies made
        by pendulums_                                        p.  98
    _The centre of percussion_                               p. 100
    _The motion of projectiles_                              p. 102
    _The description of the conic sections_                  p. 106
    _The difference between absolute and relative motion,
        as also between absolute and relative time_          p. 112

  ~CHAP. 3.~ _Of centripetal forces_                p. 117

  ~CHAP. 4.~ _Of the resistance of fluids_          p. 143
    _Bodies are resisted in the duplicate proportion of
        their velocities_                                    p. 147
    _Of elastic fluids and their resistance_                 p. 149
    _How fluids may be rendered elastic_                     p. 150
    _The degree of resistance in regard to the proportion
        between the density of the body and of the fluid_
      _In rare and uncompressed fluids_                      p. 153
      _In compressed fluids_                                 p. 155
    _The degree of resistance as it depends upon the figure
        of bodies_
      _In rare and uncompressed fluids_                      p. 155
      _In compressed fluids_                                 p. 158


  BOOK II.

  ~CHAP. 1.~ _That the planets move in a space
      empty of sensible matter_                              p. 161
    _The system of the world described_                      p. 162
    _The planets suffer no sensible resistance in their
        motion_                                              p. 166
    _They are not kept in motion by a fluid_                 p. 168
    _That all space is not full of matter without vacancies_ p. 169

  ~CHAP. 2.~ _Concerning the cause that keeps in
        motion the primary planets_                          p. 171
    _They are influenced by a centripetal power directed to
        the sun_                                             p. 171
    _The strength of this power is reciprocally in the
        duplicate proportion of the distance_                 ibid.
    _The cause of the irregularities in the motions of the
        planets_                                             p. 175
    _A correction of their motions_                          p. 178
    _That the frame of the world is not eternal_             p. 180

  ~CHAP. 3.~ _Of the motion of the moon and the other
      secondary planets_
    _That they are influenced by a centripetal force
        directed toward their primary, as the primary are
        influenced by the sun_                               p. 182
    _That the power usually called gravity extends to
        the moon_                                            p. 189
    _That the sun acts on the secondary planets_             p. 190
    _The variation of the moon_                              p. 193
    _That the circuit of the moons orbit is increased by the
        sun in the quarters, and diminished in the
        conjunction and opposition_                          p. 198
    _The distance of the moon from the earth in the quarters
        and in the conjunction and opposition is altered by
        the sun_                                             p. 200
    _These irregularities in the moon’s motion varied by the
        change of distance between the earth and sun_        p. 201
    _The period of the moon round the earth and her distance
        varied by the same means_                             ibid.
    _The motion of the nodes and the inclination of the
        moons orbit_                                         p. 202
    _The motion of the apogeon and change of the
        eccentricity_                                        p. 218
    _The inequalities of the other secondary planets
        deducible from these of the moon_                    p. 229


  ~CHAP. 4.~ _Of comets_

    _They are not meteors, nor placed totally without the
        planetary system_                                    p. 230
    _The sun acts on them in the same manner as on the
        planets_                                             p. 231
    _Their orbits are near to parabola’s_                    p. 233
    _The comet that appeared at the end of the year 1680,
        probably performs its period in 575 years, and
        another comet in 75 years_                           p. 234
    _Why the comets move in planes more different from
        one another than the planets_                        p. 235
    _The tails of comets_                                    p. 238
    _The use of them_                                    p. 243 244
    _The possible use of the comet it self_              p. 245 246

  ~CHAP. 5.~ _Of the bodies of the sun and planets_

    _That each of the heavenly bodies is endued with an
        attractive power, and that the force of the same
        body on others is proportional to the quantity of
        matter in the body attracted_                        p. 247
    _This proved in the earth_                               p. 248
      _In the sun_                                           p. 250
      _In the rest of the planets_                           p. 251
    _That the attractive power is of the same nature in
        the sun and in all the planets, and therefore is
        the same with gravity_                               p. 252
    _That the attractive power in each of these bodies is
        proportional to the quantity of matter in the body
        attracting_                                           ibid.
    _That each particle of which the sun and planets are
        composed is endued with an attracting power, the
        strength of which is reciprocally in the duplicate
        proportion of the distance_                          p. 257

    _The power of gravity universally belongs to all matter_ p. 259

    _The different weight of the same body upon the surface
        of the sun, the earth, Jupiter and Saturn; the
        respective densities of these bodies, and the
        proportion between their diameters_                  p. 261

  ~CHAP. 6.~ _Of the fluid parts of the planets_

    _The manner in which fluids press_                       p. 264
    _The motion of waves on the surface of water_            p. 269
    _The motion of sound through the air_                    p. 270
    _The velocity of sound_                                  p. 282
    _Concerning the tides_                                   p. 283
    _The figure of the earth_                                p. 296
    _The effect of this figure upon the power of gravity_    p. 300
    _The effect it has upon pendulums_                       p. 302
    _Bodies descend perpendicularly to the surface of
        the earth_                                           p. 304
    _The axis of the earth changes its direction twice a
        year, and twice a month_                             p. 313
    _The figure of the secondary planets_                     ibid.


  BOOK III.

  ~CHAP. 1.~ _Concerning the cause of colours
                       inherent in the light_

    _The sun’s light is composed of rays of different
        colours_                                             p. 318
    _The refraction of light_                            p. 319 320
    _Bodies appear of different colour by day-light, because
        some reflect one kind of light more copiously than
        the rest, and other bodies other kinds of light_     p. 329
    _The effect of mixing rays of different colours_         p. 334

  ~CHAP. 2.~ _Of the properties of bodies whereon their
      colours depend._

    _Light is not reflected by impinging against the solid
        parts of bodies_                                     p. 339
    _The particles which compose bodies are transparent_     p. 341
    _Cause of opacity_                                       p. 342
    _Why bodies in the open day-light have different
        colours_                                             p. 344
    _The great porosity of bodies considered_                p. 355

  ~CHAP. 3.~ _Of the refraction, reflection, and
      inflection of light._

    _Rays of different colours are differently refracted_    p. 357
    _The sine of the angle of incidence in each kind of rays
        bears a given proportion to the sine of refraction_  p. 361
    _The proportion between the refractive powers in
        different bodies_                                    p. 366
    _Unctuous bodies refract most in proportion to their
        density_                                             p. 368
    _The action between light and bodies is mutual_          p. 369
    _Light has alternate fits of easy transmission and
        reflection_                                          p. 371
    _The fits found to return alternately many thousand
        times_                                               p. 375
    _Why bodies reflect part of the light incident upon them
        and transmit another part_                            ibid.
    _Sir_ ~ISAAC NEWTON~_’s conjecture
        concerning the cause of this alternate reflection
        and transmission of light_                           p. 376
    _The inflection of light_                                p. 377

  ~CHAP. 4.~ _Of optic glasses._

    _How the rays of light are refracted by a spherical
        surface of glass_                                    p. 378
    _How they are refracted by two such surfaces_            p. 380
    _How the image of objects is formed by a convex glass_   p. 381
    _Why convex glasses help the sight in old age, and
        concave glasses assist short-sighted people_         p. 383
    _The manner in which vision is performed by the eye_     p. 385
    _Of telescopes with two convex glasses_                  p. 386
    _Of telescopes with four convex glasses_                 p. 388
    _Of telescopes with one convex and one concave glass_     ibid.
    _Of microscopes_                                         p. 389
    _Of the imperfection of telescopes arising from the
        different refrangibility of the light_               p. 390
    _Of the reflecting telescope_                            p. 393

  ~CHAP. 5.~ _Of the rainbow_
    _Of the inner rainbow_                       p. 394 395 398 399
    _Of the outter bow_                              p. 396 397 400
    _Of a particular appearance in the inner rainbow_        p. 401
    _Conclusion_                                             p. 405




~ERRATA.~

 PAGE 25. line 4. read _In these Precepts._ p. 40. l. 24. for _I_
 read _K_. p. 53. l. penult. f. Æ. r. F. p. 82. l. ult. f. 40. r. 41.
 p. 83 l. ult. f. 43. r. 45. p. 91. l. 3. f. 48. r. 50. ibid. l. 25.
 for 49. r. 51. p. 92. l. 18. f. _A G F E._ r. _H G F C._ p. 96. l.
 23. dele the comma after {⅓}. p. 140. l. 12. dele _and._ p. 144. l.
 15. f. _threefold._ r. _two-fold._ p. 162. l. 25. f. {⅓}. r. {⅞}. p.
 193. 1. 2. r. _always._ p. 199. l. penult. and p. 200. l. 3. 5. f. F.
 r. C. p. 201. l. 8. f. _ascends._ r._ must ascend._ ibid. l. 10. f.
 _it descends._ r. _descend._ p. 208. l. 14. f. _W T O._ r. _N T O._
 In _fig._ 110. draw a line from _I_ through _T_, till it meets the
 circle _A D C B_, where place _W._ p. 216. l. penult. f. _action._
 r. _motion._ p. 221. l. 23. f. _A F._ r. _A H._ p. 232. l. 23. after
 _invention_ put a full point. p. 253. l. penult. delete the comma
 after _remarkable_. p. 255. l. ult. f. _D E._ r. _B E._ p. 278. l.
 17. f. ξ τ. r. ξ π. p. 299. l. 19 r. _the._ p. 361. l. 12. f. I. r.
 t. p. 369. l. 2, 3. r. _Pseudo-topaz._ p. 378. l. 12. f. _that._ r.
 _than._ p. 379. l. 15. f. _converge._ r. _diverge._ p. 384. l. 7. f.
 _optic-glass._ r. _optic-nerve._ p. 391. l. 18. r. _as 50 to 78._ p.
 392. l. 18. after _telescope_ add _be about 100 feet long and the._ in
 _fig. 161._ f. δ put ε. p. 399. l. 8. r. A n, A x. &c. p. 400. 1. 19.
 r. A π, A ρ. A σ, A τ. A φ. p. 401. l. 14. r. _fig. 163._ The pages
 374, 375, 376 are erroneously numbered 375, 376, 377; and the pages
 382, 383 are numbered 381, 382.




  A LIST of such of the
  SUBSCRIBERS NAMES
  As are come to the ~HAND~ of the
  AUTHOR.

  A

  M_Onseigneur_ d’Aguesseau, _Chancelier de_ France
  _Reverend_ Mr Abbot, _of_ Emanuel Coll. Camb.
  _Capt._ George Abell
  _The Hon. Sir_ John Anstruther, _Bar._
  Thomas Abney, _Esq;_
  Mr. Nathan Abraham
  _Sir_ Arthur Acheson, Bart.
  Mr William Adair
  _Rev._ Mr John Adams, _Fellow of_ Sidney Coll. Cambridge
  Mr William Adams
  Mr George Adams
  Mr William Adamson, _Scholar of_ Caius Coll. Camb.
  Mr Samuel Adee, _Fell. of_ Corp.  Chr. Coll. Oxon
  Mr Andrew Adlam
  Mr John Adlam
  Mr Stephen Ainsworth
  Mrs Aiscot
  Mr Robert Akenhead, _Bookseller at_ Newcastle _upon_ Tyne
  S. B. Albinus, M. D. Anatom. _and_ Chirurg _in_ Acad. L. B. Prof.
  George Aldridge, _M. D._
  Mr George Algood
  Mr Aliffe
  Robert Allen, _Esq;_
  Mr Zach. Allen
  _Rev._ Mr Allerton, _Fellow of_ Sidney Coll. Cambridge
  Mr St. Amand
  Mr John Anns
  Thomas Anson, _Esq;_
  _Rev. Dr._ Christopher Anstey
  Mr Isaac Antrabus
  Mr Joshua Appleby
  John Arbuthnot, _M. D._
  William Archer, _Esq;_
  Mr John Archer, _Merchant of_ Amsterdam
  Thomas Archer, _Esq;_
  _Coll._ John Armstrong, Surveyor-General _of_ His Majesty’s Ordnance
  Mr Armytage
  Mr Street Arnold, _Surgeon_
  Mr Richard Arnold
  Mr Ascough
  Mr Charles Asgill
  Richard Ash, _Esq; of_ Antigua
  Mr Ash, _Fellow-Commoner of_ Jesus Coll. Cambridge
  William Ashurst, _Esq; of_ Castle Henningham, Essex
  Mr Thomas Ashurst
  Mr Samuel Ashurst
  Mr John Askew, _Merchant_
  Mr Edward Athawes, _Merchant_
  Mr Abraham Atkins
  Mr Edward Kensey Atkins
  Mr Ayerst
  Mr Jonathan Ayleworth, _Jun._
  Rowland Aynsworth, _Esq;_


  B

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Bedford
  _Right Honourable the Marquis of_ Bowmont
  _Right Hon. the Earl of_ Burlington
  _Right Honourable Lord Viscount_ Bateman
  _Rt. Rev. Ld. Bp. of_ Bath _and_ Wells
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Bristol
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Bathurst
  Richard Backwell, _Esq;_
  Mr William Backshell, _Merch._
  Edmund Backwell, _Gent._
  _Sir_ Edmund Bacon
  Richard Bagshaw, _of_ Oakes, _Esq;_
  Tho. Bagshaw, _of_ Bakewell, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr. Bagshaw
  _Sir_ Robert Baylis
  _Honourable_ George Baillie, _Esq;_
  Giles Bailly, _M. D. of_ Bristol
  Mr Serjeant Baines
  _Rev._ Mr. Samuel Baker, _Residen. of St._ Paul’s.
  Mr George Baker
  Mr Francis Baker
  Mr Robert Baker
  Mr John Bakewell
  Anthony Balam, _Esq;_
  Charles Bale, _M. D._
  Mr Atwell, _Fellow of_ Exeter Coll. Oxon
  Mr Savage Atwood
  Mr John Atwood
  Mr James Audley
  _Sir_ Robert Austen, _Bart._
  _Sir_ John Austen
  Benjamin Avery, _L. L. D._
  Mr Balgay
  _Rev._ Mr Tho. Ball, _Prebendary of_ Chichester
  Mr Pappillon Ball, _Merchant_
  Mr Levy Ball
  _Rev._ Mr Jacob Ball, _of_ Andover
  _Rev._ Mr Edward Ballad, _of_ Trin. Coll. Cambridge
  Mr Baller
  John Bamber, _M. D._
  _Rev._ Mr Banyer, _Fellow of_ Emanuel Coll. Cambridge
  Mr Henry Banyer, _of_ Wisbech, _Surgeon_
  Mr John Barber, _Apothecary in_ Coventry
  Henry Steuart Barclay, _of_ Colairny, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Barclay, _Canon of_ Windsor
  Mr David Barclay
  Mr Benjamin Barker, _Bookseller in_ London
  ---- Barker, _Esq;_
  Mr Francis Barkstead
  _Rev._ Mr Barnard
  Thomas Barrett, _Esq;_
  Mr Barrett
  Richard Barret, _M. D._
  Mr Barrow, _Apothecary_
  William Barrowby, _M. D._
  Edward Barry, _M. D. of_ Corke
  Mr Humphrey Bartholomew, _of_ University College, Oxon
  Mr Benjamin Bartlett
  Mr Henry Bartlett
  Mr James Bartlett
  Mr Newton Barton, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  _Rev._ Mr. Barton
  William Barnsley, _Esq;_
  Mr Samuel Bateman
  Mr Thomas Bates
  Peter Barhurst, _Esq;_
  Mark Barr, _Esq;_
  Thomas Bast, _Esq;_
  Mr Batley, _Bookseller in_ London
  Mr Christopher Batt, _jun._
  Mr William Batt, _Apothecary_
  Rev. Mr Battely, _M. A. Student of_ Christ Church, Oxon
  Mr Edmund Baugh
  _Rev._ Mr. Thomas Bayes
  Edward Bayley, _M. D. of_ Havant
  John Bayley, _M. D. of_ Chichester
  Mr. Alexander Baynes, _Professor of Law in the University of_
        Edinburgh
  Mr Benjamin Beach
  Thomas Beacon, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Philip Bearcroft
  Mr Thomas Bearcroft
  Mr William Beachcroft
  Richard Beard, _M. D. of_ Worcester
  Mr Joseph Beasley
  _Rev._ Mr Beats, _M. A. Fellow of_ Magdalen College, Cambridge
  _Sir_ George Beaumont
  John Beaumont, _Esq; of_ Clapham
  William Beecher, _of_ Howberry, _Esq;_
  Mr Michael Beecher
  Mr Finney Beifield, _of the_ Inner-Temple
  Mr Benjamin Bell
  Mr Humphrey Bell
  Mr Phineas Bell
  Leonard Belt, _Gent._
  William Benbow, _Esq;_
  Mr Martin Bendall
  Mr George Bennet, _of_ Cork, _Bookseller_
  Rev. Mr Martin Benson, _Archdeacon of_ Berks
  Samuel Benson, _Esq;_
  William Benson, _Esq;_
  Rev. Richard Bently, _D. D. Master of_ Trinity Coll. Cambridge
  Thomas Bere, _Esq;_
  _The Hon._ John Berkley, _Esq;_
  Mr Maurice Berkley, sen. _Surgeon_
  John Bernard, _Esq;_
  Mr Charles Bernard
  Hugh Bethell, _of_ Rise _in_ Yorkshire, _Esq;_
  Hugh Bethell, _of_ Swindon _in_ Yorkshire, _Esq;_
  Mr Silvanus Bevan, _Apothecary_
  Mr Calverly Bewick, jun.
  Henry Bigg, _B. D._ Warden _of_ New College, Oxon
  _Sir_ William Billers
  ---- Billers, _Esq;_
  Mr John Billingsley
  Mr George Binckes
  _Rev._ Mr Birchinsha, _of_ Exeter College, Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Biscoe
  Mr Hawley Bishop, _Fellow of St._ John’s College, Oxon
  _Dr_ Bird, _of_ Reading
  Henry Blaake, _Esq;_
  Mr Henry Blaake
  _Rev._ Mr George Black
  Steward Blacker, _Esq;_
  William Blacker, _Esq;_
  Rowland Blackman, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Charles Blackmore, _of_ Worcester
  _Rev_ Mr Blackwall, _of_ Emanuel College, Cambridge
  Jonathan Blackwel, _Esq;_
  James Blackwood, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Blandford
  Arthur Blaney, _Esq;_
  Mr James Blew
  Mr William Blizard
  _Dr_ Blomer
  Mr Henry Blunt
  Mr Elias Bocket
  Mr Thomas Bocking
  Mr Charles Boehm, _Merchant_
  Mr William Bogdani
  Mr John Du Bois, _Merchant_
  Mr Samuel Du Bois
  Mr Joseph Bolton, of Londonderry, _Esq;_
  Mr John Bond
  John Bonithon, _M. A._
  Mr James Bonwick, _Bookseller in_ London
  Thomas Boone, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Pennystone, _M. A._
  Mrs Judith Booth
  Thomas Bootle, _Esq;_
  Thomas Borret, _Esq;_
  Mr Benjamin Boss
  _Dr_ Bostock
  Henry Bosville, _Esq;_
  Mr John Bosworth
  _Dr_ George Boulton
  _Hon._ Bourn _M. D. of_ Chesterfield
  Mrs Catherine Bovey
  Mr Humphrey Bowen
  Mr Bower
  John Bowes, _Esq;_
  William Bowles, _Esq;_
  Mr John Bowles
  Mr Thomas Bowles
  Mr Duvereux Bowly
  Duddington Bradeel, _Esq;_
  Rev. Mr James Bradley, _Professor of_ Astronomy, _in_ Oxford
  Mr Job Bradley, _Bookseller in_ Chesterfield
  _Rev._ Mr John Bradley
  _Rev._ Mr Bradshaw, _Fellow of_ Jesus College, Cambridge
  Mr Joseph Bradshaw
  Mr Thomas Blackshaw
  Mr Robert Bragge
  Champion Bramfield, _Esq;_
  Joseph Brand, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Brancker
  Mr Thomas Brand
  Mr Braxton
  _Capt._ David Braymer
  _Rev_ Mr Charles Brent, _of_ Bristol
  Mr William Brent
  Mr Edmund Bret
  John Brickdale, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr John Bridgen _A. M._
  Abraham Bridges, _Esq;_
  George Briggs, _Esq;_
  John Bridges, _Esq;_
  Brook Bridges, _Esq;_
  Orlando Bridgman, _Esq;_
  Mr Charles Bridgman
  Mr William Bridgman, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  _Sir_ Humphrey Briggs, _Bart._
  Robert Bristol, _Esq;_
  Mr Joseph Broad
  Peter Brooke, _of_ Meer, _Esq;_
  Mr Jacob Brook
  Mr Brooke, _of_ Oriel Coll. Oxon
  Mr Thomas Brookes
  Mr James Brooks
  William Brooks, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr William Brooks
  Stamp Brooksbank, _Esq;_
  Mr Murdock Broomer
  William Brown, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Brown, _of_ Norwich
  Mr William Brown, _of_ Hull
  Mrs Sarah Brown
  Mr John Browne
  Mr John Browning, _of_ Bristol
  Mr John Browning
  Noel Broxholme, _M. D._
  William Bryan, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Brydam
  Christopher Buckle, _Esq;_
  Samuel Buckley, _Esq;_
  Mr Budgen
  _Sir_ John Bull
  Josiah Bullock, _of_ Faulkbourn-Hall, Essex, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Bullock
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Bundy
  Mr Alexander Bunyan
  _Rev._ Mr D. Burges
  Ebenezer Burgess, _Esq;_
  Robert Burleston, _M. B._
  Gilbert Burnet, _Esq;_
  Thomas Burnet, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Gilbert Burnet
  _His Excellency_ Will. Burnet, _Esq;_ Governour _of_ New-York
  Mr Trafford Burnston, _of_ Trin. College, Cambridge
  Peter Burrel _Esq;_
  John Burridge, _Esq;_
  James Burrough, _Esq;_ Beadle _and Fellow of_ Caius Coll. Cambr.
  Mr Benjamin Burroughs
  Jeremiah Burroughs, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Joseph Burroughs
  Christopher Burrow, _Esq;_
  James Burrow, _Esq;_
  William Burrow, _A. M._
  Francis Burton, _Esq;_
  John Burton, _Esq;_
  Samuel Burton, _of_ Dublin, _Esq;_
  William Burton, _Esq;_
  Mr Burton.
  Richard Burton, _Esq;_
  _Dr_ Simon Burton
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Burton, _M.A. Fellow of_ Caius College, Cambridge
  John Bury, jun. _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Samuel Bury
  Mr William Bush
  _Rev._ Mr Samuel Butler
  Mr Joseph Button, _of_ Newcastle _upon_ Tyne
  _Hon._ Edward Byam, _Governour of_ Antigua
  Mr Edward Byam, _Merchant_
  Mr John Byrom
  Mr Duncumb Bristow, _Merch._
  Mr William Bradgate

  C

  _His Grace the_ Archbishop _of_ Canterbury
  _Right Hon. the Lord_ Chancellor
  _His Grace the_ Duke _of_ Chandois
  _The Right Hon. the Earl of_ Carlisle
  _Right Hon._ Earl Cowper
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Carlisle
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Chichester
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bish. of_ Clousert _in_ Ireland
  _Rt. Rev, Lord Bishop of_ Cloyne
  _Rt. Hon. Lord_ Clinton
  _Rt. Hon. Lord_ Chetwynd
  _Rt. Hon. Lord_ James Cavendish
  _The Hon. Lord_ Cardross
  _Rt. Hon. Lord_ Castlemain
  _Right Hon. Lord St._ Clare
  Cornelius Callaghan, _Esq;_
  Mr Charles Callaghan
  Felix Calvert, _of_ Allbury, _Esq;_
  Peter Calvert, _of_ Hunsdown _in_ Hertfordshire, _Esq;_
  Mr William Calvert _of_ Emanuel College, Cambridge
  _Reverend_ Mr John Cambden
  John Campbell, _of_ Stackpole-Court, _in the County of_ Pembroke,
        _Esq;_
  Mrs Campbell, _of_ Stackpole-Court
  Mrs. Elizabeth Caper
  Mr Dellillers Carbonel
  Mr John Carleton
  Mr Richard Carlton, _of_ Chesterfield
  Mr Nathaniel Carpenter
  Henry Carr, _Esq;_
  John Carr, _Esq;_
  John Carruthers, _Esq;_
  _Rev. Dr._ George Carter, _Provost of_ Oriel College
  Mr Samuel Carter
  _Honourable_ Edward Carteret, _Esq;_
  Robert Cartes, jun. _in_ Virginia, _Esq;_
  Mr William Cartlich
  James Maccartney, _Esq;_
  Mr Cartwright, _of_ Ainho
  Mr William Cartwright, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  _Reverend_ Mr William Cary, _of_ Bristol
  Mr Lyndford Caryl
  Mr John Case
  Mr John Castle
  _Reverend_ Mr Cattle
  _Hon._ William Cayley, _Consul at_ Cadiz, _Esq;_
  William Chambers, _Esq;_
  Mr Nehemiah Champion
  Mr Richard Champion
  Matthew Chandler, _Esq;_
  Mr George Channel
  Mr Channing
  Mr Joseph Chappell, _Attorney at_ Bristol
  Mr Rice Charlton, _Apothecary at_ Bristol
  St. John Charelton, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Charelton
  Mr Thomas Chase, _of_ Lisbon, _Merchant_
  Robert Chauncey, _M. D._
  Mr Peter Chauvel
  Patricius Chaworth, _of_ Ansley, _Esq;_
  Pole Chaworth _of the_ Inner Temple, _Esq;_
  Mr William Cheselden, _Surgeon to her Majesty_
  James Chetham, _Esq;_
  Mr James Chetham
  Charles Child, A. B. _of_ Clare-Hall, _in_ Cambridge, _Esq;_
  Mr Cholmely, _Gentleman Commoner of_ New-College, Oxon
  Thomas Church, _Esq;_
  _Reverend_ Mr St. Clair
  _Reverend_ Mr Matthew Clarke
  Mr William Clark
  Bartholomew Clarke, _Esq;_
  Charles Clarke, _of_ Lincolns-Inn, _Esq;_
  George Clarke, _Esq;_
  Samuel Clarke, _of the_ Inner-Temple, _Esq;_
  _Reverend_ Mr Alured Clarke, _Prebendary of_ Winchester
  _Rev._ John Clarke, _D. D. Dean of_ Sarum
  Mr John Clark, _A. B. of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Matthew Clarke, _M. D._
  _Rev._ Mr Renb. Clarke, _Rector of_ Norton, Leicestershire
  _Rev._ Mr Robert Clarke, _of_ Bristol
  _Rev._ Samuel Clarke, _D. D._
  Mr Thomas Clarke, _Merchant_
  Mr Thomas Clarke
  _Rev._ Mr Clarkson, _of_ Peter-House, Cambridge
  Mr Richard Clay
  William Clayton, _of_ Marden, _Esq;_
  Samuel Clayton, _Esq;_
  Mr William Clayton
  Mr John Clayton
  Mr Thomas Clegg
  Mr Richard Clements, _of_ Oxford, _Bookseller_
  Theophilus Clements, _Esq;_
  Mr George Clifford, _jun. of_ Amsterdam
  George Clitherow, _Esq;_
  George Clive, _Esq;_
  _Dr._ Clopton, _of_ Bury
  Stephen Clutterbuck, _Esq;_
  Henry Coape, _Esq;_
  Mr Nathaniel Coatsworth
  _Rev._ Dr. Cobden, _Chaplain to the Bishop of_ London
  _Hon. Col._ John Codrington, _of_ Wraxall, Somersetshire
  _Right Hon._ Marmaduke Coghill, _Esq;_
  Francis Coghlan, _Esq;_
  Sir Thomas Coke
  Mr Charles Colborn
  Benjamin Cole, _Gent._
  Dr Edward Cole
  Mr Christian Colebrandt
  James Colebrooke, _Esq;_
  Mr William Coleman, _Merchant_
  Mr Edward Collet
  Mrs Henrietta Collet
  Mr John Collet
  Mrs Mary Collett
  Mr Samuel Collet
  Mr Nathaniel Collier
  Anthony Collins, _Esq;_
  Thomas Collins, _of_ Greenwich, _M. D._
  Mr Peter Collinson
  Edward Colmore, _Fellow of_ Magdalen College, Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr John Colson
  Mrs Margaret Colstock, _of_ Chichester
  _Capt._ John Colvil
  Renè de la Combe, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr John Condor
  John Conduit, _Esq;_
  John Coningham, _M. D._
  _His Excellency_ William Conolly, _one of the Lords Justices of_
        Ireland
  Mr Edward Constable, _of_ Reading
  _Rev._ Mr Conybeare, _M. A._
  _Rev._ Mr James Cook
  Mr John Cooke
  Mr Benjamin Cook
  William Cook, _B L. of St._ John’s College, Oxon
  James Cooke, _Esq;_
  John Cooke, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Cooke
  Mr William Cooke, _Fellow of St._ John’s College, Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr Cooper, _of_ North-Hall
  Charles Cope, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Barclay Cope
  Mr John Copeland
  John Copland, _M. B._
  Godfrey Copley, _Esq;_
  Sir Richard Corbet, _Bar._
  _Rev._ Mr Francis Corbett
  Mr Paul Corbett
  Mr Thomas Corbet
  Henry Cornelisen, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr John Cornish
  Mrs Elizabeth Cornwall
  Library _of_ Corpus Christi College, Cambridge
  Mr William Cossley, _of_ Bristol, _Bookseller_
  Mr Solomon du Costa
  _Dr._ Henry Costard
  _Dr._ Cotes, _of_ Pomfret
  Caleb Cotesworth, _M. D._
  Peter Cottingham, _Esq;_
  Mr John Cottington
  _Sir_ John Hinde Cotton
  Mr James Coulter
  George Courthop, _of_ Whiligh _in_ Sussex, _Esq;_
  Mr Peter Courthope
  Mr John Coussmaker, _jun._
  Mr Henry Coward, _Merchant_
  Anthony Ashley Cowper, _Esq;_
  _The Hon._ Spencer Cowper, _Esq; One of the Justices of the Court of_
        Common Pleas
  Mr Edward Cowper
  _Rev._ Mr John Cowper
  _Sir_ Charles Cox
  Samuel Cox, _Esq;_
  Mr Cox, _of_ New Coll. Oxon
  Mr Thomas Cox
  Mr Thomas Cradock, _M. A._
  _Rev._ Mr John Craig
  _Rev._ Mr John Cranston, _Archdeacon of_ Cloghor
  John Crafter, _Esq;_
  Mr John Creech
  James Creed, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr William Crery
  John Crew, _of_ Crew Hall, _in_ Cheshire, _Esq;_
  Thomas Crisp, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Crispe
  _Rev._ Mr Samuel Cuswick
  Tobias Croft, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Mr John Crook
  _Rev._ Dr Crosse, _Master of_ Katherine Hall
  Christopher Crowe, _Esq;_
  George Crowl, _Esq;_
  _Hon._ Nathaniel Crump, _Esq; of_ Antigua
  Mrs Mary Cudworth
  Alexander Cunningham, _Esq;_
  Henry Cunningham, _Esq;_
  Mr Cunningham
  Dr Curtis _of_ Sevenoak
  Mr William Curtis
  Henry Curwen, _Esq;_
  Mr John Caswall, _of_ London, _Merchant_
  _Dr_ Jacob de Castro Sarmento


  D

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Devonshire
  _His Grace the Duke of_ Dorset
  _Right Rev. Ld. Bishop of_ Durham
  _Right Rev. Ld. Bishop of St._ David
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Delaware
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Digby
  _Right Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Derry
  _Right Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Donne
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Dromore
  _Right Hon._ Dalhn, _Lord Chief Baron of_ Ireland
  Mr Thomas Dade
  _Capt._ John Dagge
  Mr Timothy Dallowe
  Mr James Danzey, _Surgeon_
  _Rev. Dr_ Richard Daniel, _Dean of_ Armagh
  Mr Danvers
  _Sir_ Coniers Darcy, _Knight of the_ Bath
  Mr Serjeant Darnel
  Mr Joseph Dash
  Peter Davall, _Esq;_
  Henry Davenant, _Esq;_
  Davies Davenport, _of the_ Inner-Temple, _Esq;_
  _Sir_ Jermyn Davers, _Bart._
  _Capt._ Thomas Davers
  Alexander Davie, _Esq;_
  _Rev. Dr._ Davies, _Master of_ Queen’s College, Cambridge
  Mr John Davies, _of_ Christ-Church, Oxon
  Mr Davies, _Attorney at Law_
  Mr William Dawkins, _Merch._
  Rowland Dawkin, _of_ Glamorganshire, _Esq;_
  Mr John Dawson
  Edward Dawson, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Dawson
  William Dawsonne, _Esq;_
  Thomas Day, _Esq;_
  Mr John Day
  Mr Nathaniel Day
  Mr Deacon
  Mr William Deane
  Mr James Dearden, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Sir Matthew Deckers, _Bart._
  Edward Deering, _Esq;_
  Simon Degge, _Esq;_
  Mr Staunton Degge, _A. B. of_ Trinity Col. Cambridge
  _Rev. Dr_ Patrick Delaney
  Mr Delhammon
  _Rev._ Mr Denne
  Mr William Denne
  _Capt._ Jonathan Dennis
  Daniel Dering, _Esq;_
  Jacob Desboverie, _Esq;_
  Mr James Deverell, _Surgeon in_ Bristol
  _Rev._ Mr John Diaper
  Mr Rivers Dickenson
  _Dr._ George Dickens, _of_ Liverpool
  _Hon._ Edward Digby, _Esq;_
  Mr Dillingham
  Mr Thomas Dinely
  Mr Samuel Disney, _of_ Bennet College, Cambridge
  Robert Dixon, _Esq;_
  Pierce Dodd, _M. D._
  _Right Hon._ Geo. Doddinton, _Esq;_
  _Rev. Sir_ John Dolben, _of_ Findon, _Bart._
  Nehemiah Donellan, _Esq;_
  Paul Doranda, _Esq;_
  James Douglas, _M. D._
  Mr Richard Dovey, _A. B. of_ Wadham College, Oxon
  John Dowdal, _Esq;_
  William Mac Dowell, _Esq;_
  Mr Peter Downer
  Mr James Downes
  _Sir_ Francis Henry Drake, _Knt._
  William Drake, _of_ Barnoldswick-Cotes, _Esq;_
  Mr Rich. Drewett, _of_ Fareham
  Mr Christopher Drisfield, _of_ Christ-Church, Oxon
  Edmund Dris, _A. M. Fellow of_ Trinity Coll. Cambridge
  George Drummond, _Esq; Lord Provost of_ Edenburgh
  Mr Colin Drummond, _Professor of Philosophy in the University of_
        Edinburgh
  Henry Dry, _Esq;_
  Richard Ducane _Esq;_
  _Rev. Dr_ Paschal Ducasse, _Dean of_ Ferns
  George Ducket, _Esq;_
  Mr Daniel Dufresnay
  Mr Thomas Dugdale
  Mr Humphry Duncalfe, _Merchant_
  Mr James Duncan
  John Duncombe, _Esq;_
  Mr William Duncombe
  John Dundass, _jun. of_ Duddinstown, _Esq;_
  William Dunstar, _Esq;_
  James Dupont, _of_ Trinity Coll. Cambridge


  E

  _Right Rev. and Right Hon. Lord_ Erskine
  Theophilus, _Lord Bishop of_ Elphin
  Mr Thomas Eames
  _Rev._ Mr. Jabez Earle
  Mr William East
  _Sir_ Peter Eaton
  Mr John Eccleston
  James Eckerfall, _Esq;_
  —— Edgecumbe, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Edgley
  _Rev. Dr_ Edmundson, _President of_ St. John’s Coll. Cambridge
  Arthur Edwards, _Esq;_
  Thomas Edwards, _Esq;_
  Vigerus Edwards, _Esq;_
  _Capt._ Arthur Edwards
  Mr Edwards
  Mr William Elderton
  Mrs Elizabeth Elgar
  _Sir_ Gilbert Eliot, _of_ Minto, _Bart. one of the Lords of_ Session
  Mr John Elliot, _Merchant_
  George Ellis, _of_ Barbadoes, _Esq;_
  Mr John Ellison, _of_ Sheffield
  _Sir_ Richard Ellys, _Bart._
  Library _of_ Emanuel College, Cambridge
  Francis Emerson, _Gent._
  Thomas Emmerson, _Esq;_
  Mr Henry Emmet
  Mr John Emmet
  Thomas Empson, _of the_ Middle-Temple, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Engeir
  Mr Robert England
  Mr Nathaniel English
  _Rev._ Mr Ensly, _Minister of the_ Scotch Church _in_ Rotterdam
  John Essington, _Esq;
  Rev._ Mr Charles Este, _of_ Christ-Church, Oxon
  Mr Hugh Ethersey, _Apothecary_
  Henry Evans, _of_ Surry, _Esq;_
  Isaac Ewer, _Esq;_
  Mr Charles Ewer
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Exton
  _Sir_ John Eyles, _Bar._
  _Sir_ Joseph Eyles
  _Right Hon. Sir_ Robert Eyre, _Lord Chief Justice of the Common
        Pleas._
  Edward Eyre, _Esq;_
  Henry Samuel Eyre, _Esq;_
  Kingsmill Eyre, _Esq;_
  Mr Eyre


  F

  _Right Rev._ Josiah, _Lord Bishop of_ Fernes _and_ Loghlin
  Den Heer Fagel
  Mr Thomas Fairchild
  Thomas Fairfax, _of the_ Middle Temple, _Esq;_
  Mr John Falconer, _Merchant_
  Daniel Falkiner, _Esq;_
  Charles Farewell, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Farnaby, _of_ Merton College, Oxon
  Mr William Farrel
  James Farrel, _Esq;_
  Thomas Farrer, _Esq;_
  Dennis Farrer, _Esq;_
  John Farrington, _Esq;_
  Mr Faukener
  Mr Edward Faulkner
  Francis Fauquiere, _Esq;_
  Charles De la Fay, _Esq;_
  Thomas De lay Fay, _Esq;_
  _Capt._ Lewis De la Fay
  Nicholas Fazakerly, _Esq;_
  _Governour_ Feake
  Mr John Fell, _of_ Attercliffe
  Martyn Fellowes, _Esq;_
  Coston Fellows, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Fellows
  Mr Francis Fennell
  Mr Michael Fenwick
  John Ferdinand, _of the_ Inner-Temple, _Esq;_
  Mr James Ferne, _Surgeon_
  Mr John Ferrand, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Mr Daniel Mussaphia Fidalgo
  Mr Fidler
  _Hon._ Mrs Celia Fiennes
  _Hon. and Rev._ Mr. Finch, _Dean of_ York
  _Hon._ Edward Finch, _Esq;_
  Mr John Finch
  Philip Fincher _Esq;_
  Mr Michael Fitch, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Hon. John Fitz-Morris, _Esq;_
  Mr Fletcher
  Martin Folkes, _Esq;_
  _Dr_ Foot
  Mr Francis Forester
  John Forester, _Esq;_
  Mrs Alice Forth
  Mr John Forthe
  Mr Joseph Foskett
  Mr Edward Foster
  Mr Peter Foster
  Peter Foulkes, _D. D. Canon of_ Christ-Church, Oxon
  _Rev. Dr._ Robert Foulkes
  _Rev. Mr_ Robert Foulks, _M. A.  Fellow of_ Magdalen College,
        Cambridge
  Mr Abel Founereau, _Merchant_
  Mr Christopher Fowler
  Mr John Fowler, _of_ Northamp.
  Mr Joseph Fowler
  _Hon. Sir_ William Fownes, _Bar._
  George Fox, _Esq;_
  Edward Foy, _Esq;_
  _Rev. Dr._ Frankland, _Dean of_ Gloucester
  Frederick Frankland, _Esq;_
  Mr Joseph Franklin
  Mr Abraham Franks
  Thomas Frederick, _Esq; Gentleman Commoner of_ New College, Oxon
  Thomas Freeke, _Esq;_
  Mr Joseph Freame
  Richard Freeman, _Esq;_
  Mr Francis Freeman, _of_ Bristol
  Ralph Freke, _Esq;_
  Patrick French, _Esq;_
  Edward French, _M. D._
  _Dr._ Frewin
  John Freind, _M. D._
  Mr Thomas Frost
  Thomas Fry, _of_ Hanham, Gloucestershire, _Esq;_
  Mr Rowland Fry, _Merchant_
  Francis Fuljam, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Fuller, _Fellow of_ Emanuel College, Cambridge
  Mr John Fuller
  Thomas Fuller, _M. D._
  Mr William Fullwood, _of_ Huntingdon
  _Rev._ James Fynney, _D. D. Prebendary of_ Durham
  _Capt._ Fyshe
  Mr Francis Fayram, _Bookseller in_ London


  G

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Grafton
  _Right Hon. Earl of_ Godolphin
  _Right Hon. Lady_ Betty Germain
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Garlet
  _Right Rev. Bishop of_ Gloucester
  _Right Hon. Lord St._ George
  _Rt. Hon. Lord Chief Baron_ Gilbert
  Mr Jonathan Gale, _of_ Jamaica
  Roger Gale, _Esq;_
  _His Excellency Monsieur_ Galvao, _Envoy of_ Portugal
  James Gambier, _Esq;_
  Mr Joseph Gambol, _of_ Barbadoes
  Mr Joseph Gamonson
  Mr Henry Garbrand
  _Rev._ Mr Gardiner
  Mr Nathaniel Garland
  Mr Nathaniel Garland, _jun._
  Mr Joas Garland
  Mr James Garland
  Mrs Anne Garland
  Mr Edward Garlick
  Mr Alexander Garrett
  Mr John Gascoygne, _Merchant_
  _Rev. Dr_ Gasketh
  Mr Henry Gatham
  Mr John Gay
  Thomas Gearing, _Esq;_
  _Coll._ Gee
  Mr Edward Gee, _of_ Queen’s College, Cambridge
  Mr Joshua Gee, _sen._
  Mr Joshua Gee, _jun._
  Richard Fitz-Gerald, _of_ Gray’s-Inn, _Esq_
  Mr Thomas Gerrard
  Edward Gibbon, _Esq;_
  John Gibbon, _Esq;_
  Mr Harry Gibbs
  _Rev._ Mr Philip Gibbs
  Thomas Gibson, _Esq;_
  Mr John Gibson
  Mr Samuel Gideon
  _Rev. Dr_ Clandish Gilbert, _of_ Trinity College, Dublin
  Mr John Gilbert
  John Girardos, _Esq;_
  Mr John Girl, _Surgeon_
  _Rev._ Dr. Gilbert, _Dean of_ Exeter, 4 Books
  Mr Gisby, _Apothecary_
  Mr Richard Glanville
  John Glover, _Esq;_
  Mr John Glover, _Merchant_
  Mr Thomas Glover, _Merchant_
  John Goddard, _Merchant, in_ Rotterdam
  Peter Godfrey, _Esq;_
  Mr Joseph Godfrey
  _Capt._ John Godlee
  Joseph Godman, _Esq;_
  _Capt._ Harry Goff
  Mr Thomas Goldney
  Jonathan Goldsmyth, _M. D._
  _Rev._ Mr William Goldwin
  ---- Gooday, _Esq;_
  John Goodrick, _Esq; Fellow Commoner of_ Trinity Coll. Cambridge
  _Sir_ Henry Goodrick, _Bart._
  Mr Thomas Goodwin
  _Sir_ William Gordon, _Bar._
  _Right Hon. Sir_ Ralph Gore, _Bart._
  Arthur Gore, _Esq;_
  Mr Francis Gore
  Mr John Charles Goris
  Rev. Mr William Gosling, _M. A._
  William Goslin, _Esq;_
  Mr William Gossip, _A. B. of_ Trin. Coll. Cambridge
  John Gould, _jun. Esq;_
  Nathaniel Gould, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Gould
  _Rev._ Mr Gowan, _of_ Leyden
  Richard Graham, _jun. Esq;_
  Mr George Graham
  Mr Thomas Grainger
  Mr Walter Grainger
  Mr John Grant
  _Monsieur_ S’ Gravesande, _Professor of_ Astronomy _and_ Experim.
        Philosophy _in_ Leyden
  _Dr_ Gray
  Mr Charles Gray _of_ Colchester
  Mr John Greaves
  Mr Francis Green
  _Dr_ Green, _Professor of_ Physick _in_ Cambridge
  Samuel Green, _Gent._
  Mr George Green, _B. D._
  Mr Peter Green
  Mr Matthew Green
  Mr Nathaniel Green, _Apothecary_
  Mr Stephen Greenhill, _of_ Jesus College, Cambridge
  Mr Arthur Greenhill
  Mr Joseph Greenup
  Mr Randolph Greenway, _of_ Thavies Inn
  Mr Thomas Gregg, _of the_ Middle Temple
  Mr Gregory, _Profess. of_ Modern Hist. _in_ Oxon
  Mrs Katherine Gregory
  Samuel Gray, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Gray, _Merchant in_ Rotterdam
  Thomas Griffiths, _M. D._
  Mr Stephen Griggman
  Mr Renè Grillet
  Mr Richard Grimes
  Johannes Groeneveld, J. U. & _M. D. and_ Poliater Leidensis
  _Rev._ Mr Grosvenor
  Mr Richard Grosvenor
  Mr Joseph Grove, _Merchant_
  Mr John Henry Grutzman, _Merchant_
  Mathurin Guiznard, _Esq;_
  _Sir_ John Guise
  _Rev._ Mr John Guise
  Mr Ralph Gulston
  Matthew Gundry, _Esq;_
  Nathaniel Gundry, _Esq;_
  Mrs Sarah Gunston
  Charles Gunter Niccol, _Esq;_
  Thomas Gwillin, _Esq;_
  Marmaduke Gwynne, _Esq;_
  Roderick Gwynne, _Esq;_
  David Gausell, _Esq; of_ Leyton Grange
  Samuel Grey, _Esq;_
  Mr J. Grisson


  H.

  _Right Hon._ Earl _of_ Hertford
  _Rt. Hon. Ld._ Herbert, _of_ Cherbury
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Herbert
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Hervey
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Hunsdon
  John Haddon, _M. B. of_ Christ-Church, Oxon
  Mr Haines
  Mrs Mary Haines
  Edward Haistwell, _Esq;_
  Othniel Haggett, _of_ Barbadoes, _Esq;_
  Robert Hale, _Esq;_
  Mr Philip Hale
  Mr Charles Hallied
  Abraham Hall, _M. B._
  _Dr._ Hall
  Mr Henry Hall
  Mr Jonathan Hall
  Mr Matthew Hall
  Francis Hall, _Esq; of_ St. James’s Place
  _Rev._ Mr Hales
  William Hallet, _of_ Exeter, _M. D._
  Edmund Halley, _L. L. D._ Astro. Reg. & Profess. _of_ Modern Hist.
        _in_ Ox. Savilian.
  Edmund Hallsey, _Esq;_
  Mr John Hamerse
  John Hamilton, _Esq;_
  Andrew Hamilton, _Esq;_
  Rev. Andrew Hamilton, _D. D. Arch-Deacon of_ Raphoe
  Mr William Hamilton, _Professor of Divinity in the University of_
        Edinburgh
  Mr John Hamilton
  Mr Thomas Hammond, _Bookseller in_ York
  Mrs Martha Hammond
  Mr John Hand
  _Rev._ Mr Hand, _Fellow of_ Emanuel College, Cambridge
  Mr Samuel Handly
  Gabriel Hanger, _Esq;_
  James Hannott, _of_ Spittle-Fields, _Esq;_
  Mr Han Hankey
  Harbord Harbord, _of_ Gunton _in_ Norfolk, _Esq;_
  Richard Harcourt, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Hardey
  John Harding, _Esq;_
  Sir William Hardress, _Bar._
  Peter Hardwick, _M. D. of_ Bristol
  Mr Thomas Hardwick, _Attorney_
  _Rev._ Mr Jonathan Hardey
  Henry Hare, _Esq;_
  Mr Hare, _of_ Beckingham _in_ Kent
  Mr Mark Harford
  Mr Trueman Harford
  _Hon._ Edward Harley, _Esq;_
  _Capt._ Harlowe
  Mr Henry Harmage
  Mr Jeremiah Harman
  Henry Harrington, _Esq;_
  Barrows Harris, _Esq;_
  James Harris, _Esq;_
  William Harris, _of_ Sarum, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Dean Harris
  Mr Thomas Harris
  _Rev._ Mr Harris, _Professor of Modern History in_ Cambridge
  Mr Richard Harris
  Mrs Barbara Harrison
  Mr William Harrison
  _Rev._ Mr Henry Hart
  Mr Moses Hart
  _Sir_ John Hartop, _Bart._
  Mr Peter Harvey
  Henry Harwood, _Esq;_
  John Harwood, _L. D._
  Robert Prose Hassel, _Esq;_
  George Hatley, _Esq;_
  Mr William Havens
  _Capt._ John Hawkins
  Mr Mark Hawkins, _Surgeon_
  Mr Walter Hawksworth, _Merch._
  Mr Francis Hawling
  Mr John Huxley, _of_ Sheffield
  Mr Richard Hayden, _Merchant_
  Cherry Hayes, _M. A._
  Mr Thompson Hayne
  Mr Samuel Haynes
  Mr Thomas Haynes
  Mr John Hayward, _Surgeon_
  Mr Joseph Hayward, _of_ Madera, _Merchant_
  _Rev. Sir_ Francis Head, _Bart._
  James Head, _Esq;_
  Thomas Heames, _Esq;_
  Edmund Heath, _Esq;_
  Thomas Heath, _Esq;_
  Mr Benjamin Heath
  Cornelius Heathcote, _of_ Cutthoy, _M. D._
  Mr James Hamilton, _Merchant_
  Mr Thomas Hasleden
  _Sir_ Gilbert Heathcote
  John Heathcote, _Esq;_
  William Heathcote, _Esq;_
  Mr Abraham Heaton
  Anthony Heck, _Esq;_
  John Hedges, _Esq;_
  Mr Paul Heeger, jun. _Merch._
  Dr Richard Heisham
  Mr Jacob Henriques
  Mr John Herbert, _Apothecary in_ Coventry
  George Hepburn, _M. D. of_ Lynn-Regis
  Mr Samuel Herring
  Mr John Hetherington
  Mr Richard Hett, _Bookseller_
  Fitz Heugh, _Esq;_
  Hewer Edgley Hewer, _Esq;_
  Robert Heysham, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Heywood
  Mr John Heywood
  Mr Samuel Hibberdine
  Nathaniel Hickman, _M. A._
  Mr Samuel Hickman
  _Rev._ Mr Hiffe, _Schoolmaster at_ Kensington
  Mr Banger Higgens
  Mr Samuel Highland
  Mr Joseph Highmore
  Rev. Mr John Hildrop. _M. A. Master of the Free-School in_ Marlborough
  Mr Francis Hildyard, _Bookseller in_ York
  Mr Hilgrove
  Mr James Hilhouse
  John Hill, _Esq;_
  Mr John Hill
  Mr Rowland Hill, _of St._ John’s College, Cambridge
  Samuel Hill, _Esq;_
  Mr Humphrey Hill
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Hill
  Mr Peter St. Hill, _Surgeon_
  Mr William Hinchliff, _Bookseller_
  Mr Peter Hind
  Benjamin Hinde, _of the_ Inner-Temple, _Esq;_
  Robert Hinde, _Esq;_
  Mr Peter Hinde, _jun._
  _Rev._ Mr Dean Hinton
  Mr Robert Hirt
  _Capt._ Joseph Hiscox, _Merchant_
  Mr William Hoare
  Mr William Hobman
  _Sir_ Nathaniel Hodges
  Mr Hodges, _M. A. of_ Jesus College, Oxon
  Mr Joseph Jory Hodges
  Mr Hodgson, _Master of the_ Mathematicks _in_ Christ’s Hospital
  Mr Hodson
  Edward Hody, _M. D._
  Mr Thomas Hook
  Samuel Holden, _Esq;_
  Mr Adam Holden, _of_ Greenwich
  Rogers Holland, _Esq;_
  Mr James Holland, _Merchant_
  Richard Holland _M. D._
  John Hollings, _M. D._
  Mr Thomas Hollis
  Mr John Hollister
  Mr Edward Holloway
  Mr Thomas Holmes
  _Rev._ Mr Holmes, _Fellow of_ Emanuel College, Cambridge
  _Rev._ Mr Samuel Holt
  Matthew Holworthy, _Esq;_
  Mr John Hook
  Mr Le Hook
  Mrs Elizabeth Hooke
  John Hooker, _Esq;_
  Mr John Hoole
  Mr Samuel Hoole
  Mr Thomas Hope
  Thomas Hopgood, _Gent._
  _Sir_ Richard Hopkins
  Richard Hopwood, _M. D._
  Mr Henry Horne
  _Rev._ Mr John Horseley
  Samuel Horseman, _M. D._
  Mr Stephen Horseman
  Mr Thomas Houghton
  Mr Thomas Houlding
  James How, _Esq;_
  John How, _of_ Hans Cope, _Esq;_
  Mr John Howe
  Mr Richard How
  _Hon._ Edward Howard, _Esq;_
  William Howard, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Dean Robert Howard
  Thomas Hucks, _Esq;_
  Mr Hudsford, _of_ Trinity Coll.  Oxon
  _Capt._ Robert Hudson, _jun._
  Mr John Hughes
  Edward Hulse, _M. D._
  _Sir_ Gustavus Humes
  _Rev._ Mr David Humphreys, _S. T. B. Fellow of_ Trin. Coll. Cambridge
  Maurice Hunt, _Esq;_
  Mr Hunt, _of_ Hart-Hall, Oxon
  Mr John Hunt
  James Hunter, _Esq;_
  Mr William Hunter
  Mr John Hussey, _of_ Sheffield
  Ignatius Hussey, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Christopher Hussey, _M. A. Rector of_ West-Wickham _in_ Kent
  Thomas Hutchinson, _Esq; Fellow Commoner of_ Sidney-College, Cambridge
  _Rev._ Mr Hutchinson, _of_ Hart-Hall, Oxon
  Mr Sandys Hutchinson, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Mr Huxley, _M. A. of_ Brazen Nose College, Oxon
  Mr Thomas Hyam, _Merchant_
  Mr John Hyde
  Mr Hyett, _Gent. Commoner of_ Pembroke College, Oxon


  I

  _Right Hon. the_ Earl _of_ Ilay
  Edward Jackson, _Esq;_
  Mr Stephen Jackson, _Merchant_
  Mr Cuthbert Jackson
  _Rev._ Mr. Peter Jackson
  Mr Joshua Jackson
  John Jacob, _Esq;_
  Mr Jacobens
  Joseph Jackson, _of_ London, _Goldsmith_
  _Rev. Sir_ George Jacobs, _of_ Houghton _in_ Norfolk
  Mr Henry Jacomb
  Mr John Jacques, _Apothecary in_ Coventry
  Mr Samuel Jacques, _Surgeon at_ Uxbridge
  William James, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr David James, _Rector of_ Wroughton, Bucks
  Mr Benjamin James
  Mr Robert James, _of St._ John’s, Oxon
  _Sir_ Theodore Janssen, _Bart._
  Mr John Jarvis, _Surgeon at_ Dartford _in_ Kent
  Mr Edward Jasper
  Edward Jauncy, _of the Middle-Temple Esq;_
  Rev. Dr Richard Ibbetson
  John Idle, _of the_ Middle Temple, _Esq;_
  Mr Samuel Jeake
  Mr Samuel Jebb
  Mr David Jefferies
  Rev. Mr Joseph Jefferies
  Bartholomew Jeffrey, _of the_ Middle Temple, _Esq;_
  Edward Jeffries, _Esq;_
  _Lady_ Jekyll
  Ralph Jenison, _Esq;_ 2 Books
  David Jenkins, _L. L. D. Chancellor of_ Derry
  Mr Jenkins
  Mr Samuel Jennings, _of_ Hull
  Library _of_ Jesus Coll. Cambridge
  John Ingilby, _Esq;_
  Martin Innys, _of_ Bristol, _Gent._
  _Messieurs_ William _and_ John Innys _of_ London, _Booksellers_
  Thomas Jobber, _Esq;_
  Robert Jocelyn, _Esq;_
  Rev. Mr Samuel Jocham
  Oliver St. John, _Esq;_
  George Johnson, _Esq;_
  _Hon._ James Johnson, _Esq;_
  James Jurin, _M. D._
  _Rev._ Mr Rob. Johnson. _S. T. B. Fellow of_ Trinity College,
  Cambridge
  Mr Isaac Johnson
  Mr Michael Johnson, _Merchant in_ Rotterdam
  Edward Jones, _Esq; Chancellor of the Diocese of St._ David’s
  Mr Jones, _M. A. of_ Jesus College, Oxon
  Mr Jacob Jones
  _Rev._ Mr James Jones, _Rector of_ Cound, Salop
  Mr Somerset Jones, _A. B. of_ Christ-Church, Oxon
  Mr John Jones, _Surgeon_
  Mr John Jope, _Fellow of_ New College, Oxon
  Charles Joy, _Esq;_
  Daniel Ivie, _Esq; of_ Chelsea Hospital


  K

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Kingston
  _Right Honourable_ Gerrard, _Lord Viscount_ Kingsale
  _Right Reverend Lord Bishop of_ Killale
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Killdare
  _Right Reverend Lord Bishop of_ Killmore
  _Rev._ Mr William Kay, _Rector of_ Wigginton, Yorkshire
  Benjamin Keene, _Esq;_
  _Hon. Major General_ Kellum
  Mr Thomas Kemp, _M. A of St._ John’s College, Oxon
  Mr Robert Kendall
  Mr Clayton Kendrick
  John Kendrick, _Esq;_
  John Kemp, _of the_ Middle Temple, _Esq;_
  Mr Chidrock Kent
  Samuel Kent, _Esq;_
  _Rev_ Mr Samuel Kerrick, _Fellow of_ Christ Church College,
  Cambridge.
  Mr Kidbey
  Mr Robert Kidd
  _Library of_ King’s College, Cambridge
  Benjamin King, _of_ Antigua, _Esq;_
  Mr Matthias King
  Mrs Jane King
  _Hon. Colonel_ Pearcy Kirke
  Mr Thomas Knap
  _Rev._ Samuel Knight, _D. D. Prebendary of_ Ely
  Mr Robert Knight, _jun._
  Francis Knowllyes, _Esq;_
  Mr Ralph Knox


  L

  _Rt. Hon. Lord Viscount_ Lonsdale
  _Rt. Hon. Ld. Viscount_ Lymington
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of_ London
  _Right Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Landaff
  _Right Honourable Lord_ Lyn
  John Lade, _Esq;_
  Mr Hugh Langharne
  Mr John Langford
  Mr William Larkman
  Mr William Lambe, _of_ Exeter College, Oxon
  Richard Langley, _Esq;_
  Mr Robert Lacy
  James Lamb, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Lambert, _M. A. Vicar of_ Ledburgh, Yorkshire
  Mr Daniel Lambert
  Mr John Lampe
  Dr. Lane, _of_ Hitchin _in_ Hertfordshire
  Mr Timothy Lane
  _Rev._ Dr. Laney, _Master of_ Pembroke Hall, Cambr. 2 Books
  Mr Peter de Langley
  _Rev._ Mr Nathaniel Lardner
  Mr Larnoul
  Mr Henry Lascelles, _of_ Barbadoes, _Merchant_
  _Rev._ Mr John Laurence, _Rector of_ Bishop’s Waremouth
  Mr Roger Laurence, _M. A._
  Mr Lavington
  Mr William Law, _Professor of_ Moral Philosophy _in the University of_
        Edinburgh
  Mr John Lawton, _of the_ Excise-Office
  Mr Godfrey Laycock, _of_ Hallifax
  Mr Charles Leadbetter, _Teacher of the_ Mathematicks
  Mr James Leake, _Bookseller in_ Bath
  Stephen Martin Leak, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Lechmere
  William Lee, _Esq;_
  Mr Lee, _of_ Christ Church, Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr John Lee
  Mr William Leek
  _Rev._ Mr Leeson
  Peter Legh, _of_ Lyme _in_ Cheshire, _Esq;_
  Robert Leguarre, _of_ Gray’s-Inn, _Esq_;
  Mr Lehunt
  Mr John Lehunt, _of_ Canterbury
  Francis Leigh, _Esq_;
  Mr John Leigh
  Mr Percival Lewis
  Mr Thomas Lewis
  New College Library
  _Sir_ Henry Liddell, _Bar. of St._ Peter’s College, Cambridge
  Henry Liddell, _Esq_;
  Mr William Limbery
  Robert Lindsay, _Esq_;
  _Countess of_ Lippe
  _Rev. Dr._ James Lisle
  _Rev. Mr_ Lister
  Mr George Livingstone, _One of the Clerks of_ Session
  Salisbury Lloyd, _Esq_;
  _Rev._ Mr John Lloyd, _A. B. of_ Jesus College
  Mr Nathaniel Lloyd, _Merchant_
  Mr Samuel Lobb, _Bookseller at_ Chelmsford
  William Lock, _Esq_;
  Mr James Lock, 2 Books
  Mr Joshua Locke
  Charles Lockier, _Esq_;
  Richard Lockwood, _Esq_;
  Mr Bartholom. Loftus, 9 Books
  William Logan, _M. D._
  Mr Moses Loman, _jun._
  Mr Longley
  Mr Benjamin Longuet
  Mr Grey Longueville
  Mr Robert Lord
  Mrs Mary Lord
  Mr Benjamin Lorkin
  Mr William Loup
  Richard Love, _of_ Basing _in_ Hants, _Esq_;
  Mrs Love, _in_ Laurence-Lane
  Mr Joshua Lover, _of_ Chichester
  William Lowndes, _Esq_;
  Charles Lowndes, _Esq_;
  Mr Cornelius Lloyd
  Robert Lucas, _Esq_;
  _Coll._ Richard Lucas
  _Sir_ Bartlet Lucy
  Edward Luckin, _Esq_;
  Mr John Ludbey
  Mr Luders, _Merchant_
  Lambert Ludlow, _Esq_;
  William Ludlow, _Esq_;
  Peter Ludlow, _Esq_;
  John Lupton, _Esq_;
  Nicholas Luke, _Esq_;
  Lyonel Lyde, _Esq_;
  _Dr._ George Lynch
  Mr Joshua Lyons


  M.

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Montague
  _His Grace the Duke of_ Montrosse
  _His Grace the Duke of_ Manchester
  _The Rt. Hon. Lord Viscount_ Molesworth
  _The Rt. Hon. Lord_ Mansel
  _The Rt. Hon. Ld._ Micklethwait
  _The Rt. Rev. Ld. Bishop of_ Meath
  Mr Mace
  Mr Joseph Macham, _Merchant_
  Mr John Machin, _Professor of_ Astronomy _in_ Gresham College
  Mr Mackay
  Mr Mackelcan
  William Mackinen, _of_ Antigua, _Esq_;
  Mr Colin Mac Laurin, _Professor of the_ Mathematicks _in the
        University of_ Edinburgh
  Galatius Macmahon, _Esq_;
  Mr Madox, _Apothecary_
  _Rev._ Mr Isaac Madox, _Prebendary of_ Chichester
  Henry Mainwaring, _of_ Over-Peover _in_ Cheshire, _Esq_;
  Mr Robert Mainwaring, _of_ London, _Merchant_
  _Capt._ John Maitland
  Mr Cecil Malcher
  Sydenham Mallhust, _Esq_;
  Richard Malone, _Esq_;
  Mr Thomas Malyn
  Mr John Mann
  Mr William Man
  _Dr._ Manaton
  Mr John Mande
  _Dr._ Bernard Mandeville
  Mr James Mandy
  _Rev._ Mr Bellingham Manleveror, _M. A. Rector of_ Mahera
  Isaac Manley, _Esq_;
  Thomas Manley, _of the_ Inner-Temple, _Esq_;
  Mr John Manley
  Mr William Manley
  Mr Benjamin Manning
  Rawleigh Mansel, _Esq_;
  Henry March, _Esq_;
  Mr John Marke
  _Sir_ George Markham
  Mr John Markham, _Apothecary_
  Mr William Markes
  Mr James Markwick
  _Hon._ Thomas Marley, _Esq; one of his Majesty’s Sollicitors general
        of_ Ireland
  _Rev._ Mr George Marley
  Mr Benjamin Marriot, _of the Exchequer_
  John Marsh, _Esq_;
  Mr Samuel Marsh
  Robert Marshall, _Esq; Recorder of_ Clonmell
  _Rev._ Mr Henry Marshall
  _Rev._ Nathaniel Marshall, _D. D. Canon of_ Windsor
  Matthew Martin, _Esq_;
  Thomas Martin, _Esq_;
  Mr John Martin
  Mr James Martin
  Mr Josiah Martin
  _Coll._ Samuel Martin, _of_ Antigua
  John Mason, _Esq_;
  Mr John Mason, _of_ Greenwich
  Mr Charles Mason, _M. A. Fell.  of_ Trin. Coll. Cambridge
  Mr Cornelius Mason
  _Dr._ Richard Middleton Massey
  Mr Masterman
  Robert Mather, _of the_ Middle-Temple, _Esq_;
  Mr William Mathews
  Rev. Mr Mathew
  Mr John Matthews
  Mrs Hester Lumbroso de Mattos
  _Rev. Dr._ Peter Maturin, _Dean of_ Killala
  William Maubry, _Esq_;
  Mr Gamaliel Maud
  _Rev._ Mr Peter Maurice, _Treasurer of the Ch. of_ Bangor
  Henry Maxwell, _Esq_;
  John Maxwell, _jun. of_ Pollock, _Esq_;
  _Rev._ Dr. Robert Maxwell, _of_ Fellow’s Hall, Ireland
  Mr May
  Mr Thomas Mayleigh
  Thomas Maylin, _jun. Esq_;
  _Hon._ Charles Maynard, _Esq_;
  Thomas Maynard, _Esq_;
  _Dr._ Richard Mayo
  Mr Samuel Mayo
  Samuel Mead, _Esq_;
  Richard Mead, _M. D._
  _Rev._ Mr Meadowcourt
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Meadowcourt, _Fellow of_ Merton Coll. Oxon
  Mr Mearson
  Mr George Medcalfe
  Mr David Medley, 3 Books
  Charles Medlycott, _Esq;_
  _Sir_ Robert Menzies, _of_ Weem, _Bart._
  Mr Thomas Mercer, _Merchant_
  John Merrill, _Esq;_
  Mr Francis Merrit
  _Dr._ Mertins
  Mr John Henry Mertins
  _Library of_ Merton College
  Mr William Messe, Apothecary
  Mr Metcalf
  Mr Thomas Metcalf, _of_ Trinity Coll. Cambridge
  Mr Abraham Meure, _of_ Leatherhead in Surrey
  Mr John Mac Farlane
  _Dr._ John Michel
  _Dr._ Robert Michel, _of_ Blandford
  Mr Robert Michell
  Nathaniel Micklethwait, _Esq;_
  Mr Jonathan Micklethwait, _Merchant_
  Mr John Midford, _Merchant_
  Mr Midgley
  _Rev._ Mr Miller, 2 Books
  _Rev._ Mr Milling, _of_ the Hague
  _Rev._ Mr Benjamin Mills
  _Rev._ Mr Henry Mills, _Rector of_ Meastham, _Head-Master of_
        Croyden-School
  Thomas Milner, _Esq;_
  Charles Milner, _M. D._
  Mr William Mingay
  John Misaubin, _M. D._
  Mrs Frances Mitchel
  David Mitchell, _Esq;_
  Mr John Mitton
  Mr Abraham de Moivre
  John Monchton, _Esq;_
  Mr John Monk, _Apothecary_
  J. Monro, _M. D._
  _Sir_ William Monson, _Bart._
  Edward Montagu, _Esq;_
  Colonel John Montagu
  _Rev._ John Montague, _Dean of_ Durham, _D. D._
  Mr Francis Moor
  Mr Jarvis Moore
  Mr Richard Moore, _of_ Hull, 3 Books
  Mr William Moore
  _Sir_ Charles Mordaunt, _of_ Walton, _in_ Warwickshire
  Mr Mordant, _Gentleman Commoner of_ New College, Oxon
  Charles Morgan, _Esq;_
  Francis Morgan, _Esq;_
  Morgan Morgan, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr William Morland, _Fell. of_ Trin. Coll. Cambr. 2 Books
  Thomas Morgan, _M. D._
  Mr John Morgan, _of_ Bristol
  Mr Benjamin Morgan, _High-Master of_ St. Paul’s-School
  _Hon. Coll._ Val. Morris, _of_ Antigua
  Mr Gael Morris
  Mr John Morse, _of_ Bristol
  Hon. Ducey Morton, _Esq;_
  Mr Motte
  Mr William Mount
  _Coll._ Moyser
  _Dr._ Edward Mullins
  Mr Joseph Murden
  Mr Mustapha
  Robert Myddleton, _Esq;_
  Robert Myhil, _Esq;_

  N

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Newcastle
  _Rt. Rev. Ld. Bishop of_ Norwich
  Stephen Napleton, _M. D._
  Mr Robert Nash, _M. A. Fellow of_ Wadham College, Oxon
  Mr Theophilus Firmin Nash
  _Dr._ David Natto
  Mr Anthony Neal
  Mr Henry Neal, _of_ Bristol
  Hampson Nedham, _Esq; Gentleman Commoner of_ Christ Church Oxon
  _Rev. Dr._ Newcome, _Senior-Fellow of St._ John’s College, Cambridge,
        6 Books
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Newcome
  Mr Henry Newcome
  Mr Newland
  _Rev._ Mr John Newey, _Dean of_ Chichester
  Mr Benjamin Newington, _M. A._
  John Newington, _M. B. of_ Greenwich in Kent
  Mr Samuel Newman
  Mrs Anne Newnham
  Mr Nathaniel Newnham, _sen._
  Mr Nathaniel Newnham, _jun._
  Mr Thomas Newnham
  Mrs Catherine Newnham
  _Sir_ Isaac Newton, 12 Books
  _Sir_ Michael Newton
  Mr Newton
  William Nicholas, _Esq;_
  John Nicholas, _Esq;_
  John Niccol, _Esq;_
  _General_ Nicholson
  Mr Samuel Nicholson
  John Nicholson, _M. A. Rector of_ Donaghmore
  Mr Josias Nicholson, 3 Books
  Mr James Nimmo, _Merchant of_ Edinburgh
  David Nixon, _Esq;_
  Mr George Noble
  Stephen Noquiez, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Norman, _Bookseller at_ Lewes
  Mr Anthony Norris
  Mr Henry Norris
  _Rev._ Mr Edward Norton
  Richard Nutley, _Esq;_
  Mr John Nutt, _Merchant_


  O

  _Right Hon. Lord_ Orrery
  _Rev._ Mr John Oakes
  Mr William Ockenden
  Mr Elias Ockenden
  Mr Oddie
  Crew Offley, _Esq;_
  Joseph Offley, _Esq;_
  William Ogbourne, _Esq;_
  _Sir_ William Ogbourne
  James Oglethorp, _Esq;_
  Mr William Okey
  John Oldfield, _M. D._
  Nathaniel Oldham, _Esq;_
  William Oliver, _M. D. of_ Bath
  John Olmins, _Esq;_
  Arthur Onslow, _Esq;_
  Paul Orchard, _Esq;_
  Robert Ord, _Esq;_
  John Orlebar, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr George Osborne
  _Rev._ Mr John Henry Ott
  Mr James Ottey
  Mr Jan. Oudam, _Merchant at_ Rotterdam
  Mr Overall
  John Overbury, _Esq;_
  Mr Charles Overing
  Mr Thomas Owen
  Charles Owsley, _Esq;_
  Mr John Owen
  Mr Thomas Oyles


  P

  _Right Hon. Countess of_ Pembroke, 10 Books
  _Right Hon. Lord_ Paisley
  _Right Hon. Lady_ Paisley
  _The Right Hon. Lord_ Parker
  Christopher Pack, _M. D._
  Mr Samuel Parker, _Merchant at_ Bristol
  Mr Thomas Page, _Surgeon at_ Bristol
  _Sir_ Gregory Page, _Bar._
  William Palgrave, _M. D, Fellow of_ Caius Coll. Cambridge
  William Pallister, _Esq;_
  Thomas Palmer, _Esq;_
  Samuel Palmer, _Esq;_
  Henry Palmer, _Merchant_
  Mr John Palmer, _of_ Coventry
  Mr Samuel Palmer, _Surgeon_
  William Parker, _Esq;_
  Edmund Parker, _Gent._
  _Rev._ Mr Henry Parker, _M. A._
  Mr John Parker
  Mr Samuel Parkes, _of Fort St._ George _in_ East-India
  Mr Daniel Parminter
  Mr Parolet, _Attorney_
  _Rev._ Thomas Parn, _Fellow of_ Trin. Coll. Cambr. 2 Books
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Parne, _Fellow of_ Trin. Coll. Cambridge
  _Rev._ Mr Henry Parratt, _M. A. Rector of_ Holywell _in_
        Huntingtonshire
  Thomas Parratt, _M. D._
  Stannier Parrot, _Gent._
  _Right Hon._ Benjamin Parry, _Esq;_
  Mr Parry, _of_ Jesus Coll. Oxon _B. D._
  Robert Paul, _of_ Gray’s-Inn, _Esq;_
  Mr Josiah Paul, _Surgeon_
  Mr Paulin
  Robert Paunceforte, _Esq;_
  Edward Pawlet, _of_ Hinton St. George, _Esq;_
  Mr Henry Pawson, _of_ York, _Merchant_
  Mr Payne
  Mr Samuel Peach
  Mr Marmaduke Peacock, _Merchant in_ Rotterdam
  Flavell Peake, _Esq;_
  _Capt._ Edward Pearce
  _Rev._ Zachary Pearce, _D. D._
  James Pearse, _Esq;_
  Thomas Pearson, _Esq;_
  John Peers, _Esq;_
  Mr Samuel Pegg, _of St._ John’s College, Cambridge
  Mr Peirce, _Surgeon at_ Bath
  Mr Adam Peirce
  Harry Pelham, _Esq;_
  James Pelham, _Esq;_
  Jeremy Pemberton, _of the_ Inner-Temple, _Esq;_
  _Library of_ Pembroke-Hall, Camb.
  Mr Thomas Penn
  Philip Pendock, _Esq;_
  Edward Pennant, _Esq;_
  _Capt._ Philip Pennington
  Mr Thomas Penny
  Mr Henry Penton
  Mr Francis Penwarne, _at_ Liskead _in_ Cornwall
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Penwarne
  Mr John Percevall
  _Rev._ Mr Edward Percevall
  Mr Joseph Percevall
  _Rev. Dr._ Perkins, _Prebend. of_ Ely
  Mr Farewell Perry
  Mr James Petit
  Mr John Petit, _of_ Aldgate
  Mr John Petit, _of_ Nicholas Lane
  Mr John Petitt, _of_ Thames-Street
  _Honourable Coll._ Pettit, _of_ Eltham _in_ Kent
  Mr Henry Peyton, _of St._ John’s College, Cambridge
  Daniel Phillips, _M. D._
  John Phillips, _Esq;_
  Thomas Phillips, _Esq;_
  Mr Gravet Phillips
  William Phillips, _of_ Swanzey, _Esq;_
  Mr Buckley Phillips
  John Phillipson, _Esq;_
  William Phipps, _L. L. D._
  Mr Thomas Phipps, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  _The_ Physiological _Library in the College of_ Edinburgh
  Mr Pichard
  Mr William Pickard
  Mr John Pickering
  Robert Pigott, _of_ Chesterton, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Pike
  Henry Pinfield, _of_ Hampstead, _Esq;_
  Charles Pinfold, _L. L. D._
  _Rev._ Mr. Pit, _of_ Exeter College, Oxon
  Mr Andrew Pitt
  Mr Francis Place
  Thomas Player, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Plimly
  Mr William Plomer
  William Plummer, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Plumpton
  John Plumptre, _Esq;_
  Fitz-Williams Plumptre, _M. D._
  Henry Plumptre, _M. D._
  John Pollen, _Esq;_
  Mr Joshua Pocock
  Francis Pole, _of_ Park-Hall, _Esq;_
  Mr Isaac Polock
  Mr Benjamin Pomfret
  Mr Thomas Pool, _Apothecary_
  Alexander Pope, _Esq;_
  Mr Arthur Pond
  Mr Thomas Port
  Mr John Porter
  Mr Joseph Porter
  Mr Thomas Potter, _of St._ John’s College, Oxon
  Mr John Powel
  ---- Powis, _Esq;_
  Mr Daniel Powle
  John Prat, _Esq;_
  Mr James Pratt
  Mr Joseph Pratt
  Mr Samuel Pratt
  Mr Preston, _City-Remembrancer_
  Capt. John Price
  _Rev._ Mr Samuel Price
  Mr Nathaniel Primat
  Dr. John Pringle
  Thomas Prior, _Esq;_
  Mr Henry Proctor, _Apothecary_
  _Sir_ John Pryse, _of_ Newton Hill _in_ Montgomeryshire
  Mr Thomas Purcas
  Mr Robert Purse
  Mr John Putland
  George Pye, _M. D._
  Samuel Pye, _M. D._
  Mr Samuel Pye, _Surgeon at_ Bristol
  Mr Edmund Pyle, _of_ Lynn
  Mr John Pine, _Engraver_

  Q.

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Queenborough
  _Rev._ Mr. Question, _M. A. of_ Exeter College, Oxon
  Jeremiah Quare, _Merchant_

  R.

  _His Grace the Duke of_ Richmond
  _The Rt. Rev. Ld. Bishop of_ Raphoe
  _The Rt. Hon. Lord_ John Russel
  _Rev._ Mr Walter Rainstorp, _of_ Bristol
  Mr John Ranby, _Surgeon_
  _Rev._ Mr Rand
  Mr Richard Randall
  _Rev._ Mr Herbert Randolph, _M.A._
  Moses Raper, _Esq;_
  Matthew Raper, _Esq;_
  Mr William Rastrick, _of_ Lynne
  Mr Ratcliffe, _M. A. of_ Pembroke College, Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr John Ratcliffe
  Anthony Ravell, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Rawlins
  Mr Robert Rawlinson _A. B. of_ Trinity College, Cambr.
  Mr Walter Ray
  _Coll._ Hugh Raymond
  _Rt. Hon. Sir_ Robert Raymond, _Lord Chief Justice of the_
        King’s-Bench
  Mr Alexander Raymond
  Samuel Read, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr James Read
  Mr John Read, _Merchant_
  Mr William Read, _Merchant_
  Mr Samuel Read
  Mrs Mary Reade
  Mr Thomas Reddall
  Mr Andrew Reid
  Felix Renolds, _Esq;_
  John Renton, _of_ Christ-Church, _Esq;_
  Leonard Reresby, _Esq;_
  Thomas Reve, _Esq;_
  Mr Gabriel Reve
  William Reeves, _Merch. of_ Bristol
  Mr Richard Reynell, _Apothecary_
  Mr John Reynolds
  Mr Richard Ricards
  John Rich, _of_ Bristol, _Esq;_
  Francis Richards, _M. B._
  _Rev._ Mr Escourt Richards, _Prebend. of_ Wells
  _Rev._ Mr Richards, _Rector of_ Llanvyllin, _in_ Montgomeryshire
  William Richardson, _of_ Smally _in_ Derbyshire, _Esq;_
  Mr Richard Richardson
  Mr Thomas Richardson, _Apothecary_
  Edward Richier, _Esq;_
  Dudley Rider, _Esq;_
  Richard Rigby, _M. D._
  Edward Riggs, _Esq;_
  Thomas Ripley, _Esq. Comptroller of his Majesty’s Works_
  _Sir_ Thomas Roberts, _Bart._
  Richard Roberts, _Esq;_
  _Capt._ John Roberts
  Thomas Robinson, _Esq;_
  Matthew Robinson, _Esq;_
  Tancred Robinson, _M. D._
  Nicholas Robinson, _M. D._
  Christopher Robinson, _of_ Sheffield, _A. M._
  Mr Henry Robinson
  Mr William Robinson
  Mrs Elizabeth Robinson
  John Rochfort, _Esq;_
  Mr Rodrigues
  Mr Rocke
  _Sir_ John Rodes, _Bart._
  Mr Francis Rogers
  _Rev._ Mr Sam. Rogers, _of_ Bristol
  John Rogerson, _Esq; his Majesty’s General of_ Ireland
  Edmund Rolfe, _Esq;_
  Henry Roll, _Esq; Gent. Comm. of_ New College, Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr Samuel Rolleston, _Fell. of_ Merton College, Oxon
  Lancelot Rolleston, _of_ Wattnal, _Esq;_
  Philip Ronayne, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr de la Roque
  Mr Benjamin Rosewell, _jun._
  Joseph Rothery, _M. A. Arch-Deacon of_ Derry
  Guy Roussignac, _M. D._
  Mr James Round
  Mr William Roundell, _of_ Christ Church, Oxon
  Mr Rouse, _Merchant_
  Cuthbert Routh, _Esq;_
  John Rowe, _Esq;_
  Mr John Rowe
  _Dr._ Rowel, _of_ Amsterdam
  John Rudge, _Esq;_
  Mr James Ruck
  _Rev. Dr._ Rundle, _Prebendary of_ Durham
  Mr John Rust
  John Rustatt, _Gent._
  Mr Zachias Ruth
  William Rutty, _M. D. Secretary of the Royal Society_
  Maltis Ryall, _Esq;_

  S

  _His Grace the Duke of St._ Albans
  _Rt. Hon. Earl of_ Sunderland
  _Rt. Hon. Earl of_ Scarborough
  _Rt. Rev. Ld. Bp. of_ Salisbury
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of St._ Asaph
  _Rt. Hon._ Thomas _Lord_ Southwell
  _Rt. Hon. Lord_ Sidney
  _Rt. Hon. Lord_ Shaftsbury
  _The Rt. Hon. Lord_ Shelburn
  _His Excellency Baron_ Sollenthal, _Envoy extraordinary from the King
        of_ Denmark
  Mrs Margarita Sabine
  Mr Edward Sadler, 2 Books
  Thomas Sadler, _of the_ Pell-Office, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Joseph Sager, _Canon of the Church of_ Salisbury
  Mr William Salkeld
  Mr Robert Salter
  _Lady_ Vanaker Sambrooke
  Jer. Sambrooke, _Esq;_
  John Sampson, _Esq;_
  _Dr._ Samuda
  Mr John Samwaies
  Alexander Sanderland, _M. D._
  Samuel Sanders, _Esq;_
  William Sanders, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Daniel Sanxey
  John Sargent, _Esq;_
  Mr Saunderson
  Mr Charles Savage, _jun._
  Mr John Savage
  Mrs Mary Savage
  _Rev._ Mr Samuel Savage
  Mr William Savage
  Jacob Sawbridge, _Esq;_
  John Sawbridge, _Esq;_
  Mr William Sawrey
  Humphrey Sayer, _Esq;_
  Exton Sayer, _L. L. D. Chanceller of_ Durham
  _Rev._ Mr George Sayer, _Prebendary of_ Durham
  Mr Thomas Sayer
  Herm. Osterdyk Schacht, _M. D._ & _M. Theor. & Pratt, in Acad._ Lug.
        Bat. Prof.
  Meyer Schamberg, _M. D._
  Mrs Schepers, _of_ Rotterdam
  _Dr._ Scheutcher
  Mr Thomas Scholes
  Mr Edward Score, _of_ Exeter, _Bookseller_
  Thomas Scot, of Essex, _Esq;_
  Daniel Scott, _L. L. D._
  _Rev._ Mr Scott, _Fellow of_ Winton College
  Mr Richard Scrafton, _Surgeon_
  Mr Flight Scurry, _Surgeon_
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Seeker
  _Rev_ Mr Sedgwick
  Mr Selwin
  Mr Peter Serjeant
  Mr John Serocol, _Merchant_
  _Rev._ Mr Seward, _of_ Hereford
  Mr Joseph Sewel
  Mr Thomas Sewell
  Mr Lancelot Shadwell
  Mr Arthur Shallet
  Mr Edmund Shallet, _Consul at_ Barcelona
  Mr _Archdeacon_ Sharp
  James Sharp, _jun. Surgeon_
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Sharp, _Arch-Deacon of_ Northumberland
  Mr John Shaw, _jun._
  Mr Joseph Shaw
  Mr Sheafe
  Mr Edw. Sheldon, _of_ Winstonly
  Mr Shell
  Mr Richard Shephard
  Mr Shepherd _of_ Trinity Coll. Oxon
  Mrs Mary Shepherd
  Mr William Sheppard
  _Rev._ Mr William Sherlock, _M. A._
  William Sherrard, _L. L. D._
  John Sherwin, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Sherwood
  Mr Thomas Shewell
  Mr John Shipton, _Surgeon_
  Mr John Shipton, _sen._
  Mr John Shipton, _jun._
  Francis Shipwith, _Esq, Fellow Comm. of_ Trinity Coll. Camb.
  John Shish, _of_ Greenwich _in_ Kent, _Esq;_
  Mr Abraham Shreighly
  John Shore, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Shove
  Bartholomew Shower, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Sibley, _jun._
  Mr Jacob Silver, _Bookseller in_ Sandwich
  Robert Simpson, _Esq; Beadle and Fellow of_ Caius Coll. Cambr.
  Mr Robert Simpson _Professor of the_ Mathematicks _in the University
        of_ Glascow
  Henry Singleton, _Esq; Prime Sergeant of_ Ireland
  _Rev._ Mr John Singleton
  _Rev._ Mr Rowland Singleton
  Mr Singleton, _Surgeon_
  Mr Jonathan Sisson
  Francis Sitwell, _of_ Renishaw, _Esq;_
  Ralph Skerret, _D. D._
  Thomas Skinner, _Esq;_
  Mr John Skinner
  Mr Samuel Skinner, _jun._
  Mr John Skrimpshaw
  Frederic Slare, _M. D._
  Adam Slater, _of_ Chesterfield, _Surgeon_
  _Sir_ Hans Sloane, _Bar._
  William Sloane, _Esq;_
  William Sloper, _Esq;_
  William Sloper, _Esq, Fellow Commoner of_ Trin. Coll. Cambr.
  _Dr._ Sloper, _Chancellor of the Diocese of_ Bristol
  Mr Smart
  Mr John Smibart
  Robert Smith, _L. L. D. Professor of_ Astronomy _in the University of_
        Cambridge, 22 Books
  Robert Smith, _of_ Bristol, _Esq;_
  William Smith, _of the_ Middle-Temple, _Esq;_
  James Smith, _Esq;_
  Morgan Smith, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Smith, _of_ Stone _in the County of_ Bucks
  John Smith, _Esq;_
  Mr John Smith
  Mr John Smith, _Surgeon in_ Coventry, 2 Books
  Mr John Smith, _Surgeon in_ Chichester
  Mr Allyn Smith
  Mr Joshua Smith
  Mr Joseph Smith
  _Rev._ Mr Elisha Smith, _of_ Tid _St. Gyles’s, in the Isle of_ Ely
  Mr Ward Smith
  Mr Skinner Smith
  _Rev._ Mr George Smyth
  Mr Snablin
  _Dr._ Snell, _of_ Norwich
  Mr Samuel Snell
  Mr William Snell
  William Snelling, _Esq;_
  William Sneyd, _Esq;_
  Mr Ralph Snow
  Mr Thomas Snow
  Stephen Soame, _Esq; Fellow Commoner of_ Sidney Coll. Cambr.
  Cockin Sole, _Esq;_
  Joseph Somers, _Esq;_
  Mr Edwin Sommers, _Merchant_
  Mr Adam Soresby
  Thomas Southby, _Esq;_
  Sontley South, _Esq;_
  Mr Sparrow
  Mr Speke, _of_ Wadham Coll. Ox.
  _Rev._ Mr Joseph Spence
  Mr Abraham Spooner
  _Sir_ Conrad Joachim Springel
  Mr William Stammers
  Mr Charles Stanhope
  Mr Thomas Stanhope
  _Sir_ John Stanley
  George Stanley, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Dr. Stanley, _Dean of St._ Asaph
  Mr John Stanly
  Eaton Stannard, _Esq;_
  Thomas Stansal, _Esq;_
  Mr Samuel Stanton
  Temple Stanyan, _Esq;_
  Mrs Mary Stanyforth
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Starges, _Rector of_ Hadstock, Essex
  Mr Benjamin Steel
  Mr John Stebbing, _of St._ John’s College, Cambridge
  Mr John Martis Stehelin, _Merch._
  _Dr._ Steigerthal
  Mr Stephens, _of_ Gloucester
  Mr Joseph Stephens
  _Sir_ James Steuart _of_ Gutters, _Bar._
  Mr Robert Steuart, _Professor of_ Natural Philosophy, _in the
        University of_ Edinburgh
  _Rev._ Mr Stevens, _Fellow of_ Corp. Chr. Coll. Cambridge
  Mr John Stevens, _of_ Trinity College, Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr Bennet Stevenson
  _Hon._ Richard Stewart, _Esq;_
  _Major_ James Stewart
  _Capt_ Bartholomew Stibbs
  Mr Denham Stiles
  Mr Thomas Stiles, _sen._
  Mr Thomas Stiles, _jun._
  _Rev._ Mr Stillingfleet
  Mr Edward Stillingfleet
  Mr John Stillingfleet
  Mr William Stith
  Mr Stock, _of_ Rochdall _in_ Lancashire
  Mr Stocton, _Watch-Maker_
  Mr Robert Stogdon
  _Rev._ Mr Richard Stonehewer
  Thomas Stoner, _Esq;_
  Mr George Story, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Mr Thomas Story
  William Strahan, _L. L. D._
  Mr Thomas Stratfield
  _Rev. Dr._ Stratford, _Canon of_ Christ Church, Oxford
  _Capt._ William Stratton
  _Rev._ Mr Streat
  Samuel Strode, _Esq;_
  Mr George Strode
  _Rev._ Mr John Strong
  _Hon. Commodore_ Stuart
  Alexander Stuart, _M. D._
  Charles Stuart, _M. D._
  Lewis Stucly
  Mr John Sturges, _of_ Bloomsbury
  Mr Sturgeon, _Surgeon in_ Bury
  _Hon. Lady_ Suasso
  Mr Gerrard Suffield
  Mr William Sumner, _of_ Windsor
  _Sir_ Robert Sutton, _Kt. of the_ Bath
  _Rev._ Mr John Sutton
  Mr Gerrard Swartz
  Mr Thomas Swayne
  William Swinburn, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr. John Swinton, _M. A._
  Mr Joshua Symmonds, _Surgeon_
  _Rev._ Mr Edward Synge


  T.

  _His Grace the Archbishop of_ Tuam
  _Right Hon. Earl of_ Tankerville
  _Rt. Hon. Ld. Viscount_ Townshend, _One of His Majesty’s Principal
        Secretaries of State_
  _Right Honourable Lady Viscountess_ Townshend
  _Right Hon Ld Viscount_ Tyrconnel
  _The Honourable Lord_ Trevor Charles Talbot, _Esq; Solicitor-General._
  Francis Talbot, _Esq;_
  John Ivory Talbot, _Esq;_
  Mr George Talbot, _M. A._
  Mr Talbot
  Thomas Tanner, _D. D. Chancellor of_ Norwich
  Mr Thomas Tanner
  Mr Tateham _of_ Clapham
  Mr Henry Tatham
  Mr John Tatnall
  Mr Arthur Tayldeur
  Mr John Tayleur
  Arthur Taylor, _Esq;_
  Joseph Taylor, _Esq;_
  Simon Taylor, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Abraham Taylor
  Brook Taylor, _L. L. D._
  William Tempest, _Esq;_
  William Tenison, _Esq;_
  _Dr._ Tenison
  _Rev. Dr._ Terry, _Canon of_ Christ Church, Oxon
  Mr Theed, _Attorney_
  Mr Lewis Theobald
  James Theobalds, _Esq;_
  Robert Thistlethwayte, _D. D. Warden of_ Wadham Coll. Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr Thomlinson
  Richard Thompson Coley, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr William Thompson
  Mr William Thompson, _A. B. of_ Trinity Coll. Cambridge
  Mr Thoncas
  Mr Thornbury, _Vicar of_ Thame
  _Sir_ James Thornhill, 3 Books
  Mr Thornhill
  William Thornton, _Esq;_
  Mr Catlyn Thorowgood
  Mr John Thorpe
  William Thorseby, _Esq;_
  Mr William Thurlbourn, _Bookseller in_ Cambridge
  Mark Thurston, _Esq; Master in_ Chancery
  _Rev._ Mr William Tiffin, _of_ Lynn
  Edmund Tigh, _Esq;_
  _Right Hon._ Richard Tighe, _Esq;_
  Mr Abraham Tilghman
  Mr George Tilson
  _Rev_ Mr Tilson
  Mr William Tims
  _Rev._ Mr John Tisser
  _Capt._ Joseph Tolson
  Mr Tomkins
  Mr William Tomlinson
  Richard Topham, _Esq;_
  _Dr._ Torey
  George Torriano, _of_ West-Ham, _Esq;_
  Mr John Torriano
  Mr James le Touch
  _Rev._ Mr Charles Tough
  Mr John Towers
  _Rev._ Mr Nehemiah Towgood
  Mr Edward Town
  Joseph Townsend, _Esq;_
  Charles Townshend, _of_ Lincoln’s Inn, _Esq;_
  _Hon._ Thomas Townshend, _Esq;_
  Mr Townson
  John Tracey, _of_ Stanway _in_ Gloucester, _Esq;_
  Capt. Richard Tracey
  Mr Samuel Traverse, _Merchant_
  Mr Charles Trelawny, _Student of_ Christ Church
  Fredric Trench, _Esq;_
  Mr Edmund Trench
  Mr Samuel Trench
  Richard Trevor, _Esq;_
  _Hon._ Thomas Trevor, _Esq;_
  _Hon._ Mr John Trevor
  Mr Trimble, _Merch. in_ Rotterd.
  _Rev. Dr._ Trimnell, _Dean of_ Winchester
  Thomas Trotter, _L. L. D._
  John Trubshaw, _Esq;_
  Mr Thomas Truman
  Dr. Daniel Turner
  _Rev._ Mr. Robert Turner, _of_ Colchester
  Mr John Turton
  Mr William Turton
  John Twistleton, _near the City of_ York, _Esq;_
  _Col._ Tyrrell
  Mr William Tyson
  Mr Samuel Tyssen
  _Capt._ Edward Tyzack

  V

  _Rt. Hon. Lord_ Viscount Vane
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Valentine
  Mr Vallack, _of_ Plymouth
  Mr John Vanderbank
  Mr Daniel Vandewall
  Mr John Vandewall, _Merchant_
  Mr Edward Vaus
  _Hon._ John Verney, _Esq;_
  William Vesey, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr John Vesey
  William Vigor, _of_ Westbury College _near_ Bristol
  Mr George Virgoe
  Mr Frederick Voguel, _Merchant_
  Mr Thomas Vickers
  Robert Viner, _Esq;_

  W

  _Rt. Hon. the Earl of_ Winchelsea
  _Rt. Rev. Lord Bishop of_ Winchester
  _Rev._ Mr Wade
  _Sir_ Charles Wager
  _Rev._ Mr Wagstaffe
  _Rev. Dr._ Edward Wake
  Mr Jasper Wakefield
  Mr Samuel Walbank
  Mr Walbridge
  Mr Waldron
  Edmund Waldrond. _M. A._
  Mr Walford, _of_ Wadham Coll. Oxon
  _Rev._ Mr Edward Walker
  Mr Samuel Walker, _of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Mr Thomas Walker
  Henry Waller, _Esq;_
  William Waller, _Esq;_
  Mrs Waller
  Mr John Waller, _of_ Lincoln’s-Inn
  Mr George Wallis
  _Rev._ Mr William Wallis
  Mr Edward Walmsley, 2 Books
  Edward Walpole, _Esq;_
  Mr Peter Walter
  John Walton, _Esq;_
  Peter Warburton _of_ Ford _in_ Cheshire, _Esq;_
  Richard Warburton, _Esq;_
  John Ward, _jun. Esq;_
  Michael Ward, _Esq;_
  Edward Ward, _Esq;_
  Knox Ward, _Esq;_
  Mr John Ward, _Professor of_ Rhetoric _in_ Gresham College
  William Ward, _L. L. D._
  Mr Richard Warring
  Mr Jacob Warneck
  Mr Richard Warner
  Mr Robert Warner
  William Wasey, _M. D._
  _Rev._ Mr Washington, _Fellow of_ Peterhouse, Cambridge
  Mr Edward Wastfield
  Mr Watkins
  _Rev._ Mr Thomas Watkis, _of_ Knutsford
  Robert Watley, _Esq;_
  Mr Joel Watson
  Mr John Watson
  Mr Thomas Watson
  Richard Watts, _M. D._ 2 Books
  Mr Thomas Watts
  _Rev._ Mr Isaac Watts
  Mr William Weamen
  Mr Thomas Wear
  Mr William Weathers
  Edward Weaver, _Esq;_
  Anthony Weaver, _M. D._
  Mr Webb
  Mr Willam Webb, _A. B. of_ Trinity College, Cambridge
  Mr Humphrey Webb, _M. A._
  Rt. Hon. Edward Webster, _Esq;_
  William Wenman, _of_ Edwinstowe, _Esq;_
  Mr Samuel Wesley, _jun._
  Gilbert West, _Esq;_
  Rt. Hon Richard West, _Esq; late Lord high Chancellor of_ Ireland
  Thomas West, _Esq;_
  _Dr._ Thomas West
  Mrs Anne West
  Daniel Westcomb, _Esq;_
  Herbert Westfaling, _Esq;_
  _Messieurs_ Werstein _and_ Smith, _Booksellers in_ Amsterdam
  Mr Western, _in_ Dover-Street
  Mr Matthew Westly
  Mr Tho. Weston, _of_ Greenwich
  Matthew Weymondefold, _Esq;_
  Mr Edward Wharton
  Mr Stephen Whatley
  Mr James Whatman
  Granville Wheler, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr William Whiston
  _Dr._ William Whitaker
  Taylor White, _Esq;_
  Mr Charles White
  Mr Edward White, _Scholar of_ Caius College, Cambridge
  Mr John White
  Mr Joseph White
  Mr Nicholas White
  Mr William Whitehead
  _Rev._ Mr Whitehead, _Fellow of_ Emanuel College, Cambridge 6 Books
  John Whitfield, _D. D. Rector of_ Dickleburgh
  _Rev._ Mr Whitfield
  Mr Nathaniel Whitlock
  Mr John Whittering
  Robert Wild, _Esq;_
  Mr William Wildman
  _Rev._ Mr Wilkes, _Prebendary of_ Westminster
  _Dr._ Wilkin
  Mr Wilkins, Bookseller
  Mr Abel Wilkinson
  Mr William Wilks
  John Willes, _Esq;_
  John Willet, _Esq; of the Island of St._ Christophers
  John Williams, _Esq;_
  William Peer Williams, _jun. Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Philip Williams, _B. D._
  Mr Williams, _B. A. of_ Jesus College, Oxon
  Mr Francis Williams
  _Hon. Coll._ Adam Williamson
  Mr Robert Willimott
  John Willis, _Esq;_
  Edward Wilmot, _M. D._
  Mr Robert Willmott
  Mr Joseph Willoughby
  William Willys, _Esq;_
  Mr John Wilmer, _Merchant_
  Mr John Wilmer, _Apothecary_
  Mr Wilmott, _Bookseller in_ Oxford
  Richard Wilson, of Leeds, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr Daniel Wilson, _Prebendary of the Church of_ Hereford
  William Winde, _Esq;_
  Mr Samuel Winder, _jun._
  _Sir_ William Windham _Bar._
  Mr John Windsor
  _Library of_ Windsor College
  Mr Winnington
  Mr Winnock
  Mr Abraham Winterbottom
  Will. Withers, _of_ Gray’s-Inn, _Esq;_
  Mr Conway Withorne, _of the_ Inner-Temple
  _Rev._ Mr John Witter
  Jacobus Wittichius, Phil. _D. & in Acad._ Lugd. Bat. _Prof._
  Mr John Wittingham
  _Rev._ Mr John Witton, _Rector of_ Howton Witton, Cambridge
  Mr Thomas Wood
  Thomas Woodcock, _Esq;_
  Thomas Woodford, _Esq;_
  William Woodford, _M. D._
  John Woodhouse, _M. D._
  Mr J. Woods, _of_ Bramshot, _Merch._
  _Rev._ Mr Benjamin Woodroof, _Prebendary of_ Worcester
  Mr Joseph Woodward
  Josiah Woolaston, _Esq;_
  Mr Woolball, _Merchant_
  Francis Woollaston, _Esq;_
  Charlton Woollaston, _Esq;_
  Mr William Woollaston
  Wight Woolly, _Esq;_
  _Library of the Cathed. of_ Worcester
  Josias Wordsworth, _jun. Esq;_
  Mr John Worster, _Merchant_
  _Rev. Dr._ William Wotton
  Mr John Wowen
  Edward Wright, _of the_ Middle-Temple, _Esq;_
  Henry Wright, _of_ Molberly, _in_ Cheshire, _Esq;_
  Samual Wright, _Esq;_
  William Wright, _of_ Offerton, _in_ Cheshire, _Esq;_
  Mr Wright
  Mr William Wright, _of_ Baldock, Hertfordshire
  _Rev._ Mr Wrigley, _Fellow of St._ John’s College, Cambridge
  _Rt. Hon._ Thomas Wyndham, _Ld. Chief Justice of the Common Pleas, of_
      Ireland
  Mr Joseph Wyeth
  Thomas Wyndham, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Mr John Wynne

  Y

  Mr John Yardley, _Surg. in_ Coven.
  Mr Thomas Yates
  Mrs Yeo, _of_ Exeter, _Bookseller_
  _Sir_ William Yonge
  _Lady_ York
  Nicholas Young, _of the_ Inner-Temple, _Esq;_
  Hitch Young, _Esq;_
  _Rev._ Edward Young, _L. L. D._

[Illustration]




INTRODUCTION.

THE manner, in which Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has published his philosophical
discoveries, occasions them to lie very much concealed from all, who
have not made the mathematics particularly their study. He once,
indeed, intended to deliver, in a more familiar way, that part of
his inventions, which relates to the system of the world; but upon
farther consideration he altered his design. For as the nature of
those discoveries made it impossible to prove them upon any other than
geometrical principles; he apprehended, that those, who should not
fully perceive the force of his arguments, would hardly be prevailed
on to exchange their former sentiments for new opinions, so very
different from what were commonly received[1]. He therefore chose
rather to explain himself only to mathematical readers; and declined
the attempting to instruct such in any of his principles, who, by
not comprehending his method of reasoning, could not, at the first
appearance of his discoveries, have been persuaded of their truth. But
now, since Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~’s doctrine has been fully established
by the unanimous approbation of all, who are qualified to understand
the same; it is without doubt to be wished, that the whole of his
improvements in philosophy might be universally known. For this purpose
therefore I drew up the following papers, to give a general notion
of our great philosopher’s inventions to such, as are not prepared
to read his own works, and yet might desire to be informed of the
progress, he has made in natural knowledge; not doubting but there were
many, besides those, whose turn of mind had led them into a course of
mathematical studies, that would take great pleasure in tasting of this
delightful fountain of science.

2. IT is a just remark, which has been made upon the human mind, that
nothing is more suitable to it, than the contemplation of truth; and
that all men are moved with a strong desire after knowledge; esteeming
it honourable to excel therein; and holding it, on the contrary,
disgraceful to mistake, err, or be in any way deceived. And this
sentiment is by nothing more fully illustrated, than by the inclination
of men to gain an acquaintance with the operations of nature; which
disposition to enquire after the causes of things is so general, that
all men of letters, I believe, find themselves influenced by it. Nor
is it difficult to assign a reason for this, if we consider only, that
our desire after knowledge is an effect of that taste for the sublime
and the beautiful in things, which chiefly constitutes the difference
between the human life, and the life of brutes. These inferior animals
partake with us of the pleasures, that immediately flow from the bodily
senses and appetites; but our minds are furnished with a superior
sense, by which we are capable of receiving various degrees of delight,
where the creatures below us perceive no difference. Hence arises
that pursuit of grace and elegance in our thoughts and actions, and
in all things belonging to us, which principally creates imployment
for the active mind of man. The thoughts of the human mind are too
extensive to be confined only to the providing and enjoying of what
is necessary for the support of our being. It is this taste, which
has given rise to poetry, oratory, and every branch of literature and
science. From hence we feel great pleasure in conceiving strongly, and
in apprehending clearly, even where the passions are not concerned.
Perspicuous reasoning appears not only beautiful; but, when set forth
in its full strength and dignity, it partakes of the sublime, and not
only pleases, but warms and elevates the soul. This is the source of
our strong desire of knowledge; and the same taste for the sublime
and the beautiful directs us to chuse particularly the productions of
nature for the subject of our contemplation: our creator having so
adapted our minds to the condition, wherein he has placed us, that all
his visible works, before we inquire into their make, strike us with
the most lively ideas of beauty and magnificence.

3. BUT if there be so strong a passion in contemplative minds for
natural philosophy; all such must certainly receive a particular
pleasure in being informed of Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~’s discoveries, who
alone has been able to make any great advancements in the true course
leading to natural knowledge: whereas this important subject had before
been usually attempted with that negligence, as cannot be reflected
on without surprize. Excepting a very few, who, by pursuing a more
rational method, had gained a little true knowledge in some particular
parts of nature; the writers in this science had generally treated of
it after such a manner, as if they thought, that no degree of certainty
was ever to be hoped for. The custom was to frame conjectures; and if
upon comparing them with things, there appeared some kind of agreement,
though very imperfect, it was held sufficient. Yet at the same time
nothing less was undertaken than intire systems, and fathoming at once
the greatest depths of nature; as if the secret causes of natural
effects, contrived and framed by infinite wisdom, could be searched
out by the slightest endeavours of our weak understandings. Whereas
the only method, that can afford us any prospect of success in this
difficult work, is to make our enquiries with the utmost caution, and
by very slow degrees. And after our most diligent labour, the greatest
part of nature will, no doubt, for ever remain beyond our reach.

4. THIS neglect of the proper means to enlarge our knowledge, joined
with the presumption to attempt, what was quite out of the power of our
limited faculties, the Lord BACON judiciously observes to be the great
obstruction to the progress of science[2]. Indeed that excellent person
was the first, who expresly writ against this way of philosophizing;
and he has laid open at large the absurdity of it in his admirable
treatise, intitled NOVUM ORGANON SCIENTIARUM; and has there likewise
described the true method, which ought to be followed.

5. THERE are, saith he, but two methods, that can be taken in the
pursuit of natural knowledge. One is to make a hasty transition
from our first and slight observations on things to general axioms,
and then to proceed upon those axioms, as certain and uncontestable
principles, without farther examination. The other method; (which he
observes to be the only true one, but to his time unattempted;) is to
proceed cautiously, to advance step by step, reserving the most general
principles for the last result of our inquiries[3]. Concerning the
first of these two methods; where objections, which happen to appear
against any such axioms taken up in haste, are evaded by some frivolous
distinction, when the axiom it self ought rather to be corrected[4];
he affirms, that the united endeavours of all ages cannot make it
successful; because this original error in the first digestion of
the mind (as he expresses himself) cannot afterwards be remedied[5]:
whereby he would signify to us, that if we set out in a wrong way; no
diligence or art, we can use, while we follow so erroneous a course,
will ever bring us to our designed end. And doubtless it cannot prove
otherwise; for in this spacious field of nature, if once we forsake
the true path, we shall immediately lose our selves, and must for ever
wander with uncertainty.

6. THE impossibility of succeeding in so faulty a method of
philosophizing his Lordship endeavours to prove from the many false
notions and prejudices, to which the mind of man is exposed[6]. And
since this judicious writer apprehends, that men are so exceeding
liable to fall into these wrong tracts of thinking, as to incur great
danger of being misled by them, even while they enter on the true
course in pursuit of nature[7]; I trust, I shall be excused, if, by
insisting a little particularly upon this argument, I endeavour to
remove whatever prejudice of this kind, might possibly entangle the
mind of any of my readers.

7. HIS Lordship has reduced these prejudices and false modes of
conception under four distinct heads[8].

8. THE first head contains such, as we are subject to from the very
condition of humanity, through the weakness both of our senses, and of
the faculties of the mind[9]; seeing, as this author well observes, the
subtilty of nature far exceeds the greatest subtilty of our senses or
acutest reasonings[10]. One of the false modes of conception, which
he mentions under this head, is the forming to our selves a fanciful
simplicity and regularity in natural things. This he illustrates by
the following instances; the conceiving the planets to move in perfect
circles; the adding an orb of fire to the other three elements, and
the supposing each of these to exceed the other in rarity, just in a
decuple proportion[11]. And of the same nature is the assertion of
~DES CARTES~, without any proof, that all things are made up
of three kinds of matter only[12]. As also this opinion of another
philosopher; that light, in passing through different mediums, was
refracted, so as to proceed by that way, through which it would move
more speedily, than through any other[13]. The second erroneous turn
of mind, taken notice of by his Lordship under this head, is, that
all men are in some degree prone to a fondness for any notions, which
they have once imbibed; whereby they often wrest things to reconcile
them to those notions, and neglect the consideration of whatever will
not be brought to an agreement with them; just as those do, who are
addicted to judicial astrology, to the observation of dreams, and to
such-like superstitions; who carefully preserve the memory of every
incident, which serves to confirm their prejudices, and let slip out of
their minds all instances, that make against them[14]. There is also
a farther impediment to true knowledge, mentioned under the same head
by this noble writer, which is; that whereas, through the weakness
and imperfection of our senses, many things are concealed. from us,
which have the greatest effect in producing natural appearances; our
minds are ordinarily most affected by that, which makes the strongest
impression on our organs of sense; whereby we are apt to judge of
the real importance of things in nature by a wrong measure[15]. So,
because the figuration and the motion of bodies strike our senses more
immediately than most of their other properties, DES CARTES and his
followers will not allow any other explication of natural appearances,
than from the figure and motion of the parts of matter. By which
example we see how justly his Lordship observes this cause of error to
be the greatest of any[16]; since it has given rise to a fundamental
principle in a system of philosophy, that not long ago obtained almost
an universal reputation.

9. THESE are the chief branches of those obstructions to knowledge,
which this author has reduced under his first head of false
conceptions. The second head contains the errors, to which particular
persons are more especially obnoxious[17]. One of these is the
consequence of a preceding observation: that as we are exposed to be
captivated by any opinions, which have once taken possession of our
minds; so in particular, natural knowledge has been much corrupted by
the strong attachment of men to some one part of science, of which
they reputed themselves the inventers, or about which they have spent
much of their time; and hence have been apt to conceive it to be of
greater use in the study of natural philosophy than it was: like
ARISTOTLE, who reduced his physics to logical disputations; and the
chymists, who thought, that nature could be laid open only by the
force of their fires[18]. Some again are wholly carried away by an
excessive veneration for antiquity; others, by too great fondness
for the moderns; few having their minds so well balanced, as neither
to depreciate the merit of the ancients, nor yet to despise the real
improvements of later times[19]. To this is added by his Lordship a
difference in the genius of men, that some are most fitted to observe
the similitude, there is in things, while others are more qualified to
discern the particulars, wherein they disagree; both which dispositions
of mind are useful: but to the prejudice of philosophy men are apt to
run into excess in each; while one sort of genius dwells too much upon
the gross and sum of things, and the other upon trifling minutenesses
and shadowy distinctions[20].

10. UNDER the third head of prejudices and false notions this writer
considers such, as follow from the lax and indefinite use of words in
ordinary discourse; which occasions great ambiguities and uncertainties
in philosophical debates (as another eminent philosopher has since
shewn more at large[21];) insomuch that this our author thinks a strict
defining of terms to be scarce an infallible remedy against this
inconvenience[22]. And perhaps he has no small reason on his side: for
the common inaccurate sense of words, notwithstanding the limitations
given them by definitions, will offer it self so constantly to the
mind, as to require great caution and circumspection for us not to be
deceived thereby. Of this we have a very eminent instance in the great
disputes, that have been raised about the use of the word attraction in
philosophy; of which we shall be obliged hereafter to make particular
mention[23]. Words thus to be guarded against are of two kinds. Some
are names of things, that are only imaginary[24]; such words are wholly
to be rejected. But there are other terms, that allude to what is real,
though their signification is confused[25]. And these latter must of
necessity be continued in use; but their sense cleared up, and freed,
as much as possible, from obscurity.

11. THE last general head of these errors comprehends such, as follow
from the various sects of false philosophies; which this author divides
into three sorts, the sophistical, empirical, and superstitious[26]. By
the first of these he means a philosophy built upon speculations only
without experiments[27]; by the second, where experiments are blindly
adhered to, without proper reasoning upon them[28]; and by the third,
wrong opinions of nature fixed in mens minds either through false
religions, or from misunderstanding the declarations of the true[29].

12. THESE are the four principal canals, by which this judicious author
thinks, that philosophical errors have flowed in upon us. And he
rightly observes, that the faulty method of proceeding in philosophy,
against which he writes[30], is so far from assisting us towards
overcoming these prejudices; that he apprehends it rather suited to
rivet them more firmly to the mind[31]. How great reason then has his
Lordship to call this way of philosophizing the parent of error, and
the bane of all knowledge[32]? For, indeed, what else but mistakes can
so bold and presumptuous a treatment of nature produce? have we the
wisdom necessary to frame a world, that we should think so easily,
and with so slight a search to enter into the most secret springs of
nature, and discover the original causes of things? what chimeras, what
monsters has not this preposterous method brought forth? what schemes,
or what hypothesis’s of the subtilest wits has not a stricter enquiry
into nature not only overthrown, but manifested to be ridiculous and
absurd? Every new improvement, which we make in this science, lets us
see more and more the weakness of our guesses. Dr. HARVEY, by that
one discovery of the circulation of the blood, has dissipated all the
speculations and reasonings of many ages upon the animal oeconomy.
ASELLIUS, by detecting the lacteal veins, shewed how little ground all
physicians and philosophers had in conjecturing, that the nutritive
part of the aliment was absorbed by the mouths of the veins spread
upon the bowels: and then PECQUET, by finding out the thoracic duct,
as evidently proved the vanity of the opinion, which was persisted in
after the lacteal vessels were known, that the alimental juice was
conveyed immediately to the liver, and there converted into blood.

13. AS these things set forth the great absurdity of proceeding in
philosophy on conjectures, by informing us how far the operations
of nature are above our low conceptions; so on the other hand, such
instances of success from a more judicious method shew us, that our
bountiful maker has not left us wholly without means of delighting
our selves in the contemplation of his wisdom. That by a just way of
inquiry into nature, we could not fail of arriving at discoveries
very remote from our apprehensions; the Lord ~BACON~ himself
argues from the experience of mankind. If, says he, the force of guns
should be described to any one ignorant of them, by their effects only,
he might reasonably suppose, that those engines of destruction were
only a more artificial composition, than he knew, of wheels and other
mechanical powers: but it could never enter his thoughts, that their
immense force should be owing to a peculiar substance, which would
enkindle into so violent an explosion, as we experience in gunpowder:
since he would no where see the least example of any such operation;
except perhaps in earthquakes and thunder, which he would doubtless
look upon as exalted powers of nature, greatly surpassing any art of
man to imitate. In the same manner, if a stranger to the original
of silk were shewn a garment made of it, he would be very far from
imagining so strong a substance to be spun out of the bowels of a small
worm; but must certainly believe it either a vegetable substance, like
flax or cotton; or the natural covering of some animal, as wool is
of sheep. Or had we been told, before the invention of the magnetic
needle among us, that another people was in possession of a certain
contrivance, by which they were inabled to discover the position of
the heavens, with vastly more ease, than we could do; what could have
been imagined more, than that they were provided with some fitter
astronomical instrument for this purpose than we? That any stone should
have so amazing a property, as we find in the magnet, must have been
the remotest from our thoughts[33].

14. BUT what surprizing advancements in the knowledge of nature may be
made by pursuing the true course in philosophical inquiries; when those
searches are conducted by a genius equal to so divine a work, will be
best understood by considering Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ discoveries.
That my’s reader may apprehend as just a notion of these, as can be
conveyed to him, by the brief account, which I intend to lay before
him; I have set apart this introduction for explaining, in the fullest
manner I am able, the principles, whereon Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ proceeds.
For without a clear conception of these, it is impossible to form any
true idea of the singular excellence of the inventions of this great
philosopher.

15. THE principles then of this philosophy are; upon no consideration
to indulge conjectures concerning the powers and laws of nature, but
to make it our endeavour with all diligence to search out the real
and true laws, by which the constitution of things is regulated. The
philosopher’s first care must be to distinguish, what he sees to be
within his power, from what is beyond his reach; to assume no greater
degree of knowledge, than what he finds himself possessed of; but to
advance by slow and cautious steps; to search gradually into natural
causes; to secure to himself the knowledge of the most immediate cause
of each appearance, before he extends his views farther to causes
more remote. This is the method, in which philosophy ought to be
cultivated; which does not pretend to so great things, as the more
airy speculations; but will perform abundantly more: we shall not
perhaps seem to the unskilful to know so much, but our real knowledge
will be greater. And certainly it is no objection against this method,
that some others promise, what is nearer to the extent of our wishes:
since this, if it will not teach us all we could desire to be informed
of, will however give us some true light into nature; which no other
can do. Nor has the philosopher any reason to think his labour lost,
when he finds himself stopt at the cause first discovered by him, or
at any other more remote cause, short of the original: for if he has
but sufficiently proved any one cause, he has entered so far into the
real constitution of things, has laid a safe foundation for others to
work upon, and has facilitated their endeavours in the search after
yet more distant causes; and besides, in the mean time he may apply
the knowledge of these intermediate causes to many useful purposes.
Indeed the being able to make practical deductions from natural causes,
constitutes the great distinction between the true philosophy and the
false. Causes assumed upon conjecture, must be so loose and undefined,
that nothing particular can be collected from them. But those causes,
which are brought to light by a strict examination of things, will be
more distinct. Hence it appears to have been no unuseful discovery,
that the ascent of water in pumps is owing to the pressure of the
air by its weight or spring; though the causes, which make the air
gravitate, and render it elastic, be unknown: for notwithstanding
we are ignorant of the original, whence these powers of the air are
derived; yet we may receive much advantage from the bare knowledge of
these powers. If we are but certain of the degree of force, wherewith
they act, we shall know the extent of what is to be expected from
them; we shall know the greatest height, to which it is possible by
pumps to raise water; and shall thereby be prevented from making any
useless efforts towards improving these instruments beyond the limits
prescribed to them by nature; whereas without so much knowledge as
this, we might probably have wasted in attempts of this kind much time
and labour. How long did philosophers busy themselves to no purpose
in endeavouring to perfect telescopes, by forming the glasses into
some new figure; till Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ demonstrated, that
the effects of telescopes were limited from another cause, than was
supposed; which no alteration in the figure of the glasses could
remedy? What method Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ himself has found for
the improvement of telescopes shall be explained hereafter[34]. But
at present I shall proceed to illustrate, by some farther instances,
this distinguishing character of the true philosophy, which we have now
under consideration. It was no trifling discovery, that the contraction
of the muscles of animals puts their limbs in motion, though the
original cause of that contraction remains a secret, and perhaps may
always do so; for the knowledge of thus much only has given rise to
many speculations upon the force and artificial disposition of the
muscles, and has opened no narrow prospect into the animal fabrick.
The finding out, that the nerves are great agents in this action,
leads us yet nearer to the original cause, and yields us a wider
view of the subject. And each of these steps affords us assistance
towards restoring this animal motion, when impaired in our selves,
by pointing out the seats of the injuries, to which it is obnoxious.
To neglect all this, because we can hitherto advance no farther, is
plainly ridiculous. It is confessed by all, that ~GALILEO~
greatly improved philosophy, by shewing, as we shall relate hereafter,
that the power in bodies, which we call gravity, occasions them to
move downwards with a velocity equably accelerated[35]; and that when
any body is thrown forwards, the same power obliges it to describe in
its motion that line, which is called by geometers a parabola[36]:
yet we are ignorant of the cause, which makes bodies gravitate. But
although we are unacquainted with the spring, whence this power in
nature is derived, nevertheless we can estimate its effects. When a
body falls perpendicularly, it is known, how long time it takes in
descending from any height whatever: and if it be thrown forwards,
we know the real path, which it describes; we can determine in what
direction, and with what degree of swiftness it must be projected,
in order to its striking against any object desired; and we can also
ascertain the very force, wherewith it will strike. Sir ~ISAAC
NEWTON~ has farther taught, that this power of gravitation extends
up to the moon, and causes that planet to gravitate as much towards
the earth, as any of the bodies, which are familiar to us, would, if
placed at the same distance[37]: he has proved likewise, that all
the planets gravitate towards the sun, and towards one another; and
that their respective motions follow from this gravitation. All this
he has demonstrated upon indisputable geometrical principles, which
cannot be rendered precarious for want of knowing what it is, which
causes these bodies thus mutually to gravitate: any more than we can
doubt of the propensity in all the bodies about us, to descend towards
the earth; or can call in question the forementioned propositions
of ~GALILEO~, which are built upon that principle. And as
~GALILEO~ has shewn more fully, than was known before, what
effects were produced in the motion of bodies by their gravitation
towards the earth; so Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~, by this his
invention, has much advanced our knowledge in the celestial motions.
By discovering that the moon gravitates towards the sun, as well as
towards the earth; he has laid open those intricacies in the moon’s
motion, which no astronomer, from observations only, could ever find
out[38]: and one kind of heavenly bodies, the comets, have their motion
now clearly ascertained; whereof we had before no true knowledge at
all[39].

16. DOUBTLESS it might be expected, that such surprizing success should
have silenced, at once, every cavil. But we have seen the contrary.
For because this philosophy professes modestly to keep within the
extent of our faculties, and is ready to confess its imperfections,
rather than to make any fruitless attempts to conceal them, by seeking
to cover the defects in our knowledge with the vain ostentation of
rash and groundless conjectures; hence has been taken an occasion
to insinuate that we are led to miraculous causes, and the occult
qualities of the schools.

17. BUT the first of these accusations is very extraordinary. If by
calling these causes miraculous nothing more is meant than only, that
they often appear to us wonderful and surprizing, it is not easy
to see what difficulty can be raised from thence; for the works of
nature discover every where such proofs of the unbounded power, and
the consummate wisdom of their author, that the more they are known,
the more they will excite our admiration: and it is too manifest to
be insisted on, that the common sense of the word miraculous can have
no place here, when it implies what is above the ordinary course of
things. The other imputation, that these causes are occult upon the
account of our not perceiving what produces them, contains in it great
ambiguity. That something relating to them lies hid, the followers
of this philosophy are ready to acknowledge, nay desire it should be
carefully remarked, as pointing out proper subjects for future inquiry.
But this is very different from the proceeding of the schoolmen in
the causes called by them occult. For as their occult qualities were
understood to operate in a manner occult, and not apprehended by us; so
they were obtruded upon us for such original and essential properties
in bodies, as made it vain to seek any farther cause; and a greater
power was attributed to them, than any natural appearances authorized.
For instance, the rise of water in pumps was ascribed to a certain
abhorrence of a vacuum, which they thought fit to assign to nature. And
this was so far a true observation, that the water does move, contrary
to its usual course, into the space, which otherwise would be left
void of any sensible matter; and, that the procuring such a vacuity
was the apparent cause of the water’s ascent. But while we were not in
the least informed how this power, called an abhorrence of a vacuum,
produced the visible effects; instead of making any advancement in the
knowledge of nature, we only gave an artificial name to one of her
operations: and when the speculation was pushed so beyond what any
appearances required, as to have it concluded, that this abhorrence
of a vacuum was a power inherent in all matter, and so unlimited as
to render it impossible for a vacuum to exist at all; it then became
a much greater absurdity, in being made the foundation of a most
ridiculous manner of reasoning; as at length evidently appeared, when
it came to be discovered, that this rise of the water followed only
from the pressure of the air, and extended it self no farther, than
the power of that cause. The scholastic stile in discoursing of these
occult qualities, as if they were essential differences in the very
substances, of which bodies consisted, was certainly very absurd; by
reason it tended to discourage all farther inquiry. But no such ill
consequences can follow from the considering of any natural causes,
which confessedly are not traced up to their first original. How
shall we ever come to the knowledge of the several original causes of
things, otherwise than by storing up all intermediate causes which we
can discover? Are all the original and essential properties of matter
so very obvious, that none of them can escape our first view? This is
not probable. It is much more likely, that, if some of the essential
properties are discovered by our first observations, a stricter
examination should bring more to light.


18. BUT in order to clear up this point concerning the essential
properties of matter, let us consider the subject a little distinctly.
We are to conceive, that the matter, out of which the universe of
things is formed, is furnished with certain qualities and powers,
whereby it is rendered fit to answer the purposes, for which it was
created. But every property, of which any particle of this matter is
in it self possessed, and which is not barely the consequence of the
union of this particle with other portions of matter, we may call an
essential property: whereas all other qualities or attributes belonging
to bodies, which depend on their particular frame and composition, are
not essential to the matter, whereof such bodies are made; because
the matter of these bodies will be deprived of those qualities, only
by the dissolution of the body, without working any change in the
original constitution of one single particle of this mass of matter.
Extension we apprehend to be one of these essential properties, and
impenetrability another. These two belong universally to all matter;
and are the principal ingredients in the idea, which this word matter
usually excites in the mind. Yet as the idea, marked by this name,
is not purely the creature of our own understandings, but is taken
for the representation of a certain substance without us; if we
should discover, that every part of the substance, in which we find
these two properties, should likewise be endowed universally with any
other essential qualities; all these, from the time they come to our
notice, must be united under our general idea of matter. How many
such properties there are actually in all matter we know not; those,
of which we are at present apprized, have been found out only by our
observations on things; how many more a farther search may bring to
light, no one can say; nor are we certain, that we are provided with
sufficient methods of perception to discern them all. Therefore, since
we have no other way of making discoveries in nature, but by gradual
inquiries into the properties of bodies; our first step must be to
admit without distinction all the properties, which we observe; and
afterwards we must endeavour, as far as we are able, to distinguish
between the qualities, wherewith the very substances themselves are
indued, and those appearances, which result from the structure only of
compound bodies. Some of the properties, which we observe in things,
are the attributes of particular bodies only; others universally belong
to all, that fall under our notice. Whether some of the qualities and
powers of particular bodies, be derived from different kinds of matter
entring their composition, cannot, in the present imperfect state
of our knowledge, absolutely be decided; though we have not yet any
reason to conclude, but that all the bodies, with which we converse,
are framed out of the very same kind of matter, and that their
distinct qualities are occasioned only by their structure; through
the variety whereof the general powers of matter are caused to produce
different effects. On the other hand, we should not hastily conclude,
that whatever is found to appertain to all matter, which falls under
our examination, must for that reason only be an essential property
thereof, and not be derived from some unseen disposition in the frame
of nature. Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has found reason to conclude,
that gravity is a property universally belonging to all the perceptible
bodies in the universe, and to every particle of matter, whereof they
are composed. But yet he no where asserts this property to be essential
to matter. And he was so far from having any design of establishing
it as such, that, on the contrary, he has given some hints worthy of
himself at a cause for it[40]; and expresly says, that he proposed
those hints to shew, that he had no such intention[41].

19. IT appears from hence, that it is not easy to determine, what
properties of bodies are essentially inherent in the matter, out of
which they are made, and what depend upon their frame and composition.
But certainly whatever properties are found to belong either to any
particular systems of matter, or universally to all, must be considered
in philosophy; because philosophy will be otherwise imperfect. Whether
those properties can be deduced from some other appertaining to
matter, either among those, which are already known, or among such as
can be discovered by us, is afterwards to be sought for the farther
improvement of our knowledge. But this inquiry cannot properly have
place in the deliberation about admitting any property of matter or
bodies into philosophy; for that purpose it is only to be considered,
whether the existence of such a property has been justly proved or not.
Therefore to decide what causes of things are rightly received into
natural philosophy, requires only a distinct and clear conception of
what kind of reasoning is to be allowed of as convincing, when we argue
upon the works of nature.

20. THE proofs in natural philosophy cannot be so absolutely
conclusive, as in the mathematics. For the subjects of that science
are purely the ideas of our own minds. They may be represented to our
senses by material objects, but they are themselves the arbitrary
productions of our own thoughts; so that as the mind can have a full
and adequate knowledge of its own ideas, the reasoning in geometry
can be rendered perfect. But in natural knowledge the subject of
our contemplation is without us, and not so compleatly to be known:
therefore our method of arguing must fall a little short of absolute
perfection. It is only here required to steer a just course between
the conjectural method of proceeding, against which I have so largely
spoke; and demanding so rigorous a proof, as will reduce all philosophy
to mere scepticism, and exclude all prospect of making any progress in
the knowledge of nature.

21. THE concessions, which are to be allowed in this science, are by
Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ included under a very few simple precepts.

22. THE first is, that more causes are not to be received into
philosophy, than are sufficient to explain the appearances of nature.
That this rule is approved of unanimously, is evident from those
expressions so frequent among all philosophers, that nature does
nothing in vain; and that a variety of means, where fewer would
suffice, is needless. And certainly there is the highest reason
for complying with this rule. For should we indulge the liberty of
multiplying, without necessity, the causes of things, it would reduce
all philosophy to mere uncertainty; since the only proof, which we can
have, of the existence of a cause, is the necessity of it for producing
known effects. Therefore where one cause is sufficient, if there really
should in nature be two, which is in the last degree improbable, we can
have no possible means of knowing it, and consequently ought not to
take the liberty of imagining, that there are more than one.

23. THE second precept is the direct consequence of the first, that to
like effects are to be ascribed the same causes. For instance, that
respiration in men and in brutes is brought about by the same means;
that bodies descend to the earth here in EUROPE, and in AMERICA from
the same principle; that the light of a culinary fire, and of the sun
have the same manner of production; that the reflection of light is
effected in the earth, and in the planets by the same power; and the
like.

24. THE third of these precepts has equally evident reason for it.
It is only, that those qualities, which in the same body can neither
be lessened nor increased, and which belong to all bodies that are
in our power to make trial upon, ought to be accounted the universal
properties of all bodies whatever.

25. IN this precept is founded that method of arguing by induction,
without which no progress could be made in natural philosophy. For as
the qualities of bodies become known to us by experiments only; we
have no other way of finding the properties of such bodies, as are
out of our reach to experiment upon, but by drawing conclusions from
those which fall under our examination. The only caution here required
is, that the observations and experiments, we argue upon, be numerous
enough, and that due regard be paid to all objections, that occur, as
the Lord BACON very judiciously directs[42]. And this admonition is
sufficiently complied with, when by virtue of this rule we ascribe
impenetrability and extension to all bodies, though we have no sensible
experiment, that affords a direct proof of any of the celestial bodies
being impenetrable; nor that the fixed stars are so much as extended.
For the more perfect our instruments are, whereby we attempt to find
their visible magnitude, the less they appear; insomuch that all the
sensible magnitude, which we observe in them, seems only to be an
optical deception by the scattering of their light. However, I suppose
no one will imagine they are without any magnitude, though their
immense distance makes it undiscernable by us. After the same manner,
if it can be proved, that all bodies here gravitate towards the earth,
in proportion to the quantity of solid matter in each; and that the
moon gravitates to the earth likewise, in proportion to the quantity
of matter in it; and that the sea gravitates towards the moon, and
all the planets towards each other; and that the very comets have the
same gravitating faculty; we shall have as great reason to conclude by
this rule, that all bodies gravitate towards each other. For indeed
this rule will more strongly hold in this case, than in that of the
impenetrability of bodies; because there will more instances be had of
bodies gravitating, than of their being impenetrable.

25. THIS is that method of induction, whereon all philosophy is
founded; which our author farther inforces by this additional precept,
that whatever is collected from this induction, ought to be received,
notwithstanding any conjectural hypothesis to the contrary, till such
times as it shall be contradicted or limited by farther observations on
nature.

[Illustration]

[Illustration]




  ~BOOK I.~
  CONCERNING THE
  MOTION of BODIES
  IN GENERAL.


  CHAP. I.
  Of the LAWS of MOTION.

HAVING thus explained Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON’s~ method of reasoning
in philosophy, I shall now proceed to my intended account of his
discoveries. These are contained in two treatises. In one of them, the
MATHEMATICAL PRINCIPLES OF NATURAL PHILOSOPHY, his chief design is to
shew by what laws the heavenly motions are regulated; in the other,
his OPTICS, he discourses of the nature of light and colours, and of
the action between light and bodies. This second treatise is wholly
confined to the subject of light: except some conjectures proposed
at the end concerning other parts of nature, which lie hitherto more
concealed. In the other treatise our author was obliged to smooth the
way to his principal intention, by explaining many things of a more
general nature: for even some of the most simple properties of matter
were scarce well established at that time. We may therefore reduce Sir
~ISAAC NEWTON~’s doctrine under three general heads; and I
shall accordingly divide my account into three books. In the first I
shall speak of what he has delivered concerning the motion of bodies,
without regard to any particular system of matter; in the second I
shall treat of the heavenly motions; and the third shall be employed
upon light.

2. IN the first part of my design, we must begin with an account of the
general laws of motion.

3. THESE laws are some universal affections and properties of matter
drawn from experience, which are made use of as axioms and evident
principles in all our arguings upon the motion of bodies. For as it
is the custom of geometers to assume in their demonstrations some
propositions, without exhibiting the proof of them; so in philosophy,
all our reasoning must be built upon some properties of matter, first
admitted as principles whereon to argue. In geometry these axioms are
thus assumed, on account of their being so evident as to make any
proof in form needless. But in philosophy no properties of bodies can
be in this manner received for self-evident; since it has been observed
above, that we can conclude nothing concerning matter by any reasonings
upon its nature and essence, but that we owe all the knowledge, we
have thereof, to experience. Yet when our observations on matter have
inform’d us of some of its properties, we may securely reason upon them
in our farther inquiries into nature. And these laws of motion, of
which I am here to speak, are found so universally to belong to bodies,
that there is no motion known, which is not regulated by them. These
are by Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ reduced to three[43].

4. THE first law is, that all bodies have such an indifference to rest,
or motion, that if once at rest they remain so, till disturbed by some
power acting upon them: but if once put in motion, they persist in
it; continuing to move right forwards perpetually, after the power,
which gave the motion, is removed; and also preserving the same degree
of velocity or quickness, as was first communicated, not stopping or
remitting their course, till interrupted or otherwise disturbed by some
new power impressed.

5. THE second law of motion is, that the alteration of the state of
any body, whether from rest to motion, or from motion to rest, or
from one degree of motion to another, is always proportional to the
force impressed. A body at rest, when acted upon by any power, yields
to that power, moving in the same line, in which the power applied
is directed; and moves with a less or greater degree of velocity,
according to the degree of the power; so that twice the power shall
communicate a double velocity, and three times the power a threefold
velocity. If the body be moving, and the power impressed act upon the
body in the direction of its motion, the body shall receive an addition
to its motion, as great as the motion, into which that power would
have put it from a state of rest; but if the power impressed upon a
moving body act directly opposite to its former motion, that power
shall then take away from the body’s motion, as much as in the other
case it would have added to it. Lastly, if the power be impressed
obliquely, there will arise an oblique motion differing more or less
from the former direction, according as the new impression is greater
or less. For example, if the body A (in fig. 1.) be moving in the
direction A B, and when it is at the point A, a power be impressed upon
it in the direction A C, the body shall from henceforth neither move
in its first direction A B, nor in the direction of the adventitious
power, but shall take a course as A D between them: and if the power
last impressed be just equal to that, which first gave to the body
its motion; the line A D shall pass in the middle between A B and A
C, dividing the angle under B A C into two equal parts; but if the
power last impressed be greater than the first, the line A D shall
incline most to A C; whereas if the last impression be less than the
first, the line A D shall incline most to A B. To be more particular,
the situation of the line A D is always to be determined after this
manner. Let A E be the space, which the body would have moved through
in the line A B during any certain portion of time; provided that body,
when at A, had received no second impulse. Suppose likewise, that A F
is the part of the line A C, through which the body would have moved
during an equal portion of time, if it had been at rest in A, when it
received the impulse in the direction A C: then if from E be drawn a
line parallel to, or equidistant from A C, and from F another line
parallel to A B, those two lines will meet in the line A D.

6. THE third and last of these laws of motion is, that when any body
acts upon another, the action of that body upon the other is equalled
by the contrary reaction of that other body upon the first.

7. THESE laws of motion are abundantly confirmed by this, that all the
deductions made from them, in relation to the motion of bodies, how
complicated soever, are found to agree perfectly with observation. This
shall be shewn more at large in the next chapter. But before we proceed
to so diffusive a proof; I chuse here to point out those appearances of
bodies, whereby the laws of motion are first suggested to us.

8. DAILY observation makes it appear to us, that any body, which we
once see at rest, never puts it self into fresh motion; but continues
always in the same place, till removed by some power applied to it.

9. AGAIN, whenever a body is once in motion, it continues in that
motion some time after the moving power has quitted it, and it is left
to it self. Now if the body continue to move but a single moment, after
the moving power has left it, there can no reason be assigned, why it
should ever stop without some external force. For it is plain, that
this continuance of the motion is caused only by the body’s having
already moved, the sole operation of the power upon the body being the
putting it in motion; therefore that motion continued will equally be
the cause of its farther motion, and so on without end. The only doubt
that can remain, is, whether this motion communicated continues intire,
after the power, that caused it, ceases to act; or whether it does not
gradually languish and decrease. And this suspicion cannot be removed
by a transient and slight observation on bodies, but will be fully
cleared up by those more accurate proofs of the laws of motion, which
are to be considered in the next chapter.

10. LASTLY, bodies in motion appear to affect a straight course without
any deviation, unless when disturbed by some adventitious power acting
upon them. If a body be thrown perpendicularly upwards or downwards,
it appears to continue in the same straight line during the whole time
of its motion. If a body be thrown in any other direction, it is found
to deviate from the line, in which it began to move, more and more
continually towards the earth, whither it is directed by its weight:
but since, when the weight of a body does not alter the direction of
its motion, it always moves in a straight line, without doubt in this
other case the body’s, declining from its first course is no more,
than what is caused by its weight alone. As this appears at first
sight to be unquestionable, so we shall have a very distinct proof
thereof in the next chapter, where the oblique motion of bodies will be
particularly considered.

11. THUS we see how the first of the laws of motion agrees with
what appears to us in moving bodies. But here occurs this farther
consideration, that the real and absolute motion of any body is not
visible to us: for we are our selves also in constant motion along with
the earth whereon we dwell; insomuch that we perceive bodies to move
so far only, as their motion is different from our own. When a body
appears to us to lie at rest, in reality it only continues the motion,
it has received, without putting forth any power to change that motion.
If we throw a body in the course or direction, wherein we are carried
our selves; so much motion as we seem to have given to the body, so
much we have truly added to the motion, it had, while it appeared to us
to be at rest. But if we impel a body the contrary way, although the
body appears to us to have received by such an impulse as much motion,
as when impelled the other way; yet in this case we have taken from the
body so much real motion, as we seem to have given it. Thus the motion,
which we see in bodies, is not their real motion, but only relative
with respect to us; and the forementioned observations only shew us,
that this first law of motion has place in this relative or apparent
motion. However, though we cannot make any observation immediately on
the absolute motion of bodies, yet by reasoning upon what we observe
in visible motion, we can discover the properties and effects of real
motion.

12. WITH regard to this first law of motion, which is now under
consideration, we may from the foregoing observations most truly
collect, that bodies are disposed to continue in the absolute motion,
which they have once received, without increasing or diminishing their
velocity. When a body appears to us to lie at rest, it really preserves
without change the motion, which it has in common with our selves:
and when we put it into visible motion, and we see it continue that
motion; this proves, that the body retains that degree of its absolute
motion, into which it is put by our acting upon it: if we give it such
an apparent motion, which adds to its real motion, it preserves that
addition; and if our acting on the body takes off from its real motion,
it continues afterwards to move with no more real motion, than we have
left it.

13. AGAIN, we do not observe in bodies any disposition or power within
themselves to change the direction of their motion; and if they had any
such power, it would easily be discovered. For suppose a body by the
structure or disposition of its parts, or by any other circumstance in
its make, was indued with a power of moving it self; this self-moving
principle, which should be thus inherent in the body, and not depend on
any thing external, must change the direction wherein it would act, as
often as the position of the body was changed: so that for instance,
if a body was lying before me in such a position, that the direction,
wherein this principle disposes the body to move, was pointed directly
from me; if I then gradually turned the body about, the direction
of this self-moving principle would no longer be pointed directly
from me, but would turn about along with the body. Now if any body,
which appears to us at rest, were furnished with any such self-moving
principle; from the body’s appearing without motion we must conclude,
that this self-moving principle lies directed the same way as the
earth is carrying the body; and such a body might immediately be put
into visible motion only by turning it about in any degree, that this
self-moving principle might receive a different direction.

14. FROM these considerations it very plainly follows, that if a body
were once absolutely at rest; not being furnished with any principle,
whereby it could put it self into motion, it must for ever continue in
the same place, till acted upon by something external: and also that
when a body is put into motion, it has no power within it self to make
any change in the direction of that motion; and consequently that the
body must move on straight forward without declining any way whatever.
But it has before been shewn, that bodies do not appear to have in
themselves any power to change the velocity of their motion: therefore
this first law of motion has been illustrated and confirmed, as much as
can be from the transient observations, which have here been discoursed
upon; and in the next chapter all this will be farther established by
more correct observations.

15. BUT I shall now pass to the second law of motion; wherein, when it
is asserted, that the velocity, with which any body is moved by the
action of a power upon it, is proportional to that power; the degree of
power is supposed to be measured by the greatness of the body, which
it can move with a given celerity. So that the sense of this law is,
that if any body were put into motion with that degree of swiftness, as
to pass in one hour the length of a thousand yards; the power, which
would give the same degree of velocity to a body twice as great, would
give this lesser body twice the velocity, causing it to describe in the
same space of an hour two thousand yards. But by a body twice as great
as another, I do not here mean simply of twice the bulk, but one that
contains a double quantity of solid matter.

16. WHY the power, which can move a body twice as great as another with
the same degree of velocity, should be called twice as great as the
power, which can give the lesser body the same velocity, is evident.
For if we should suppose the greater body to be divided into two equal
parts, each equal to the lesser body, each of these halves will require
the same degree of power to move them with the velocity of the lesser
body, as the lesser body it self requires; and therefore both those
halves, or the whole greater body, will require the moving power to be
doubled.

17. THAT the moving power being in this sense doubled, should just
double likewise the velocity of the same body, seems near as evident,
if we consider, that the effect of the power applied must needs be
the same, whether that power be applied to the body at once, or in
parts. Suppose then the double power not applied to the body at
once, but half of it first, and afterwards the other half; it is not
conceivable for what reason the half last applied should come to have
a different effect upon the body, from that which is applied first;
as it must have, if the velocity of the body was not just doubled by
the application of it. So far as experience can determine, we see
nothing to favour such a supposition. We cannot indeed (by reason of
the constant motion of the earth) make trial upon any body perfectly at
rest, whereby to see whether a power applied in that case would have a
different effect, from what it has, when the body is already moving;
but we find no alteration in the effect of the same power on account of
any difference there may be in the motion of the body, when the power
is applied. The earth does not always carry bodies with the same degree
of velocity; yet we find the visible effects of any power applied to
the same body to be, at all times the very same: and a bale of goods,
or other moveable body lying in a ship is as easily removed from place
to place, while the ship is under sail, if its motion be steady, as
when it is fixed at anchor.

18. NOW this experience is alone sufficient to shew to us the whole of
this law of motion.

19. SINCE we find, that the same power will always produce the same
change in the motion of any body, whether that body were before moving
with a swifter or slower motion; the change wrought in the motion of
a body depends only on the power applied to it, without any regard to
the body’s former motion: and therefore the degree of motion, which the
body already possesses, having no influence on the power applied to
disturb its operation, the effects of the same power will not only be
the same in all degrees of motion of the body; but we have likewise no
reason to doubt, but that a body perfectly at rest would receive from
any power as much motion, as would be equivalent to the effect of the
same power applied to that body already in motion.

20. AGAIN, suppose a body being at rest, any number of equal powers
should be successively applied to it; pushing it forward from time to
time in the same course or direction. Upon the application of the first
power the body would begin to move; when the second power was applied,
it appears from what has been said, that the motion of the body would
become double; the third power would treble the motion of the body; and
so on, till after the operation of the last power the motion of the
body would be as many times the motion, which the first power gave it,
as there are powers in number. and the effect of this number of powers
will be always the same, without any regard to the space of time taken
up in applying them: so that greater or lesser intervals between the
application of each of these powers will produce no difference at all
in their effects. Since therefore the distance of time between the
action of each power is of no consequence; without doubt the effect
will still be the same, though the powers should all be applied at
the very same instant; or although a single power should be applied
equal in strength to the collective force of all these powers. Hence
it plainly follows, that the degree of motion, into which any body
will be put out of a state of rest by any power, will be proportional
to that power. A double power will give twice the velocity, a treble
power three times the velocity, and so on. The foregoing reasoning will
equally take place, though the body were not supposed to be at rest,
when the powers began to be applied to it; provided the direction, in
which the powers were applied, either conspired with the action of
the body, or was directly opposite to it. Therefore if any power be
applied to a moving body, and act upon the body either in the direction
wherewith the body moves, so as to accelerate the body; or if it act
directly opposite to the motion of the body, so as to <DW44> it: in
both these cases the change of motion will be proportional to the
power applied; nay, the augmentation of the motion in one case, and
the diminution thereof in the other, will be equal to that degree of
motion, into which the same power would put the body, had it been at
rest, when the power was applied.

21. FARTHER, a power may be so applied to a moving body, as to act
obliquely to the motion of the body. And the effects of such an oblique
motion may be deduced from this observation; that as all bodies are
continually moving along with the earth, we see that the visible
effects of the same power are always the same, in whatever direction
the power acts: and therefore the visible effects of any power upon
a body, which seems only to be at rest, is always to appearance the
same as the real effect would be upon a body truly at rest. Now
suppose a body were moving along the line A B (in fig. 2.) and the eye
accompanied it with an equal motion in the line C D equidistant from A
B; so that when the body is at A, the eye shall be at C, and when the
body is advanced to E in the line A B, the eye shall be advanced to F
in the line C D, the distances A E and C F being equal. It is evident,
that here the body will appear to the eye to be at rest; and the line
F E G drawn from the eye through the body shall seem to the eye to be
immoveable; though as the body and eye move forward together, this
line shall really also move; so that when the body shall be advanced
to H and the eye to K, the line F E G shall be transferred into the
situation K H L, this line K H L being equidistant from F E G. Now
if the body when at E were to receive an impulse in the direction of
the line F E G; while the eye is moving on from F to K and carrying
along with it the line F E G, the body will appear to the eye to move
along this line F E G: for this is what has just now been said; that
while bodies are moving along with the earth, and the spectator’s eye
partakes of the same motion, the effect of any power upon the body
will appear to be what it would really have been, had the body been
truly at rest, when the power was applied. From hence it follows, that
when the eye is advanced to K, the body will appear somewhere in the
line K H L. Suppose it appear in M; then it is manifest, from what has
been premised at the beginning of this paragraph, that the distance H
M is equal to what the body would have run upon the line E G, during
the time, wherein the eye has passed from F to K, provided that the
body had been at rest, when acted upon in E. If it be farther asked,
after what manner the body has moved from E to M? I answer, through a
straight line; for it has been shewn above in the explication of the
first law of motion, that a moving body, from the time it is left to it
self, will proceed on in one continued straight line.

22. IF E N be taken equal to H M and N M be drawn; since H M is
equidistant from E N, N M will be equidistant from E H. Therefore the
effect of any power upon a moving body, when that power acts obliquely
to the motion of the body, is to be determined in this manner. Suppose
the body is moving along the straight line A E B, if when the body is
come to E, a power gives it an impulse in the direction of the line E
G, to find what course the body will afterwards take we must proceed
thus. Take in E B any length E H, and in E G take such a length E N,
that if the body had been at rest in E, the power applied to it would
have caused it to move over E N in the same space of time, as it would
have employed in passing over E H, if the power had not acted at all
upon it. Then draw H L equidistant from E G, and N M equidistant from
E B. After this, if a line be drawn from E to the point M, where these
two lines meet, the line E M will be the course into which the body
will be put by the action of the power upon it at E.

23. A MATHEMATICAL reader would here expect in some particulars more
regular demonstrations; but as I do not at present address my self to
such, so I hope, what I have now written will render my meaning evident
enough to those, who are unacquainted with that kind of reasoning.

24. NOW as we have been shewing, that some actual force is necessary
either to put bodies out of a state of rest into motion, or to change
the motion, which they have once received; it is proper here to
observe, that this quality in bodies, whereby they preserve their
present state, with regard to motion or rest, till some active force
disturb them, is called the ~VIS INERTIAE~ of matter: and
by this property, matter, sluggish and unactive of it self, retains
all the power impressed upon it, and cannot be made to cease from
action, but by the opposition of as great a power, as that which first
moved it. By the degree of this ~VIS INERTIAE~, or power of
inactivity, as we shall henceforth call it, we primarily judge of the
quantity of solid matter in each body; for as this quality is inherent
in all the bodies, upon which we can make any trial, we conclude it to
be a property essential to all matter; and as we yet know no reason
to suppose, that bodies are composed of different kinds of matter, we
rather presume, that the matter of all bodies is the same; and that
the degree of this power of inactivity is in every body proportional
to the quantity of the solid matter in it. But although we have no
absolute proof, that all the matter in the universe is uniform, and
possesses this power of inactivity in the same degree; yet we can with
certainty compare together the different degrees of this power of
inactivity in different bodies. Particularly this power is proportional
to the weight of bodies, as Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has demonstrated[44].
However, notwithstanding that this power of inactivity in any body can
be more certainly known, than the quantity of solid matter in it; yet
since there is no reason to suspect that one is not proportional to
the other, we shall hereafter speak without hesitation of the quantity
of matter in bodies, as the measure of the degree of their power of
inactivity.

25. THIS being established, we may now compare the effects of the
same power upon different bodies, as hitherto we have shewn the
effects of different powers upon the same body. And here if we limit
the word motion to the peculiar sense given to it in philosophy, we
may comprehend all that is to be said upon this head under one short
precept; that the same power, to whatever body it is applied, will
always produce the same degree of motion. But here motion does not
signify the degree of celerity or velocity with which a body moves,
in which sense only we have hitherto used it; but it is made use of
particularly in philosophy to signify the force with which a body
moves: as if two bodies A and B being in motion, twice the force
would be required to stop A as to stop B, the motion of A would be
esteemed double the motion of B. In moving bodies, these two things are
carefully to be distinguished; their velocity or celerity, which is
measured by the space they pass through during any determinate portion
of time; and the quantity of their motion, or the force, with which
they will press against any resistance. Which force, when different
bodies move with the same velocity, is proportional to the quantity of
solid matter in the bodies; but if the bodies are equal, this force is
proportional to their respective velocities, and in other cases it is
proportional both to the quantity of solid matter in the body, and also
to its velocity. To instance in two bodies A and B: if A be twice as
great as B, and they have both the same velocity, the motion of A shall
be double the motion of B; and if the bodies be equal, and the velocity
of A be twice that of B, the motion of A shall likewise be double that
of B; but if A be twice as large as B, and move twice as swift, the
motion of A will be four times the motion of B; and lastly, if A be
twice as large as B, and move but half as fast, the degree of their
motion shall be the same.

26. THIS is the particular sense given to the word motion by
philosophers, and in this sense of the word the same power always
produces the same quantity or degree of motion. If the same power act
upon two bodies A and B, the velocities, it shall give to each of them,
shall be so adjusted to the respective bodies, that the same degree
of motion shall be produced in each. If A be twice as great as B, its
velocity shall be half that of B; if A has three times as much solid
matter as B, the velocity of A shall be one third of the velocity of B;
and generally the velocity given to A shall bear the same proportion to
the velocity given to B, as the quantity of solid matter contained in
the body B bears to the quantity of solid matter contained in A.

27. THE reason of all this is evident from what has gone before. If
a power were applied to B, which should bear the same proportion to
the power applied to A, as the body B bears to A, the bodies B and
A would both receive the same velocity; and the velocity, which B
will receive from this power, will bear the same proportion to the
velocity, which it would receive from the action of the power applied
to A, as the former of these powers bears to the latter: that is, the
velocity, which A receives from the power applied to it, will bear
to the velocity, which B would receive from the same power, the same
proportion as the body B bears to A.

28. FROM hence we may now pass to the third law of motion, where
this distinction between the velocity of a body and its whole motion
is farther necessary to be regarded, as shall immediately be shewn;
after having first illustrated the meaning of this law by a familiar
instance. If a stone or other load be drawn by a horse; the load
re-acts upon the horse, as much as the horse acts upon the load; for
the harness, which is strained between them, presses against the horse
as much as against the load; and the progressive motion of the horse
forward is hindred as much by the load, as the motion of the load is
promoted by the endeavour of the horse: that is, if the horse put forth
the same strength, when loosened from the load, he would move himself
forwards with greater swiftness in proportion to the difference between
the weight of his own body and the weight of himself and load together.

29. THIS instance will afford some general notion of the meaning of
this law. But to proceed to a more philosophical explication: if a body
in motion strike against another at rest, let the body striking be
ever so small, yet shall it communicate some degree of motion to the
body it strikes against, though the less that body be in comparison
of that it impinges upon, and the less the velocity is, with which
it moves, the smaller will be the motion communicated. But whatever
degree of motion it gives to the resting body, the same it shall lose
it self. This is the necessary consequence of the forementioned power
of inactivity in matter. For suppose the two bodies equal, it is
evident from the time they meet, both the bodies are to be moved by the
single motion of the first; therefore the body in motion by means of
its power of inactivity retaining the motion first given it, strikes
upon the other with the same force, wherewith it was acted upon it
self: but now both the bodies being to be moved by that force, which
before moved one only, the ensuing velocity will be the same, as if the
power, which was applied to one of the bodies, and put it into motion,
had been applied to both; whence it appears, that they will proceed
forwards, with half the velocity, which the body first in motion had:
that is, the body first moved will have lost half its motion, and the
other will have gained exactly as much. This rule is just, provided
the bodies keep contiguous after meeting; as they would always do, if
it were not for a certain cause that often intervenes, and which must
now be explained. Bodies upon striking against each other, suffer an
alteration in their figure, having their parts pressed inwards by the
stroke, which for the most part recoil again afterwards, the bodies
endeavouring to recover their former shape. This power, whereby bodies
are inabled to regain their first figure, is usually called their
elasticity, and when it acts, it forces the bodies from each other,
and causes them to separate. Now the effect of this elasticity in the
present case is such, that if the bodies are perfectly elastic, so
as to recoil with as great a force as they are bent with, that they
recover their figure in the same space of time, as has been taken up
in the alteration made in it by their compression together; then this
power will separate the bodies as swiftly, as they before approached,
and acting upon both equally, upon the body first in motion contrary
to the direction in which it moves, and upon the other as much in the
direction of its motion, it will take from the first, and add to the
other equal degrees of velocity: so that the power being strong enough
to separate them with as great a velocity, as they approached with, the
first will be quite stopt, and that which was at rest, will receive all
the motion of the other. If the bodies are elastic in a less degree,
the first will not lose all its motion, nor will the other acquire
the motion of the first, but fall as much short of it, as the other
retains. For this rule is never deviated from, that though the degree
of elasticity determines how much more than half its velocity the body
first in motion shall lose; yet in every case the loss in the motion
of this body shall be transferred to the other, that other body always
receiving by the stroke as much motion, as is taken from the first.

30. This is the case of a body striking directly against an equal body
at rest, and the reasoning here used is fully confirmed by experience.
There are many other cases of bodies impinging against one another: but
the mention of these shall be reserved to the next chapter, where we
intend to be more particular and diffusive in the proof of these laws
of motion, than we have been here.




CHAP. II.

Farther proofs of the LAWS OF MOTION.


HAVING in the preceding chapter deduced the three laws of motion,
delivered by our great philosopher, from the most obvious observations,
that suggest them to us; I now intend to give more particular proofs
of them, by recounting some of the discoveries which have been made in
philosophy before Sir Isaac Newton. For as they were all collected by
reasoning upon those laws; so the conformity of these discoveries to
experience makes them so many proofs of the truth of the principles,
from which they were derived.

2. LET us begin with the subject, which concluded the last chapter.
Although the body in motion be not equal to the body at rest, on which
it strikes; yet the motion after the stroke is to be estimated in the
same manner as above. Let A (in fig. 3.) be a body in motion towards
another body B lying at rest. When A is arrived at B, it cannot proceed
farther without putting B into motion; and what motion it gives to
B, it must lose it self, that the whole degree of motion of A and B
together, if neither of the bodies be elastic, shall be equal, after
the meeting of the bodies, to the single motion of A before the stroke.
Therefore, from what has been said above, it is manifest, that as soon
as the two bodies are met, they will move on together with a velocity,
which will bear the same proportion to the original velocity of A, as
the body A bears to the sum of both the bodies.

3. IF the bodies are elastic, so that they shall separate after the
stroke, A must lose a greater part of its motion, and the subsequent
motion of B will be augmented by this elasticity, as much as the motion
of A is diminished by it. The elasticity acting equally between both
the bodies, it will communicate to each the same degree of motion; that
is, it will separate the bodies by taking from the body A and adding
to the body B different degrees of velocity, so proportioned to their
respective quantities of matter, that the degree of motion, wherewith
A separates from B, shall be equal to the degree of motion, wherewith
B separates from A. It follows therefore, that the velocity taken from
A by the elasticity bears to the velocity, which the same elasticity
adds to B, the same proportion, as B bears to A: consequently the
velocity, which the elasticity takes from A, will bear the same
proportion to the whole velocity, wherewith this elasticity causes the
two bodies to separate from each other, as the body B bears to the sum
of the two bodies A and B; and the velocity, which is added to B by the
elasticity, bears to the velocity, wherewith the bodies separate, the
same proportion, as the body A bears to the sum of the two bodies A
and B. Thus is found, how much the elasticity takes from the velocity
of A, and adds to the velocity of B; provided the degree of elasticity
be known, whereby to determine the whole velocity wherewith the bodies
separate from each other after the stroke[45].

4. AFTER this manner is determined in every case the result of a body
in motion striking against another at rest. The same principles will
also determine the effects, when both bodies are in motion.

5. LET two equal bodies move against each other with equal swiftness.
Then the force, with which each of them presses forwards, being equal
when they strike; each pressing in its own direction with the same
energy, neither shall surmount the other, but both be stopt, if they
be not elastic: for if they be elastic, they shall from thence recover
new motion, and recede from each other, as swiftly as they met, if they
be perfectly elastic; but more slowly, if less so. In the same manner,
if two bodies of unequal bigness strike against each other, and their
velocities be so related, that the velocity of the lesser body shall
exceed the velocity of the greater in the same proportion, as the
greater body exceeds the lesser (for instance, if one body contains
twice the solid matter as the other, and moves but half as fast) two
such bodies will entirely suppress each other’s motion, and remain from
the time of their meeting fixed; if, as before, they are not elastic:
but, if they are so in the highest degree, they shall recede again,
each with the same velocity, wherewith they met. For this elastic
power, as in the preceding case, shall renew their motion, and pressing
equally upon both, shall give the same motion to both; that is, shall
cause the velocity, which the lesser body receives, to bear the same
proportion to the velocity, which the greater receives, as the greater
body bears to the lesser: so that the velocities shall bear the same
proportion to each other after the stroke, as before. Therefore if the
bodies, by being perfectly elastic, have the sum of their velocities
after the stroke equal to the sum of their velocities before the
stroke, each body after the stroke will receive its first velocity.
And the same proportion will hold likewise between the velocities,
wherewith they go off, though they are elastic but in a less degree;
only then the velocity of each will be less in proportion to the defect
of elasticity.

6. IF the velocities, wherewith the bodies meet, are not in the
proportion here supposed; but if one of the bodies, as A, has a swifter
velocity in comparison to the velocity of the other; then the effect
of this excess of velocity in the body A must be joined to the effect
now mentioned, after the manner of this following example. Let A be
twice as great as B, and move with the same swiftness as B. Here A
moves with twice that degree of swiftness, which would answer to the
forementioned proportion. For A being double to B, if it moved but
with half the swiftness, wherewith B advances, it has been just now
shewn, that the two bodies upon meeting would stop, if they were not
elastic; and if they were elastic, that they would each recoil, so as
to cause A to return with half the velocity, wherewith B would return.
But it is evident from hence, that B by encountring A will annul half
its velocity, if the bodies be not elastic; and the future motion of
the bodies will be the same, as if A had advanced against B at rest
with half the velocity here assigned to it. If the bodies be elastic,
the velocity of A and B after the stroke may be thus discovered. As
the two bodies advance against each other, the velocity, with which
they meet, is made up of the velocities of both bodies added together.
After the stroke their elasticity will separate them again. The degree
of elasticity will determine what proportion the velocity, wherewith
they separate, must bear to that, wherewith they meet. Divide this
velocity, with which the bodies separate into two parts, that one of
the parts bear to the other the same proportion, as the body A bears to
B; and ascribe the lesser part to the greater body A, and the greater
part of the velocity to the lesser body B. Then take the part ascribed
to A from the common velocity, which A and B would have had after the
stroke, if they had not been elastic; and add the part ascribed to B to
the same common velocity. By this means the true velocities of A and B
after the stroke will be made known.

7. IF the bodies are perfectly elastic, the great ~HUYGENS~
has laid down this rule for finding their motion after concourse[46].
Any straight line C D (in fig. 4, 5.) being drawn, let it be divided
in E, that C E bear the same proportion to E D, as the swiftness of A
bore to the swiftness of B before the stroke. Let the same line C D be
also divided in F, that C F bear the same proportion to F D, as the
body B bears to the body A. Then F G being taken equal to F E, if the
point G falls within the line C D, both the bodies shall recoil after
the stroke, and the velocity, wherewith the body A shall return, will
bear the same proportion to the velocity, wherewith B shall return, as
G C bears to G D; but if the point G falls without the line C D, then
the bodies after their concourse shall both proceed to move the same
way, and the velocity of A shall bear to the velocity of B the same
proportion, that G C bears to G D, as before.

8. IF the body B had stood still, and received the impulse of the other
body A upon it; the effect has been already explained in the case, when
the bodies are not elastic. And when they are elastic, the result of
their collision is found by combining the effect of the elasticity with
the other effect, in the same manner as in the last case.

9. WHEN the bodies are perfectly elastic, the rule of
~HUYGENS~[47] here is to divide the line C D (fig. 6.) in E as
before, and to take E G equal to E D. And by these points thus found,
the motion of each body after the stroke is determined, as before.

10. IN the next place, suppose the bodies A and B were both moving the
same way, but A with a swifter motion, so as to overtake B, and strike
against it. The effect of the percussion or stroke, when the bodies are
not elastic, is discovered by finding the common motion, which the two
bodies would have after the stroke, if B were at rest, and A were to
advance against it with a velocity equal to the excess of the present
velocity of A above the velocity of B; and by adding to this common
velocity thus found the velocity of B.

11. IF the bodies are elastic, the effect of the elasticity is to be
united with this other, as in the former cases.

12. WHEN the bodies are perfectly elastic, the rule of HUYGENS[48] in
this case is to prolong C D (fig. 7.) and to take in it thus prolonged
C E in the same proportion to E D, as the greater velocity of A bears
to the lesser velocity of B; after which F G being taken equal to F E,
the velocities of the two bodies after the stroke will be determined,
as in the two preceding cases.

13. THUS I have given the sum of what has been written concerning the
effects of percussion, when two bodies freely in motion strike directly
against each other; and the results here set down, as the consequence
of our reasoning from the laws of motion, answer most exactly to
experience. A particular set of experiments has been invented to make
trial of these effects of percussion with the greatest exactness. But
I must defer these experiments, till I have explained the nature of
pendulums[49]. I shall therefore now proceed to describe some of the
appearances, which are caused in bodies from the influence of the power
of gravity united with the general laws of motion; among which the
motion of the pendulum will be included.

14. THE most simple of these appearances is, when bodies fall down
merely by their weight. In this case the body increases continually
its velocity, during the whole time of its fall, and that in the very
same proportion as the time increases. For the power of gravity acts
constantly on the body with the same degree of strength: and it has
been observed above in the first law of motion, that a body being once
in motion will perpetually preserve that motion without the continuance
of any external influence upon it: therefore, after a body has been
once put in motion by the force of gravity, the body would continue
that motion, though the power of gravity should cease to act any
farther upon it; but, if the power of gravity continues still to draw
the body down, fresh degrees of motion must continually be added to
the body; and the power of gravity acting at all times with the same
strength, equal degrees of motion will constantly be added in equal
portions of time.

15. THIS conclusion is not indeed absolutely true: for we shall find
hereafter[50], that the power of gravity is not of the same strength at
all distances from the center of the earth. But nothing of this is in
the least sensible in any distance, to which we can convey bodies. The
weight of bodies is the very same to sense upon the highest towers or
mountains, as upon the level ground; so that in all the observations
we can make, the forementioned proportion between the velocity of a
falling body and the time, in which it has been descending, obtains
without any the least perceptible difference.

16. FROM hence it follows, that the space, through which a body falls,
is not proportional to the time of the fall; for since the body
increases its velocity, a greater space will be passed over in the same
portion of time at the latter part of the fall, than at the beginning.
Suppose a body let fall from the point A (in fig. 8.) were to descend
from A to B in any portion of time; then if in an equal portion of time
it were to proceed from B to C; I say, the space B C is greater than A
B; so that the time of the fall from A to C being double the time of
the fall from A to B, A C shall be more than double of A B.

17. THE geometers have proved, that the spaces, through which bodies
fall thus by their weight, are just in a duplicate or two-fold
proportion of the times, in which the body has been falling. That is,
if we were to take the line D E in the same proportion to A B, as the
time, which the body has imployed in falling from A to C, bears to the
time of the fall from A to B; then A C will be to D E in the same
proportion. In particular, if the time of the fall through A C be twice
the time of the fall through A B; then D E will be twice A B, and A C
twice D E; or A C four times A B. But if the time of the fall through
A C had been thrice the time of the fall through A B; D E would have
been treble of A B, and A C treble of D E; that is, A C would have been
equal to nine times A B.

18. IF a body fall obliquely, it will approach the ground by slower
degrees, than when it falls perpendicularly. Suppose two lines A B, A
C (in fig. 9.) were drawn, one perpendicular, and the other oblique to
the ground D E: then if a body were to descend in the slanting line
A C; because the power of gravity draws the body directly downwards,
if the line A C supports the body from falling in that manner, it
must take off part of the effect of the power of gravity; so that
in the time, which would have been sufficient for the body to have
fallen through the whole perpendicular line A B, the body shall not
have passed in the line A C a length equal to A B; consequently the
line A C being longer than A B, the body shall most certainly take up
more time in passing through A C, than it would have done in falling
perpendicularly down through A B.

19. THE geometers demonstrate, that the time, in which the body
will descend through the oblique straight line A C, bears the same
proportion to the time of its descent through the perpendicular A B,
as the line it self A C bears to A B. And in respect to the velocity,
which the body will have acquired in the point C, they likewise
prove, that the length of the time imployed in the descent through A
C so compensates the diminution of the influence of gravity from the
obliquity of this line, that though the force of the power of gravity
on the body is opposed by the obliquity of the line A C, yet the time
of the body’s descent shall be so much prolonged, that the body shall
acquire the very same velocity in the point C, as it would have got at
the point B by falling perpendicularly down.

20. IF a body were to descend in a crooked line, the time of its
descent cannot be determined in so simple a manner; but the same
property, in relation to the velocity, is demonstrated to take place in
all cases: that is, in whatever line the body descends, the velocity
will always be answerable to the perpendicular height, from which the
body has fell. For instance, suppose the body A (in fig. 10.) were hung
by a string to the pin B. If this body were let fall, till it came to
the point C perpendicularly under B, it will have moved from A to C in
the arch of a circle. Then the horizontal line A D being drawn, the
velocity of the body in C will be the same, as if it had fallen from
the point D directly down to C.

21. IF a body be thrown perpendicularly upward with any force, the
velocity, wherewith the body ascends, shall continually diminish,
till at length it be wholly taken away; and from that time the body
will begin to fall down again, and pass over a second time in its
descent the line, wherein it ascended; falling through this line with
an increasing velocity in such a manner, that in every point thereof,
through which it falls, it shall have the very same velocity, as it
had in the same place, when it ascended; and consequently shall come
down into the place, whence it first ascended, with the velocity which
was at first given to it. Thus if a body were thrown perpendicularly
up in the line A B (in fig. II.) with such a force, as that it should
stop at the point B, and there begin to fall again; when it shall have
arrived in its descent to any point as C in this line, it shall there
have the same velocity, as that wherewith it passed by this point C
in its ascent; and at the point A it shall have gained as great a
velocity, as that wherewith it was first thrown upwards. As this is
demonstrated by the geometrical writers; so, I think, it will appear
evident, by considering only, that while the body descends, the power
of gravity must act over again, in an inverted order, all the influence
it had on the body in its ascent; so as to give again to the body the
same degrees of velocity, which it had taken away before.

22. AFTER the same manner, if the body were thrown upwards in the
oblique straight line C A (in fig. 9.) from the point C, with such a
degree of velocity as just to reach the point A; it shall by its own
weight return again through the line A C by the same degrees, as it
ascended.

23. AND lastly, if a body were thrown with any velocity in a line
continually incurvated upwards, the like effect will be produced upon
its return to the point, whence it was thrown. Suppose for instance,
the body A (in fig. 12.) were hung by a string A B. Then if this body
be impelled any way, it must move in the arch of a circle. Let it
receive such an impulse, as shall cause it to move in the arch A C; and
let this impulse be of such strength, that the body may be carried from
A as far as D, before its motion is overcome by its weight: I say here,
that the body forthwith returning from D, shall come again into the
point A with the same velocity, as that wherewith it began to move.

24. IT will be proper in this place to observe concerning the power of
gravity, that its force upon any body does not at all depend upon the
shape of the body; but that it continues constantly the same without
any variation in the same body, whatever change be made in the figure
of the body: and if the body be divided into any number of pieces,
all those pieces shall weigh just the same, as they did, when united
together in one body: and if the body be of a uniform contexture,
the weight of each piece will be proportional to its bulk. This has
given reason to conclude, that the power of gravity acts upon bodies
in proportion to the quantity of matter in them. Whence it should
follow, that all bodies must fall from equal heights in the same space
of time. And as we evidently see the contrary in feathers and such
like substances, which fall very slowly in comparison of more solid
bodies; it is reasonable to suppose, that some other cause concurs to
make so manifest a difference. This cause has been found by particular
experiments to be the air. The experiments for this purpose are made
thus. They set up a very tall hollow glass; within which near the top
they lodge a feather and some very ponderous body, usually a piece
of gold, this metal being the most weighty of any body known to us.
This glass they empty of the air contained within it, and by moving a
wire, which passes through the top of the glass, they let the feather
and the heavy body fall together; and it is always found, that as the
two bodies begin to descend at the same time, so they accompany each
other in the fall, and come to the bottom at the very same instant,
as near as the eye can judge. Thus, as far as this experiment can be
depended on, it is certain, that the effect of the power of gravity
upon each body is proportional to the quantity of solid matter, or
to the power of inactivity in each body. For in the limited sense,
which we have given above to the word motion, it has been shown, that
the same force gives to all bodies the same degree of motion, and
different forces communicate different degrees of motion proportional
to the respective powers[51]. In this case, if the power of gravity
were to act equally upon the feather, and upon the more solid body,
the solid body would descend so much slower than the feather, as to
have no greater degree of motion than the feather: but as both bodies
descend with equal swiftness, the degree of motion in the solid body is
greater than in the feather, bearing the same proportion to it, as the
quantity of matter in the solid body to the quantity of matter in the
feather. Therefore the effect of gravity on the solid body is greater
than on the feather, in proportion to the greater degree of motion
communicated; that is, the effect of the power of gravity on the solid
body bears the same proportion to its effect on the feather, as the
quantity of matter in the solid body bears to the quantity of matter
in the feather. Thus it is the proper deduction from this experiment,
that the power of gravity acts not on the surface of bodies only, but
penetrates the bodies themselves most intimately, and operates alike
on every particle of matter in them. But as the great quickness, with
which the bodies fall, leaves it something uncertain, whether they do
descend absolutely in the same time, or only so nearly together, that
the difference in their swift motion is not discernable to the eye;
this property of the power of gravity, which has here been deduced from
this experiment, is farther confirmed by pendulums, whose motion is
such, that a very minute difference would become sufficiently sensible.
This will be farther discoursed on in another place[52]; but here I
shall make use of the principle now laid down to explain the nature of
what is called the center of gravity in bodies.

25. THE center of gravity is that point, by which if a body be
suspended, it shall hang at rest in any situation. In a globe of a
uniform texture the center of gravity is the same with the center of
the globe; for as the parts of the globe on every side of its center
are similarly disposed, and the power of gravity acts alike on every
part; it is evident, that the parts of the globe on each side of the
center are drawn with equal force, and therefore neither side can
yield to the other; but the globe, if supported at its center, must
of necessity hang at rest. In like manner, if two equal bodies A and
B (in fig. 13.) be hung at the extremities of an inflexible rod C D,
which should have no weight; these bodies, if the rod be supported at
its middle E, shall equiponderate; and the rod remain without motion.
For the bodies being equal and at the same distance from the point of
support E, the power of gravity will act upon each with equal strength,
and in all respects under the same circumstances; therefore the weight
of one cannot overcome the weight of the other. The weight of A can no
more surmount the weight of B, than the weight of B can surmount the
weight of A. Again, suppose a body as A B (in fig. 14.) of a uniform
texture in the form of a roller, or as it is more usually called a
cylinder, lying horizontally. If a straight line be drawn between C and
D, the centers of the extreme circles of this cylinder; and if this
straight line, commonly called the axis of the cylinder, be divided
into two equal parts in E: this point E will be the center of gravity
of the cylinder. The cylinder being a uniform figure, the parts on each
side of the point E are equal, and situated in a perfectly similar
manner; therefore this cylinder, if supported at the point E, must hang
at rest, for the same reason as the inflexible rod above-mentioned
will remain without motion, when suspended at its middle point. And it
is evident, that the force applied to the point E, which would uphold
the cylinder, must be equal to the cylinder’s weight. Now suppose two
cylinders of equal thickness A B and C D to be joined together at C B,
so that the two axis’s E F, and F G lie in one straight line. Let the
axis E F be divided into two equal parts at H, and the axis F G into
two equal parts at I. Then because the cylinder A B would be upheld
at rest by a power applied in H equal to the weight of this cylinder,
and the cylinder C D would likewise be upheld by a power applied in I
equal to the weight of this cylinder; the whole cylinder A D will be
supported by these two powers: but the whole cylinder may likewise be
supported by a power applied to K, the middle point of the whole axis
E G, provided that power be equal to the weight of the whole cylinder.
It is evident therefore, that this power applied in K will produce the
same effect, as the two other powers applied in H and I. It is farther
to be observed, that H K is equal to half F G, and K I equal to half
E F; for E K being equal to half E G, and E H equal to half E F, the
remainder H K must be equal to half the remainder F G; so likewise G
K being equal to half G E, and G I equal to half G F, the remainder I
K must be equal to half the remainder E F. It follows therefore, that
H K bears the same proportion to K I, as F G bears to E F. Besides,
I believe, my readers will perceive, and it is demonstrated in form
by the geometers, that the whole body of the cylinder C D bears the
same proportion to the whole body of the cylinder A B, as the axis F G
bears to the axis E F[53]. But hence it follows, that in the two powers
applied at H and I, the power applied at H bears the same proportion to
the power applied at I, as K I bears to K H. Now suppose two strings
H L and I M extended upwards, one from the point H and the other from
I, and to be laid hold on by two powers, one strong enough to hold up
the cylinder A B, and the other of strength sufficient to support the
cylinder C D. Here as these two powers uphold the whole cylinder, and
therefore produce an effect, equal to what would have been produced
by a power applied to the point K of sufficient force to sustain the
whole cylinder: it is manifest, that if the cylinder be taken away,
the axis only being left, and from the point K a string, as K N, be
extended, which shall be drawn down by a power equivalent to the weight
of the cylinder, this power shall act against the other two powers, as
much as the cylinder acted against them; and consequently these three
powers shall be upon a balance, and hold the axis H I fixed between
them. But if these three powers preserve a mutual balance, the two
powers applied to the strings H L and I M are a balance to each other;
the power applied to the string H L bearing the same proportion to
the power applied to the string I M, as the distance I K bears to the
distance K H. Hence it farther appears, that if an inflexible rod A B
(in fig. 15.) be suspended by any point C not in the middle thereof;
and if at A the end of the shorter arm be hung a weight, and at B
the end of the longer arm be also hung a weight less than the other,
and that the greater of these weights bears to the lesser the same
proportion, as the longer arm of the rod bears to the shorter; then
these two weights will equiponderate: for a power applied at C equal to
both these weights will support without motion the rod thus charged;
since here nothing is changed from the preceding case but the situation
of the powers, which are now placed on the contrary sides of the line,
to which they are fixed. Also for the same reason, if two weights A
and B (in fig. 16.) were connected together by an inflexible rod C D,
drawn from C the center of gravity of A to D the center of gravity of
B; and if the rod C D were to be so divided in E, that the part D E
bear the same proportion to the other part C E, as the weight A bears
to the weight B: then this rod being supported at E will uphold the
weights, and keep them at rest without motion. This point E, by which
the two bodies A and B will be supported, is called their common center
of gravity. And if a greater number of bodies were joined together,
the point, by which they could all be supported, is called the common
center of gravity of them all. Suppose (in fig. 17.) there were three
bodies A, B, C, whose respective centers of gravity were joined by the
three lines D E, D F, E F: the line D E being so divided in G, that D
G bear the same proportion to G E, as B bears to A; G is the center
of gravity common to the two bodies A and B; that is, a power equal
to the weight of both the bodies applied to G would support them, and
the point G is pressed as much by the two weights A and B, as it would
be, if they were both hung together at that point. Therefore, if a
line be drawn from G to F, and divided in H, so that G H bear the same
proportion to H F, as the weight C bears to both the weights A and
B, the point H will be the common center of gravity of all the three
weights; for H would be their common center of gravity, if both the
weights A and B were hung together at G, and the point G is pressed as
much by them in their present situation, as it would be in that case.
In the same manner from the common center of these three weights, you
might proceed to find the common center, if a fourth weight were added,
and by a gradual progress might find the common center of gravity
belonging to any number of weights whatever.

26. AS all this is the obvious consequence of the proposition laid down
for assigning the common center of gravity of any two weights, by the
same proposition the center of gravity of all figures is found. In a
triangle, as A B C (in fig. 18.) the center of gravity lies in the line
drawn from the middle point of any one of the sides to the opposite
angle, as the line B D is drawn from D the middle of the line A C to
the opposite angle B[54]; so that if from the middle of either of the
other sides, as from the point E in the side A B, a line be drawn, as
E C, to the opposite angle; the point F, where this line crosses the
other line B D, will be the center of gravity of the triangle[55].
Likewise D F is equal to half F B, and E F equal to half F C[56]. In a
hemisphere, as A B C (fig. 19.) if from D the center of the base the
line D B be erected perpendicular to that base, and this line be so
divided in E, that D E be equal to three fifths of B E, the point E is
the center of gravity of the hemisphere[57].

27. IT will be of use to observe concerning the center of gravity of
bodies; that since a power applied to this center alone can support
a body against the power of gravity, and hold it fixed at rest; the
effect of the power of gravity on a body is the same, as if that whole
power were to exert itself on the center of gravity only. Whence it
follows, that, when the power of gravity acts on a body suspended by
any point, if the body is so suspended, that the center of gravity
of the body can descend; the power of gravity will give motion to
that body, otherwise not: or if a number of bodies are so connected
together, that, when any one is put into motion, the rest shall, by
the manner of their being joined, receive such motion, as shall keep
their common center of gravity at rest; then the power of gravity
shall not be able to produce any motion in these bodies, but in all
other cases it will. Thus, if the body A B (in fig. 20, 21.) whose
center of gravity is C, be hung on the point A, and the center C be
perpendicularly under A (as in fig. 20.) the weight of the body will
hold it still without motion, because the center C cannot descend any
lower. But if the body be removed into any other situation, where the
center C is not perpendicularly under A (as in fig. 21.) the body by
its weight will be put into motion towards the perpendicular situation
of its center of gravity. Also if two bodies A, B (in fig. 22.) be
joined together by the rod C D lying in an horizontal situation, and
be supported at the point E; if this point be the center of gravity
common to the two bodies, their weight will not put them into motion;
but if this point E is not their common center of gravity, the bodies
will move; that part of the rod C D descending, in which the common
center of gravity is found. So in like manner, if these two bodies were
connected together by any more complex contrivance; yet if one of
the bodies cannot move without so moving the other, that their common
center of gravity shall rest, the weight of the bodies will not put
them in motion, otherwise it will.

28. I SHALL proceed in the next place to speak of the mechanical
powers. These are certain instruments or machines, contrived for the
moving great weights with small force; and their effects are all
deducible from the observation we have just been making. They are
usually reckoned in number five; the lever, the wheel and axis, the
pulley, the wedge, and the screw; to which some add the inclined
plane. As these instruments have been of very ancient use, so the
celebrated ~ARCHIMEDES~ seems to have been the first, who discovered
the true reason of their effects. This, I think, may be collected
from what is related of him, that some expressions, which he used to
denote the unlimited force of these instruments, were received as very
extraordinary paradoxes: whereas to those, who had understood the cause
of their great force, no expressions of that kind could have appeared
surprizing.

29. ALL the effects of these powers may be judged of by this one rule,
that, when two weights are applied to any of these instruments, the
weights will equiponderate, if, when put into motion, their velocities
will be reciprocally proportional to their respective weights. And what
is said of weights, must of necessity be equally understood of any
other forces equivalent to weights, such as the force of a man’s arm,
a stream of water, or the like.

30. BUT to comprehend the meaning of this rule, the reader must know,
what is to be understood by reciprocal proportion; which I shall now
endeavour to explain, as distinctly as I can; for I shall be obliged
very frequently to make use of this term. When any two things are so
related, that one increases in the same proportion as the other, they
are directly proportional. So if any number of men can perform in a
determined space of time a certain quantity of any work, suppose drain
a fish-pond, or the like; and twice the number of men can perform twice
the quantity of the same work, in the same time; and three times the
number of men can perform as soon thrice the work; here the number
of men and the quantity of the work are directly proportional. On
the other hand, when two things are so related, that one decreases
in the same proportion, as the other increases, they are said to be
reciprocally proportional. Thus if twice the number of men can perform
the same work in half the time, and three times the number of men can
finish the same in a third part of the time; then the number of men
and the time are reciprocally proportional. We shewed above[58] how to
find the common center of gravity of two bodies, there the distances of
that common center from the centers of gravity of the two bodies are
reciprocally proportional to the respective bodies. For C E in fig. 16.
being in the same proportion to E D, as B bears to A; C E is so much
greater in proportion than E D, as A is less in proportion than B.

31. NOW this being understood, the reason of the rule here stated will
easily appear. For if these two bodies were put in motion, while the
point E rested, the velocity, wherewith A would move, would bear the
same proportion to the velocity, wherewith B would move, as E C bears
to E D. The velocity therefore of each body, when the common center of
gravity rests, is reciprocally proportional to the body. But we have
shewn above[59], that if two bodies are so connected together, that the
putting them in motion will not move their common center of gravity;
the weight of those bodies will not produce in them any motion.
Therefore in any of these mechanical engines, if, when the bodies are
put into motion, their velocities are reciprocally proportional to
their respective weights, whereby the common center of gravity would
remain at rest; the bodies will not receive any motion from their
weight, that is, they will equiponderate. But this perhaps will be yet
more clearly conceived by the particular description of each mechanical
power.

32. THE lever was first named above. This is a bar made use of to
sustain and move great weights. The bar is applied in one part to
some strong support; as the bar A B (in fig. 23, 24.) is applied at
the point C to the support D. In some other part of the bar, as E, is
applied the weight to be sustained or moved; and in a third place, as
F, is applied another weight or equivalent force, which is to sustain
or move the weight at E. Now here, if, when the level should be put in
motion, and turned upon the point C, the velocity, wherewith the point
F would move, bears the same proportion to the velocity, wherewith the
point E would move, as the weight at E bears to the weight or force at
F; then the lever thus charged will have no propensity to move either
way. If the weight or other force at F be not so great as to bear this
proportion, the weight at E will not be sustained; but if the force at
F be greater than this, the weight at E will be surmounted. This is
evident from what has been said above[60], when the forces at E and F
are placed (as in fig. 23.) on different sides of the support D. It
will appear also equally manifest in the other case, by continuing
the bar B C in fig. 24. on the other side of the support D, till C G
be equal to C F, and by hanging at G a weight equivalent to the power
at F; for then, if the power at F were removed, the two weights at G
and E would counterpoize each other, as in the former case: and it is
evident, that the point F will be lifted up by the weight at G with the
same degree of force, as by the other power applied to F; since, if the
weight at E were removed, a weight hung at F equal to that at G would
balance the lever, the distances C G and C F being equal.

33. IF the two weights, or other powers, applied to the lever do
not counterbalance each other; a third power may be applied in any
place proposed of the lever, which shall hold the whole in a just
counterpoize. Suppose (in fig. 25.) the two powers at E and F did not
equiponderate, and it were required to apply a third power to the point
G, that might be sufficient to balance the lever. Find what power in
F would just counterbalance the power in E; then if the difference
between this power and that, which is actually applied at F, bear the
same proportion to the third power to be applied at G, as the distance
C G bears to C F; the lever will be counterpoized by the help of this
third power, if it be so applied as to act the same way with the power
in F, when that power is too small to counterbalance the power in E;
but otherwise the power in G must be so applied, as to act against the
power in F. In like manner, if a lever were charged with three, or any
greater number of weights or other powers, which did not counterpoize
each other, another power might be applied in any place proposed,
which should bring the whole to a just balance. And what is here said
concerning a plurality of powers, may be equally applied to all the
following cases.

34. IF the lever should consist of two arms making an angle at the
point C (as in fig. 26.) yet if the forces are applied perpendicularly
to each arm, the same proportion will hold between the forces applied,
and the distances of the center, whereon the lever rests, from the
points to which they are applied. That is, the weight at E will be to
the force in F in the same proportion, as C F bears to C E.

35. BUT whenever the forces applied to the lever act obliquely to the
arm, to which they are applied (as in fig. 27.) then the strength of
the forces is to be estimated by lines let fall from the center of
the lever to the directions, wherein the forces act. To balance the
levers in fig. 27, the weight or other force at F will bear the same
proportion to the weight at E, as the distance C E bears to C G the
perpendicular let fall from the point C upon the line, which denotes
the direction wherein the force applied to F acts: for here, if the
lever be put into motion, the power applied to F will begin to move in
the direction of the line F G; and therefore its first motion will be
the same, as the motion of the point G.

36. WHEN two weights hang upon a lever, and the point, by which the
lever is supported, is placed in the middle between the two weights,
that the arms of the lever are both of equal length; then this lever is
particularly called a balance; and equal weights equiponderate as in
common scales. When the point of support is not equally distant from
both weights, it constitutes that instrument for weighing, which is
called a steelyard. Though both in common scales, and the steelyard,
the point, on which the beam is hung, is not usually placed just in the
same straight line with the points, that hold the weights, but rather
a little above (as in fig. 28.) where the lines drawn from the point
C, whereon the beam is suspended, to the points E and F, on which the
weights are hung, do not make absolutely one continued line. If the
three points E, C, and F were in one straight line, those weights,
which equiponderated, when the beam hung horizontally, would also
equiponderate in any other situation.

[Illustration]

But we see in these instruments, when they are charged with weights,
which equiponderate with the beam hanging horizontally; that, if
the beam be inclined either way, the weight most elevated surmounts
the other, and descends, causing the beam to swing, till by degrees
it recovers its horizontal position. This effect arises from the
forementioned structure: for by this structure these instruments are
levers composed of two arms, which make an angle at the point of
support (as in fig. 29, 30.) the first of which represents the case
of the common balance, the second the case of the steelyard. In the
first, where C E and C F are equal, equal weights hung at E and F will
equiponderate, when the points E and F are in an horizontal situation.
Suppose the lines E G and F H to be perpendicular to the horizon, then
they will denote the directions, wherein the forces applied to E and
F act. Therefore the proportion between the weights at E and F, which
shall equiponderate, are to be judged of by perpendiculars, as C I, C
K, let fall from C upon E G and F H: so that the weights being equal,
the lines C I, C K, must be equal also, when the weights equiponderate.
But I believe my readers will easily see, that since C E and C F are
equal, the lines C I and C K will be equal, when the points E and F are
horizontally situated.

37. IF this lever be set into any other position (as in fig. 31.) then
the weight, which is raised highest, will outweigh the other. Here,
if the point F be raised higher than E, the perpendicular C K will be
longer than C I: and therefore the weights would equiponderate, if
the weight at F were less than the weight at E. But the weight at
F is equal to that at E; therefore is greater, than is necessary to
counterbalance the weight at E, and consequently will outweigh it, and
draw the beam of the lever down.

38. IN like manner in the case of the steelyard (fig. 32.) if the
weights at E and F are so proportioned, as to equiponderate, when the
points E and F are horizontally situated; then in any other situation
of this lever the weight, which is raised highest, will preponderate.
That is, if in the horizontal situation of the points E and F the
weight at F bears the same proportion to the weight at E, as C I bears
to C K; then, if the point F be raised higher than E (as in fig. 32.)
the weight at F shall bear a greater proportion to the weight at E,
than C I bears to C K.

39. FARTHER a lever may be hung upon an axis, and then the two arms
of the lever need not be continuous, but fixed to different parts of
this axis; as in fig. 33, where the axis A B is supported by its two
extremities A and B. To this axis one arm of the lever is fixed at the
point C, the other at the point D. Now here, if a weight be hung at E,
the extremity of that arm, which is fixed to the axis at the point C;
and another weight be hung at F, the extremity of the arm, which is
fixed on the axis at D; then these weights will equiponderate, when the
weight at E bears the same proportion to the weight at F, as the arm D
F bears to C E.

40. THIS is the case, if both the arms are perpendicular to the axis,
and lie (as the geometers express themselves) in the same plane; or, in
other words, if the arms are so fixed perpendicularly upon the axis,
that, when one of them lies horizontally, the other shall also be
horizontal. If either arm stand not perpendicular to the axis; then, in
determining the proportion between the weights, instead of the length
of that arm, you must use the perpendicular let fall upon the axis from
the extremity of that arm. If the arms are not so fixed as to become
horizontal, at the same time; the method of assigning the proportion
between the weights is analogous to that made use of above in levers,
which make an angle at the point, whereon they are supported.

41. FROM this case of the lever hung on an axis, it is easy to make a
transition to another mechanical power, the wheel and axis.

42. THIS instrument is a wheel fixed on a roller, the roller being
supported at each extremity so as to turn round freely with the wheel,
in the manner represented in fig. 34, where A B is the wheel, C D the
roller, and E F its two supports. Now suppose a weight G hung by a cord
wound round the roller, and another weight H hung by a cord wound about
the wheel the contrary way: that these weights may support each other,
the weight H must bear the same proportion to the weight G, as the
thickness of the roller bears to the diameter of the wheel.

43. SUPPOSE the line _k l_ to be drawn through the middle of the
roller; and from the place of the roller, where the cord, on which the
weight G hangs, begins to leave the roller, as at _m_, let the line_
m n_ be drawn perpendicularly to _k l_; and from the point, where
the cord holding the weight H begins to leave the wheel, as at _o_,
let the line _o p_ be drawn perpendicular to _k l_. This being done,
the two lines _o p_ and _m n_ represent two arms of a lever fixed on
the axis _k l_; consequently the weight H will bear to the weight G
the same proportion, as _m n_ bears to _o p_. But _m n_ bears the
same proportion to _o p_, as the thickness of the roller bears to the
diameter of the wheel; for _m n_ is half the thickness of the roller,
and _o p_ half the diameter of the wheel.

44. IF the wheel be put into motion, and turned once round, that the
cord, on which the weight G hangs, be wound once more round the axis;
then at the same time the cord, whereon the weight H hangs, will be
wound off from the wheel one circuit. Therefore the velocity of the
weight G will bear the same proportion to the velocity of the weight H,
as the circumference of the roller to the circumference of the wheel.
But the circumference of the roller bears the same proportion to the
circumference of the wheel, as the thickness of the roller bears to
the diameter of the wheel, consequently the velocity of the weight
G bears to the velocity of the weight H the same proportion, as the
thickness of the roller bears to the diameter of the wheel, which is
the proportion that the weight H bears to the weight G. Therefore as
before in the lever, so here also the general rule laid down above is
verified, that the weights equiponderate, when their velocities would
be reciprocally proportional to their respective weights.

45. IN like manner, if on the same axis two wheels of different sizes
are fixed (as in fig. 35.) and a weight hung on each; the weights will
equiponderate, if the weight hung on the greater wheel bear the same
proportion to the weight hung on the lesser, as the diameter of the
lesser wheel bears to the diameter of the greater.

46. IT is usual to join many wheels together in the same frame, which
by the means of certain teeth, formed in the circumference of each
wheel, shall communicate motion to each other. A machine of this nature
is represented in fig. 36. Here A B C is a winch, upon which is fixed
a small wheel D indented with teeth, which move in the like teeth of
a larger wheel E F fixed on the axis G H. Let this axis carry another
wheel I, which shall move in like manner a greater wheel K L fixed on
the axis M N. Let this axis carry another small wheel O, which after
the same manner shall turn about a larger wheel P Q fixed on the roller
R S, on which a cord shall be wound, that holds a weight, as T. Now
the proportion required between the weight T and a power applied to
the winch at A sufficient to support the weight, will most easily be
estimated, by computing the proportion, which the velocity of the point
A would bear to the velocity of the weight. If the winch be turned
round, the point A will describe a circle as A V. Suppose the wheel E F
to have ten times the number of teeth, as the wheel D; then the winch
must turn round ten times to carry the wheel E F once round. If wheel K
L has also ten times the number of teeth, as I, the wheel I must turn
round ten times to carry the wheel K L once round; and consequently
the winch A B C must turn round an hundred times to turn the wheel K L
once round. Lastly, if the wheel P Q has ten times the number of teeth,
as the wheel O, the winch must turn about one thousand times in order
to turn the wheel P Q, or the roller R S once round. Therefore here
the point A must have gone over the circle A V a thousand times, in
order to lift the weight T through a space equal to the circumference
of the roller R S: whence it follows, that the power applied at A will
balance the weight T, if it bear the same proportion to it, as the
circumference of the roller to one thousand times the circle A V; or
the same proportion as half the thickness of the roller bears to one
thousand times A B.

47. I SHALL now explain the effect of the pulley. Let a weight hang by
a pulley, as in fig. 37. Here it is evident, that the power A, by which
the weight B is supported, must be equal to the weight; for the cord C
D is equally strained between them; and if the weight B move, the power
A must move with equal velocity. The pulley E has no other effect, than
to permit the power A to act in another direction, than it must have
done, if it had been directly applied to support the weight without the
intervention of any such instrument.

48. AGAIN, let a weight be supported, as in fig. 38; where the weight
A is fixed to the pulley B, and the cord, by which the weight is
upheld, is annexed by one extremity to a hook C, and at the other end
is held by the power D. Here the weight is supported by a cord doubled;
insomuch that although the cord were not strong enough to hold the
weight single, yet being thus doubled it might support it. If the
end of the cord held by the power D were hung on the hook C, as well
as the other end; then, when both ends of the cord were tied to the
hook, it is evident, that the hook would bear the whole weight; and
each end of the string would bear against the hook with the force of
half the weight only, seeing both ends together bear with the force of
the whole. Hence it is evident, that, when the power D holds one end
of the weight, the force, which it must exert to support the weight,
must be equal to just half the weight. And the same proportion between
the weight and power might be collected from comparing the respective
velocities, with which they would move; for it is evident, that the
power must move through a space equal to twice the distance of the
pulley from the hook, in order to lift the pulley up to the hook.

49. IT is equally easy to estimate the effect, when many pulleys are
combined together, as in fig. 39, 40; in the first of which the under
set of pulleys, and consequently the weight is held by six strings; and
in the latter figure by five: therefore in the first of these figures
the power to support the weight, must be one sixth part only of the
weight, and in the latter figure the power must be one fifth part.

50. THERE are two other ways of supporting a weight by pulleys, which I
shall particularly consider.

51. ONE of these ways is represented in fig. 41. Here the weight being
connected to the pulley B, a power equal to half the weight A would
support the pulley C, if applied immediately to it. Therefore the
pulley C is drawn down with a force equal to half the weight A. But if
the pulley D were to be immediately supported by half the force, with
which the pulley C is drawn down, this pulley D will uphold the pulley
C; so that if the pulley D be upheld with a force equal to one fourth
part of the weight A, that force will support the weight. But, for the
same reason as before, if the power in E be equal to half the force
necessary to uphold the pulley D; this pulley, and consequently the
weight A, will be upheld: therefore, if the power in E be one eighth
part of the weight A, it will support the weight.

52. ANOTHER way of applying pulleys to a weight is represented in fig.
42. To explain the effect of pulleys thus applied, it will be proper to
consider different weights hanging, as in fig. 43. Here, if the power
and weights balance each other, the power A is equal to the weight B;
the weight C is equal to twice the power A, or the weight B; and for
the same reason the weight D is equal to twice the weight C, or equal
to four times the power A. It is evident therefore, that all the three
weights B, C, D together are equal to seven times the power A. But if
these three weights were joined in one, they would produce the case of
fig. 40: so that in that figure the weight A, where there are three
pulleys, is seven times the power B. If there had been but two pulleys,
the weight would have been three times the power; and if there had been
four pulleys, the weight would have been fifteen times the power.

53. THE wedge is next to be considered. The form of this instrument is
sufficiently known. When it is put under any weight (as in fig. 44.)
the force, with which the wedge will lift the weight, when drove under
it by a blow upon the end A B, will bear the same proportion to the
force, wherewith the blow would act on the weight, if directly applied
to it; as the velocity, which the wedge receives from the blow, bears
to the velocity, wherewith the weight is lifted by the wedge.

54. THE screw is the fifth mechanical power. There are two ways of
applying this instrument. Sometimes it is screwed into a hole, as
in fig. 45, where the screw A B is screwed through the plank C D.
Sometimes the screw is applied to the teeth of a wheel, as in fig. 46,
where the thread of the screw A B turns in the teeth of a wheel C D. In
both these cases, if a bar, as A E, be fixed to the end A of the screw;
the force, wherewith the end B of the screw in fig. 45 is forced down,
and the force, wherewith the teeth of the wheel C D in fig. 44 are
held, bears the same proportion to the power applied to the end E of
the bar; as the velocity, wherewith the end E will move, when the screw
is turned, bears to the velocity, wherewith the end B of the screw in
fig. 43, or the teeth of the wheel C D in fig. 46, will be moved.

55. THE inclined plane affords also a means of raising a weight with
less force, than what is equal to the weight it self. Suppose it were
required to raise the globe A (in fig. 47.) from the ground B C up
to the point, whose perpendicular height from the ground is E D. If
this globe be drawn along the slant D F, less force will be required
to raise it, than if it were lifted directly up. Here if the force
applied to the globe bear the same proportion only to its weight, as
E D bears to F D, it will be sufficient to hold up the globe; and
therefore any addition to that force will put it in motion, and draw
it up; unless the globe, by pressing against the plane, whereon it
lies, adhere in some degree to the plane. This indeed it must always
do more or less, since no plane can be made so absolutely smooth as
to have no inequalities at all; nor yet so infinitely hard, as not to
yield in the least to the pressure of the weight. Therefore the globe
cannot be laid on such a plane, whereon it will slide with perfect
freedom, but they must in some measure rub against each other; and this
friction will make it necessary to imploy a certain degree of force
more, than what is necessary to support the globe, in order to give
it any motion. But as all the mechanical powers are subject in some
degree or other to the like impediment from friction; I shall here
only shew what force would be necessary to sustain the globe, if it
could lie upon the plane without causing any friction at all. And I
say, that if the globe were drawn by the cord G H, lying parallel to
the plane D F; and the force, wherewith the cord is pulled, bear the
same proportion to the weight of the globe, as E D bears to D F; this
force will sustain the globe. In order to the making proof of this, let
the cord G H be continued on, and turned over the pulley I, and let
the weight K be hung to it. Now I say, if this weight bears the same
proportion to the globe A, as D E bears to D F, the weight will support
the globe. I think it is very manifest, that the center of the globe A
will lie in one continued line with the cord H G. Let L be the center
of the globe, and M the center of gravity of the weight K. In the first
place let the weight hang so, that a line drawn from L to M shall lie
horizontally; and I say, if the globe be moved either up or down the
plane D F, the weight will so move along with it, that the center of
gravity common to both the weights shall continue in this line L M, and
therefore shall in no case descend. To prove this more fully, I shall
depart a little from the method of this treatise, and make use of a
mathematical proportion or two: but they are such, as any person, who
has read ~EUCLID’S ELEMENTS~, will fully comprehend; and are
in themselves so evident, that, I believe, my readers, who are wholly
strangers to geometrical writings, will make no difficulty of admitting
them. This being premised, let the globe be moved up, till its center
be at G, then will M the center of gravity of the weight K be sunk to
N; so that M N shall be equal to G L. Draw N G crossing the line M L
in O; then I say, that O is the common center of gravity of the two
weights in this their new situation. Let G P be drawn perpendicular to
M L; then G L will bear the same proportion to G P, as D F bears to D
E; and M N being equal to G L, M N will bear the same proportion to G
P, as D F bears to D E. But N O bears the same proportion to O G, as
M N bears to G P; consequently N O will bear the same proportion to
O G, as D F bears to D E. In the last place, the weight of the globe
A bears the same proportion to the other weight K, as D F bears to D
E; therefore N O bears the same proportion to O G, as the weight of
the globe A bears to the weight K. Whence it follows, that, when the
center of the globe A is in G, and the center of gravity of the weight
K is in N, O will be the center of gravity common to both the weights.
After the same manner, if the globe had been caused to descend, the
common center of gravity would have been found in this line M L. Since
therefore no motion of the globe either way will make the common center
of gravity descend, it is manifest, from what has been said above, that
the weights A and K counterpoize each other.

56. I SHALL now consider the case of pendulums. A pendulum is made
by hanging a weight to a line, so that it may swing backwards and
forwards. This motion the geometers have very carefully considered,
because it is the most commodious instrument of any for the exact
measurement of time.

57. I HAVE observed already[61], that if a body hanging perpendicularly
by a string, as the body A (in fig. 48.) hangs by the string A B, be
put so into motion, as to be made to ascend up the circular arch A C;
then as soon as it has arrived at the highest point, to which the
motion, that the body has received, will carry it; it will immediately
begin to descend, and at A will receive again as great a degree of
motion, as it had at first. This motion therefore will carry the
body up the arch A D, as high as it ascended before in the arch A C.
Consequently in its return through the arch D A it will acquire again
at A its original velocity, and advance a second time up the arch
A C as high as at first; by this means continuing without end its
reciprocal motion. It is true indeed, that in fact every pendulum,
which we can put in motion, will gradually lessen its swing, and
at length stop, unless there be some power constantly applied to
it, whereby its motion shall be renewed; but this arises from the
resistance, which the body meets with both from the air, and the string
by which it is hung: for as the air will give some obstruction to the
progress of the body moving through it; so also the string, whereon the
body hangs, will be a farther impediment; for this string must either
slide on the pin, whereon it hangs, or it must bend to the motion of
the weight; in the first there must be some degree of friction, and
in the latter the string will make some resistance to its inflection.
However, if all resistance could be removed, the motion of a pendulum
would be perpetual.

58. BUT to proceed, the first property, I shall take notice of in this
motion, is, that the greater arch the pendulous body moves through, the
greater time it takes up: though the length of time does not increase
in so great a proportion as the arch. Thus if C D be a greater arch,
and E F a lesser, where C A is equal to A D, and E A equal to A F;
the body, when it swings through the greater arch C D, shall take up
in its swing from C to D a longer time than in swinging from E to F,
when it moves only in that lesser arch; or the time in which the body
let fall from C will descend through the arch C A is greater than the
time, in which it will descend through the arch E A, when let fall from
E. But the first of these times will not hold the same proportion to
the latter, as the first arch C A bears to the other arch E A; which
will appear thus. Let C G and E H be two horizontal lines. It has been
remarked above[62], that the body in falling through the arch C A will
acquire as great a velocity at the point A, as it would have gained by
falling directly down through G A; and in falling through the arch E A
it will acquire in the point A only that velocity, which it would have
got in falling through H A. Therefore, when the body descends through
the greater arch C A, it shall gain a greater velocity, than when it
passes only through the lesser; so that this greater velocity will in
some degree compensate the greater length of the arch.

59. THE increase of velocity, which the body acquires in falling from
a greater height, has such an effect, that, if straight lines be drawn
from A to C and E, the body would fall through the longer straight
line C A just in the same time, as through the shorter straight line
E A. This is demonstrated by the geometers, who prove, that if any
circle, as A B C D (fig. 49.) be placed in a perpendicular situation;
a body shall fall obliquely through every line, as A B drawn from the
lowest point A in the circle to any other point in the circumference
just in the same time, as would be imployed by the body in falling
perpendicularly down through the diameter C A. But the time in which
the body will descend through the arch, is different from the time,
which it would take up in falling through the line A B.

60. IT has been thought by some, that because in very small arches this
correspondent straight line differs but little from the arch itself;
therefore the descent through this straight line would be performed
in such small arches nearly in the same time as through the arches
themselves: so that if a pendulum were to swing in small arches,
half the time of a single swing would be nearly equal to the time,
in which a body would fall perpendicularly through twice the length
of the pendulum. That is, the whole time of the swing, according to
this opinion, will be four fold the time required for the body to fall
through half the length of the pendulum; because the time of the body’s
falling down twice the length of the pendulum is half the time required
for the fall through one quarter of this space, that is through half
the pendulum’s length. However there is here a mistake; for the whole
time of the swing, when the pendulum moves through small arches, bears
to the time required for a body to fall down through half the length of
the pendulum very nearly the same proportion, as the circumference of a
circle bears to its diameter; that is very nearly the proportion of 355
to 113, or little more than the proportion of 3 to 1. If the pendulum
takes so great a swing, as to pass over an arch equal to one sixth part
of the whole circumference of the circle, it will swing 115 times,
while it ought according to this proportion to have swung 117 times; so
that, when it swings in so large an arch, it loses something less than
two swings in an hundred. If it swing through 1/10 only of the circle,
it shall not lose above one vibration in 160. If it swing in 1/20 of
the circle, it shall lose about one vibration in 690. If its swing be
confined to 1/40 of the whole circle, it shall lose very little more
than one swing in 2600. And if it take no greater a swing than through
1/60 of the whole circle, it shall not lose one swing in 5800.

61. NOW it follows from hence, that, when pendulums swing in small
arches, there is very nearly a constant proportion observed between
the time of their swing, and the time, in which a body would fall
perpendicularly down through half their length. And we have declared
above, that the spaces, through which bodies fall, are in a two fold
proportion of the times, which they take up in falling[63]. Therefore
in pendulums of different lengths, swinging through small arches, the
lengths of the pendulums are in a two fold or duplicate proportion of
the times, they take in swinging; so that a pendulum of four times the
length of another shall take up twice the time in each swing, one of
nine times the length will make one swing only for three swings of the
shorter, and so on.

62. THIS proportion in the swings of different pendulums not only holds
in small arches; but in large ones also, provided they be such, as the
geometers call similar; that is, if the arches bear the same proportion
to the whole circumferences of their respective circles. Suppose (in
fig. 48.) A B, C D to be two pendulums. Let the arch E F be described
by the motion of the pendulum A B, and the arch G H be described by
the pendulum C D; and let the arch E F bear the same proportion to the
whole circumference, which would be formed by turning the pendulum A
B quite round about the point A, as the arch G H bears to the whole
circumference, that would be formed by turning the pendulum C D quite
round the point C. Then I say, the proportion, which the length of the
pendulum A B bears to the length of the pendulum C D, will be two fold
of the proportion, which the time taken up in the description of the
arch E F bears to the time employed in the description of the arch G H.

63. THUS pendulums, which swing in very small arches, are nearly an
equal measure of time. But as they are not such an equal measure to
geometrical exactness; the mathematicians have found out a method of
causing a pendulum so to swing, that, if its motion were not obstructed
by any resistance, it would always perform each swing in the same time,
whether it moved through a greater, or a lesser space. This was first
discovered by the great ~HUYGENS~, and is as follows. Upon the
straight line A B (in fig. 49.) let the circle C D E be so placed, as
to touch the straight line in the point C. Then let this circle roll
along upon the straight line A B, as a coach-wheel rolls along upon
the ground. It is evident, that, as soon as ever the circle begins to
move, the point C in the circle will be lifted off from the straight
line A B; and in the motion of the circle will describe a crooked
course, which is represented by the line C F G H. Here the part C H of
the straight line included between the two extremities C and H of the
line C F G H will be equal to the whole circumference of the circle C D
E; and if C H be divided into two equal parts at the point I, and the
straight line I K be drawn perpendicular to C H, this line I K will
be equal to the diameter of the circle C D E. Now in this line if a
body were to be let fall from the point H, and were to be carried by
its weight down the line H G K, as far as the point K, which is the
lowest point of the line C F G H; and if from any other point G a body
were to be let fall in the same manner; this body, which falls from
G, will take just the same time in coming to K, as the body takes up,
which falls from H. Therefore if a pendulum can be so hung, that the
ball shall move in the line A G F E, all its swings, whether long or
short, will be performed in the same time; for the time, in which the
ball will descend to the point K, is always half the time of the whole
swing. But the ball of a pendulum will be made to swing in this line by
the following means. Let K I (in fig. 52.) be prolonged upwards to L,
till I L is equal to I K. Then let the line L M H equal and like to K
H be applied, as in the figure between the points L and H, so that the
point which in this line L M H answers to the point H in the line K H
shall be applied to the point L, and the point answering to the point
K shall be applied to the point H. Also let such another line L N C be
applied between L and C in the same manner. This preparation being
made; if a pendulum be hung at the point L of such a length, that the
ball thereof shall reach to K; and if the string shall continually bend
against the lines H M L and L N C, as the pendulum swings to and fro;
by this means the ball shall constantly keep in the line C K H.

64. NOW in this pendulum, as all the swings, whether long or short,
will be performed in the same time; so the time of each will exactly
bear the same proportion to the time required for a body to fall
perpendicularly down, through half the length of the pendulum, that is
from I to K, as the circumference of a circle bears to its diameter.

65. IT may from hence be understood in some measure, why, when
pendulums swing in circular arches, the times of their swings are
nearly equal, if the arches are small, though those arches be of very
unequal lengths; for if with the semidiameter L K the circular arch O
K P be described, this arch in the lower part of it will differ very
little from the line C K H.

66. IT may not be amiss here to remark, that a body will fall in this
line C K H (fig. 53.) from C to any other point, as Q or R in a shorter
space of time, than if it moved through the straight line drawn from
C to the other point; or through any other line whatever, that can be
drawn between these two points.

67. BUT as I have observed, that the time, which a pendulum takes in
swinging, depends upon its length; I shall now say something concerning
the way, in which this length of the pendulum is to be estimated. If
the whole ball of the pendulum could be crouded into one point, this
length, by which the motion of the pendulum is to be computed, would
be the length of the string or rod. But the ball of the pendulum must
have a sensible magnitude, and the several parts of this ball will not
move with the same degree of swiftness; for those parts, which are
farthest from the point, whereon the pendulum is suspended, must move
with the greatest velocity. Therefore to know the time in which the
pendulum swings, it is necessary to find that point of the ball, which
moves with the same degree of velocity, as if the whole ball were to be
contracted into that point.

68. THIS point is not the center of gravity, as I shall now endeavour
to shew. Suppose the pendulum A B (in fig. 54.) composed of an
inflexible rod A C and ball C B, to be fixed on the point A, and lifted
up into an horizontal situation. Here if the rod were not fixed to the
point A, the body C B would descend directly with the whole force of
its weight; and each part of the body would move down with the same
degree of swiftness. But when the rod is fixed at the point A, the
body must fall after another manner; for the parts of the body must
move with different degrees of velocity, the parts more remote from A
descending with a swifter motion, than the parts nearer to A; so that
the body will receive a kind of rolling motion while it descends. But
it has been observed above, that the effect of gravity upon any body
is the same, as if the whole force were exerted on the body’s center of
gravity[64].

[Illustration]

Since therefore the power of gravity in drawing down the body must also
communicate to it the rolling motion just described; it seems evident,
that the center of gravity of the body cannot be drawn down as swiftly,
as when the power of gravity has no other effect to produce on the
body, than merely to draw it downward. If therefore the whole matter of
the body C B could be crouded into its center of gravity, so that being
united into one point, this rolling motion here mentioned might give
no hindrance to its descent; this center would descend faster, than it
can now do. And the point, which now descends as fast, as if the whole
matter or the body C B were crouded into it, will be farther removed
from the point A, than the center of gravity of the body C B.

69. AGAIN, suppose the pendulum A B (in fig. 55.) to hang obliquely.
Here the power of gravity will operate less upon the ball of the
pendulum, than before: but the line D E being drawn so, as to stand
perpendicular to the rod A C of the pendulum; the force of gravity
upon the body C B, now it is in this situation, will produce the same
effect, as if the body were to glide down an inclined plane in the
position of D E. But here the motion of the body, when the rod is fixed
to the point A, will not be equal to the uninterrupted descent of the
body down this plane; for the body will here also receive the same
kind of rotation in its motion, as before; so that the motion of the
center of gravity will in like manner be retarded; and the point, which
here descends with that degree of swiftness, which the body would have,
if not hindered by being fixed to the point A; that is, the point,
which descends as fast, as if the whole body were crouded into it, will
be as far removed from the point A, as before.

70. THIS point, by which the length of the pendulum is to be estimated,
is called the center of oscillation. And the mathematicians have laid
down general directions, whereby to find this center in all bodies. If
the globe A B (in fig. 56.) be hung by the string C D, whose weight
need not be regarded, the center of oscillation is found thus. Let the
straight line drawn from C to D be continued through the globe to F.
That it will pass through the center of the globe is evident. Suppose E
to be this center of the globe; and take the line G of such a length,
that it shall bear the same proportion to E D, as E D bears to E C.
Then E H being made equal to ⅖ of G, the point H shall be the center of
oscillation[65]. If the weight of the rod C D is too considerable to
be neglected, divide C D (fig. 57) in I, that D I be equal to ⅓, part
of C D; and take K in the same proportion to C I, as the weight of the
globe A B to the weight of the rod C D. Then having found H, the center
of oscillation of the globe, as before, divide I K in I, so that I L
shall bear the same proportion to L H, as the line C H bears to K; and
L shall be the center of oscillation of the whole pendulum.

71. THIS computation is made upon supposition, that the center of
oscillation of the rod C D, if that were to swing alone without any
other weight annexed, would be the point I. And this point would be
the true center of oscillation, so far as the thickness of the rod is
not to be regarded. If any one chuses to take into consideration the
thickness of the rod, he must place the center of oscillation thereof
so much below the point I, that eight times the distance of the center
from the point I shall bear the same proportion to the thickness of the
rod, as the thickness of the rod bears to its length C D[66].

72. IT has been observed above, that when a pendulum swings in an
arch of a circle, as here in fig. 58, the pendulum A B swings in the
circular arch C D; if you draw an horizontal line, as E F, from the
place whence the pendulum is let fall, to the line A G, which is
perpendicular to the horizon: then the velocity, which the pendulum
will acquire in coming to the point G, will be the same, as any body
would acquire in falling directly down from F to G. Now this is to be
understood of the circular arch, which is described by the center of
oscillation of the pendulum. I shall here farther observe, that if the
straight line E G be drawn from the point, whence the pendulum falls,
to the lowest point of the arch; in the same or in equal pendulums the
velocity, which the pendulum acquires in G, is proportional to this
line: that is, if the pendulum, after it has descended from E to G, be
taken back to H, and let fall from thence, and the line H G be drawn;
the velocity, which the pendulum shall acquire in G by its descent from
H, shall bear the same proportion to the velocity, which it acquires
in falling from E to G, as the straight line H G bears to the straight
line E G.

73. WE may now proceed to those experiments upon the percussion of
bodies, which I observed above might be made with pendulums. This
expedient for examining the effects of percussion was first proposed
by our late great architect Sir ~CHRISTOPHER WREN~. And it
is as follows. Two balls, as A and B (in fig. 59.) either equal or
unequal, are hung by two strings from two points C and D, so that, when
the balls hang down without motion, they shall just touch each other,
and the strings be parallel. Here if one of these balls be removed to
any distance from its perpendicular situation, and then let fall to
descend and strike against the other; by the last preceding paragraph
it will be known, with what velocity this ball shall return into its
first perpendicular situation, and consequently with what force it
shall strike against the other ball; and by the height to which this
other ball ascends after the stroke, the velocity communicated to this
ball will be discovered. For instance, let the ball A be taken up to
E, and from thence be let fall to strike against B, passing over in
its descent the circular arch E F. By this impulse let B fly up to G,
moving through the circular arch H G. Then E I and G K being drawn
horizontally, the ball A will strike against B with the velocity,
which it would acquire in falling directly down from I; and the ball
B has received a velocity, wherewith, if it had been thrown directly
upward, it would have ascended up to K. Likewise if straight lines be
drawn from E to F and from H to G, the velocity of A, wherewith it
strikes, will bear the same proportion to the velocity, which B has
received by the blow, as the straight line E F bears to the straight
line H G. In the same manner by noting the place to which A ascends
after the stroke, its remaining velocity may be compared with that,
wherewith it struck against B. Thus may be experimented the effects of
the body A striking against B at rest. If both the bodies are lifted
up, and so let fall as to meet and impinge against each other just upon
the coming of both into their perpendicular situation; by observing
the places into which they move after the stroke, the effects of their
percussion in all these cases may be found in the same manner as before.

74. SIR ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has described these experiments;
and has shewn how to improve them to a greater exactness by making
allowance for the resistance, which the air gives to the motion of the
balls[67]. But as this resistance is exceeding small, and the manner
of allowing for it is delivered by himself in very plain terms, I need
not enlarge upon it here. I shall rather speak to a discovery, which
he made by these experiments upon the elasticity of bodies. It has
been explained above[68], that when two bodies strike, if they be not
elastic, they remain contiguous after the stroke; but that if they
are elastic, they separate, and that the degree of their elasticity
determines the proportion between the celerity wherewith they separate,
and the celerity wherewith they meet. Now our author found, that the
degree of elasticity appeared in the same bodies always the same, with
whatever degree of force they struck; that is, the celerity wherewith
they separated, always bore the same proportion to the celerity
wherewith they met: so that the elastic power in all the bodies, he
made trial upon, exerted it self in one constant proportion to the
compressing force. Our author made trial with balls of wool bound up
very compact, and found the celerity with which they receded, to bear
about the proportion of 5 to 9 to the celerity wherewith they met; and
in steel he found nearly the same proportion; in cork the elasticity
was something less; but in glass much greater; for the celerity,
wherewith balls of that material separated after percussion, he found
to bear the proportion of 15 to 16 to the celerity wherewith they
met[69].

75. I SHALL finish my discourse on pendulums, with this farther
observation only, that the center of oscillation is also the center
of another force. If a body be fixed to any point, and being put in
motion turns round it; the body, if uninterrupted by the power of
gravity or any other means, will continue perpetually to move about
with the same equable motion. Now the force, with which such a body
moves, is all united in the point, which in relation to the power of
gravity is called the center of oscillation. Let the cylinder A B C D
(in fig. 60.) whose axis is E F, be fixed to the point E. And supposing
the point E to be that on which the cylinder is suspended, let the
center of oscillation be found in the axis E F, as has been explained
above[70]. Let G be that center: then I say, that the force, wherewith
this cylinder turns round the point E, is so united in the point G,
that a sufficient force applied in that point shall stop the motion of
the cylinder, in such a manner, that the cylinder should immediately
remain without motion, though it were to be loosened from the point E
at the same instant, that the impediment was applied to G: whereas, if
this impediment had been applied to any other point of the axis, the
cylinder would turn upon the point, where the impediment was applied.
If the impediment had been applied between E and G, the cylinder would
so turn on the point, where the impediment was applied, that the end
B C would continue to move on the same way it moved before along with
the whole cylinder; but if the impediment were applied to the axis
farther off from E than G, the end A D of the cylinder would start out
of its present place that way in which the cylinder moved. From this
property of the center of oscillation, it is also called the center of
percussion. That excellent mathematician, Dr. BROOK TAYLOR, has farther
improved this doctrine concerning the center of percussion, by shewing,
that if through this point G a line, as G H I, be drawn perpendicular
to E F, and lying in the course of the body’s motion; a sufficient
power applied to any point of this line will have the same effect, as
the like power applied to G[71]: so that as we before shewed the center
of percussion within the body on its axis; by this means we may find
this center on the surface of the body also, for it will be where this
line H I crosses that surface.

76. I SHALL now proceed to the last kind of motion, to be treated on
in this place, and shew what line the power of gravity will cause a
body to describe, when it is thrown forwards by any force. This was
first discovered by the great ~GALILEO~, and is the principle,
upon which engineers should direct the shot of great guns. But as in
this case bodies describe in their motion one of those lines, which in
geometry are called conic sections; it is necessary here to premise a
description of those lines. In which I shall be the more particular,
because the knowledge of them is not only necessary for the present
purpose, but will be also required hereafter in some of the principal
parts of this treatise.

77. THE first lines considered by the ancient geometers were the
straight line and the circle. Of these they composed various figures,
of which they demonstrated many properties, and resolved divers
problems concerning them. These problems they attempted always to
resolve by the describing straight lines and circles. For instance, let
a square A B C D (fig. 61.) be proposed, and let it be required to make
another square in any assigned proportion to this. Prolong one side,
as D A, of this square to E, till A E bear the same proportion to A D,
as the new square is to bear to the square A C. If the opposite side B
C of the square A C be also prolonged to F, till B F be equal to A E,
and E F be afterwards drawn, I suppose my readers will easily conceive,
that the figure A B F E will bear to the square A B C D the same
proportion, as the line A E bears to the line A D. Therefore the figure
A B F E will be equal to the new square, which is to be found, but is
not it self a square, because the side A E is not of the same length
with the side E F. But to find a square equal to the figure A B F E
you must proceed thus. Divide the line D E into two equal parts in the
point G, and to the center G with the interval G D describe the circle
D H E I; then prolong the line A B, till it meets the circle in K; and
make the square A K L M, which square will be equal to the figure A B F
E, and bear to the square A B C D the same proportion, as the line A E
bears to A D.

78. I SHALL not proceed to the proof of this, having only here set it
down as a specimen of the method of resolving geometrical problems
by the description of straight lines and circles. But there are some
problems, which cannot be resolved by drawing straight lines or circles
upon a plane. For the management therefore of these they took into
consideration solid figures, and of the solid figures they found that,
which is called a cone, to be the most useful.

79. A CONE is thus defined by EUCLIDE in his elements of geometry[72].
If to the straight line A B (in fig. 62.) another straight line, as A
C, be drawn perpendicular, and the two extremities B and C be joined by
a third straight line composing the triangle A C B (for so every figure
is called, which is included under three straight lines) then the two
points A and B being held fixed, as two centers, and the triangle A C B
being turned round upon the line A B, as on an axis; the line A C will
describe a circle, and the figure A C B will describe a cone, of the
form represented by the figure B C D E F (fig. 63.) in which the circle
C D E F is usually called the base of the cone, and B the vertex.

80. NOW by this figure may several problems be resolved, which cannot
by the simple description of straight lines and circles upon a plane.
Suppose for instance, it were required to make a cube, which should
bear any assigned proportion to some other cube named. I need not here
inform my readers, that a cube is the figure of a dye. This problem
was much celebrated among the ancients, and was once inforced by the
command of an oracle. This problem may be performed by a cone thus.
First make a cone from a triangle, whose side A C shall be half the
length of the side B C Then on the plane A B C D (fig. 64.) let the
line E F be exhibited equal in length to the side of the cube proposed;
and let the line F G be drawn perpendicular to E F, and of such a
length, that it bear the same proportion to E F, as the cube to be
sought is required to bear to the cube proposed. Through the points E,
F, and G let the circle F H I be described. Then let the line E F be
prolonged beyond F to K, that F K be equal to F E, and let the triangle
F K L, having all its sides F K, K L, L F equal to each other, be hung
down perpendicularly from the plane A B C D. After this, let another
plane M N O P be extended through the point L, so as to be equidistant
from the former plane A B C D, and in this plane let the line Q L R
be drawn so, as to be equidistant from the line E F K. All this being
thus prepared, let such a cone, as was above directed to be made, be so
applied to the plane M N O P, that it touch this plane upon the line
Q R, and that the vertex of the cone be applied to the point L. This
cone, by cutting through the first plane A B C D, will cross the circle
F H I before described. And if from the point S, where the surface of
this cone intersects the circle, the line S T be drawn so, as to be
equidistant from the line E F; the line F T will be equal to the side
of the cube sought: that is, if there be two cubes or dyes formed, the
side of one being equal to E F, and the side of the other equal to F T;
the former of these cubes shall bear the same proportion to the latter,
as the line E F bears to F G.

81. INDEED this placing a cone to cut through a plane is not a
practicable method of resolving problems. But when the geometers had
discovered this use of the cone, they applied themselves to consider
the nature of the lines, which will be produced by the intersection
of the surface of a cone and a plane; whereby they might be enabled
both to reduce these kinds of solutions to practice, and also to render
their demonstrations concise and elegant.

82. WHENEVER the plane, which cuts the cone, is equidistant from
another plane, that touches the cone on the side; (which is the case of
the present figure;) the line, wherein the plane cuts the surface of
the cone, is called a parabola. But if the plane, which cuts the cone,
be so inclined to this other, that it will pass quite through the cone
(as in fig. 65.) such a plane by cutting the cone produces the figure
called an ellipsis, in which we shall hereafter shew the earth and
other planets to move round the sun. If the plane, which cuts the cone,
recline the other way (as in fig. 66.) so as not to be parallel to any
plane, whereon the cone can lie, nor yet to cut quite through the cone;
such a plane shall produce in the cone a third kind of line, which
is called an hyperbola. But it is the first of these lines named the
parabola, wherein bodies, that are thrown obliquely, will be carried
by the force of gravity; as I shall here proceed to shew, after having
first directed my readers how to describe this sort of line upon a
plane, by which the form of it may be seen.

83. TO any straight line A B (fig. 67.) let a straight ruler C D be
so applied, as to stand against it perpendicularly. Upon the edge of
this ruler let another ruler E F be so placed, as to move along upon
the edge of the first ruler C D, and keep always perpendicular to it.
This being so disposed, let any point, as G, be taken in the line A B,
and let a string equal in length to the ruler E F be fastened by one
end to the point G, and by the other to the extremity F of the ruler E
F. Then if the string be held down to the ruler E F by a pin H, as is
represented in the figure; the point of this pin, while the ruler E F
moves on the ruler C D, shall describe the line I K L, which will be
one part of the curve line, whose description we were here to teach:
and by applying the rulers in the like manner on the other side of
the line A B, we may describe the other part I M of this line. If the
distance C G be equal to half the line E F in fig. 64, the line M I L
will be that very line, wherein the plane A B C D in that figure cuts
the cone.

84. THE line A I is called the axis of the parabola M I L, and the
point G is called the focus.

85. NOW by comparing the effects of gravity upon falling bodies, with
what is demonstrated of this figure by the geometers, it is proved,
that every body thrown obliquely is carried forward in one of these
lines, the axis whereof is perpendicular to the horizon.

86. THE geometers demonstrate, that if a line be drawn to touch a
parabola in any point, as the line A B (in fig. 68.) touches the
parabola C D, whose axis is Y Z, in the point E; and several lines F
G, H I, K L be drawn parallel to the axis of the parabola: then the
line F G will be to H I in the duplicate proportion of E F to E H,
and F G to K L in the duplicate proportion of E F to E K; likewise
H I to K L in the duplicate proportion of E H to E K. What is to be
understood by duplicate or two-fold proportion, has been already
explained[73]. Accordingly I mean here, that if the line M be taken to
bear the same proportion to E H, as E H bears to E F, H I will bear
the same proportion to F G, as M bears to E F; and if the line N bears
the same proportion to E K, as E K bears to E F, K L will bear the
same proportion to F G, as N bears to E F; or if the line O bear the
same proportion to E K, as E K bears to E H, K L will bear the same
proportion to H I, as O bears to E H.

87. THIS property is essential to the parabola, being so connected with
the nature of the figure, that every line possessing this property is
to be called by this name.

88. NOW suppose a body to be thrown from the point A (in fig. 69.)
towards B in the direction of the line A B. This body, if left to
it self, would move on with a uniform motion through this line A B.
Suppose the eye of a spectator to be placed at the point C just under
the point A; and let us imagine the earth to be so put into motion
along with the body, as to carry the spectator’s eye along the line C D
parallel to A B; and that the eye would move on with the same velocity,
wherewith the body would proceed in the line A B, if it were to be
left to move without any disturbance from its gravitation towards the
earth. In this case if the body moved on without being drawn towards
the earth, it would appear to the spectator to be at rest. But if the
power of gravity exerted it self on the body, it would appear to the
spectator to fall directly down. Suppose at the distance of time,
wherein the body by its own progressive motion would have moved from A
to E, it should appear to the spectator to have fallen through a length
equal to E F: then the body at the end of this time will actually have
arrived at the point F. If in the space of time, wherein the body
would have moved by its progressive motion from A to G, it would have
appeared to the spectator to have fallen down the space G H: then the
body at the end of this greater interval of time will be arrived at
the point H. Now if the line A F H I be that, through which the body
actually passes; from what has here been said, it will follow, that
this line is one of those, which I have been describing under the name
of the parabola. For the distances E F, G H, through which the body
is seen to fall, will increase in the duplicate proportion of the
times[74]; but the lines A E, A G will be proportional to the times
wherein they would have been described by the single progressive motion
of the body: therefore the lines E F, G H will be in the duplicate
proportion of the lines A F, A G; and the line A F H I possesses the
property of the parabola.

89. IF the earth be not supposed to move along with the body, the
case will be a little different. For the body being constantly drawn
directly towards the center of the earth, the body in its motion will
be drawn in a direction a little oblique to that, wherein it would be
drawn by the earth in motion, as before supposed. But the distance to
the center of the earth bears so vast a proportion to the greatest
length, to which we can throw bodies, that this obliquity does not
merit any regard. From the sequel of this discourse it may indeed
be collected, what line the body being thrown thus would be found
to describe, allowance being made for this obliquity of the earth’s
action[75]. This is the discovery of Sir IS. NEWTON; but has no use in
this place. Here it is abundantly sufficient to consider the body as
moving in a parabola.

90. THE line, which a projected body describes, being thus known,
practical methods have been deduced from hence for directing the
shot of great guns to strike any object desired. This work was first
attempted by ~GALILEO~, and soon after farther improved by
his scholar ~TORRICELLI~; but has lately been rendred more
complete by the great Mr. ~COTES~, whose immature death is an
unspeakable loss to mathematical learning. If it be required to throw
a body from the point A (in fig. 70.) so as to strike the point B;
through the points A, B draw the straight line C D, and erect the line
A E perpendicular to the horizon, and of four times the height, from
which a body must fall to acquire the velocity, wherewith the body is
intended to be thrown. Through the points A and E describe a circle,
that shall touch the line C D in the point A. Then from the point
B draw the line B F perpendicular to the horizon, intersecting the
circle in the points G and H. This being done, if the body be projected
directly towards either of these points G or H, it shall fall upon
the point B; but with this difference, that, if it be thrown in the
direction A G, it shall sooner arrive at B, than if it were projected
in the direction A H. When the body is projected in the direction A
G; the time, it will take up in arriving at B, will bear the same
proportion to the time, wherein it would fall down through one fourth
part of A E, as A G bears to half A E. But when the body is thrown in
the direction of A H, the time of its passing to B will bear the same
proportion to the time, wherein it would fall through one fourth part
of A E, as A H bears to half A E.

91. IF the line A I be drawn so as to divide the angle under E A D in
the middle, and the line I K be drawn perpendicular to the horizon;
this line will touch the circle in the point I, and if the body be
thrown in the direction A I, it will fall upon the point K: and this
point K is the farthest point in the line A D, which the body can be
made to strike, without increasing its velocity.

92. THE velocity, wherewith the body every where moves, may be found
thus. Suppose the body to move in the parabola A B (fig. 71.) Erect A
C perpendicular to the horizon, and equal to the height, from which a
body must fall to acquire the velocity, wherewith the body sets out
from A. If you take any points as D and E in the parabola, and draw
D F and E G parallel to the horizon; the velocity of the body in D
will be equal to what a body will acquire in falling down by its own
weight through C F, and in E the velocity will be the same, as would
be acquired in falling through C G. Thus the body moves slowest at
the highest point H of the parabola; and at equal distances from this
point will move with equal swiftness, and descend from that highest
point through the line H B altogether like to the line A H in which it
ascended; abating only the resistance of the air, which is not here
considered. If the line H I be drawn from the highest point H parallel
to the horizon, A I will be equal to ¼ of B G in fig. 70, when the body
is projected in the direction A G, and equal to ¼ of B H, when the body
is thrown in the direction A H provided A D be drawn horizontally.

93. THUS I have recounted the principal discoveries, which had been
made concerning the motion of bodies by Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~’S
predecessors; all these discoveries, by being found to agree with
experience, contributing to establish the laws of motion, from whence
they were deduced. I shall therefore here finish what I had to say
upon those laws; and conclude this chapter with a few words concerning
the distinction which ought to be made between absolute and relative
motion. For some have thought fit to confound them together; because
they observe the laws of motion to take place here on the earth, which
is in motion, after the same manner as if it were at rest. But Sir
~ISAAC NEWTON~ has been careful to distinguish between the
relative and absolute consideration both of motion and time[76]. The
astronomers anciently found it necessary to make this distinction in
time. Time considered in it self passes on equably without relation to
any thing external, being the proper measure of the continuance and
duration of all things. But it is most frequently conceived of by us
under a relative view to some succession in sensible things, of which
we take cognizance. The succession of the thoughts in our own minds
is that, from whence we receive our first idea of time, but is a very
uncertain measure thereof; for the thoughts of some men flow on much
more swiftly, than the thoughts of others; nor does the same person
think equally quick at all times. The motions of the heavenly bodies
are more regular; and the eminent division of time into night and day,
made by the sun, leads us to measure our time by the motion of that
luminary: nor do we in the affairs of life concern our selves with any
inequality, which there may be in that motion; but the space of time
which comprehends a day and night is rather supposed to be always the
same. However astronomers anciently found these spaces of time not to
be always of the same length, and have taught how to compute their
differences. Now the time, when so equated as to be rendered perfectly
equal, is the true measure of duration, the other not. And therefore
this latter, which is absolutely true time, differs from the other,
which is only apparent. And as we ordinarily make no distinction
between apparent time, as measured by the sun, and the true; so we
often do not distinguish in our usual discourse between the real, and
the apparent or relative motion of bodies; but use the same words for
one, as we should for the other. Though all things about us are really
in motion with the earth; as this motion is not visible, we speak of
the motion of every thing we see, as if our selves and the earth stood
still. And even in other cases, where we discern the motion of bodies,
we often speak of them not in relation to the whole motion we see, but
with regard to other bodies, to which they are contiguous. If any body
were lying on a table; when that table shall be carried along, we say
the body rests upon the table, or perhaps absolutely, that the body is
at rest. However philosophers must not reject all distinction between
true and apparent motions, any more than astronomers do the distinction
between true and vulgar time; for there is as real a difference between
them, as will appear by the following consideration. Suppose all the
bodies of the universe to have their courses stopped, and reduced to
perfect rest. Then suppose their present motions to be again restored;
this cannot be done without an actual impression made upon some of them
at least. If any of them be left untouched, they will retain their
former state, that is, still remain at rest; but the other bodies,
which are wrought upon, will have changed their former state of rest,
for the contrary state of motion. Let us now suppose the bodies left
at rest to be annihilated, this will make no alteration in the state
of the moving bodies; but the effect of the impression, which was made
upon them, will still subsist. This shews the motion they received to
be an absolute thing, and to have no necessary dependence upon the
relation which the body said to be in motion has to any other body[77].

94. BESIDES absolute and relative motion are distinguishable by their
Effects. One effect of motion is, that bodies, when moved round any
center or axis, acquire a certain power, by which they forcibly
press themselves from that center or axis of motion. As when a body
is whirled about in a sling, the body presses against the sling, and
is ready to fly out as soon as liberty is given it. And this power
is proportional to the true, not relative motion of the body round
such a center or axis. Of this Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ gives the following
instance[78]. If a pail or such like vessel near full of water be
suspended by a string of sufficient length, and be turned about till
the string be hard twisted. If then as soon as the vessel and water
in it are become still and at rest, the vessel be nimbly turned about
the contrary way the string was twisted, the vessel by the strings
untwisting it self shall continue its motion a long time. And when the
vessel first begins to turn, the water in it shall receive little or
nothing of the motion of the vessel, but by degrees shall receive a
communication of motion, till at last it shall move round as swiftly
as the vessel it self. Now the definition of motion, which ~DES
CARTES~ has given us upon this principle of making all motion
meerly relative, is this: that motion, is a removal of any body from
its vicinity to other bodies, which were in immediate contact with
it, and are considered as at rest[79]. And if this be compared with
what he soon after says, that there is nothing real or positive in the
body moved, for the sake of which we ascribe motion to it, which is
not to be found as well in the contiguous bodies, which are considered
as at rest[80]; it will follow from thence, that we may consider the
vessel as at rest and the water as moving in it: and the water in
respect of the vessel has the greatest motion, when the vessel first
begins to turn, and loses this relative motion more and more, till
at length it quite ceases. But now, when the vessel first begins to
turn, the surface of the water remains smooth and flat, as before the
vessel began to move; but as the motion of the vessel communicates by
degrees motion to the water, the surface of the water will be observed
to change, the water subsiding in the middle and rising at the edges:
which elevation of the water is caused by the parts of it pressing from
the axis, they move about; and therefore this force of receding from
the axis of motion depends not upon the relative motion of the water
within the vessel, but on its absolute motion; for it is least, when
that relative motion is greatest, and greatest, when that relative
motion is least, or none at all.

95. THUS the true cause of what appears in the surface of this water
cannot be assigned, without considering the water’s motion within the
vessel. So also in the system of the world, in order to find out the
cause of the planetary motions, we must know more of the real motions,
which belong to each planet, than is absolutely necessary for the uses
of astronomy. If the astronomer should suppose the earth to stand
still, he could ascribe such motions to the celestial bodies, as should
answer all the appearances; though he would not account for them in so
simple a manner, as by attributing motion to the earth. But the motion
of the earth must of necessity be considered, before the real causes,
which actuate the planetary system, can be discovered.




CHAP. III.

Of CENTRIPETAL FORCES.


WE have just been describing in the preceding chapter the effects
produced on a body in motion, from its being continually acted upon
by a power always equal in strength, and operating in parallel
directions[81]. But bodies may be acted upon by powers, which in
different places shall have different degrees of force, and whose
several directions shall be variously inclined to each other. The most
simple of these in respect to direction is, when the power is pointed
constantly to one center. This is truly the case of that power, whose
effects we described in the foregoing chapter; though the center of
that power is so far removed, that the subject then before us is most
conveniently to be considered in the light, wherein we have placed it:
But Sir ISAAC NEWTON has considered very particularly this other case
of powers, which are constantly directed to the same center. It is upon
this foundation, that all his discoveries in the system of the world
are raised. And therefore, as this subject bears so very great a share
in the philosophy, of which I am discoursing, I think it proper in this
place to take a short view of some of the general effects of these
powers, before we come to apply them particularly to the system of the
world.

2. THESE powers or forces are by Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ called centripetal;
and their first effect is to cause the body, on which they act, to quit
the straight course, wherein it would proceed if undisturbed, and to
describe an incurvated line, which shall always be bent towards the
center of the force. It is not necessary, that such a power should
cause the body to approach that center. The body may continue to
recede from the center of the power, notwithstanding its being drawn
by the power; but this property must always belong to its motion, that
the line, in which it moves, will continually be concave towards the
center, to which the power is directed. Suppose A (in fig. 72.) to be
the center of a force. Let a body in B be moving in the direction of
the straight line B C, in which line it would continue to move, if
undisturbed; but being attracted by the centripetal force towards A,
the body must necessarily depart from this line B C, and being drawn
into the curve line B D, must pass between the lines A B and B C. It is
evident therefore, that the body in B being gradually turned off from
the straight line B C, it will at first be convex toward the line B C,
and consequently concave towards the point A: for these centripetal
powers are supposed to be in strength proportional to the power of
gravity, and, like that, not to be able after the manner of an impulse
to turn the body sensibly out of its course into a different one in
an instant, but to take up some space of time in producing a visible
effect. That the curve will always continue to have its concavity
towards A may thus appear. In the line B C near to B take any point as
E, from which the line E F G may be so drawn, as to touch the curve
line B D in some point as F. Now when the body is come to F, if the
centripetal power were immediately to be suspended, the body would no
longer continue to move in a curve line, but being left to it self
would forthwith reassume a straight course; and that straight course
would be in the line F G: for that line is in the direction of the
body’s motion at the point F. But the centripetal force continuing its
energy, the body will be gradually drawn from this line F G so as to
keep in the line F D, and make that line near the point F to be convex
toward F G, and concave toward A. After the same manner the body may be
followed on in its course through the line B D, and every part of that
line be shewn to be concave toward the point A.

3. THIS then is the constant character belonging to those motions,
which are carried on by centripetal forces; that the line, wherein the
body moves, is throughout concave towards the center of the force. In
respect to the successive distances of the body from the center there
is no general rule to be laid down; for the distance of the body from
the center may either increase, or decrease, or even keep always the
same. The point A (in fig. 73.) being the center of a centripetal
force, let a body at B set out in the direction of the straight line B
C perpendicular to the line A B drawn from A to B. It will be easily
conceived, that there is no other point in the line B C so near to A,
as the point B; that A B is the shortest of all the lines, which can
be drawn from A to any part of the line B C; all other lines, as A D,
or A E, drawn from A to the line B C being longer than A B. Hence it
follows, that the body setting out from B, if it moved in the line B
C, it would recede more and more from the point A. Now as the operation
of a centripetal force is to draw a body towards the center of the
force: if such a force act upon a resting body, it must necessarily put
that body so into motion, as to cause it to move towards the center
of the force: if the body were of it self moving towards that center,
the centripetal force would accelerate that motion, and cause it to
move faster down: but if the body were in such a motion, as being left
to itself it would recede from this center, it is not necessary, that
the action of a centripetal power upon it should immediately compel
the body to approach the center, from which it would otherwise have
receded; the centripetal power is not without effect, if it cause the
body to recede more slowly from that center, than otherwise it would
have done. Thus in the case before us, the smallest centripetal power,
if it act on the body, will force it out of the line B C, and cause it
to pass in a bent line between B C and the point A, as has been before
explained. When the body, for instance, has advanced to the line A D,
the effect of the centripetal force discovers it self by having removed
the body out of the line B C, and brought it to cross the line A D
somewhere between A and D: suppose at F. Now A D being longer than A B,
A F may also be longer than A B. The centripetal power may indeed be
so strong, that A F shall be shorter than A B; or it may be so evenly
balanced with the progressive motion of the body, that A F and A B
shall be just equal: and in this last case, when the centripetal force
is of that strength, as constantly to draw the body as much toward the
center, as the progressive motion would carry it off, the body will
describe a circle about the center A, this center of the force being
also the center of the circle.

4. IF the body, instead of setting out in the line B C perpendicular
to A B, had set out in another line B G more inclined towards the
line A B, moving in the curve line B H; then as the body, if it were
to continue its motion in the line B G, would for some time approach
the center A; the centripetal force would cause it to make greater
advances toward that center. But if the body were to set out in the
line B I reclined the other way from the perpendicular B C, and were to
be drawn by the centripetal force into the curve line B K; the body,
notwithstanding any centripetal force, would for some time recede from
the center; since some part at least of the curve line B K lies between
the line B I and the perpendicular B C.

5. THUS far we have explained such effects, as attend every centripetal
force. But as these forces may be very different in regard to the
different degrees of strength, wherewith they act upon bodies in
different places; I shall now proceed to make mention in general of
some of the differences attending these centripetal motions.

6. TO reassume the consideration of the last mentioned case. Suppose a
centripetal power directed toward the point A (in fig. 74.) to act on
a body in B, which is moving in the direction of the straight line B
C, the line B C reclining off from A B. If from A the straight lines A
D, A E, A F are drawn at pleasure to the line C B; the line C B being
prolonged beyond B to G, it appears that A D is inclined to the line
G C more obliquely, than A B is inclined to it, A E is inclined more
obliquely than A D, and A F more than A E. To speak more correctly, the
angle under A D G is less than that under A B G, the angle under A E G
less than that under A D G, and the angle under A F G less than that
under A E G. Now suppose the body to move in the curve line B H I K.
Then it is here likewise evident, that the line B H I K being concave
towards A, and convex towards the line B C, it is more and more turned
off from the line B C; so that in the point H the line A H will be less
obliquely inclined to the curve line B H I K, than the same line A H
D is inclined to B C at the point D; at the point I the inclination
of the line A I to the curve line will be more different from the
inclination of the same line A I E to the line B C, at the point E;
and in the points K and F the difference of inclination will be still
greater; and in both the inclination at the curve will be less oblique,
than at the straight line B C. But the straight line A B is less
obliquely inclined to B G, than A D is inclined towards D G: therefore
although the line A H be less obliquely inclined towards the curve H B,
than the same line A H D is inclined towards D G; yet it is possible,
that the inclination at H may be more oblique, than the inclination at
B. The inclination at H may indeed be less oblique than the other, or
they may be both the same. This depends upon the degree of strength,
wherewith the centripetal force exerts it self, during the passage of
the body from B to H. After the same manner the inclinations at I and K
depend entirely on the degree of strength, wherewith the centripetal
force acts on the body in its passage from H to K: if the centripetal
force be weak enough, the lines A H and A I drawn from the center A to
the body at H and at I shall be more obliquely inclined to the curve,
than the line A B is inclined towards B G. The centripetal force may
be of that strength as to render all these inclinations equal, or if
stronger, the inclinations at I and K will be less oblique than at
B. Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has particularly shewn, that if the
centripetal power decreases after a certain manner with the increase
of distance, a body may describe such a curve line, that all the
lines drawn from the center to the body shall be equally inclined to
that curve line.[82] But I do not here enter into any particulars, my
present intention being only to shew, that it is possible for a body to
be acted upon by a force continually drawing it down towards a center,
and yet that the body shall continue to recede from that center; for
here as long as the lines A H, A I, &c drawn from the center A to the
body do not become less oblique to the curve, in which the body moves;
so long shall those lines perpetually increase, and consequently the
body shall more and more recede from the center.

7. BUT we may observe farther, that if the centripetal power, while
the body increases its distance from the center, retain sufficient
strength to make the lines drawn from the center to the body to become
at length less oblique to the curve; then if this diminution of the
obliquity continue, till at last the line drawn from the center to
the body shall cease to be obliquely inclined to the curve, and shall
become perpendicular thereto; from this instant the body shall no
longer recede from the center, but in its following motion it shall
again descend, and shall describe a curve line in all respects like to
that, which it has described already; provided the centripetal power,
every where at the same distance from the center, acts with the same
strength. So we observed in the preceding chapter, that, when the
motion of a projectile became parallel to the horizon, the projectile
no longer ascended, but forthwith directed its course downwards,
descending in a line altogether like that, wherein it had before
ascended[83].

8. THIS return of the body may be proved by the following proposition:
that if the body in any place, suppose at I, were to be stopt, and
be thrown directly backward with the velocity, wherewith it was
moving forward in that point I; then the body, by the action of the
centripetal force upon it, would move back again over the path I H B,
in which it had before advanced forward, and would arrive again at the
point B in the same space of time, as was taken up in its passage from
B to I; the velocity of the body at its return to the point B being
the same, as that wherewith it first set out from that point. To give
a full demonstration of this proposition, would require that use of
mathematics, which I here purpose to avoid; but, I believe, it will
appear in great measure evident from the following considerations.

9. SUPPOSE (in fig. 75.) that a body were carried after the following
manner through the bent figure A B C D E F, composed of the straight
lines A B, B C, C D, D E, E F. First let it be moving in the line A B,
from A towards B, with any uniform velocity. At B let the body receive
an impulse directed toward some point, as G, taken within the concavity
of the figure. Now whereas this body, when once moving in the straight
line A B, will continue to move on in this line, so long as it shall be
left to it self; but being disturbed at the point B in its motion by
the impulse, which there acts upon it, it will be turned out of this
line A B into some other straight line, wherein it will afterwards
continue to move, as long as it shall be left to itself. Therefore
let this impulse have strength sufficient to turn the body into the
line B C. Then let the body move on undisturbed from B to C, but at C
let it receive another impulse pointed toward the same point G, and
of sufficient strength to turn the body into the line C D. At D let a
third impulse, directed like the rest to the point G, turn the body
into the line D E. And at E let another impulse, directed likewise to
the point G, turn the body into the line E F. Now, I say, if the body
while moving in the line E F be stopt, and turned back again in this
line with the same velocity, as that wherewith it was moving forward in
this line; then by the repetition of the former impulse at E the body
will be turned into the line E D, and move in it from E to D with the
same velocity as before it moved with from D to E; by the repetition of
the impulse at D, when the body shall have returned to that point, it
will be turned into the line D C; and by the repetition of the other
impulses at C and B the body will be brought back again into the line
B A, with the velocity, wherewith it first moved in that line.

10. THIS I prove as follows. Let D E and F E be continued beyond E. In
D E thus continued take at pleasure the length E H, and let H I be so
drawn, as to be equidistant from the line G E. Then, by what has been
written upon the second law of motion[84], it follows, that after the
impulse on the body in E it will move through E I in the same time, as
it would have imployed in moving from E to H, with the velocity which
it had in the line D E. In F E prolonged take E K equal to E I, and
draw K L equidistant from G E. Then, because the body is thrown back in
the line F E with the same velocity as that wherewith it went forward
in that line; if, when the body was returned to E, it were permitted
to go straight on, it would pass through E K in the same time, as it
took up in passing through E I, when it went forward in the line E F.
But, if at the body’s return to the point E, such an impulse directed
toward the point D were to be given it, whereby it should be turned
into the line D E; I say, that the impulse necessary to produce this
effect must be equal to that, which turned the body out of the line D E
into E F; and that the velocity, with which the body will return into
the line E D, is the same, as that wherewith it before moved through
this line from D to E. Because E K is equal to E I, and K L and H I,
being each equidistant from G E, are by consequence equidistant from
each other; it follows, that the two triangular figures I E H and K
E L are altogether like and equal to each other. If I were writing to
mathematicians, I might refer them to some proportions in the elements
of EUCLID for the proof of this[85] but as I do not here address my
self to such, so I think this assertion will be evident enough without
a proof in form; at least I must desire my readers to receive it as a
proposition true in geometry. But these two triangular figures being
altogether like each other and equal; as E K is equal to E I, so E L is
equal to E H, and K L equal to H I. Now the body after its return to
E being turned out of the line F E into E D by an impulse acting upon
it in E, after the manner above expressed; the body will receive such
a velocity by this impulse, as will carry it through E L in the same
time, as it would have imployed in passing through E K, if it had gone
on in that line undisturbed. And it has already been observed, that the
time, in which the body would pass over E K with the velocity wherewith
it returns, is equal to the time it took up in going forward from E to
I; that is, equal to the time, in which it would have gone through E H
with the velocity, wherewith it moved from D to E. Therefore the time,
in which the body will pass through E L after its return into the line
E D, is the same, as would have been taken up by the body in passing
through E H with the velocity, wherewith the body first moved in the
line D E. Since therefore E L and E H are equal, the body returns into
the line D E with the velocity, which it had before in that line. Again
I say, the second impulse in E is equal to the first. By what has
been said on the second law of motion concerning the effect of oblique
impulses[86], it will be understood, that the impulse in E, whereby
the body was turned out of the line D E into the line E F, is of such
strength, that if the body had been at rest, when this impulse had
acted upon it, this impulse would have communicated so much motion to
the body, as would have carried it through a length equal to H I, in
the time wherein the body would have passed from E to H, or in the time
wherein it passed from E to I. In the same manner, on the return of the
body, the impulse in E, whereby the body is turned out of the line F
E into E D, is of such strength, that if it had acted on the body at
rest, it would have caused the body to move through a length equal to
K L, in the same time, as the body would imploy in passing through E K
with the velocity, wherewith it returns in the line F E. Therefore the
second impulse, had it acted on the body at rest, would have caused it
to move through a length equal to K L in the same space of time, as
would be taken up by the body in passing through a length equal to H I,
were the first impulse to act on the body when at rest. That is, the
effects of the first and second impulse on the body when at rest would
be the same; for K L and H I are equal: consequently the second impulse
is equal to the first.

11. THUS if the body be returned through F E with the velocity,
wherewith it moved forward; we have shewn how by the repetition of the
impulse, which acted on it at E, the body will return again into the
line D E with the velocity, which it had before in that line. By the
same process of reasoning it may be proved, that, when the body is
returned back to D, the impulse, which before acted on the body at that
point, will throw the body into the line D C with the velocity, which
it first had in that line; and the other impulses being successively
repeated, the body will at length be brought back again into the line B
A with the velocity, wherewith it set out in that line.

12. THUS these impulses, by acting over again in an inverted order
all their operation on the body, bring it back again through the
path, in which it had proceeded forward. And this obtains equally,
whatever be the number of the straight lines, whereof this curve
figure is composed. Now by a method of reasoning, which Sir ~ISAAC
NEWTON~ makes great use of, and which he introduced into geometry,
thereby greatly inriching that science[87]; we might make a transition
from this figure composed of a number of straight lines to a figure
of one continued curvature, and from a number of separate impulses
repeated at distinct intervals to a continual centripetal force, and
shew, that, because what has been here advanced holds universally
true, whatever be the number of straight lines, whereof the curve
figure A C F is composed, and howsoever frequently the impulses at
the angles of this figure are repeated; therefore the same will still
remain true, although this figure should be converted into one of a
continued curvature, and these distinct impulses should be changed
into a continual centripetal force. But as the explaining this method
of reasoning is foreign to my present design; so I hope my readers,
after what has been said, will find no difficulty in receiving the
proposition laid down above: that, if the body, which has moved through
the curve line B H I (in fig. 74.) from B to I, when it is come to I,
be thrown directly back with the same velocity as that, wherewith it
proceeded forward, the centripetal force, by acting over again all its
operation on the body, shall bring the body back again in the line I H
B: and as the motion of the body in its course from B to I was every
where in such a manner oblique to the line drawn from the center to
the body, that the centripetal power acted in some degree against the
body’s motion, and gradually diminished it; so in the return of the
body, the centripetal power will every where draw the body forward, and
accelerate its motion by the same degrees, as before it retarded it.

13. THIS being agreed, suppose the body in K to have the line A K no
longer obliquely inclined to its motion. In this case, if the body
be turned back, in the manner we have been considering, it must be
directed back perpendicularly to A K. But if it had proceeded forward,
it would likewise have moved in a direction perpendicular to A K;
consequently, whether it move from this point K backward or forward, it
must describe the same kind of course. Therefore since by being turned
back it will go over again the line K I H B; if it be permitted to go
forward, the line K L, which it shall describe, will be altogether
similar to the line K H B.

14. IN like manner we may determine the nature of the motion, if
the line, wherein the body sets out, be inclined (as in fig. 76.)
down toward the line B A drawn between the body and the center. If
the centripetal power so much increases in strength, as the body
approaches, that it can bend the path, in which the body moves, to
that degree, as to cause all the lines as A H, A I, A K to remain no
less oblique to the motion of the body, than A B is oblique to B C;
the body shall continually more and more approach the center. But if
the centripetal power increases in so much less a degree, as to permit
the line drawn from the center to the body, as it accompanies the
body in its motion, at length to become more and more erect to the
curve wherein the body moves, and in the end, suppose at K, to become
perpendicular thereto; from that time the body shall rise again. This
is evident from what has been said above; because for the very same
reason here also the body shall proceed from the point K to describe a
line altogether similar to the line, in which it has moved from B to K.
Thus, as it was observed of the pendulum in the preceding chapter[88],
that all the time it approaches towards being perpendicular to the
horizon, it more and more descends; but, as soon as it is come into
that perpendicular situation, it immediately rises again by the same
degrees, as it descended by before: so here the body more and more
approaches the center all the time it is moving from B to K; but thence
forward it rises from the center again by the same degrees, as it
approached by before.

15. IF (in fig. 77.) the line B C be perpendicular to A B; then it has
been observed above[89], that the centripetal power may be so balanced
with the progressive motion of the body, that the body may keep moving
round the center A constantly at the same distance; as a body does,
when whirled about any point, to which it is tyed by a string. If the
centripetal power be too weak to produce this effect, the motion of
the body will presently become oblique to the line drawn from itself
to the center, after the manner of the first of the two cases, which
we have been considering. If the centripetal power be stronger, than
what is required to carry the body in a circle, the motion of the body
will presently fall in with the second of the cases, we have been
considering.

16. IF the centripetal power so change with the change of distance,
that the body, after its motion has become oblique to the line drawn
from itself to the center, shall again become perpendicular thereto;
which we have shewn to be possible in both the cases treated of
above; then the body shall in its subsequent motion return again to
the distance of A B, and from that distance take a course similar
to the former: and thus, if the body move in a space free from all
resistance, which has been here all along supposed; it shall continue
in a perpetual motion about the center, descending and ascending
alternately therefrom. If the body setting out from B (in fig. 78.) in
the line B C perpendicular to A B, describe the line B D E, which in D
shall be oblique to the line A D, but in E shall again become erect to
A E drawn from the body in E to the center A; then from this point E
the body shall describe the line E F G altogether like to the line B D
E, and at G shall be at the same distance from A, as it was at B. But
likewise the line A G shall be erect to the body’s motion. Therefore
the body shall proceed to describe from G the line G H I altogether
similar to the line G F E, and at I have the same distance from the
center, as it had at E; and also have the line A I erect to its motion:
so that its following motion must be in the line I K L similar to I H
G, and the distance A L equal to A G. Thus the body will go on in a
perpetual round without ceasing, alternately inlarging and contracting
its distance from the center.

[Illustration]

17. IF it so happen, that the point E fall upon the line B A continued
beyond A; then the point G will fall on B, I on E, and L also on B;
so that the body will describe in this case a simple curve line round
the center A, like the line B D E F in fig. 79, in which it will
continually revolve from B to E and from E to B without end.

18. IF A E in fig. 78 should happen to be perpendicular to A B, in this
case also a simple line will be described; for the point G will fall on
the line B A prolonged beyond A, the point I on the line A E prolonged
beyond A, and the point L on B: so that the body will describe a line
like the curve line B E G I in fig. 80, in which the opposite points B
and G are equally distant from A, and the opposite points E and I are
also equally distant from the same point A.

19. IN other cases the line described will have a more complex figure.

20. THUS we have endeavoured to shew how a body, while it is constantly
attracted towards a center, may notwithstanding by its progressive
motion keep it self from falling down to that center; but describe
about it an endless circuit, sometimes approaching toward that center,
and at other times as much receding from the same.

21. BUT here we have supposed, that the centripetal power is of equal
strength every where at the same distance from the center. And this is
the case of that centripetal power, which will hereafter be shewn to be
the cause, that keeps the planets in their courses. But a body may be
kept on in a perpetual circuit round a center, although the centripetal
power have not this property. Indeed a body may by a centripetal
force be kept moving in any curve line whatever, that shall have its
concavity turned every where towards the center of the force.

22. TO make this evident I shall first propose the case of a body
moving through the incurvated figure A B C D E (in fig. 81.) which is
composed of the straight lines A B, B C, C D, D E, and E A; the motion
being carried on in the following manner. Let the body first move in
the line A B with any uniform velocity. When it is arrived at the point
B, let it receive an impulse directed toward any point F taken within
the figure; and let the impulse be of that strength as to turn the body
out of the line A B into the line B C. The body after this impulse,
while left to itself, will continue moving in the line B C. At C let
the body receive another impulse directed towards the same point F, of
such strength, as to turn the body from the line B C into the line C D.
At D let the body by another impulse, directed likewise to the point F,
be turned out of the line C D into D E. And at E let another impulse,
directed toward the point F, turn the body from the line D E into E
A. Thus we see how a body may be carried through the figure A B C D E
by certain impulses directed always toward the same center, only by
their acting on the body at proper intervals, and with due degrees of
strength.

23. BUT farther, when the body is come to the point A, if it there
receive another impulse directed like the rest toward the point F, and
of such a degree of strength as to turn the body into the line A B,
wherein it first moved; I say that the body shall return into this line
with the same velocity, as it had at first.

24. LET A B be prolonged beyond B at pleasure, suppose to G; and from G
let G H be drawn, which if produced should always continue equidistant
from B F, or, according to the more usual phrase, let G H be drawn
parallel to B F. Then it appears, from what has been said upon the
second law of motion[90], that in the time, wherein the body would have
moved from B to G, had it not received a new impulse in B, by the means
of that impulse it will have acquired a velocity, which will carry it
from B to H. After the same manner, if C I be taken equal to B H,
and I K be drawn equidistant from or parallel to C F; the body will
have moved from C to K with the velocity, which it has in the line C
D, in the same time, as it would have employed in moving from C to I
with the velocity, it had in the line B C. Therefore since C I and B
H are equal, the body will move through C K in the same time, as it
would have taken up in moving from B to G with the original velocity,
wherewith it moved through the line A B. Again, D L being taken equal
to C K and L M drawn parallel to D F; for the same reason as before the
body will move through D M with the velocity, which it has in the line
D E, in the same time, as it would imploy in moving through B G with
its original velocity. In the last place, if E N be taken equal to D M,
and N O be drawn parallel to E F; likewise if A P be taken equal to E
O, and P Q be drawn parallel to A F: then the body with the velocity,
wherewith it returns into the line A B, will pass through A Q in the
same time, as it would have imployed in passing through B G with its
original velocity. Now as all this follows directly from what has above
been delivered, concerning the effect of oblique impulses impressed
upon bodies in motion; so we must here observe farther, that it can be
proved by geometry, that A Q will always be equal to E G. The proof of
this I am obliged, from the nature of my present design, to omit; but
this geometrical proportion being granted, it follows, that the body
has returned into the line A B with the velocity, which it had, when
it first moved in that line; for the velocity, with which it returns
into the line A B, will carry it over the line A Q in the same time, as
would have been taken up in its passing over an equal line B G with
the original velocity.

25. THUS we have found, how a body may be carried round the figure A
B C D E by the action of certain impulses upon it which should all be
pointed toward one center. And we likewise see, that when the body is
brought back again to the point, whence it first set out; if it there
meet with an impulse sufficient to turn it again into the line, wherein
it moved at first, its original velocity will be again restored; and by
the repetition of the same impulses, the body will be carried again in
the same round. Therefore if these impulses, which act on the body at
the points B, C, D, E, and A, continue always the same, the body will
make round this figure innumerable revolutions.

26. THE proof, which we have here made use of, holds the same in any
number of straight lines, whereof the figure A B D should be composed;
and therefore by the method of reasoning referred to above[91] we are
to conclude, that what has here been said upon this rectilinear figure,
will remain true, if this figure were changed into one of a continued
curvature, and instead of distinct impulses acting by intervals at the
angles of this figure, we had a continual centripetal force. We have
therefore shewn, that a body may be carried round in any curve figure
A B C ( fig. 82.) which shall every where be concave towards any one
point as D, by the continual action of a centripetal power directed to
that point, and when it is returned to the point, from whence it set
out, it shall recover again the velocity, with which it departed from
that point. It is not indeed always necessary, that it should return
again into its first course; for the curve line may have some such
figure as the line A B C D B E in fig. 83. In this curve line, if the
body set out from B in the direction B F, and moved through the line B
C D, till it returned to B; here the body would not enter again into
the line B C D, because the two parts B D and B C of the curve line
make an angle at the point B: so that the centripetal power, which at
the point B could turn the body from the line B F into the curve, will
not be able to turn the body into the line B C from the direction, in
which it returns to the point B; a forceable impulse must be given the
body in the point B to produce that effect.

27. IF at the point B, whence the body sets out, the curve line return
into it self (as in fig. 82;) then the body, upon its arrival again at
B, may return into its former course, and thus make an endless circuit
about the center of the centripetal power.

28. WHAT has here been said, I hope, will in some measure enable my
readers to form a just idea of the nature of these centripetal motions.

29. I HAVE not attempted to shew, how to find particularly, what kind
of centripetal force is necessary to carry a body in any curve line
proposed. This is to be deduced from the degree of curvature, which
the figure has in each point of it, and requires a long and complex
mathematical reasoning. However I shall speak a little to the first
proportion, which Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ lays down for this
purpose. By this proposition, when a body is found moving in a curve
line, it may be known, whether the body be kept in its course by a
power always pointed toward the same center; and if it be so, where
that center is placed. The proposition is this: that if a line be drawn
from some fixed point to the body, and remaining by one extream united
to that point, it be carried round along with the body; then, if the
power, whereby the body is kept in its course, be always pointed to
this fixed point as a center, this line will move over equal spaces in
equal portions of time. Suppose a body were moving through the curve
line A B C D (in fig. 84.) and passed over the arches A B, B C, C D
in equal portions of time; then if a point, as E, can be found, from
whence the line E A being drawn to the body in A, and accompanying the
body in its motion, it shall make the spaces E A B, E B C, and E C D
equal, over which it passes, while the body describes the arches A B, B
C, and C D: and if this hold the same in all other arches, both great
and small, of the curve line A B C D, that these spaces are always
equal, where the times are equal; then is the body kept in this line by
a power always pointed to E as a center.

30. THE principle, upon which Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has
demonstrated this, requires but small skill in geometry to comprehend.
I shall therefore take the liberty to close the present chapter with
an explication of it; because such an example will give the clearest
notion of our author’s method of applying mathematical reasoning to
these philosophical subjects.

31. HE reasons thus. Suppose a body set out from the point A (in fig.
85.) to move in the straight line A B; and after it had moved for some
time in that line, it were to receive an impulse directed to some point
as C. Let it receive that impulse at D; and thereby be turned into the
line D E; and let the body after this impulse take the same length of
time in passing from D to E, as it imployed in the passing from A to
D. Then the straight lines C A, C D, and C E being drawn, Sir ~ISAAC
NEWTON~ proves, that the and triangular spaces C A D and C D E are
equal. This he does in the following manner.

32. LET E F be drawn parallel to C D. Then, from what has been said
upon the second law of motion[92], it is evident, that since the
body was moving in the line A B, when it received the impulse in the
direction D C; it will have moved after that impulse through the line
D E in the same time, as it would have taken up in moving through D
F, provided it had received no disturbance in D. But the time of the
body’s moving from D to E is supposed to be equal to the time of its
moving through A D; therefore the time, which the body would have
imployed in moving through D F, had it not been disturbed in D, is
equal to the time, wherein it moved through A D: consequently D F is
equal in length to A D; for if the body had gone on to move through
the line A B without interruption, it would have moved through all
parts thereof with the same velocity, and have passed over equal parts
of that line in equal portions of time. Now C F being drawn, since
A D and D F are equal, the triangular space C D F is equal to the
triangular space C A D. Farther, the line E F being parallel to C D, it
is proved by EUCLID, that the triangle C E D is equal to the triangle C
F D[93]: therefore the triangle C E D is equal to the triangle C A D.

33. AFTER the same manner, if the body receive at E another impulse
directed toward the point C, and be turned by that impulse into the
line E G; if it move afterwards from E to G in the same space of time,
as was taken up by its motion from D to E, or from A to D; then C G
being drawn, the triangle C E G is equal to C D E. A third impulse at
G directed as the two former to C, whereby the body shall be turned
into the line G H, will have also the like effect with the rest. If the
body move over G H in the same time, as it took up in moving over E
G, the triangle C G H will be equal to the triangle C E G. Lastly, if
the body at H be turned by a fresh impulse directed toward C into the
line H I, and at I by another impulse directed also to C be turned into
the line I K; and if the body move over each of the lines H I, and I K
in the same time, as it imployed in moving over each of the preceding
lines A D, D E, E G, and G H: then each of the triangles C H I, and C
I K will be equal to each of the preceding. Likewise as the time, in
which the body moves over A D E, is equal to the time of its moving
over E G H, and to the time of its moving over H I K; the space C A D
E will be equal to the space C E G H, and to the space C H I K. In the
same manner as the time, in which the body moved over A D E G is equal
to the time of its moving over G H I K, so the space C A D E G will be
equal to the space C G H I K.

34. FROM this principle Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ demonstrates the proposition
mentioned above, by that method of arguing introduced by him into
geometry, whereof we have before taken notice[94], by making according
to the principles of that method a transition from this incurvated
figure composed of straight lines, to a figure of continued curvature;
and by shewing, that since equal spaces are described in equal times
in this present figure composed of straight lines, the same relation
between the spaces described and the times of their description will
also have place in a figure of one continued curvature. He also deduces
from this proposition the reverse of it; and proves, that whenever
equal spaces are continually described; the body is acted upon by
a centripetal force directed to the center, at which the spaces
terminate.




CHAP. IV.

Of the RESISTANCE of FLUIDS.


BEFORE the cause can be discovered, which keeps the planets in motion,
it is necessary first to know, whether the space, wherein they move, is
empty and void, or filled with any quantity of matter. It has been a
prevailing opinion, that all space contains in it matter of some kind
or other; so that where no sensible matter is found, there was yet a
subtle fluid substance by which the space was filled up; even so as
to make an absolute plenitude. In order to examine this opinion, Sir
~ISAAC NEWTON~ has largely considered the effects of fluids upon bodies
moving in them.

2. THESE effects he has reduced under these three heads. In the
first place he shews how to determine in what manner the resistance,
which bodies suffer, when moving in a fluid, gradually increases in
proportion to the space, they describe in any fluid; to the velocity,
with which they describe it; and to the time they have been in motion.
Under the second head he considers what degree of resistance different
bodies moving in the same fluid undergo, according to the different
proportion between the density of the fluid and the density of the
body. The densities of bodies, whether fluid or solid, are measured by
the quantity of matter, which is comprehended under the same magnitude;
that body being the most dense or compact, which under the same bulk
contains the greatest quantity of solid matter, or which weighs most,
the weight of every body being observed above to be proportional
to the quantity of matter in it[95]. Thus water is more dense than
cork or wood, iron more dense than water, and gold than iron. The
third particular Sir ~IS. NEWTON~ considers concerning the
resistance of fluids is the influence, which the diversity of figure in
the resisted body has upon its resistance.

3. FOR the more perfect illustration of the first of these heads, he
distinctly shews the relation between all the particulars specified
upon three different suppositions. The first is, that the same body
be resisted more or less in the simple proportion to its velocity; so
that if its velocity be doubled, its resistance shall become threefold.
The second is of the resistance increasing in the duplicate proportion
of the velocity; so that, if the velocity of a body be doubled, its
resistance shall be rendered four times; and if the velocity be
trebled, nine times as great as at first. But what is to be understood
by duplicate proportion has been already explained[96]. The third
supposition is, that the resistance increases partly in the single
proportion of the velocity, and partly in the duplicate proportion
thereof.

4. IN all these suppositions, bodies are considered under two respects,
either as moving, and opposing themselves against the fluid by
that power alone, which is essential to them, of resisting to the
change of their state from rest to motion, or from motion to rest,
which we have above called their power of inactivity; or else, as
descending or ascending, and so having the power of gravity combined
with that other power. Thus our author has shewn in all those three
suppositions, in what manner bodies are resisted in an uniform fluid,
when they move with the aforesaid progressive motion[97]; and what the
resistance is, when they ascend or descend perpendicularly[98]. And
if a body ascend or descend obliquely, and the resistance be singly
proportional to the velocity, it is shewn how the body is resisted in
a fluid of an uniform density, and what line it will describe[99],
which is determined by the measurement of the hyperbola, and appears
to be no other than that line, first considered in particular by Dr.
~BARROW~[100], which is now commonly known by the name of the
logarithmical curve. In the supposition that the resistance increases
in the duplicate proportion of the velocity, our author has not given
us the line which would be described in an uniform fluid; but has
instead thereof discussed a problem, which is in some sort the reverse;
to find the density of the fluid at all altitudes, by which any given
curve line may be described; which problem is so treated by him, as
to be applicable to any kind of resistance whatever[101]. But here
not unmindful of practice, he shews that a body in a fluid of uniform
density, like the air, will describe a line, which approaches towards
an hyperbola; that is, its motion will be nearer to that curve line
than to the parabola. And consequent upon this remark, he shews how to
determine this hyperbola by experiment, and briefly resolves the chief
of those problems relating to projectiles, which are in use in the art
of gunnery, in this curve[102]; as ~TORRICELLI~ and others
have done in the parabola[103], whose inventions have been explained at
large above[104].

5. OUR author has also handled distinctly that particular sort of
motion, which is described by pendulums[105]; and has likewise
considered some few cases of bodies moving in resisting fluids round a
center, to which they are impelled by a centripetal force, in order to
give an idea of those kinds of motions[106].

6. THE treating of the resistance of pendulums has given him
an opportunity of inserting into another part of his work some
speculations upon the motions of them without resistance, which have
a very peculiar elegance; where in he treats of them as moved by a
gravitation acting in the law, which he shews to belong to the earth
below its surface[107]; performing in this kind of gravitation, where
the force is proportional to the distance from the center, all that
HUYGENS had before done in the common supposition of its being uniform,
and acting in parallel lines[108].

7. HUYGENS at the end of his treatise of the cause of gravity[109]
informs us, that he likewise had carried his speculations on the
first of these suppositions, of the resistance in fluids being
proportional to the velocity of the body, as far as our author. But
finding by experiment that the second was more conformable to nature,
he afterwards made some progress in that, till he was stopt, by not
being able to execute to his wish what related to the perpendicular
descent of bodies; not observing that the measurement of the curve
line, he made use of to explain it by, depended on the hyperbola.
Which oversight may well be pardoned in that great man, considering
that our author had not been pleased at that time to communicate to
the publick his admirable discourse of the QUADRATURE or MEASUREMENT
OF CURVE LINES, with which he has since obliged the world: for without
the use of that treatise, it is I think no injury even to our author’s
unparalleled abilities to believe, it would not have been easy for
himself to have succeeded so happily in this and many other parts of
his writings.

8. WHAT HUYGENS found by experiment, that bodies were in reality
resisted in the duplicate proportion of their velocity, agrees with the
reasoning of our author[110], who distinguishes the resistance, which
fluids give to bodies by the tenacity of their parts, and the friction
between them and the body, from that, which arises from the power of
inactivity, with which the constituent particles of fluids are endued
like all other portions of matter, by which power the particles of
fluids like other bodies make resistance against being put into motion.

9. THE resistance, which arises from the friction of the body
against the parts of the fluid, must be very inconsiderable; and the
resistance, which follows from the tenacity of the parts of fluids, is
not usually very great, and does not depend much upon the velocity of
the body in the fluid; for as the parts of the fluid adhere together
with a certain degree of force, the resistance, which the body receives
from thence, cannot much depend upon the velocity, with which the body
moves; but like the power of gravity, its effect must be proportional
to the time of its acting. This the reader may find farther explained
by Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ himself in the postscript to a discourse
published by me in THE PHILOSOPHICAL TRANSACTIONS, N^o 371. The
principal resistance, which most fluids give to bodies, arises from the
power of inactivity in the parts of the fluids, and this depends upon
the velocity, with which the body moves, on a double account. In the
first place, the quantity of the fluid moved out of place by the moving
body in any determinate space of time is proportional to the velocity,
wherewith the body moves; and in the next place, the velocity with
which each particle of the fluid is moved, will also be proportional
to the velocity of the body: therefore since the resistance, which
any body makes against being put into motion, is proportional both
to the quantity of matter moved and the velocity it is moved with;
the resistance, which a fluid gives on this account, will be doubly
increased with the increase of the velocity in the moving body; that
is, the resistance will be in a two-fold or duplicate proportion of the
velocity, wherewith the body moves through the fluid.

10. FARTHER it is most manifest, that this latter kind of resistance
increasing with the increase of velocity, even in a greater degree than
the velocity it self increases, the swifter the body moves, the less
proportion the other species of resistance will bear to this: nay that
this part of the resistance may be so much augmented by a due increase
of velocity, till the former resistances shall bear a less proportion
to this, than any that might be assigned. And indeed experience shews,
that no other resistance, than what arises from the power of inactivity
in the parts of the fluid, is of moment, when the body moves with any
considerable swiftness.

11. THERE is besides these yet another species of resistance, found
only in such fluids, as, like our air, are elastic. Elasticity belongs
to no fluid known to us beside the air. By this property any quantity
of air may be contracted into a less space by a forcible pressure, and
as soon as the compressing power is removed, it will spring out again
to its former dimensions. The air we breath is held to its present
density by the weight of the air above us. And as this incumbent
weight, by the motion of the winds, or other causes, is frequently
varied (which appears by the barometer;) so when this weight is
greatest, we breath a more dense air than at other times. To what
degree the air would expand it self by its spring, if all pressure
were removed, is not known, nor yet into how narrow a compass it is
capable of being compressed. Mr. BOYLE found it by experiment capable
both of expansion and compression to such a degree, that he could cause
a quantity of air to expand it self over a space some hundred thousand
times greater, than the space to which he could confine the same
quantity[111]. But I shall treat more fully of this spring in the air
hereafter[112]. I am now only to consider what resistance to the motion
of bodies arises from it.

12. BUT before our author shews in what manner this cause of resistance
operates, he proposes a method, by which fluids may be rendered
elastic, demonstrating that if their particles be provided with a power
of repelling each other, which shall exert it self with degrees of
strength reciprocally proportional to the distances between the centers
of the particles; that then such fluids will observe the same rule in
being compressed, as our air does, which is this, that the space, into
which it yields upon compression, is reciprocally proportional to the
compressing weight[113]. The term reciprocally proportional has been
explained above[114]. And if the centrifugal force of the particles
acted by other laws, such fluids would yield in a different manner to
compression[115].

13. WHETHER the particles of the air be endued with such a power,
by which they can act upon each other out of contact, our author
does not determine, but leaves that to future examination, and to
be discussed by philosophers. Only he takes occasion from hence to
consider the resistance in elastic fluids, under this notion; making
remarks, as he passes along, upon the differences, which will arise,
if their elasticity be derived from any other fountain[116]. And this,
I think, must be confessed to be done by him with great judgment;
for this is far the most reasonable account, which has been given of
this surprizing power, as must without doubt be freely acknowledged
by any one, who in the least considers the insufficiency of all the
other conjectures, which have been framed; and also how little reason
there is to deny to bodies other powers, by which they may act upon
each other at a distance, as well as that of gravity; which we shall
hereafter shew to be a property universally belonging to all the bodies
of the universe, and to all their parts[117]. Nay we actually find
in the loadstone a very apparent repelling, as well as an attractive
power. But of this more in the conclusion of this discourse.

14. BY these steps our author leads the way to explain the resistance,
which the air and such like fluids will give to bodies by their
elasticity; which resistance he explains thus. If the elastic power
of the fluid were to be varied so, as to be always in the duplicate
proportion of the velocity of the resisted body, it is shewn that
then the resistance derived from the elasticity, would increase in
the duplicate proportion of the velocity; in so much that the whole
resistance would be in that proportion, excepting only that small
part, which arises from the friction between the body and the parts
of the fluid. From whence it follows, that because the elastic power
of the same fluid does in truth continue the same, if the velocity of
the moving body be diminished, the resistance from the elasticity, and
therefore the whole resistance, will decrease in a less proportion,
than the duplicate of the velocity; and if the velocity be increased,
the resistance from the elasticity will increase in a less proportion,
than the duplicate of the velocity, that is in a less proportion, than
the resistance made by the power of inactivity of the parts of the
fluid. And from this foundation is raised the proof of a property of
this resistance, given by the elasticity in common with the others from
the tenacity and friction of the parts of the fluid; that the velocity
may be increased, till this resistance from the fluid’s elasticity
shall bear no considerable proportion to that, which is produced by the
power of inactivity thereof[118]. From whence our author draws this
conclusion; that the resistance of a body, which moves very swiftly in
an elastic fluid, is near the same, as if the fluid were not elastic;
provided the elasticity arises from the centrifugal power of the
parts of the medium, as before explained, especially if the velocity
be so great, that this centrifugal power shall want time to exert it
self[119]. But it is to be observed, that in the proof of all this our
author proceeds upon the supposition of this centrifugal power in the
parts of the fluid; but if the elasticity be caused by the expansion
of the parts in the manner of wool compressed, and such like bodies,
by which the parts of the fluid will be in some measure entangled
together, and their motion be obstructed, the fluid will be in a manner
tenacious, and give a resistance upon that account over and above what
depends upon its elasticity only[120]; and the resistance derived from
that cause is to be judged of in the manner before set down.

15. IT is now time to pass to the second part of this theory; which
is to assign the measure of resistance, according to the proportion
between the density of the body and the density of the fluid. What
is here to be understood by the word density has been explained
above[121]. For this purpose as our author before considered two
distinct cases of bodies moving in mediums; one when they opposed
themselves to the fluid by their power of inactivity only, and another
when by ascending or descending their weight was combined with that
other power: so likewise, the fluids themselves are to be regarded
under a double capacity; either as having their parts at rest, and
disposed freely without restraint, or as being compressed together by
their own weight, or any other cause.

16. IN the first case, if the parts of the fluid be wholly disingaged
from one another, so that each particle is at liberty to move all ways
without any impediment, it is shewn, that if a globe move in such
a fluid, and the globe and particles of the fluid are endued with
perfect elasticity; so that as the globe impinges upon the particles
of it, they shall bound off and separate themselves from the globe,
with the same velocity, with which the globe strikes upon them; then
the resistance, which the globe moving with any known velocity suffers,
is to be thus determined. From the velocity of the globe, the time,
wherein it would move over two third parts of its own diameter with
that velocity, will be known. And such proportion as the density of the
fluid bears to the density of the globe, the same the resistance given
to the globe will bear to the force, which acting, like the power of
gravity, on the globe without intermission during the space of time now
mentioned, would generate in the globe the same degree of motion, as
that wherewith it moves in the fluid[122]. But if neither the globe nor
the particles of the fluid be elastic, so that the particles, when the
globe strikes against them, do not rebound from it, then the resistance
will be but half so much[123]. Again, if the particles of the fluid and
the globe are imperfectly elastic, so that the particles will spring
from the globe with part only of that velocity wherewith the globe
impinges upon them; then the resistance will be a mean between the two
preceding cases, approaching nearer to the first or second, according
as the elasticity is more or less[124].

17. THE elasticity, which is here ascribed to the particles of the
fluid, is not that power of repelling one another, when out of
contact, by which, as has before been mentioned, the whole fluid may be
rendred elastic; but such an elasticity only, as many solid bodies have
of recovering their figure, whenever any forcible change is made in it,
by the impulse of another body or otherwise. Which elasticity has been
explained above at large[125].

18. THIS is the case of discontinued fluids, where the body, by
pressing against their particles, drives them before itself, while
the space behind the body is left empty. But in fluids which are
compressed, so that the parts of them removed out of place by the body
resisted immediately retire behind the body, and fill that space, which
in the other case is left vacant, the resistance is still less; for a
globe in such a fluid which shall be free from all elasticity, will
be resisted but half as much as the least resistance in the former
case[126]. But by elasticity I now mean that power, which renders
the whole fluid so; of which if the compressed fluid be possessed,
in the manner of the air, then the resistance will be greater than
by the foregoing rule; for the fluid being capable in some degree
of condensation, it will resemble so far the case of uncompressed
fluids[127]. But, as has been before related, this difference is most
considerable in slow motions.

19. IN the next place our author is particular in determining the
degrees of resistance accompanying bodies of different figures; which
is the last of the three heads, we divided the whole discourse of
resistance into. And in this disquisition he finds a very surprizing
and unthought of difference, between free and compressed fluids.
He proves, that in the former kind, a globe suffers but half the
resistance, which the cylinder, that circumscribes the globe, will
do, if it move in the direction of its axis[128]. But in the latter
he proves, that the globe and cylinder are resisted alike[129]. And
in general, that let the shape of bodies be ever so different, yet if
the greatest sections of the bodies perpendicular to the axis of their
motion be equal, the bodies will be resisted equally[130].

20. PURSUANT to the difference found between the resistance of the
globe and cylinder in rare and uncompressed fluids, our author gives us
the result of some other inquiries of the same nature. Thus of all the
frustums of a cone, that can be described upon the same base and with
the same altitude, he shews how to find that, which of all others will
be the least resisted, when moving in the direction of its axis[131].
And from hence he draws an easy method of altering the figure of any
spheroidical solid, so that its capacity may be enlarged, and yet the
resistance of it diminished[132]: a note which he thinks may not be
useless to ship-wrights. He concludes with determining the solid, which
will be resisted the least that is possible, in these discontinued
fluids[133].

21. THAT I may here be understood by readers unacquainted with
mathematical terms, I shall explain what I mean by a frustum of a cone,
and a spheroidical solid. A cone has been defined above. A frustum is
what remains, when part of the cone next the vertex is cut away by a
section parallel to the base of the cone, as in fig. 86. A spheroid is
produced from an ellipsis, as a sphere or globe is made from a circle.
If a circle turn round on its diameter, it describes by its motion a
sphere; so if an ellipsis (which figure has been defined above, and
will be more fully explained hereafter[134]) be turned round either
upon the longest or shortest line, that can be drawn through the middle
of it, there will be described a kind of oblong or flat sphere, as
in fig. 87. Both these figures are called spheroids, and any solid
resembling these I here call spheroidical.

22. IF it should be asked, how the method of altering spheroidical
bodies, here mentioned, can contribute to the facilitating a ship’s
motion, when I just above affirmed, that the figure of bodies, which
move in a compressed fluid not elastic, has no relation to the
augmentation or diminution of the resistance; the reply is, that what
was there spoken relates to bodies deep immerged into such fluids, but
not of those, which swim upon the surface of them; for in this latter
case the fluid, by the appulse of the anterior parts of the body, is
raised above the level of the surface, and behind the body is sunk
somewhat below; so that by this inequality in the superficies of
the fluid, that part of it, which at the head of the body is higher
than the fluid behind, will resist in some measure after the manner
of discontinued fluids[135], analogous to what was before observed to
happen in the air through its elasticity, though the body be surrounded
on every side by it[136]. And as far as the power of these causes
extends, the figure of the moving body affects its resistance; for
it is evident, that the figure, which presses least directly against
the parts of the fluid, and so raises least the surface of a fluid
not elastic, and least compresses one that is elastic, will be least
resisted.

23. THE way of collecting the difference of the resistance in rare
fluids, which arises from the diversity of figure, is by considering
the different effect of the particles of the fluid upon the body moving
against them, according to the different obliquity of the several
parts of the body upon which they respectively strike; as it is known,
that any body impinging against a plane obliquely, strikes with a less
force, than if it fell upon it perpendicularly; and the greater the
obliquity is, the weaker is the force. And it is the same thing, if the
body be at rest, and the plane move against it[137].

24. THAT there is no connexion between the figure of a body and its
resistance in compressed fluids, is proved thus. Suppose A B C D (in
fig. 88.) to be a canal, having such a fluid, water for instance,
running through it with an equable velocity; and let any body E, by
being placed in the axis of the canal, hinder the passage of the water.
It is evident, that the figure of the fore part of this body will have
little influence in obstructing the water’s motion, but the whole
impediment will arise from the space taken up by the body, by which it
diminishes the bore of the canal, and straightens the passage of the
water[138]. But proportional to the obstruction of the water’s motion,
will be the force of the water upon the body E[139]. Now suppose both
orifices of the canal to be closed, and the water in it to remain at
rest; the body E to move, so that the parts of the water may pass by
it with the same degree of velocity, as they did before; it is beyond
contradiction, that the pressure of the water upon the body, that
is, the resistance it gives to its motion, will remain the same; and
therefore will have little connexion with the figure of the body[140].

25. BY a method of reasoning drawn from the same fountain is determined
the measure of resistance these compressed fluids give to bodies, in
reference to the proportion between the density of the body and that of
the fluid. This shall be explained particularly in my comment on Sir
~IS. NEWTON~’s mathematical principles of natural philosophy;
but is not a proper subject to be insisted on farther in this place.

26. WE have now gone through all the parts of this theory. There
remains nothing more, but in few words to mention the experiments,
which our author has made, both with bodies falling perpendicularly
through water, and the air[141], and with pendulums[142]: all which
agree with the theory. In the case of falling bodies, the times
of their fall determined by the theory come out the same, as by
observation, to a surprizing exactness; in the pendulums, the rod, by
which the ball of the pendulum hangs, suffers resistance as well as the
ball, and the motion of the ball being reciprocal, it communicates such
a motion to the fluid, as increases the resistance, but the deviation
from the theory is no more, than what may reasonably follow from these
causes.

27. BY this theory of the resistance of fluids, and these experiments,
our author decides the question so long agitated among natural
philosophers, whether all space is absolutely full of matter. The
Aristotelians and Cartesians both assert this plenitude; the Atomists
have maintained the contrary. Our author has chose to determine this
question by his theory of resistance, as shall be explained in the
following chapter.

[Illustration]

[Illustration]




  ~BOOK II.~
  CONCERNING THE
  SYSTEM of the WORLD.




CHAP. I.

That the Planets move in a space empty of all sensible matter.


I HAVE now gone through the first part of my design, and have
explained, as far as the nature of my undertaking would permit, what
Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has delivered in general concerning the motion
of bodies. It follows now to speak of the discoveries, he has made
in the system of the world; and to shew from him what cause keeps
the heavenly bodies in their courses. But it will be necessary for
the use of such, as are not skilled in astronomy, to premise a brief
description of the planetary system.

2. THIS system is disposed in the following manner. In the middle is
placed the sun. About him six globes continually roll. These are the
primary planets; that which is nearest to the sun is called Mercury,
the next Venus, next to this is our earth, the next beyond is Mars,
after him Jupiter, and the outermost of all Saturn. Besides these there
are discovered in this system ten other bodies, which move about some
of these primary planets in the same manner, as they move round the
sun. These are called secondary planets. The most conspicuous of them
is the moon, which moves round our earth; four bodies move in like
manner round Jupiter; and five round Saturn. Those which move about
Jupiter and Saturn, are usually called satellites; and cannot any of
them be seen without a telescope. It is not impossible, but there may
be more secondary planets, beside these; though our instruments have
not yet discovered any other. This disposition of the planetary or
solar system is represented in fig. 89.

3. THE same planet is not always equally distant from the sun. But
the middle distance of Mercury is between ⅕ and ⅖ of the distance of
the earth from the sun; Venus is distant from the sun almost ¾ of the
distance of the earth; the middle distance of Mars is something more
than half as much again, as the distance of the earth; Jupiter’s
middle distance exceeds five times the distance of the earth, by
between ⅕ and 1/6 part of this distance; Saturn’s middle distance is
scarce more than 9½ times the distance between the earth and sun; but
the middle distance between the earth and sun is about 217⅛ times the
sun’s semidiameter.

[Illustration]

4. ALL these planets move one way, from west to east; and of the
primary planets the most remote is longest in finishing its course
round the sun. The period of Saturn falls short only sixteen days of 29
years and a half. The period of Jupiter is twelve years wanting about
50 days. The period of Mars falls short of two years by about 43 days.
The revolution of the earth constitutes the year. Venus performs her
period in about 224½ days, and Mercury in about 88 days.

5. THE course of each planet lies throughout in one plane or flat
surface, in which the sun is placed; but they do not all move in the
same plane, though the different planes, in which they move, cross each
other in very small angles. They all cross each other in lines, which
pass through the sun; because the sun lies in the plane of each orbit.
This inclination of the several orbits to each other is represented in
fig. 90. The line, in which the plane of any orbit crosses the plane of
the earth’s motion, is called the line of the nodes of that orbit.

6. EACH planet moves round the sun in the line, which we have mentioned
above[143] under the name of ellipsis; which I shall here shew more
particularly how to describe. I have there said how it is produced in
the cone. I shall now shew how to form it upon a plane. Fix upon any
plane two pins, as at A and B in fig. 91. To these tye a string A C B
of any length. Then apply a third pin D so to the string, as to hold
it strained; and in that manner carrying this pin about, the point of
it will describe an ellipsis. If through the points A, B the straight
line E A B F be drawn, to be terminated at the ellipsis in the points
E and F, this is the longest line of any, that can be drawn within the
figure, and is called the greater axis of the ellipsis. The line G H,
drawn perpendicular to this axis E F, so as to pass through the middle
of it, is called the lesser axis. The two points A and B are called
focus’s. Now each planet moves round the sun in a line of this kind, so
that the sun is found in one focus. Suppose A to be the place of the
sun. Then E is the point, wherein the planet will be nearest of all to
the sun, and at F it will be most remote. The point E is called the
perihelion of the planet, and F the aphelion. In G and H the planet is
said to be in its middle or mean distance; because the distance A G or
A H is truly the middle between A E the least, and A F the greatest
distance. In fig. 92. is represented how the greater axis of each orbit
is situated in respect of the rest. The proportion between the greatest
and least distances of the planet from the sun is very different in the
different planets.

[Illustration]

In Saturn the proportion of the greatest distance to the least is
something less, than the proportion of 9 to 8, but much nearer to
this, than to the proportion of 10 to 9. In Jupiter this proportion
is a little greater, than that of 11 to 10. In Mars it exceeds the
proportion of 6 to 5. In the earth it is about the proportion of 30 to
29. In Venus it is near to that of 70 to 69. And in Mercury it comes
not a great deal short of the proportion of 3 to 2.

[Illustration]

7. EACH of these planets so moves through its ellipsis, that the line
drawn from the sun to the planet, by accompanying the planet in its
motion, will describe about the sun equal spaces in equal times, after
the manner spoke of in the chapter of centripetal forces[144]. There is
also a certain relation between the greater axis’s of these ellipsis’s,
and the times, in which the planets perform their revolutions through
them. Which relation may be expressed thus. Let the period of one
planet be denoted by the letter A, the greater axis of its orbit by
D; let the period of another planet be denoted by B, and the greater
axis of this planet’s orbit by E. Then if C be taken to bear the same
proportion to B, as B bears to A; likewise if F be taken to bear the
same proportion to E, as E bears to D; and G taken to bear the same
proportion likewise to F, as E bears to D; then A shall bear the same
proportion to C, as D bears to G.

8. THE secondary planets move round their respective primary, much
in the same manner as the primary do round the sun. But the motions
of these shall be more fully explained hereafter[145]. And there is,
besides the planets, another sort of bodies, which in all probability
move round the sun; I mean the comets. The farther description of which
bodies I also leave to the place, where they are to be particularly
treated on[146].

9. FAR without this system the fixed stars are placed. These are all so
remote from us, that we seem almost incapable of contriving any means
to estimate their distance. Their number is exceeding great. Besides
two or three thousand, which we see with the naked eye, telescopes open
to our view vast numbers; and the farther improved these instruments
are, we still discover more and more. Without doubt these are luminous
globes, like our sun, and ranged through the wide extent of space; each
of which, it is to be supposed, perform the same office, as our sun,
affording light and heat to certain planets moving about them. But
these conjectures are not to be pursued in this place.

10. I SHALL therefore now proceed to the particular design of this
chapter, and shew, that there is no sensible matter lodged in the space
where the planets move.

11. THAT they suffer no sensible resistance from any such matter, is
evident from the agreement between the observations of astronomers in
different ages, with regard to the time, in which the planets have
been found to perform their periods. But it was the opinion of DES
CARTES[147], that the planets might be kept in their courses by the
means of a fluid matter, which continually circulating round should
carry the planets along with it. There is one appearance that may seem
to favour this opinion; which is, that the sun turns round its own
axis the same way, as the planets move. The earth also turns round its
axis the same way, as the moon moves round the earth. And the planet
Jupiter turns upon its axis the same way, as his satellites revolve
round him. It might therefore be supposed, that if the whole planetary
region were filled with a fluid matter, the sun, by turning round on
its own axis, might communicate motion first to that part of the fluid,
which was contiguous, and by degrees propagate the like motion to the
parts more remote. After the same manner the earth might communicate
motion to this fluid, to a distance sufficient to carry round the moon,
and Jupiter communicate the like to the distance of its satellites.
Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has particularly examined what might be
the result of such a motion as this[148]; and he finds, that the
velocities, with which the parts of this fluid will move in different
distances from the center of the motion, will not agree with the motion
observed in different planets: for instance, that the time of one
intire circulation of the fluid, wherein Jupiter should swim, would
bear a greater proportion to the time of one intire circulation of the
fluid, where the earth is; than the period of Jupiter bears to the
period of the earth. But he also proves[149], that the planet cannot
circulate in such a fluid, so as to keep long in the same course,
unless the planet and the contiguous fluid are of the same density,
and the planet be carried along with the same degree of motion, as
the fluid. There is also another remark made upon this motion by
our author; which is, that some vivifying force will be continually
necessary at the center of the motion[150]. The sun in particular, by
communicating motion to the ambient fluid, will lose from it self as
much motion, as it imparts to the fluid; unless some acting principle
reside in the sun to renew its motion continually. If the fluid be
infinite, this gradual loss of motion would continue till the whole
should stop[151]; and if the fluid were limited, this loss of motion
would continue, till there would remain no swifter a revolution in the
sun, than in the utmost part of the fluid; so that the whole would turn
together about the axis of the sun, like one solid globe[152].

12. IT is farther to be observed, that as the planets do not move in
perfect circles round the sun; there is a greater distance between
their orbits in some places, than in others. For instance, the distance
between the orbit of Mars and Venus is near half as great again in one
part of their orbits, as in the opposite place. Now here the fluid,
in which the earth should swim, must move with a less rapid motion,
where there is this greater interval between the contiguous orbits; but
on the contrary, where the space is straitest, the earth moves more
slowly, than where it is widest[153].

13. FARTHER, if this our globe of earth swam in a fluid of equal
density with the earth it self, that is, in a fluid more dense than
water; all bodies put in motion here upon the earth’s surface must
suffer a great resistance from it; where as, by Sir ~ISAAC
NEWTON~’s experiments mentioned in the preceding chapter, bodies,
that fell perpendicularly down through the air, felt about 1/860 part
only of the resistance, which bodies suffered that fell in like manner
through water.

14. Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ applies these experiments yet farther,
and examines by them the general question concerning the absolute
plenitude of space. According to the Aristotelians, all space was
full without any the least vacuities whatever. DESCARTES embraced the
same opinion, and therefore supposed a subtile fluid matter, which
should pervade all bodies, and adequately fill up their pores. The
Atomical philosophers, who suppose all bodies both fluid and solid to
be composed of very minute but solid atoms, assert that no fluid, how
subtile soever the particles or atoms whereof it is composed should be,
can ever cause an absolute plenitude; because it is impossible that
any body can pass through the fluid without putting the particles of
it into such a motion, as to separate them, at least in part, from one
another, and so perpetually to cause small vacuities; by which these
Atomists endeavour to prove, that a vacuum, or some space empty of
all matter, is absolutely necessary to be in nature. Sir ~ISAAC
NEWTON~ objects against the filling of space with such a subtile
fluid, that all bodies in motion must be unmeasurably resisted by a
fluid so dense, as absolutely to fill up all the space, through which
it is spread. And lest it should be thought, that this objection might
be evaded by ascribing to this fluid such very minute and smooth parts,
as might remove all adhesion or friction between them, whereby all
resistance would be lost, which this fluid might otherwise give to
bodies moving in it; Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ proves, in the manner
above related, that fluids resist from the power of inactivity of their
particles; and that water and the air resist almost entirely on this
account: so that in this subtile fluid, however minute and lubricated
the particles, which compose it, might be; yet if the whole fluid was
as dense as water, it would resist very near as much as water does; and
whereas such a fluid, whose parts are absolutely close together without
any intervening spaces, must be a great deal more dense than water,
it must resist more than water in proportion to its greater density;
unless we will suppose the matter, of which this fluid is composed, not
to be endued with the same degree of inactivity as other matter. But if
you deprive any substance of the property so universally belonging to
all other matter, without impropriety of speech it can scarce be called
by this name.

15. Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ made also an experiment to try
in particular, whether the internal parts of bodies suffered any
resistance. And the result did indeed appear to favour some small
degree of resistance; but so very little, as to leave it doubtful,
whether the effect did not arise from some other latent cause[154].




CHAP. II.

Concerning the cause, which keeps in motion the primary planets.


SINCE the planets move in a void space and are free from resistance;
they, like all other bodies, when once in motion, would move on in a
straight line without end, if left to themselves. And it is now to be
explained what kind of action upon them carries them round the sun.
Here I shall treat of the primary planets only, and discourse of the
secondary apart in the next chapter. It has been just now declared,
that these primary planets move so about the sun, that a line extended
from the sun to the planet, will, by accompanying the planet in its
motion, pass over equal spaces in equal portions of time[155]. And
this one property in the motion of the planets proves, that they are
continually acted on by a power directed perpetually to the sun as a
center. This therefore is one property of the cause, which keeps the
planets in their courses, that it is a centripetal power, whose center
is the sun.

2. AGAIN, in the chapter upon centripetal forces[156] it was observ’d,
that if the strength of the centripetal power was suitably accommodated
every where to the motion of any body round a center, the body might
be carried in any bent line whatever, whose concavity should be every
where turned towards the center of the force. It was farther remarked,
that the strength of the centripetal force, in each place, was to be
collected from the nature of the line, wherein the body moved[157].
Now since each planet moves in an ellipsis, and the sun is placed in
one focus; Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ deduces from hence, that the
strength of this power is reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of
the distance from the sun. This is deduced from the properties, which
the geometers have discovered in the ellipsis. The process of the
reasoning is not proper to be enlarged upon here; but I shall endeavour
to explain what is meant by the reciprocal duplicate proportion. Each
of the terms reciprocal proportion, and duplicate proportion, has been
already defined[158]. Their sense when thus united is as follows.
Suppose the planet moved in the orbit A B C (in fig. 93.) about the sun
in S. Then, when it is said, that the centripetal power, which acts on
the planet in A, bears to the power acting on it in B a proportion,
which is the reciprocal of the duplicate proportion of the distance S
A to the distance S B; it is meant that the power in A bears to the
power in B the duplicate of the proportion of the distance S B to the
distance S A. The reciprocal duplicate proportion may be explained
also by numbers as follows. Suppose several distances to bear to each
other proportions expressed by the numbers 1, 2, 3, 4, 5; that is, let
the second distance be double the first, the third be three times,
the fourth four times, and the fifth five times as great as the
first. Multiply each of these numbers by it self, and 1 multiplied by
1 produces still 1, 2 multiplied by 2 produces 4, 3 by 3 makes 9, 4
by 4 makes 16, and 5 by 5 gives 25. This being done, the fractions ¼,
1/9, 1/16, 1/25, will respectively express the proportion, which the
centripetal power in each of the following distances bears to the power
at the first distance: for in the second distance, which is double the
first, the centripetal power will be one fourth part only of the power
at the first distance; at the third distance the power will be one
ninth part only of the first power; at the fourth distance, the power
will be but one sixteenth part of the first; and at the fifth distance,
one twenty fifth part of the first power.

3. THUS is found the proportion, in which this centripetal power
decreases, as the distance from the sun increases, within the compass
of one planet’s motion. How it comes to pass, that the planet can be
carried about the sun by this centripetal power in a continual round,
sometimes rising from the sun, then descending again as low, and from
thence be carried up again as far remote as before, alternately rising
and falling without end; appears from what has been written above
concerning centripetal forces: for the orbits of the planets resemble
in shape the curve line proposed in § 17 of the chapter on these
forces[159].

4. BUT farther, in order to know whether this centripetal force
extends in the same proportion throughout, and consequently whether
all the planets are influenced by the very same power, our author
proceeds thus. He inquires what relation there ought to be between
the periods of the different planets, provided they were acted
upon by the same power decreasing throughout in the forementioned
proportion; and he finds, that the period of each in this case would
have that very relation to the greater axis of its orbit, as I have
declared above[160] to be found in the planets by the observations
of astronomers. And this puts it beyond question, that the different
planets are pressed towards the sun, in the same proportion to their
distances, as one planet is in its several distances. And thence in the
last place it is justly concluded, that there is such a power acting
towards the sun in the foresaid proportion at all distances from it.

5. THIS power, when referred to the planets, our author calls
centripetal, when to the sun attractive; he gives it likewise the
name of gravity, because he finds it to be of the same nature with
that power of gravity, which is observed in our earth, as will appear
hereafter[161]. By all these names he designs only to signify a power
endued with the properties before mentioned; but by no means would he
have it understood, as if these names referred any way to the cause of
it. In particular in one place where he uses the name of attraction, he
cautions us expressly against implying any thing but a power directing
a body to a center without any reference to the cause of it, whether
residing in that center, or arising from any external impulse[162].

6. BUT now, in these demonstrations some very minute inequalities in
the motion of the planets are neglected; which is done with a great
deal of judgment; for whatever be their cause, the effects are very
inconsiderable, they being so exceeding small, that some astronomers
have thought fit wholly to pass them by[163]. However the excellency
of this philosophy, when in the hands of so great a geometer as our
author, is such, that it is able to trace the least variations of
things up to their causes. The only inequalities, which have been
observed common to all the planets, are the motion of the aphelion and
the nodes. The transverse axis of each orbit does not always remain
fixed, but moves about the sun with a very slow progressive motion:
nor do the planets keep constantly the same plane, but change them,
and the lines in which those planes intersect each other by insensible
degrees. The first of these inequalities, which is the motion of the
aphelion, may be accounted for, by supposing the gravitation of the
planets towards the sun to differ a little from the forementioned
reciprocal duplicate proportion of the distances; but the second,
which is the motion of the nodes, cannot be accounted for by any
power directed towards the sun; for no such can give the planet any
lateral impulse to divert it from the plane of its motion into any new
plane, but of necessity must be derived from some other center. Where
that power is lodged, remains to be discovered. Now it is proved, as
shall be explained in the following chapter, that the three primary
planets Saturn, Jupiter, and the earth, which have satellites revolving
about them, are endued with a power of causing bodies, in particular
those satellites, to gravitate towards them with a force, which is
reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of their distances; and the
planets are in all respects, in which they come under our examination,
so similar and alike, that there is no reason to question, but they
have all the same property. Though it be sufficient for the present
purpose to have it proved of Jupiter and Saturn only; for these
planets contain much greater quantities of matter than the rest, and
proportionally exceed the others in power[164]. But the influence of
these two planets being allowed, it is evident how the planets come to
shift continually their planes: for each of the planets moving in a
different plane, the action of Jupiter and Saturn upon the rest will
be oblique to the planes of their motion; and therefore will gradually
draw them into new ones. The same action of these two planets upon
the rest will cause likewise a progressive motion of the aphelion; so
that there will be no necessity of having recourse to the other cause
for this motion, which was before hinted at[165]; viz, the gravitation
of the planets towards the sun differing from the exact reciprocal
duplicate proportion of the distances. And in the last place, the
action of Jupiter and Saturn upon each other will produce in their
motions the same inequalities, as their joint action produces in the
rest. All this is effected in the same manner, as the sun produces the
same kind of inequalities and many others in the motion of the moon and
the other secondary planets; and therefore will be best apprehended by
what shall be said in the next chapter. Those other irregularities in
the motion of the secondary planets have place likewise here; but are
too minute to be observable: because they are produced and rectified
alternately, for the most part in the time of a single revolution;
whereas the motion of the aphelion and nodes, which continually
increase, become sensible in a long series of years. Yet some of these
other inequalities are discernible in Jupiter and Saturn, in Saturn
chiefly; for when Jupiter, who moves faster than Saturn, approaches
near to a conjunction with him, his action upon Saturn will a little
<DW44> the motion of that planet, and by the reciprocal action of
Saturn he will himself be accelerated. After conjunction, Jupiter will
again accelerate Saturn, and be likewise retarded in the same degree,
as before the first was retarded and the latter accelerated. Whatever
inequalities besides are produced in the motion of Saturn by the action
of Jupiter upon that planet, will be sufficiently rectified, by placing
the focus of Saturn’s ellipsis, which should otherwise be in the sun,
in the common center of gravity of the sun and Jupiter. And all the
inequalities in the motion of Jupiter, caused by Saturn’s action upon
him, are much less considerable than the irregularities of Saturn’s
motion[166].

7. THIS one principle therefore of the planets having a power, as well
as the sun, to cause bodies to gravitate towards them, which is proved
by the motion of the secondary planets to obtain in fact, explains
all the irregularities relating to the planets ever observed by
astronomers.

8. Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ after this proceeds to make an
improvement in astronomy by applying this theory to the farther
correction of their motions. For as we have here observed the planets
to possess a principle of gravitation, as well as the sun; so it will
be explained at large hereafter, that the third law of motion, which
makes action and reaction equal, is to be applied in this case[167];
and that the sun does not only attract each planet, but is it self
also attracted by them; the force, wherewith the planet is acted on,
bearing to the force, wherewith the sun it self is acted on at the same
time, the proportion, which the quantity of matter in the sun bears
to the quantity of matter in the planet. From the action between the
sun and planet being thus mutual Sir ISAAC NEWTON proves that the sun
and planet will describe about their common center of gravity similar
ellipsis’s; and then that the transverse axis of the ellipsis described
thus about the moveable sun, will bear to the transverse axis of the
ellipsis, which would be described about the sun at rest in the same
time, the same proportion as the quantity of solid matter in the sun
and planet together bears to the first of two mean proportionals
between this quantity and the quantity of matter in the sun only[168].

9. ABOVE, where I shewed how to find a cube, that should bear any
proportion to another cube[169], the lines F T and T S are two mean
proportionals between E F and F G; and counting from E F, F T is called
the first, and F S the second of those means. In numbers these mean
proportionals are thus found.

[Illustration]

Suppose A and B two numbers, and it be required to find C the first,
and D the second of the two mean proportionals between them. First
multiply A by it self, and the product multiply by B; then C will be
the number which in arithmetic is called the cubic root of this last
product; that is, the number C being multiplied by it self, and the
product again multiplied by the same number C, will produce the product
above mentioned. In like manner D is the cubic root of the product
of B multiplied by it self, and the produce of that multiplication
multiplied again by A.

10. IT will be asked, perhaps, how this correction can be admitted,
when the cause of the motions of the planets was before found by
supposing the sun the center of the power, which acted upon them: for
according to the present correction this power appears rather to be
directed to their common center of gravity. But whereas the sun was
at first concluded to be the center, to which the power acting on the
planets was directed, because the spaces described round the sun in
equal times were found to be equal; so Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~
proves, that if the sun and planet move round their common center of
gravity, yet to an eye placed in the planet, the spaces, which will
appear to be described about the sun, will have the same relation to
the times of their description, as the real spaces would have, if the
sun were at rest[170]. I farther asserted, that, supposing the planets
to move round the sun at rest, and to be attracted by a power, which
every where should act with degrees of strength reciprocally in the
duplicate proportion of the distances; then the periods of the planets
must observe the same relation to their distances, as astronomers find
them to do. But here it must not be supposed, that the observations of
astronomers absolutely agree without any the least difference; and the
present correction will not cause a deviation from any one astronomer’s
observations, so much as they differ from one another. For in Jupiter,
where this correction is greatest, it hardly amounts to the 3000^{th}
part of the whole axis.

11. UPON this head I think it not improper to mention a reflection made
by our excellent author upon these small inequalities in the planets
motions; which contains under it a very strong philosophical argument
against the eternity of the world. It is this, that these inequalities
must continually increase by slow degrees, till they render at length
the present frame of nature unfit for the purposes, it now serves[171].
And a more convincing proof cannot be desired against the present
constitution’s having existed from eternity than this, that a certain
period of years will bring it to an end. I am aware this thought of
our author has been represented even as impious, and as no less than
casting a reflection upon the wisdom of the author of nature, for
framing a perishable work. But I think so bold an assertion ought to
have been made with singular caution. For if this remark upon the
increasing irregularities of the heavenly motions be true in fact,
as it really is, the imputation must return upon the asserter, that
this does detract from the divine wisdom. Certainly we cannot pretend
to know all the omniscient Creator’s purposes in making this world,
and therefore cannot undertake to determine how long he designed it
should last. And it is sufficient, if it endure the time intended by
the author. The body of every animal shews the unlimited wisdom of its
author no less, nay in many respects more, than the larger frame of
nature; and yet we see, they are all designed to last but a small space
of time.

12. THERE need nothing more be said of the primary planets; the motions
of the secondary shall be next considered.




CHAP. III.

Of the motion of the MOON and the other SECONDARY PLANETS.


THE excellency of this philosophy sufficiently appears from its
extending in the manner, which has been related, to the minutest
circumstances of the primary planets motions; which nevertheless
bears no proportion to the vast success of it in the motions of the
secondary; for it not only accounts for all the irregularities, by
which their motions were known to be disturbed, but has discovered
others so complicated, that astronomers were never able to distinguish
them, and reduce them under proper heads; but these were only to be
found out from their causes, which this philosophy has brought to
light, and has shewn the dependence of these inequalities upon such
causes in so perfect a manner, that we not only learn from thence in
general, what those inequalities are, but are able to compute the
degree of them. Of this Sir ~IS. NEWTON~ has given several
specimens, and has moreover found means to reduce the moon’s motion so
completely to rule, that he has framed a theory, from which the place
of that planet may at all times be computed, very nearly or altogether
as exactly, as the places of the primary planets themselves, which is
much beyond what the greatest astronomers could ever effect.

2. THE first thing demonstrated of these secondary planets is, that
they are drawn towards their respective primary in the same manner
as the primary planets are attracted by the sun. That each secondary
planet is kept in its orbit by a power pointed towards the center of
the primary planet, about which the secondary revolves; and that the
power, by which the secondaries of the same primary are influenced,
bears the same relation to the distance from the primary, as the power,
by which the primary planets are guided, does in regard to the distance
from the sun[172]. This is proved in the satellites of Jupiter and
Saturn, because they move in circles, as far as we can observe, about
their respective primary with an equable course, the respective primary
being the center of each orbit: and by comparing the times, in which
the different satellites of the same primary perform their periods,
they are found to observe the same relation to the distances from
their primary, as the primary planets observe in respect of their mean
distances from the sun[173]. Here these bodies moving in circles with
an equable motion, each satellite passes over equal parts of its orbit
in equal portions of time; consequently the line drawn from the center
of the orbit, that is, from the primary planet, to the satellite, will
pass over equal spaces along with the satellite in equal portions of
time; which proves the power, by which each satellite is held in its
orbit, to be pointed towards the primary as a center[174]. It is also
manifest that the centripetal power, which carries a body in a circle
concentrical with the power, acts upon the body at all times with the
same strength. But Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ demonstrates that, when
bodies are carried in different circles by centripetal powers directed
to the centers of those circles, then, the degrees of strength of
those powers are to be compared by considering the relation between
the times, in which the bodies perform their periods through those
circles[175]; and in particular he shews, that if the periodical times
bear that relation, which I have just now asserted the satellites
of the same primary to observe; then the centripetal powers are
reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of the semidiameters of the
circles, or in that proportion to the distances of the bodies from the
centers[176]. Hence it follows that in the planets Jupiter and Saturn,
the centripetal power in each decreases with the increase of distance,
in the same proportion as the centripetal power appertaining to the
sun decreases with the increase of distance. I do not here mean that
this proportion of the centripetal powers holds between the power of
Jupiter at any distance compared with the power of Saturn at any other
distance; but only in the change of strength of the power belonging to
the same planet at different distances from him. Moreover what is here
discovered of the planets Jupiter and Saturn by means of the different
satellites, which revolve round each of them, appears in the earth by
the moon alone; because she is found to move round the earth in an
ellipsis after the same manner as the primary planets do about the sun;
excepting only some small irregularities in her motion, the cause of
which will be particularly explained in what follows, whereby it will
appear, that they are no objection against the earth’s acting on the
moon in the same manner as the sun acts on the primary planets; that
is, as the other primary planets Jupiter and Saturn act upon their
satellites. Certainly since these irregularities can be otherwise
accounted for, we ought not to depart from that rule of induction so
necessary in philosophy, that to like bodies like properties are to
be attributed, where no reason to the contrary appears. We cannot
therefore but ascribe to the earth the same kind of action upon the
moon, as the other primary planets Jupiter and Saturn have upon their
satellites; which is known to be very exactly in the proportion
assigned by the method of comparing the periodical times and distances
of all the satellites which move about the same planet; this abundantly
compensating our not being near enough to observe the exact figure of
their orbits. For if the little deviation of the moon’s orbit orbit
from a true permanent ellipsis arose from the action of the earth upon
the moon not being in the exact reciprocal duplicate proportion of the
distance, were another moon to revolve about the earth, the proportion
between the periodical times of this new moon, and the present,
would discover the deviation from the mentioned proportion much more
manifestly.

3. BY the number of satellites, which move round Jupiter and Saturn,
the power of each of these planets is measured in a great diversity
of distance; for the distance of the outermost satellite in each of
these planets exceeds several times the distance of the innermost. In
Jupiter the astronomers have usually placed the innermost satellite
at a distance from the center of that planet equal to about 5⅔ of
the semidiameters of Jupiter’s body, and this satellite performs its
revolution in about 1 day 18½ hours. The next satellite, which revolves
round Jupiter in about 3 days 13⅕ hours, they place at the distance
from Jupiter of about 9 of that planet’s semidiameters. To the third
satellite, which performs its period nearly in 7 days 3¾ hours, they
assign the distance of about 14⅖ semidiameters. But the outermost
satellite they remove to 25⅓ semidiameters, and this satellite makes
its period in about 16 days 16½ hours[177]. In Saturn there is still
a greater diversity in the distance of the several satellites. By the
observations of the late ~CASSINI~, a celebrated astronomer
in France, who first discovered all these satellites, except one known
before, the innermost is distant about 4½ of Saturn’s semidiameters
from his center, and revolves round in about 1 day 21⅓ hours. The next
satellite is distant about 5¾ semidiameters, and makes its period in
about 2 days 17⅔ hours. The third is removed to the distance of about
8 semidiameters, and performs its revolution in near 4 days 12½ hours.
The fourth satellite discovered first by the great HUYGENS, is near
18⅔ semidiameters, and moves round Saturn in about 15 days 22⅔ hours.
The outermost is distant 56 semidiameters, and makes its revolution in
about 79 days 7⅘ hours[178]. Besides these satellites, there belongs
to the planet Saturn another body of a very singular kind. This is a
shining, broad, and flat ring, which encompasses the planet round.
The diameter of the outermost verge of this ring is more than double
the diameter of Saturn. ~HUYGENS~, who first described this
ring, makes the whole diameter thereof to bear to the diameter of
Saturn the proportion of 9 to 4. The late reverend Mr. POUND makes the
proportion something greater, viz. that of 7 to 3. The distances of the
satellites of this planet Saturn are compared by ~CASSINI~ to
the diameter of the ring. His numbers I have reduced to those above,
according to Mr. POUND’s proportion between the diameters of Saturn and
of his ring. As this ring appears to adhere no where to Saturn, so the
distance of Saturn from the inner edge of the ring seems rather greater
than the breadth of the ring. The distances, which have here been
given, of the several satellites, both for Jupiter and Saturn, may be
more depended on in relation to the proportion, which those belonging
to the same primary planet bear one to another, than in respect to the
very numbers, that have been here set down, by reason of the difficulty
there is in measuring to the greatest exactness the diameters of the
primary planets; as will be explained hereafter, when we come to treat
of telescopes[179]. By the observations of the forementioned Mr. POUND,
in Jupiter the distance of the innermost satellite should rather be
about 6 semidiameters, of the second 9-½, of the third 15, and of
the outermost 26⅔[180]; and in Saturn the distance of the innermost
satellite 4 semidiameters, of the next 6¼, of the third 8¾, of the
fourth 20⅓, and of the fifth 59[181]. However the proportion between
the distances of the satellites in the same primary is the only thing
necessary to the point we are here upon.

4. BUT moreover the force, wherewith the earth acts in different
distances, is confirmed from the following consideration, yet more
expresly than by the preceding analogical reasoning. It will appear,
that if the power of the earth, by which it retains the moon in her
orbit, be supposed to act at all distances between the earth and moon,
according to the forementioned rule; this power will be sufficient to
produce upon bodies, near the surface of the earth, all the effects
ascribed to the principle of gravity. This is discovered by the
following method. Let A (in fig. 94.) represent the earth, B the moon,
B C D the moon’s orbit, which differs little from a circle, of which A
is the center. If the moon in B were left to it self to move with the
velocity, it has in the point B, it would leave the orbit, and proceed
right forward in the line B E, which touches the orbit in B. Suppose
the moon would upon this condition move from B to E in the space of
one minute of time. By the action of the earth upon the moon, whereby
it is retained in its orbit, the moon will really be found at the end
of this minute in the point F, from whence a straight line drawn to A
shall make the space B F A in the circle equal to the triangular space
B E A; so that the moon in the time wherein it would have moved from
B to E, if left to it self, has been impelled towards the earth from
E to F. And when the time of the moon’s passing from B to F is small,
as here it is only one minute, the distance between E and F scarce
differs from the space, through which the moon would descend in the
same time, if it were to fall directly down from B toward A without any
other motion. A B the distance of the earth and moon is about 60 of the
earth’s semidiameters, and the moon completes her revolution round the
earth in about 27 days 7 hours and 43 minutes: therefore the space E F
will here be found by computation to be about 16⅛ feet. Consequently,
if the power, by which the moon is retained in its orbit, be near the
surface of the earth greater, than at the distance of the moon in the
duplicate proportion of that distance; the number of feet, a body would
descend near the surface of the earth by the action of this power upon
it in one minute of time, would be equal to 16⅛ multiplied twice into
the number 60, that is, equal to 58050. But how fast bodies fall near
the surface of the earth may be known by the pendulum[182]; and by the
exactest experiments they are found to descend the space of 16⅛ feet in
a second of time; and the spaces described by falling bodies being in
the duplicate proportion of the times of their fall[183], the number of
feet, a body would describe in its fall near the surface of the earth
in one minute of time, will be equal to 16⅛ twice multiplied by 60, the
same as would be caused by the power which acts upon the moon.

5. IN this computation the earth is supposed to be at rest, whereas
it would have been more exact to have supposed it to move, as well
as the moon, about their common center of gravity; as will easily be
understood, by what has been said in the preceding chapter, where it
was shewn, that the sun is subjected to the like motion about the
common center of gravity of it self and the planets. The action of
the sun upon the moon, which is to be explain’d in what follows, is
likewise here neglected: and Sir ISAAC NEWTON shews, if you take in
both these considerations, the present computation will best agree
to a somewhat greater distance of the moon and earth, viz. to 60½
semidiameters of the earth, which distance is more conformable to
astronomical observations.

6. THESE computations afford an additional proof, that the action of
the earth observes the same proportion to the distance, which is here
contended for. Before I said, it was reasonable to conclude so by
induction from the planets Jupiter and Saturn; because they act in
that manner. But now the same thing will be evident by drawing no other
consequence from what is seen in those planets, than that the power,
by which the primary planets act on their secondary, is extended from
the primary through the whole interval between, so that it would act in
every part of the intermediate space. In Jupiter and Saturn this power
is so far from being confined to a small extent of distance, that it
not only reaches to several satellites at very different distances, but
also from one planet to the other, nay even through the whole planetary
system[184]. Consequently there is no appearance of reason, why this
power should not act at all distances, even at the very surfaces of
these planets as well as farther off. But from hence it follows, that
the power, which retains the moon in her orbit, is the same, as causes
bodies near the surface of the earth to gravitate. For since the
power, by which the earth acts on the moon, will cause bodies near the
surface of the earth to descend with all the velocity they are found
to do, it is certain no other power can act upon them besides; because
if it did, they must of necessity descend swifter. Now from all this
it is at length very evident, that the power in the earth, which we
call gravity, extends up to the moon, and decreases in the duplicate
proportion of the increase of the distance from the earth.

7. THIS finishes the discoveries made in the action of the primary
planets upon their secondary. The next thing to be shewn is, that the
sun acts upon them likewise: for this purpose it is to be observed,
that if to the motion of the satellite, whereby it would be carried
round its primary at rest, be superadded the same motion both in
regard to velocity and direction, as the primary it self has, it will
describe about the primary the same orbit, with as great regularity,
as if the primary was indeed at rest. The cause of this is that law
of motion, which makes a body near the surface of the earth, when let
fall, to descend perpendicularly, though the earth be in so swift a
motion, that if the falling body did not partake of it, its descent
would be remarkably oblique; and that a body projected describes in
the most regular manner the same parabola, whether projected in the
direction, in which the earth moves, or in the opposite direction, if
the projecting force be the same[185]. From this we learn, that if the
satellite moved about its primary with perfect regularity, besides its
motion about the primary, it would participate of all the motion of its
primary; have the same progressive velocity, with which the primary
is carried about the sun; and be impelled with the same velocity as
the primary towards the sun, in a direction parallel to that impulse
of its primary. And on the contrary, the want of either of these,
in particular of the impulse towards the sun, will occasion great
inequalities in the motion of the secondary planet. The inequalities,
which would arise from the absence of this impulse towards the sun are
so great, that by the regularity, which appears in the motion of the
secondary planets, it is proved, that the sun communicates, the same
velocity to them by its action, as it gives to their primary at the
same distance. For Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ informs us, that upon
examination he found, that if any of the satellites of Jupiter were
attracted by the sun more or less, than Jupiter himself at the same
distance, the orbit of that satellite, instead of being concentrical to
Jupiter, must have its center at a greater or less distance, than the
center of Jupiter from the sun, nearly in the subduplicate proportion
of the difference between the sun’s action upon the satellite, and upon
Jupiter; and therefore if any satellite were attracted by the sun but
1/1000 part more or less, than Jupiter is at the same distance, the
center of the orbit of that satellite would be distant from the center
of Jupiter no less than a fifth part of the distance of the outermost
satellite from Jupiter[186]; which is almost the whole distance of the
innermost satellite. By the like argument the satellites of Saturn
gravitate towards the sun, as much as Saturn it self at the same
distance; and the moon as much as the earth.

8. THUS is proved, that the sun acts upon the secondary planets, as
much as upon the primary at the same distance: but it was found in the
last chapter, that the action of the sun upon bodies is reciprocally
in the duplicate proportion of the distance; therefore the secondary
planets being sometimes nearer to the sun than the primary, and
sometimes more remote, they are not alway acted upon in the same degree
with their primary, but when nearer to the sun, are attracted more,
and when farther distant, are attracted less. Hence arise various
inequalities in the motion of the secondary planets[187].

9. SOME of these inequalities would take place, though the moon, if
undisturbed by the sun, would have moved in a circle concentrical
to the earth, and in the plane of the earth’s motion; others depend
on the elliptical figure, and the oblique situation of the moon’s
orbit. One of the first kind is, that the moon is caused so to move,
as not to describe equal spaces in equal times, but is continually
accelerated, as she passes from the quarter to the new or full, and is
retarded again by the like degrees in returning from the new and full
to the next quarter. Here we consider not so much the absolute, as the
apparent motion of the moon in respect to us.

10. THE principles of astronomy teach how to distinguish these two
motions. Let S (in fig. 95.) represent the sun, A the earth moving
in its orbit B C, D E F G the moon’s orbit, the place of the moon H.
Suppose the earth to have moved from A to I. Because it has been shewn,
that the moon partakes of all the progressive motion of the earth;
and likewise that the sun attracts both the earth and moon equally,
when they are at the same distance from it, or that the mean action
of the sun upon the moon is equal to its action upon the earth: we
must therefore consider the earth as carrying about with it the moon’s
orbit; so that when the earth is removed from A to I, the moon’s orbit
shall likewise be removed from its former situation into that denoted
by K L M N. But now the earth being in I, if the moon were found in O,
so that O I should be parallel to H A, though the moon would really
have moved from H to O, yet it would not have appeared to a spectator
upon the earth to have moved at all, because the earth has moved as
much it self; so that the moon would still appear in the same place
with respect to the fixed stars. But if the moon be observed in P, it
will then appear to have moved, its apparent motion being measured
by the angle under O I P. And if the angle under P I S be less than
the angle under H A S, the moon will have approached nearer to its
conjunction with the sun.

11. TO come now to the explication of the mentioned inequality in
the moon’s motion: let S (in fig. 96.) represent the sun, A the
earth, B C D E the moon’s orbit, C the place of the moon, when in
the latter quarter. Here it will be nearly at the same distance from
the sun, as the earth is. In this case therefore they will both be
equally attracted, the earth in the direction A S, and the moon in
the direction C S. Whence as the earth in moving round the sun is
continually descending toward it, so the moon in this situation must in
any equal portion of time descend as much; and therefore the position
of the line A C in respect of A S, and the change, which the moon’s
motion produces in the angle under C A S, will not be altered by the
sun.

12. BUT now as soon as ever the moon is advanced from the quarter
toward the new or conjunction, suppose to G, the action of the sun upon
it will have a different effect. Here, were the sun’s action upon the
moon to be applied in the direction G H parallel to A S, if its action
on the moon were equal to its action on the earth, no change would be
wrought by the sun on the apparent motion of the moon round the earth.
But the moon receiving a greater impulse in G than the earth receives
in A, were the sun to act in the direction G H, yet it would accelerate
the description of the space D A G, and cause the angle under G A D to
decrease faster, than otherwise it would. The sun’s action will have
this effect upon account of the obliquity of its direction to that,
in which the earth attracts the moon. For the moon by this means is
drawn by two forces oblique to each other, one drawing from G toward
A, the other from G toward H, therefore the moon must necessarily be
impelled toward D. Again, because the sun does not act in the direction
G H parallel to S A, but in the direction G S oblique to it, the sun’s
action on the moon will by reason of this obliquity farther contribute
to the moon’s acceleration. Suppose the earth in any short space of
time would have moved from A to I, if not attracted by the sun; the
point I being in the straight line C E, which touches the earth’s orbit
in A. Suppose the moon in the same time would have moved in her orbit
from G to K, and besides have partook of all the progressive motion of
the earth. Then if K L be drawn parallel to A I, and taken equal to it,
the moon, if not attracted by the sun, would be found in L. But the
earth by the sun’s action is removed from I. Suppose it were moved down
to M in the line I M N parallel to S A, and if the moon were attracted
but as much, and in the same direction, as the earth is here supposed
to be attracted, so as to have descended during the same time in the
line L O, parallel also to A S, down as far as P, till L P were equal
to I M; the angle under P M N would be equal to that under L I N, that
is, the moon will appear advanced no farther forward, than if neither
it nor the earth had been subject to the sun’s action. But this is upon
the supposition, that the action of the sun upon the moon and earth
were equal; whereas the moon being acted upon more than the earth,
did the sun’s action draw the moon in the line L O parallel to A S,
it would draw it down so far as to make L P greater than I M; whereby
the angle under P M N will be rendred less, than that under L I N. But
moreover, as the sun draws the earth in a direction oblique to I N, the
earth will be found in its orbit somewhat short of the point M; however
the moon is attracted by the sun still more out of the line L O, than
the earth is out of the line I N; therefore this obliquity of the sun’s
action will yet farther diminish the angle under P M N.

13. THUS the moon at the point G receives an impulse from the sun,
whereby her motion is accelerated. And the sun producing this effect in
every place between the quarter and the conjunction, the moon will move
from the quarter with a motion continually more and more accelerated;
and therefore by acquiring from time to time additional degrees of
velocity in its orbit, the spaces, which are described in equal times
by the line drawn from the earth to the moon, will not be every where
equal, but those toward the conjunction will be greater, than those
toward the quarter. But now in the moon’s passage from the conjunction
D to the next quarter the sun’s action will again <DW44> the moon, till
at the next quarter in E it be restored to the first velocity, which it
had in C.

14. AGAIN as the moon moves from E to the full or opposition to the
sun in B, it is again accelerated, the deficiency of the sun’s action
upon the moon, from what it has upon the earth, producing here the same
effect as before the excess of its action. Consider the moon in Q,
moving from E towards B. Here if the moon were attracted by the sun in
a direction parallel to A S, yet being acted on less than the earth,
as the earth descends toward the sun, the moon will in some measure be
left behind. Therefore Q F being drawn parallel to S B, a spectator
on the earth would see the moon move, as if attracted from the point
Q in the direction Q F with a degree of force equal to that, whereby
the sun’s action on the moon falls short of its action on the earth.
But the obliquity of the sun’s action has also here an effect. In the
time the earth would have moved from A to I without the influence of
the sun, let the moon have moved in its orbit from Q to R. Drawing
therefore R T parallel to A I, and equal to the same, for the like
reason as before, the moon by the motion of its orbit, if not at all
attracted by the sun, must be found in T; and therefore, if attracted
in a direction parallel to S A, would be in the line T V parallel to
A S; suppose in W. But the moon in Q being farther off the sun than
the earth, it will be less attracted, that is, T W will be less than
I M, and if the line S M be prolonged toward X, the angle under X M
W will be less than that under X I T. Thus by the sun’s action the
moon’s passage from the quarter to the full would be accelerated, if
the sun were to act on the earth and moon in a direction parallel to A
S: and the obliquity of the sun’s action will still more increase this
acceleration. For the action of the sun on the moon is oblique to the
line S A the whole time of the moon’s passage from Q to T, and will
carry the moon out of the line T V toward the earth. Here I suppose the
time of the moon’s passage from Q to T so short, that it shall not pass
beyond the line S A. The earth also will come a little short of the
line I N, as was said before. From these causes the angle under X M W
will be still farther lessened.

15. THE moon in passing from the opposition B to the next quarter will
be retarded again by the same degrees, as it is accelerated before
its appulse to the opposition. Because this action of the sun, which
in the moon’s passage from the quarter to the opposition causes it
to be extraordinarily accelerated, and diminishes the angle, which
measures its distance from the opposition; will make the moon slacken
its pace afterwards, and <DW44> the augmentation of the same angle in
its passage from the opposition to the following quarter; that is, will
prevent that angle from increasing so fast, as otherwise it would. And
thus the moon, by the sun’s action upon it, is twice accelerated and
twice restored to its first velocity, every circuit it makes round the
earth. This inequality of the moon’s motion about the earth is called
by astronomers its variation.

16. THE next effect of the sun upon the moon is, that it gives the
orbit of the moon in the quarters a greater degree of curvature,
than it would receive from the action of the earth alone; and on the
contrary in the conjunction and opposition the orbit is less inflected.

17. WHEN the moon is in conjunction with the sun in the point D, the
sun attracting the moon more forcibly than it does the earth, the
moon by that means is impelled less toward the earth, than otherwise
it would be, and so the orbit is less incurvated; for the power, by
which the moon is impelled toward the earth, being that, by which it is
inflected from a rectilinear course, the less that power is, the less
it will be inflected. Again, when the moon is in the opposition in B,
farther removed from the sun than the earth is; it follows then, though
the earth and moon are both continually descending to the sun, that
is, are drawn by the sun toward it self out of the place they would
otherwise move into, yet the moon descends with less velocity than
the earth; insomuch that the moon in any given space of time from its
passing the point of opposition will have less approached the earth,
than otherwise it would have done, that is, its orbit in respect of
the earth will approach nearer to a straight line. In the last place,
when the moon is in the quarter in F, and equally distant from the
sun as the earth, we observed before, that the earth and moon would
descend with equal pace toward the sun, so as to make no change by
that descent in the angle under F A S; but the length of the line F
A must of necessity be shortned. Therefore the moon in moving from F
toward the conjunction with the sun will be impelled more toward the
earth by the sun’s action, than it would have been by the earth alone,
if neither the earth nor moon had been acted on by the sun; so that
by this additional impulse the orbit is rendred more curve, than it
would otherwise be. The same effect will also be produced in the other
quarter.

18. ANOTHER effect of the sun’s action, consequent upon this we have
now explained, is, that though the moon undisturbed by the sun might
move in a circle having the earth for its center; by the sun’s action,
if the earth were to be in the very middle or center of the moon’s
orbit, yet the moon would be nearer the earth at the new and full, than
in the quarters. In this probably will at first appear some difficulty,
that the moon should come nearest to the earth, where it is least
attracted to it, and be farthest off when most attracted. Which yet
will appear evidently to follow from that very cause, by considering
what was last shewn, that the orbit of the moon in the conjunction
and opposition is rendred less curve; for the less curve the orbit of
the moon is, the less will the moon have descended from the place it
would move into, without the action of the earth. Now if the moon were
to move from any place without farther disturbance from that action,
since it would proceed in the line, which would touch its orbit in that
place, it would recede continually from the earth; and therefore if
the power of the earth upon the moon, be sufficient to retain it at the
same distance, this diminution of that power will cause the distance
to increase, though in a less degree. But on the other hand in the
quarters, the moon, being pressed more towards the earth than by the
earth’s single action, will be made to approach it; so that in passing
from the conjunction or opposition to the quarters the moon ascends
from the earth, and in passing from the quarters to the conjunction and
opposition it descends again, becoming nearer in these last mentioned
places than in the other.

19. ALL these forementioned inequalities are of different degrees,
according as the sun is more or less distant from the earth; greater
when the earth is nearest the sun, and less when it is farthest off.
For in the quarters, the nearer the moon is to the sun, the greater is
the addition to the earth’s action upon it by the power of the sun; and
in the conjunction and opposition, the difference between the sun’s
action upon the earth and upon the moon is likewise so much the greater.

20. This difference in the distance between the earth and the sun
produces a farther effect upon the moon’s motion; causing the orbit to
dilate when less remote from the sun, and become greater, than when at
a farther distance. For it is proved by Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~, that the
action of the sun, by which it diminishes the earth’s power over the
moon, in the conjunction or opposition, is about twice as great, as
the addition to the earth’s action by the sun in the quarters[188]; so
that upon the whole, the power of the earth upon the moon is diminished
by the sun, and therefore is most diminished, when the action of the
sun is strongest: but as the earth by its approach to the sun has its
influence lessened, the moon being less attracted will gradually recede
from the earth; and as the earth in its recess from the sun recovers by
degrees its former power, the orbit of the moon must again contract.
Two consequences follow from hence: the moon will be most remote from
the earth, when the earth is nearest the sun; and also will take up a
longer time in performing its revolution through the dilated orbit,
than through the more contracted.

21. THESE irregularities the sun would produce in the moon, if the
moon, without being acted on unequally by the sun, would describe a
perfect circle about the earth, and in the plane of the earth’s motion;
but though neither of these suppositions obtain in the motion of the
moon, yet the forementioned inequalities will take place, only with
some difference in respect to the degree of them; but the moon by not
moving in this manner is subject to some other inequalities also.
For as the moon describes, instead of a circle concentrical to the
earth, an ellipsis, with the earth in one focus, that ellipsis will be
subjected to various changes. It can neither preserve constantly the
same position, nor yet the same figure; and because the plane of this
ellipsis is not the same with that of the earth’s orbit, the situation
of the plane, wherein the moon moves, will continually change; neither
the line in which it intersects the plane of the earth’s orbit, nor the
inclination of the planes to each other, will remain for any time the
same. All these alterations offer themselves now to be explained.

22. I SHALL first consider the changes which are made in the plane
of the moon’s orbit. The moon not moving in the same plane with the
earth, the sun is seldom in the plane of the moon’s orbit, viz. only
when the line made by the common intersection of the two planes, if
produced, will pass through the sun, as is represented in fig. 97.
where S denotes the sun; T the earth; A T B the earth’s orbit described
upon the plane of this scheme; C D E F the moon’s orbit, the part C
D E being raised above, and the part C F E depressed under the plane
of this scheme. Here the line C E, in which the plane of this scheme,
that is, the plane of the earth’s orbit and the plane of the moon’s
orbit intersect each other, being continued passes through the sun in
S. When this happens, the action of the sun is directed in the plane of
the moon’s orbit, and cannot draw the moon out of this plane, as will
evidently appear to any one that shall consider the present scheme: for
suppose the moon in G, and let a straight line be drawn from G to S,
the sun draws the moon in the direction of this line from G toward S:
but this line lies in the plane of the orbit; and if it be prolonged
from S beyond G, the continuation of it will lie on the plane C D E;
for the plane itself, if sufficiently extended, will pass through the
sun. But in other cases the obliquity of the sun’s action to the plane
of the orbit will cause this plane continually to change.

23. SUPPOSE in the first place, the line, in which the two planes
intersect each other, to be perpendicular to the line which joins the
earth and sun. Let T (in fig. 98, 99, 100, 101.) represent the earth; S
the sun; the plane of this scheme the plane of the earth’s motion, in
which both the sun and earth are placed. Let A C be perpendicular to
S T, which joins the earth and sun; and let the line A C be that, in
which the plane of the moon’s orbit intersects the plane of the earth’s
motion. To the center T describe in the plane of the earth’s motion
the circle A B C D. And in the plane of the moon’s orbit describe the
circle A E C F, one half of which A E C will be elevated above the
plane of this scheme, the other half A F C as much depressed below it.

24. NOW suppose the moon to set forth from the point A (in fig. 98.) in
the direction of the plane A E C. Here she will be continually drawn
out of this plane by the action of the sun: for this plane A E C, if
extended, will not pass through the sun, but above it; so that the sun,
by drawing the moon directly toward it self, will force it continually
more and more from that plane towards the plane of the earth’s motion,
in which it self is; causing it to describe the line A K G H I, which
will be convex to the plane A E C, and concave to the plane of the
earth’s motion. But here this power of the sun, which is said to draw
the moon toward the plane of the earth’s motion, must be understood
principally of so much only of the sun’s action upon the moon, as
it exceeds the action of the same upon the earth. For suppose the
preceding figure to be viewed by the eye, placed in the plane of that
scheme, and in the line C T A on the side of A, the plane A B C D will
appear as the straight line D T B, (in fig. 102.) and the plane A E C
F as another straight line F E; and the curve line A K G H I under the
form of the line T K G H I.

[Illustration]

Now it is plain, that the earth and moon being both attracted by the
sun, if the sun’s action upon both was equally strong, the earth T,
and with it the plane A E C F or line F T E in this scheme, would be
carried toward the sun with as great a pace as the moon, and therefore
the moon not drawn out of it by the sun’s action, excepting only from
the small obliquity of the direction of this action upon the moon
to that of the sun’s action upon the earth, which arises from the
moon’s being out of the plane of the earth’s motion, and is not very
considerable; but the action of the sun upon the moon being greater
than upon the earth, all the time the moon is nearer to the sun than
the earth is, it will be drawn from the plane A E C or the line T E by
that excess, and made to describe the curve line A G I or T G I. But it
is the custom of astronomers, instead of considering the moon as moving
in such a curve line, to refer its motion continually to the plane,
which touches the true line wherein it moves, at the point where at
any time the moon is. Thus when the moon is in the point A, its motion
is considered as being in the plane A E C, in whose direction it then
essaies to move; and when in the point K (in fig. 99.) its motion is
referred to the plane, which passes through the earth, and touches the
line A K G H I in the point K. Thus the moon in passing from A to I
will continually change the plane of her motion. In what manner this
change proceeds, I shall now particularly explain.

25. LET the plane, which touches the line A K I in the point K (in fig.
99.) intersect the plane of the earth’s orbit in the line L T M. Then,
because the line A K I is concave to the plane A B C, it falls wholly
between that plane, and the plane which touches it in K; so that the
plane M K L will cut the plane A E C, before it meets with the plane of
the earth’s motion; suppose in the line Y T, and the point A will fall
between K and L. With a semidiameter equal to T Y or T L describe the
semicircle L Y M. Now to a spectator on the earth the moon, when in A,
will appear to move in the circle A E C F, and, when in K, will appear
to be moving in the semicircle L Y M. The earth’s motion is performed
in the plane of this scheme, and to a spectator on the earth the sun
will appear always moving in that plane. We may therefore refer the
apparent motion of the sun to the circle A B C D, described in this
plane about the earth. But the points where this circle, in which the
sun seems to move, intersects the circle in which the moon is seen at
any time to move, are called the nodes of the moon’s orbit at that
time. When the moon is seen moving in the circle A E C D, the points A
and C are the nodes of the orbit; when she appears in the semicircle
L Y M, then L and M are the nodes. Now here it appears, from what has
been said, that while the moon has moved from A to K, one of the nodes
has been carried from A to L, and the other as much from C to M. But
the motion from A to L, and from C to M, is backward in regard to the
motion of the moon, which is the other way from A to K, and from thence
toward C.

26. FARTHER the angle, which the plane, wherein the moon at any time
appears, makes with the plane of the earth’s motion, is called the
inclination of the moon’s orbit at that time. And I shall now proceed
to shew, that this inclination of the orbit, when the moon is in K, is
less than when she was in A; or, that the plane L Y M, which touches
the line of the moon’s motion in K, makes a less angle with the plane
of the earth’s motion or with the circle A B C D, than the plane A E
C makes with the same. The semicircle L Y M intersects the semicircle
A E C in Y; and the arch A Y is less than L Y, and both together less
than half a circle. But it is demonstrated by the writers on that part
of astronomy, which is called the doctrine of the sphere, that when a
triangle is made, as here, by three arches of circles A L, A Y, and Y
L, the angle under Y A B without the triangle is greater than the angle
under Y L A within, if the two arches A Y, Y L taken together do not
amount to a semicircle; if the two arches make a complete semicircle,
the two angles will be equal; but if the two arches taken together
exceed a semicircle, the inner angle under Y L A is greater than the
other[189]. Here therefore the two arches A Y and L Y together being
less than a semicircle, the angle under A L Y is less, than the angle
under B A E. But from the doctrine of the sphere it is also evident,
that the angle under A L Y is equal to that, in which the plane of the
circle L Y K M, that is, the plane which touches the line A K G H I in
K, is inclined to the plane of the earth’s motion A B C; and the angle
under B A E is equal to that, in which the plane A E C is inclined to
the same plane. Therefore the inclination of the former plane is less
than the inclination of the latter.

27. SUPPOSE now the moon to be advanced to the point G (in fig. 100.)
and in this point to be distant from its node a quarter part of the
whole circle; or in other words, to be in the midway between its two
nodes. And in this case the nodes will have receded yet more, and the
inclination of the orbit be still more diminished: for suppose the
line A K G H I to be touched in the point G by a plane passing through
the earth T: let the intersection of this plane with the plane of the
earth’s motion be the line W T O, and the line T P its intersection
with the plane L K M. In this plane let the circle N G O be described
with the semidiameter T P or N T cutting the other circle L K M in P.
Now the line A K G I is convex to the plane L K M, which touches it in
K; and therefore the plane N G O, which touches it in G, will intersect
the other touching plane between G and K; that is, the point P will
fall between those two points, and the plane continued to the plane of
the earth’s motion will pass beyond L; so that the points N and O, or
the places of the nodes, when the moon is in G, will be farther from A
and C than L and M, that is, will have moved farther backward. Besides,
the inclination of the plane N G O to the plane of the earth’s motion A
B C is less, than the inclination of the plane L K M to the same; for
here also the two arches L P and N P taken together are less than a
semicircle, each of these arches being less than a quarter of a circle;
as appears, because G N, the distance of the moon in G from its node N,
is here supposed to be a quarter part of a circle.

28. AFTER the moon is passed beyond G, the case is altered; for then
these arches will be greater than quarters of the circle, by which
means the inclination will be again increased, tho’ the nodes still go
on to move the same way. Suppose the moon in H, (in fig. 101.) and that
the plane, which touches the line A K G I in H, intersects the plane of
the earth’s motion in the line Q T R, and the plane N G O in the line T
V, and besides that the circle Q H R be described in that plane; then,
for the same reason as before, the point V will fall between H and G,
and the plane R V Q will pass beyond the last plane O V N, causing
the points Q and R to fall farther from A and C than N and O. But the
arches N V, V Q are each greater than a quarter of a circle, N V the
least of them being greater than G N, which is a quarter of a circle;
and therefore the two arches N V and V Q together exceed a semicircle;
consequently the angle under B Q V will be greater, than that under B N
V.

29. IN the last place, when the moon is by this attraction of the sun,
drawn at length into the plane of the earth’s motion, the node will
have receded yet more, and the inclination be so much increased, as
to become somewhat more than at first: for the line A K G H I being
convex to all the planes, which touch it, the part H I will wholly fall
between the plane Q V R and the plane A B C; so that the point I will
fall between B and R; and drawing I T W, the point W will be farther
remov’d from A than Q. But it is evident, that the plane, which passes
through the earth T, and touches the line A G I in the point I, will
cut the plane of the earth’s motion A B C D in the line I T W, and
be inclined to the same in the angle under H I B; so that the node,
which was first in A, after having passed into L, N and Q, comes at
last into the point W; as the node which was at first in C has passed
successively from thence through the points M, O and R to I: but the
angle under H I B, which is now the inclination of the orbit to the
plane of the ecliptic, is manifestly not less than the angle under E C
B or E A B, but rather something greater.

30. THUS the moon in the case before us, while it passes from the
plane of the earth’s motion in the quarter, till it comes again into
the same plane, has the nodes of its orbit continually moved backward,
and the inclination of its orbit is at first diminished, viz. till it
comes to G in fig. 100, which is near to its conjunction with the sun,
but afterwards is increased again almost by the same degrees, till
upon the moon’s arrival again to the plane of the earth’s motion, the
inclination of the orbit is restored to something more than its first
magnitude, though the difference is not very great, because the points
I and C are not far distant from each other[190].

31. AFTER the same manner, if the moon had departed from the quarter in
C, it should have described the curve line C X W (in fig. 98.) between
the planes A F C and A D C, which would be convex to the former of
those planes, and concave to the latter; so that, here also, the nodes
should continually recede, and the inclination of the orbit gradually
diminish more and more, till the moon arrived near its opposition to
the sun in X; but from that time the inclination should again increase,
till it became a little greater than at first. This will easily
appear, by considering, that as the action of the sun upon the moon,
by exceeding its action upon the earth, drew it out of the plane A E
C towards the sun, while the moon passed from A to I; so, during its
passage from C to W, the moon being all that time farther from the sun
than the earth, it will be attracted less; and the earth, together with
the plane A E C F, will as it were be drawn from the moon, in such
sort, that the path the moon describes shall appear from the earth, as
it did in the former case by the moon’s being drawn away.

32. THESE are the changes, which the nodes and the inclination of the
moon’s orbit undergo, when the nodes are in the quarters; but when the
nodes by their motion, and the motion of the sun together, come to
be situated between the quarter and conjunction or opposition, their
motion and the change made in the inclination of the orbit are somewhat
different.

33. LET A G C H (in fig. 103.) be a circle described in the plane of
the earth’s motion, having the earth in T for its center. Let the
point opposite to the sun be A, and the point G a fourth part of the
circle distant from A. Let the nodes of the moon’s orbit be situated
in the line B T D, and B the node, falling between A, the place where
the moon would be in the full, and G the place where the moon would
be in the quarter. Suppose B E D F to be the plane, in which the moon
essays to move, when it proceeds from the point B. Because the moon
in B is more distant from the sun than the earth, it shall be less
attracted by the sun, and shall not descend towards the sun so fast
as the earth: consequently it shall quit the plane B E D F, which we
suppose to accompany the earth, and describe the line B I K convex
thereto, till such time as it comes to the point K, where it will be in
the quarter: but from thenceforth being more attracted than the earth,
the moon shall change its course, and the following part of the path
it describes shall be concave to the plane B E D or B G D, and shall
continue concave to the plane B G D, till it crosses that plane in L,
just as in the preceding case. Now I say, while the moon is passing
from B to K, the nodes, contrary to what was found in the foregoing
case, will proceed forward, or move the same way with the moon[191];
and at the same time the inclination of the orbit will increase[192].

[Illustration]

34. WHEN the moon is in the point I, let the plane M I N pass through
the earth T, and touch the path of the moon in I, cutting the plane of
the earth’s motion, in the line M T N, and the plane B E D in the line
T O. Because the line B I K is convex to the plane B E D, which touches
it in B, the plane N I M must cross the plane D E B, before it meets
the plane C G B; and therefore the point M will fall from B towards G,
and the node of the moon’s orbit being translated from B to M is moved
forward.

35. I SAY farther, the angle under O M G, which the plane M O N makes
with the plane B G C, is greater than the angle under O B G, which
the plane B O D makes with the same. This appears from what has been
already explained; because the arches B O, O M are each less than the
quarter of a circle, and therefore taken both together are less than a
semicircle.

36. AGAIN, when the moon is come to the point K in its quarter, the
nodes will be advanced yet farther forward, and the inclination of the
orbit also more augmented. Hitherto the moon’s motion has been referred
to the plane, which passing through the earth touches the path of the
moon in the point, where the moon is, according to what was asserted at
the beginning of this discourse upon the nodes, that it is the custom
of astronomers so to do. But here in the point K no such plane can be
found; on the contrary, seeing the line of the moon’s motion on one
side the point K is convex to the plane B E D, and on the other side
concave to the same, no plane can pass through the points T and K but
will cut the line B K L in that point. Therefore instead of such a
touching plane, we must here make use of what is equivalent, the plane
P K Q, with which the line B K L shall make a less angle than with any
other plane; for this plane does as it were touch the line B K in the
point K, since it so cuts it, that no other plane can be drawn so,
as to pass between the line B K and the plane P K Q. But now it is
evident, that the point P, or the node, is removed from M towards G,
that is, has moved yet farther forward; and it is likewise as manifest,
that the angle under K P G, or the inclination of the moon’s orbit in
the point K, is greater than the angle under I M G, for the reason so
often assigned.

37. AFTER the moon has passed the quarter, the path of the moon being
concave to the plane A G C H, the nodes, as in the preceding case,
shall recede, till the moon arrives at the point L; which shews, that
considering the whole time of the moon’s passing from B to L, at the
end of that time the nodes shall be found to have receded, or to be
placed backwarder, when the moon is in L, than when it was in B. For
the moon takes a longer time in passing from K to L, than in passing
from B to K; and therefore the nodes continue to recede a longer time,
than they moved forwards; so that their recess must surmount their
advance.

38. IN the same manner, while the moon is in its passage from K to L,
the inclination of the orbit shall diminish, till the moon comes to
the point, in which it is one quarter part of a circle distant from
its node; suppose in the point R; and from that time the inclination
shall again increase. Since therefore the inclination of the orbit
increases, while the moon is passing from B to K, and diminishes itself
again only, while the moon is passing from K to R, and then augments
again, till the moon arrive in L; while the moon is passing from B to
L, the inclination of the orbit is much more increased than diminished,
and will be distinguishably greater, when the moon is come to L, than
when it set out from B.

39. IN like manner, while the moon is passing from L on the other side
the plane A G C H, the node shall advance forward, as long as the moon
is between the point L and the next quarter; but afterwards it shall
recede, till the moon come to pass the plane A G C H again in the point
V, between B and A: and because the time between the moon’s passing
from L to the next quarter is less, than the time between that quarter
and the moon’s coming to the point V, the node shall have more receded
than advanced; so that the point V will be nearer to A, than L is to C.
So also the inclination of the orbit, when the moon is in V, will be
greater, than when the moon was at L; for this inclination increases
all the time the moon is between L and the next quarter; it decreases
only while the moon is passing from this quarter to the mid way between
the two nodes, and from thence increases again during the whole passage
through the other half of the way to the next node.

40. THUS we have traced the moon from her node in the quarter, and
shewn, that at every period of the moon the nodes will have receded,
and thereby will have approached toward a conjunction with the sun.
But this conjunction will be much forwarded by the visible motion of
the sun itself. In the last scheme the sun will appear to move from
S toward W. Suppose it appeared to have moved from S to W, while the
moon’s node has receded from B to V, then drawing the line W T X,
the arch V X will represent the distance of the line drawn between
the nodes from the sun, when the moon is in V; whereas the arch B A
represented that distance, when the moon was in B. This visible motion
of the sun is much greater, than that of the node; for the sun appears
to revolve quite round each year, and the node is near 19 years in
making one revolution. We have also seen, that when the node was in
the quadrature, the inclination of the moon’s orbit decreased, till
the moon came to the conjunction, or opposition, according to which
node it set out from; but that afterwards it again increased, till it
became at the next node rather greater than at the former. When the
node is once removed from the quarter nearer to a conjunction with the
sun, the inclination of the moon’s orbit, when the moon comes into the
node, is more sensibly greater, than it was in the node preceding; the
inclination of the orbit by this means more and more increasing till
the node comes into conjunction with the sun; at which time it has
been shewn above, that the sun has no power to change the plane of the
moon’s motion; and consequently has no effect either on the nodes, or
on the inclination of the orbit.

41. AS soon as the nodes, by the action of the sun, are got out of
conjunction toward the other quarters, they begin again to recede as
before; but the inclination of the orbit in the appulse of the moon
to each succeeding node is less than at the preceding, till the nodes
come again into the quarters. This will appear as follows. Let A (in
fig. 104.) represent one of the moon’s nodes placed between the point
of opposition B and the quarter C. Let the plane A D E pass through
the earth T, and touch the path of the moon in A. Let the line A F G H
be the path of the moon in her passage from A to H, where she crosses
again the plane of the earth’s motion. This line will be convex toward
the plane A D E, till the moon comes to G, where she is in the quarter;
and after this, between G and H, the same line will be concave toward
this plane. All the time this line is convex toward the plane A D
E, the nodes will recede; and on the contrary proceed, while it is
concave to that plane. All this will easily be conceived from what has
been before so largely explained. But the moon is longer in passing
from A to G, than from G to H; therefore the nodes recede a longer
time, than they proceed; consequently upon the whole, when the moon is
arrived at H, the nodes will have receded, that is, the point H will
fall between B and E. The inclination of the orbit will decrease, till
the moon is arrived to the point F, in the middle between A and H.
Through the passage between F and G the inclination will increase, but
decrease again in the remaining part of the passage from G to H, and
consequently at H must be less than at A. The like effects, both in
respect to the nodes and inclination of the orbit, will take place in
the following passage of the moon on the other side of the plane A B E
C, from H, till it comes over that plane again in I.

42. THUS the inclination of the orbit is greatest, when the line drawn
between the moon’s nodes will pass through the sun; and least, when
this line lies in the quarters, especially if the moon at the same time
be in conjunction with the sun, or in the opposition. In the first of
these cases the nodes have no motion, in all others, the nodes will
each month have receded: and this regressive motion will be greatest,
when the nodes are in the quarters; for in that case the nodes have
no progressive motion during the whole month, but in all other cases
the nodes do at some times proceed forward, viz. whenever the moon is
between either quarter, and the node which is less distant from that
quarter than a fourth part of a circle.

43. IT now remains only to explain the irregularities in the moon’s
motion, which follow from the elliptical figure of the orbit. By
what has been said at the beginning of this chapter it appears, that
the power of the earth on the moon acts in the reciprocal duplicate
proportion of the distance: therefore the moon, if undisturbed by
the sun, would move round the earth in a true ellipsis, and the line
drawn from the earth to the moon would pass over equal spaces in equal
portions of time. That this description of the spaces is altered by
the sun, has been already declared. It has also been shown, that the
figure of the orbit is changed each month; that the moon is nearer the
earth at the new and full, and more remote in the quarters, than it
would be without the sun. Now we must pass by these monthly changes,
and consider the effect, which the sun will have in the different
situations of the axis of the orbit in respect of that luminary.

44. THE action of the sun varies the force, wherewith the moon is drawn
toward the earth; in the quarters the force of the earth is directly
increased by the sun; at the new and full the same is diminished; and
in the intermediate places the influence of the earth is sometimes
aided, and sometimes lessened by the sun. In these intermediate
places between the quarters and the conjunction or opposition, the
sun’s action is so oblique to the action of the earth on the moon, as
to produce that alternate acceleration and retardment of the moon’s
motion, which I observed above to be stiled the variation. But besides
this effect, the power, by which the earth attracts the moon toward
itself, will not be at full liberty to act with the same force, as if
the sun acted not at all on the moon. And this effect of the sun’s
action, whereby it corroborates or weakens the action of the earth, is
here only to be considered. And by this influence of the sun it comes
to pass, that the power, by which the moon is impelled toward the
earth, is not perfectly in the reciprocal duplicate proportion of the
distance. Consequently the moon will not describe a perfect ellipsis.
One particular, wherein the moon’s orbit will differ from an ellipsis,
consists in the places, where the motion of the moon is perpendicular
to the line drawn from itself to the earth. In an ellipsis, after the
moon should have set out in the direction perpendicular to this line
drawn from itself to the earth, and at its greatest distance from the
earth, its motion would again become perpendicular to this line drawn
between itself and the earth, and the moon be at its nearest distance
from the earth, when it should have performed half its period; after
performing the other half of its period its motion would again become
perpendicular to the forementioned line, and the moon return into
the place whence it set out, and have recovered again its greatest
distance. But the moon in its real motion, after setting out as before,
sometimes makes more than half a revolution, before its motion comes
again to be perpendicular to the line drawn from itself to the earth,
and the moon is at its nearest distance; and then performs more than
another half of an intire revolution before its motion can a second
time recover its perpendicular direction to the line drawn from the
moon to the earth, and the moon arrive again to its greatest distance
from the earth. At other times the moon will descend to its nearest
distance, before it has made half a revolution, and recover again
its greatest distance, before it has made an intire revolution. The
place, where the moon is at its greatest distance from the earth, is
called the moon’s apogeon, and the place of the least distance the
perigeon. This change of the place, where the moon successively comes
to its greatest distance from the earth, is called the motion of the
apogeon. In what manner the sun causes the apogeon to move, I shall now
endeavour to explain.

45. OUR author shews, that if the moon were attracted toward the
earth by a composition of two powers, one of which were reciprocally
in the duplicate proportion of the distance from the earth, and the
other reciprocally in the triplicate proportion of the same distance;
then, though the line described by the moon would not be in reality
an ellipsis, yet the moon’s motion might be perfectly explained by
an ellipsis, whose axis should be made to move round the earth; this
motion being in consequence, as astronomers express themselves, that
is, the same way as the moon itself moves, if the moon be attracted by
the sum of the two powers; but the axis must move in antecedence, or
the contrary way, if the moon be acted on by the difference of these
powers. What is meant by duplicate proportion has been often explained;
namely, that if three magnitudes, as A, B, and C, are so related, that
the second B bears the same proportion to the third C, as the first A
bears to the second B, then the proportion of the first A to the third
C, is the duplicate of the proportion of the first A to the second B.
Now if a fourth magnitude, as D, be assumed, to which C shall bear the
same proportion as A bears to B, and B to C, then the proportion of A
to D is the triplicate of the proportion of A to B.

46. THE way of representing the moon’s motion in this case is thus. T
denoting the earth (in fig. 105, 106.) suppose the moon in the point
A, its apogeon, or greatest distance from the earth, moving in the
direction A F perpendicular to A B, and acted upon from the earth by
two such forces as have been named. By that power alone, which is
reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of the distance, if the moon
let out from the point A with a proper degree of velocity, the ellipsis
A M B may be described. But if the moon be acted upon by the sum of
the forementioned powers, and the velocity of the moon in the point
A be augmented in a certain proportion[193]; or if that velocity be
diminished in a certain proportion, and the moon be acted upon by the
difference of those powers; in both these cases the line A E, which
shall be described by the moon, is thus to be determined. Let the point
M be that, into which the moon would have arrived in any given space of
time, had it moved in the ellipsis A M B. Draw M T, and likewise C T D
in such sort, that the angle under A T M shall bear the same proportion
to the angle under A T C, as the velocity, with which the ellipsis A
M B must have been described, bears to the difference between this
velocity, and the velocity, with which the moon must set out from the
point A in order to describe the path A E. Let the angle A T C be taken
toward the moon (as in fig. 105.) if the moon be attracted by the sum
of the powers; but the contrary way (as in fig. 106.) if by their
difference. Then let the line A B be moved into the position C D, and
the ellipsis A M B into the situation C N D, so that the point M be
translated to L: then the point L shall fall upon the path of the moon
A E.

47. THE angular motion of the line A T, wereby it is removed into the
situation C T, represents the motion of the apogeon; by the means of
which the motion of the moon might be fully explicated by the ellipsis
A M B, if the action of the sun upon it was directed to the center
of the earth, and reciprocally in the triplicate proportion of the
moon’s distance from it. But that not being so, the apogeon will not
move in the regular manner now described. However, it is to be observed
here, that in the first of the two preceding cases, where the apogeon
moves forward, the whole centripetal power increases faster, with the
decrease of distance, than if the intire power were reciprocally in
the duplicate proportion of the distance; because one part only is in
that proportion, and the other part, which is added to this to make up
the whole power, increases faster with the decrease of distance. On
the other hand, when the centripetal power is the difference between
these two, it increases less with the decrease of the distance, than
if it were simply in the reciprocal duplicate proportion of the
distance. Therefore if we chuse to explain the moon’s motion by an
ellipsis (as is most convenient for astronomical uses to be done, and
by reason of the small effect of the sun’s power, the doing so will
not be attended with any sensible error;) we may collect in general,
that when the power, by which the moon is attracted to the earth, by
varying the distance, increases in a greater than in the duplicate
proportion of the distance diminished, a motion in consequence must
be ascribed to the apogeon; but that when the attraction increases
in a less proportion than that named, the apogeon must have given
to it a motion in antecedence[194]. It is then observed by Sir IS.
NEWTON, that the first of these cases obtains, when the moon is in the
conjunction and opposition; and the latter, when the moon is in the
quarters: so that in the first the apogeon moves according to the order
of the signs; in the other, the contrary way[195]. But, as was said
before, the disturbance given to the action of the earth by the sun
in the conjunction and opposition being near twice as great as in the
quarters[196], the apogeon will advance with a greater velocity than
recede, and in the compass of a whole revolution of the moon will be
carried in consequence[197].

48. IT is shewn in the next place by our author, that when the line A B
coincides with that, which joins the earth and the sun, the progressive
motion of the apogeon, when the moon is in the conjunction or
opposition, exceeds the regressive in the quadratures more than in any
other situation of the line A B[198]. On the contrary, when the line
A B makes right angles with that, which joins the earth and sun, the
retrograde motion will be more considerable[199], nay is found so great
as to exceed the progressive; so that in this case the apogeon in the
compass of an intire revolution of the moon is carried in antecedence.
Yet from the considerations in the last paragraph the progressive
motion exceeds the other; so that in the whole the mean motion of the
apogeon is in consequence, according as astronomers find. Moreover, the
line A B changes its situation with that, which joins the earth and
sun, by such slow degrees, that the inequalities in the motion of the
apogeon arising from this last consideration, are much greater than
what arises from the other[200].

49. FARTHER, this unsteady motion in the apogeon is attended with
another inequality in the motion of the moon, that it cannot be
explained at all times by the same ellipsis. The ellipsis in general
is called by astronomers an eccentric orbit. The point, in which the
two axis’s cross, is called the center of the figure; because all
lines drawn through this point within the ellipsis, from side to side,
are divided in the middle by this point. But the center, about which
the heavenly bodies revolve, lying out of this center of the figure
in one focus, these orbits are said to be eccentric; and where the
distance of the focus from this center bears the greatest proportion
to the whole axis, that orbit is called the most eccentric: and in
such an orbit the distance from the focus to the remoter extremity of
the axis bears the greatest proportion to the distance of the nearer
extremity. Now whenever the apogeon of the moon moves in consequence,
the moon’s motion must be referred to an orbit more eccentric, than
what the moon would describe, if the whole power, by which the moon
was acted on in its passing from the apogeon, changed according to the
reciprocal duplicate proportion of the distance from the earth, and by
that means the moon did describe an immoveable ellipsis; and when the
apogeon moves in antecedence, the moon’s motion must be referred to an
orbit less eccentric. In the first of the two figures last referred
to, the true place of the moon L falls without the orbit A M B, to
which its motion is referred: whence the orbit A L E, truly described
by the moon, is less incurvated in the point A, than is the orbit A M
B; therefore the orbit A M B is more oblong, and differs farther from
a circle, than the ellipsis would, whose curvature in A were equal to
that of the line A L B, that is, the proportion of the distance of the
earth T from the center of the ellipsis to its axis will be greater in
the ellipsis A M B, than in the other; but that other is the ellipsis,
which the moon would describe, if the power acting upon it in the point
A were altered in the reciprocal duplicate proportion of the distance.
In the second figure, when the apogeon recedes, the place of the moon
L falls within the orbit A M B, and therefore that orbit is less
eccentric, than the immoveable orbit which the moon should describe.
The truth of this is evident; for, when the apogeon moves forward, the
power, by which the moon is influenced in its descent from the apogeon,
increases faster with the decrease of distance, than in the duplicate
proportion of the distance; and consequently the moon being drawn more
forcibly toward the earth, it will descend nearer to it. On the other
hand, when the apogeon recedes, the power acting on the moon increases
with the decrease of distance in less than the duplicate proportion of
the distance; and therefore the moon is less impelled toward the earth,
and will not descend so low.

50. NOW suppose in the first of these figures, that the apogeon A is
in the situation, where it is approaching toward the conjunction or
opposition of the sun. In this case the progressive motion of the
apogeon is more and more accelerated. Here suppose that the moon, after
having descended from A through the orbit A E as far as F, where it
is come to its nearest distance from the earth, ascends again up the
line F G. Because the motion of the apogeon is here continually more
and more accelerating, the cause of its motion is constantly upon the
increase; that is, the power, whereby the moon is drawn to the earth,
will decrease with the increase of distance, in the moon’s ascent
from F, in a greater proportion than that wherewith it increased with
the decrease of distance in the moon’s descent to F. Consequently
the moon will ascend higher than to the distance A T, from whence it
descended; therefore the proportion of the greatest distance of the
moon to the least is increased. And when the moon descends again, the
power will yet more increase with the decrease of distance, than in the
last ascent it decreased with the augmentation of distance; the moon
therefore must descend nearer to the earth than it did before, and the
proportion of the greatest distance to the least yet be more increased.
Thus as long as the apogeon is advancing toward the conjunction or
opposition, the proportion of the greatest distance of the moon from
the earth to the least will continually increase; and the elliptical
orbit, to which the moon’s motion is referred, will be rendered more
and more eccentric.

51. AS soon as the apogeon is passed the conjunction with the sun or
the opposition, the progressive motion thereof abates, and with it
the proportion of the greatest distance of the moon from the earth to
the least distance will also diminish; and when the apogeon becomes
regressive, the diminution of this proportion will be still farther
continued on, till the apogeon comes into the quarter; from thence this
proportion, and the eccentricity of the orbit will increase again.
Thus the orbit of the moon is most eccentric, when the apogeon is in
conjunction with the sun, or in opposition to it, and least of all when
the apogeon is in the quarters.

52. THESE changes in the nodes, in the inclination of the orbit to the
plane of the earth’s motion, in the apogeon, and in the eccentricity,
are varied like the other inequalities in the motion of the moon, by
the different distance of the earth from the sun; being greatest, when
their cause is greatest, that is, when the earth is nearest to the sun.

53. I SAID at the beginning of this chapter, that Sir ISAAC NEWTON
has computed the very quantity of many of the moon’s inequalities.
That acceleration of the moon’s motion, which is called the variation,
when greatest, removes the moon out of the place, in which it would
otherwise be found, something more than half a degree[201]. In the
phrase of astronomers, a degree is 1/360 part of the whole circuit of
the moon or any planet. If the moon, without disturbance from the sun,
would have described a circle concentrical to the earth, the sun will
cause the moon to approach nearer to the earth in the conjunction and
opposition, than in the quarters, nearly in the proportion of 69 to
70[202]. We had occasion to mention above, that the nodes perform their
period in almost 19 years. This the astronomers found by observation;
and our author’s computations assign to them the same period[203].
The inclination of the moon’s orbit when least, is an angle about
1/18 part of that angle, which constitutes a perpendicular; and the
difference between the greatest and least inclination of the orbit is
determined by our author’s computation to be about 1/18 of the least
inclination[204]. And this also is agreeable to the observations
of astronomers. The motion of the apogeon, and the changes in the
eccentricity, Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has not computed. The apogeon performs
its revolution in about eight years and ten months. When the moon’s
orbit is most eccentric, the greatest distance of the moon from the
earth bears to the least distance nearly the proportion of 8 to 7; when
the orbit is least eccentric, this proportion is hardly so great as
that of 12 to 11.

54. SIR ~ISAAC NEWTON~ shews farther, how, by comparing the
periods of the motion of the satellites, which revolve round Jupiter
and Saturn, with the period of our moon round the earth, and the
periods of those planets round the sun with the period of our earth’s
motion, the inequalities in the motion of those satellites may be
derived from the inequalities in the moon’s motion; excepting only in
regard to that motion of the axis of the orbit, which in the moon makes
the motion of the apogeon; for the orbits of those satellites, as far
as can be discerned by us at this distance, appearing little or nothing
eccentric, this motion, as deduced from the moon, must be diminished.




~CHAP. IV.~

Of ~Comets~.


IN the former of the two preceding chapters the powers have been
explained, which keep in motion those celestial bodies, whose courses
had been well determined by the astronomers. In the last chapter we
have shewn, how those powers have been applied by our author to the
making a more perfect discovery of the motion of those bodies, the
courses of which were but imperfectly understood; for some of the
inequalities, which we have been describing in the moon’s motion,
were unknown to the astronomers. In this chapter we are to treat of
a third species of the heavenly bodies, the true motion of which was
not at all apprehended before our author writ; in so much, that here
Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has not only explained the causes of the motion of
these bodies, but has performed also the part of an astronomer, by
discovering what their motions are.

2. THAT these bodies are not meteors in our air, is manifest; because
they rise and set in the same manner, as the sun and stars. The
astronomers had gone so far in their inquiries concerning them, as to
prove by their observations, that they moved in the etherial spaces far
beyond the moon; but they had no true notion at all of the path, which
they described. The most prevailing opinion before our author was,
that they moved in straight lines; but in what part of the heavens was
not determined. DESCARTES[205] removed them far beyond the sphere of
Saturn, as finding the straight motion attributed to them, inconsistent
with the vortical fluid, by which he explains the motions of the
planets, as we have above related[206]. But Sir ISAAC NEWTON distinctly
proves from astronomical observation, that the comets pass through the
region of the planets, and are mostly invisible at a less distance,
than that of Jupiter[207].

3. AND from hence finding the comets to be evidently within the sphere
of the sun’s action, he concludes they must, necessarily move about the
sun, as the planets do[208]. The planets move in ellipsis’s; but it is
not necessary that every body, which is influenced by the sun, should
move in that particular kind of line. However our author proves, that
the power of the sun being reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of
the distance, every body acted on by the sun must either fall directly
down, or move in some conic section; of which lines I have above
observed, that there are three species, the ellipsis, parabola, and
hyperbola[209]. If a body, which descends toward the sun as low as the
orbit of any planet, move with a swifter motion than the planet does,
that body will describe an orbit of a more oblong figure, than that
of the planet, and have a longer axis at least. The velocity of the
body may be so great, that it shall move in a parabola, and having
once passed about the sun, shall ascend for ever without returning any
more: but the sun will be placed in the focus of this parabola. With a
velocity still greater the body will move in an hyperbola. But it is
most probable, that the comets move in elliptical orbits, though of a
very oblong, or in the phrase of astronomers, of a very eccentric form,
such as is represented in fig. 107, where S is the sun, C the comet,
and A B D E its orbit, wherein the distance of S and D far exceeds that
of S and A. Whence it is, that they sometimes are found at a moderate
distance from the sun, and appear within the planetary regions; at
other times they ascend to vast distances, far beyond the very orbit of
Saturn, and so become invisible. That the comets do move in this manner
is proved by our author, from computations built upon the observations,
which astronomers had made on many comets. These computations were
performed by Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ himself upon the comet, which appeared
toward the latter end of the year 1680, and at the beginning of the
year following[210]; but the learned Dr. HALLEY prosecuted the like
computations more at large in this, and also in many other comets[211].
Which computations are made upon propositions highly worthy of our
author’s unparallel’d genius, such as could scarce have been discovered
by any one not possessed of the utmost force of invention;

4. THOSE computations depend upon this principle, that the eccentricity
of the orbits of the comets is so great, that if they are really
elliptical, yet they approach so near to parabolas in that part of
them, where they come under our view, that they may be taken for such
without sensible error[212]: as in the preceding figure the parabola
F A G differs in the lower part of it about A very little from the
ellipsis D E A B. Upon which ground our great author teaches a method
of finding by three observations made upon any comet the parabola,
which nearest agrees with its orbit[213].

5. NOW what confirms this whole theory beyond the least room for
doubt is, that the places of the comets computed in the orbits, which
the method here mentioned assigns them, agree to the observations of
astronomers with the same degree of exactness, as the computations
of the primary planets places usually do; and this in comets, whose
motions are very extraordinary[214].

6. OUR author afterwards shews how to make use of any small deviation
from the parabola, that shall be observed, to determine whether the
orbits of the comets are elliptical or not, and so to discover if the
same comet returns at certain periods[215]. And upon examining the
comet in 1680, by the rule laid down for this purpose, he finds its
orbit to agree more exactly to an ellipsis than to a parabola, though
the ellipsis be so very eccentric, that the comet cannot perform its
period through it in the space of 500 years[216]. Upon this Dr. HALLEY
observed, that mention is made in history of a comet, with the like
eminent tail as this, having appeared three several times before; the
first of which appearances was at the death of JULIUS CESAR, and each
appearance was at the distance of 575 years from the next preceding.
He therefore computed the motion of this comet in such an elliptic
orbit, as would require this number of years for the body to revolve
through it; and these computations agree yet more perfectly with the
observations made on this comet, than any parabolical orbit will
do[217].

7. THE comparing together different appearances of the same comet, is
the only way to discover certainly the true form of the orbit: for
it is impossible to determine with exactness the figure of an orbit
so exceedingly eccentric, from single observations taken in one part
of it; and therefore Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~[218] proposes to compare the
orbits, upon the supposition that they are parabolical, of such comets
as appear at different times; for if the same orbit be found to be
described by a comet at different times, in all probability it will
be the same comet which describes it. And here he remarks from Dr.
HALLEY, that the same orbit very nearly agrees to two appearances of
a comet about the space of 75 years distance[219]; so that if those
two appearances were really of the same comet, the transverse axis of
the orbit of the comet would be near 18 times the axis of the earth’s
orbit; and the comet, when at its greatest distance from the sun, will
be removed not less than 35 times as far as the middle distance of the
earth.

8. AND this seems to be the shortest period of any of the comets.
But it will be farther confirmed, if the same comet should return a
third time after another period of 75 years. However it is not to be
expected, that comets should preserve the same regularity in their
periods, as the planets; because the great eccentricity of their orbits
makes them liable to suffer very considerable alterations from the
action of the planets, and other comets, upon them.

9. IT is therefore to prevent too great disturbances in their motions
from these causes, as our author observes, that while the planets
revolve all of them nearly in the same plane, the comets are disposed
in very different ones; and distributed over all parts of the heavens;
that, when in their greatest distance from the sun, and moving slowest,
they might be removed as far as possible out of the reach of each
other’s action[220]. The same end is likewise farther answered in those
comets, which by moving slowest in the aphelion, or remotest distance
from the sun, descend nearest to it, by placing the aphelion of these
at the greatest height from the sun[221].

10. OUR philosopher being led by his principles to explain the motions
of the comets, in the manner now related, takes occasion from thence to
give us his thoughts upon their nature and use. For which end he proves
in the first place, that they must necessarily be solid and compact
bodies, and by no means any sort of vapour or light substance exhaled
from the planets or stars: because at the near distance, to which some
comets approach the sun, it could not be, but the immense heat, to
which they are exposed, should instantaneously disperse and scatter any
such light volatile substance[222]. In particular the forementioned
comet of 1680 descended so near the sun, as to come within a sixth
part of the sun’s diameter from the surface of it. In which situation
it must have been exposed, as appears by computation, to a degree of
heat exceeding the heat of the sun upon our earth no less than 28000
times; and therefore might have contracted a degree of heat 2000 times
greater, than that of red hot iron[223]. Now a substance, which could
endure so intense a heat, without being dispersed in vapor, must needs
be firm and solid.

11. IT is shewn likewise, that the comets are opake substances, shining
by a reflected light, borrowed from the sun[224]. This is proved from
the observation, that comets, though they are approaching the earth,
yet diminish in lustre, if at the same time they recede from the sun;
and on the contrary, are found to encrease daily in brightness, when
they advance towards the sun, though at the same time they move from
the earth[225].

12. THE comets therefore in these respects resemble the planets; that
both are durable opake bodies, and both revolve about the sun in conic
sections. But farther the comets, like our earth, are surrounded by
an atmosphere. The air we breath is called the earth’s atmosphere;
and it is most probable, that all the other planets are invested with
the like fluid. Indeed here a difference is found between the planets
and comets. The atmospheres of the planets are of so fine and subtile
a substance, as hardly to be discerned at any distance, by reason of
the small quantity of light which they reflect, except only in the
planet Mars. In him there is some little appearance of such a substance
surrounding him, as stars which have been covered by him are said to
look somewhat dim a small space before his body comes under them, as if
their light, when he is near, were obstructed by his atmosphere. But
the atmospheres which surround the comets are so gross and thick, as to
reflect light very copiously. They are also much greater in proportion
to the body they surround, than those of the planets, if we may judge
of the rest from our air; for it has been observed of comets, that the
bright light appearing in the middle of them, which is reflected from
the solid body, is scarce a ninth or tenth part of the whole comet,

13. I SPEAK only of the heads of the comets, the most lucid part of
which is surrounded by a fainter light, the most lucid part being
usually not above a ninth or tenth part of the whole in breadth[226].
Their tails are an appearance very peculiar, nothing of the same
nature appertaining in the least degree to any other of the celestial
bodies. Of that appearance there are several opinions; our author
reduces them to three[227]. The two first, which he proposes, are
rejected by him; but the third he approves. The first is, that they
arise from a beam of light transmitted through the head of the comet,
in like manner as a stream of light is discerned, when the sun shines
into a darkened room through a small hole. This opinion, as Sir ~ISAAC
NEWTON~ observes, implies the authors of it wholly unskilled in the
principles of optics; for that stream of light, seen in a darkened
room, arises from the reflection of the sun beams by the dust and motes
floating in the air: for the rays of light themselves are not seen,
but by their being reflected to the eye from some substance, upon
which they fall[228]. The next opinion examined by our author is that
of the celebrated DESCARTES, who imagins these tails to be the light
of the comet refracted in its passage to us, and thence affording an
oblong representation; as the light of the sun does, when refracted
by the prism in that noted experiment, which will have a great share
in the third book of this discourse[229]. But this opinion is at once
overturned from this consideration only, that the planets could be
no more free from this refraction than the comets; nay ought to have
larger or brighter tails, than they, because the light of the planets
is strongest. However our author has thought proper to add some farther
objections against this opinion: for instance, that these tails are not
variegated with colours, as is the image produced by the prism, and
which is inseparable from that unequal refraction, which produces that
disproportioned length of the image. And besides, when the light in
its passage from different comets to the earth describes the same path
through the heavens, the refraction of it should of necessity be in all
respects the same. But this is contrary to observation; for the comet
in 1680, the 28th day of December, and a former comet in the year 1577,
the 29th day of December, appear’d in the same place of the heavens,
that is, were seen adjacent to the same fixed stars, the earth likewise
being in the same place at both times; yet the tail of the latter comet
deviated from the opposition to the sun a little to the northward, and
the tail of the former comet declined from the opposition of the sun
five times as much southward[230].

14. THERE are some other false opinions, though less regarded than
these, which have been advanced upon this argument. These our
excellent author passes over, hastening to explain, what he takes to
be the true cause of this appearance. He thinks it is certainly owing
to steams and vapours exhaled from the body, and gross atmosphere of
the comets, by the heat of the sun; because all the appearances agree
perfectly to this sentiment. The tails are but small, while the comet
is descending to the sun, but enlarge themselves to an immense degree,
as soon as ever the comet has passed its perihelion; which shews the
tail to depend upon the degree of heat, which the comet receives from
the sun. And that the intense heat to which comets, when nearest the
sun, are exposed, should exhale from them a very copious vapour, is a
most reasonable supposition; especially if we consider, that in those
free and empty regions steams will more easily ascend, than here upon
the surface of the earth, where they are suppressed and hindered from
rising by the weight of the incumbent air: as we find by experiments
made in vessels exhausted of the air, where upon removal of the air
several substances will fume and discharge steams plentifully, which
emit none in the open air. The tails of comets, like such a vapour,
are always in the plane of the comet’s orbit, and opposite to the
sun, except that the upper part thereof inclines towards the parts,
which the comet has left by its motion; resembling perfectly the smoak
of a burning coal, which, if the coal remain fixed, ascends from it
perpendicularly; but, if the coal be in motion, ascends obliquely,
inclining from the motion of the coal. And besides, the tails of
comets may be compared to this smoak in another respect, that both
of them are denser and more compact on the convex side, than on the
concave. The different appearance of the head of the comet, after it
has past its perihelion, from what it had before, confirms greatly this
opinion of their tails: for smoke raised by a strong heat is blacker
and grosser, than when raised by a less; and accordingly the heads of
comets, at the same distance from the sun, are observed less bright and
shining after the perihelion, than before, as if obscured by such a
gross smoke.

15. THE observations of HEVELIUS upon the atmospheres of comets still
farther illustrate the same; who relates, that the atmospheres,
especially that part of them next the sun, are remarkably contracted
when near the sun, and dilated again afterwards.

16. TO give a more full idea of these tails, a rule is laid down by
our author, whereby to determine at any time, when the vapour in the
extremity of the tail first rose from the head of the comet. By this
rule it is found, that the tail does not consist of a fleeting vapour,
dissipated soon after it is raised, but is of long continuance; that
almost all the vapour, which rose about the time of the perihelion from
the comet of 1680, continued to accompany it, ascending by degrees,
being succeeded constantly by fresh matter, which rendered the tail
contiguous to the comet. From this computation the tails are found to
participate of another property of ascending vapours, that, when they
ascend with the greatest velocity, they are least incurvated.

17. THE only objection that can be made against this opinion is the
difficulty of explaining, how a sufficient quantity of vapour can
be raised from the atmosphere of a comet to fill those vast spaces,
through which their tails are sometimes extended. This our author
removes by the following computation: our air being an elastic fluid,
as has been said before[231], is more dense here near the surface of
the earth, where it is pressed upon by the whole air above; than it is
at a distance from the earth, where it has a less weight incumbent. I
have observed, that the density of the air is reciprocally proportional
to the compressing weight. From hence our author computes to what
degree of rarity the air must be expanded, according to this rule, at
an height equal to a semidiameter of the earth: and he finds, that
a globe of such air, as we breath here on the surface of the earth,
which shall be one inch only in diameter, if it were expanded to the
degree of rarity, which the air must have at the height now mentioned,
would fill all the planetary regions even to the very sphere of Saturn,
and far beyond. Now since the air at a greater height will be still
immensly more rarified, and the surface of the atmospheres of comets is
usually about ten times the distance from the center of the comet, as
the surface of the comet it self, and the tails are yet vastly farther
removed from the center of the comet; the vapour, which composes those
tails, may very well be allowed to be so expanded, as that a moderate
quantity of matter may fill all that space, they are seen to take up.
Though indeed the atmospheres of comets being very gross, they will
hardly be rarified in their tails to so great a degree, as our air
under the same circumstances; especially since they may be something
condensed, as well by their gravitation to the sun, as that the parts
will gravitate to one another; which will hereafter be shewn to be the
universal property of all matter[232]. The only scruple left is, how so
much light can be reflected from a vapour so rare, as this computation
implies. For the removal of which our author observes, that the most
refulgent of these tails hardly appear brighter, than a beam of the
sun’s light transmitted into a darkened room through a hole of a single
inch diameter; and that the smallest fixed stars are visible through
them without any sensible diminution of their lustre.

18. ALL these considerations put it beyond doubt, what is the true
nature of the tails of comets. There has indeed nothing been said,
which will account for the irregular figures, in which those tails
are sometimes reported to have appeared; but since none of those
appearances have ever been recorded by astronomers, who on the contrary
ascribe the same likeness to the tails of all comets, our author
with great judgment refers all those to accidental refractions by
intervening clouds, or to parts of the milky way contiguous to the
comets[233].

19. THE discussion of this appearance in comets has led Sir ~ISAAC
NEWTON~ into some speculations relating to their use, which I cannot
but extreamly admire, as representing in the strongest light
imaginable the extensive providence of the great author of nature,
who, besides the furnishing this globe of earth, and without doubt
the rest of the planets, so abundantly with every thing necessary
for the support and continuance of the numerous races of plants and
animals, they are stocked with, has over and above provided a numerous
train of comets, far exceeding the number of the planets, to rectify
continually, and restore their gradual decay, which is our author’s
opinion concerning them[234]. For since the comets are subject to such
unequal degrees of heat, being sometimes burnt with the most intense
degree of it, at other times scarce receiving any sensible influence
from the sun; it can hardly be supposed, they are designed for any
such constant use, as the planets. Now the tails, which they emit,
like all other kinds of vapour, dilate themselves as they ascend, and
by consequence are gradually dispersed and scattered through all the
planetary regions, and thence cannot but be gathered up by the planets,
as they pass through their orbs: for the planets having a power to
cause all bodies to gravitate towards them, as will in the sequel of
this discourse be shewn[235]; these vapours will be drawn in process of
time into this or the other planet, which happens to act strongest upon
them. And by entering the atmospheres of the earth and other planets,
they may well be supposed to contribute to the renovation of the face
of things, in particular to supply the diminution caused in the humid
parts by vegetation and putrefaction. For vegetables are nourished by
moisture, and by putrefaction are turned in great part into dry earth;
and an earthy substance always subsides in fermenting liquors; by which
means the dry parts of the planets must continually increase, and the
fluids diminish, nay in a sufficient length of time be exhausted, if
not supplied by some such means. It is farther our great author’s
opinion, that the most subtile and active parts of our air, upon which
the life of things chiefly depends, is derived to us, and supplied
by the comets. So far are they from portending any hurt or mischief
to us, which the natural fears of men are so apt to suggest from the
appearance of any thing uncommon and astonishing.

20. THAT the tails of comets have some such important use seems
reasonable, if we consider, that those bodies do not send out those
fumes merely by their near approach to the sun; but are framed of a
texture, which disposes them in a particular manner to fume in that
sort: for the earth, without emitting any such steam, is more than half
the year at a less distance from the sun, than the comet of 1664 and
1665 approached it, when nearest; likewise the comets of 1682 and 1683
never approached the sun much above a seventh part nearer than Venus,
and were more than half as far again from the sun as Mercury; yet all
these emitted tails.

21. FROM the very near approach of the comet of 1680 our author draws
another speculation; for if the sun have an atmosphere about it, the
comet mentioned seems to have descended near enough to the sun to
enter within it. If so, it must have been something retarded by the
resistance it would meet with, and consequently in its next descent to
the sun will fall nearer than now; by which means it will meet with a
greater resistance, and be again more retarded. The event of which must
be, that at length it will impinge upon the sun’s surface, and thereby
supply any decrease, which may have happened by so long an emission of
light, or otherwise. And something like this our author conjectures
may be the case of those fixed stars which by an additional increase
of their lustre have for a certain time become visible to us, though
usually they are out of sight. There is indeed a kind of fixed stars,
which appear and disappear at regular and equal intervals: here some
more steady cause must be sought for; perhaps these stars turn round
their own axis’s, as our sun does[236], and have some part of their
body more luminous than the other, whereby they are seen, when the most
lucid part is next to us, and when the darker part is turned toward us,
they vanish out of sight.


22. WHETHER the sun does really diminish, as has been here suggested,
is difficult to prove; yet that it either does so, or that the earth
increases, if not both, is rendered probable from Dr. HALLEY’s
observation[237], that by comparing the proportion, which the
periodical time of the moon bore to that of the sun in former times,
with the proportion between them at present, the moon is found to be
something accelerated in respect of the sun. But if the sun diminish,
the periods of the primary planets will be lengthened; and if the earth
be encreased, the period of the moon will be shortened: as will appear
by the next chapter, wherein it shall be shewn, that the power of the
sun and earth is the result of the same power being lodg’d in all their
parts, and that this principle of producing gravitation in other bodies
is proportional to the solid matter in each body.




~CHAP~. V.

Of the BODIES of the SUN and PLANETS.


OUR author, after having discovered that the celestial motions are
performed by a force extended from the sun and primary planets, follows
this power into the deepest recesses of those bodies themselves, and
proves the same to accompany the smallest particle, of which they are
composed.


2. PREPARATIVE hereto he shews first, that each of the heavenly bodies
attracts the rest, and all bodies, with such different degrees of
force, as that the force of the same attracting body is exerted on
others exactly in proportion to the quantity of matter in the body
attracted[238].

3. OF this the first proof he brings is from experiments made here
upon the earth. The power by which the moon is influenced was above
shewn to be the same, with that power here on the surface of the earth,
which we call gravity[239]. Now one of the effects of the principle
of gravity is, that all bodies descend by this force from the same
height in equal times. Which has been long taken notice of; particular
methods having been invented to shew that the only cause, why some
bodies were observed to fall from the same height sooner than others,
was the resistance of the air. This we have above related[240]; and
proved from hence, that since bodies resist to any change of their
state from rest to motion, or from motion to rest, in proportion to the
quantity of matter contained in them; the power that can move different
quantities of matter equally, must be proportional to the quantity. The
only objection here is, that it can hardly be made certain, whether
this proportion in the effect of gravity on different bodies holds
perfectly exact or not from these experiments; by reason that the
great swiftness, with which bodies fall, prevents our being able to
determine the times of their descent with all the exactness requisite.
Therefore to remedy this inconvenience, our author substitutes another
more certain experiment in the room of these made upon falling bodies.
Pendulums are caused to vibrate by the same principle, as makes
bodies descend; the power of gravity putting them in motion, as well
as the other. But if the ball of any pendulum, of the same length with
another, were more or less attracted in proportion to the quantity of
solid matter in the ball, that pendulum must accordingly move faster or
slower than the other. Now the vibrations of pendulums continue for a
great length of time, and the number of vibrations they make may easily
be determined without suspicion of error; so that this experiment may
be extended to what exactness one pleases: and our author assures us,
that he examined in this way several substances, as gold, silver, lead,
glass, sand, common salt, wood, water, and wheat; in all which he found
not the least deviation from the proportion mentioned, though he made
the experiment in such a manner, that in bodies of the same weight a
difference in the quantity of their matter less than a thousandth part
of the whole would have discovered it self[241]. It appears therefore,
that all bodies are made to descend by the power of gravity here, near
the surface of the earth, with the same degree of swiftness. We have
above observed this descent to be after the rate of 16⅛ feet in the
first second of time from the beginning of their fall. Moreover it
was also observed, that if any body, which fell here at the surface
of the earth after this rate, were to be conveyed up to the height of
the moon, it would descend from thence just with the same degree of
velocity, as that with which the moon is attracted toward the earth;
and therefore the power of the earth upon the moon bears the same
proportion to the power it would have upon those bodies at the same
distance, as the quantity of matter in the moon bears to the quantity
in those bodies.

4. THUS the assertion laid down is proved in the earth, that the power
of the earth on every body it attracts is, at the same distance from
the earth, proportional to the quantity of solid matter in the body
acted on. As to the sun, it has been shewn, that the power of the sun’s
action upon the same primary planet is reciprocally in the duplicate
proportion of the distance; and that the power of the sun decreases
throughout in the same proportion, the motion of comets traversing the
whole planetary region testifies. This proves, that if any planet were
removed from the sun to any other distance whatever, the degree of
its acceleration toward the sun would yet remain reciprocally in the
duplicate proportion of its distance. But it has likewise been shewn,
that the degree of acceleration, which the sun gives to every one of
the planets, is reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of their
respective distances. All which compared together puts it out of doubt,
that the power of the sun upon any planet, removed into the place of
any ether, would give it the same velocity of descent, as it gives that
other; and consequently, that the sun’s action upon different planets
at the same distance would be proportional to the quantity of matter
in each. It has farther been shewn, that the sun attracts the primary
planets, and their respective secondary, when at the same distance, so
as to communicate to both the same degree of velocity; and therefore
the force, wherewith the sun acts on the secondary planet, bears
the same proportion to the force, wherewith at the same distance it
attracts the primary, as the quantity of solid matter in the secondary
planet bears to the quantity of matter in the primary.

5. THIS property therefore is proved of both kinds of planets, in
respect of the sun. Therefore the sun possesses the quality found in
the earth, of acting on bodies with a degree of force proportional to
the quantity of matter in the body, which receives the influence.

6. THAT the power of attraction, with which the other planets are
endued, should differ from that of the earth, can hardly be supposed,
if we consider the similitude between those bodies; and that it does
not in this respect, is farther proved from the satellites of Saturn
and Jupiter, which are attracted by their respective primary according
to the same law, that is, in the same proportion to their distances, as
the primary are attracted by the sun: so that what has been concluded
of the sun in relation to the primary planets, may be justly concluded
of these primary in respect of their secondary, and in consequence
of that, in regard likewise to all other bodies, viz. that they will
attract every body in proportion to the quantity of solid matter it
contains.

7. HENCE it follows, that this attraction extends itself to every
particle of matter in the attracted body: and that no portion of matter
whatever is exempted from the influence of those bodies, to which we
have proved this attractive power to belong.

8. BEFORE we proceed farther, we may here remark, that this attractive
power both of the sun and planets now appears to be quite of the same
nature in all; for it acts in each in the same proportion to the
distance, and in the same manner acts alike upon every particle of
matter. This power therefore in the sun and other planets is not of a
different nature from this power in the earth; which has been already
shewn to be the same with that, which we call gravity[242].

9. AND this lays open the way to prove, that the attracting power
lodged in the sun and planets, belongs likewise to every part of them:
and that their respective powers upon the same body are proportional to
the quantity of matter, of which they are composed; for instance, that
the force with which the earth attracts the moon, is to the force, with
which the sun would attract it at the same distance, as the quantity of
solid matter contained in the earth, to the quantity contained in the
sun[243].

10. THE first of these assertions is a very evident consequence from
the latter. And before we proceed to the proof, it must first be
shewn, that the third law of motion, which makes action and reaction
equal, holds in these attractive powers. The most remarkable attractive
force, next to the power of gravity, is that, by which the loadstone
attracts iron. Now if a loadstone were laid upon water, and supported
by some proper substance, as wood or cork, so that it might swim;
and if a piece of iron were caused to swim upon the water in like
manner: as soon as the loadstone begins to attract the iron, the iron
shall move toward the stone, and the stone shall also move toward
the iron; when they meet, they shall stop each other, and remain
fixed together without any motion. This shews, that the velocities,
wherewith they meet, are reciprocally proportional to the quantities
of solid matter in each; and that by the stone’s attracting the iron,
the stone itself receives as much motion, in the strict philosophic
sense of that word[244], as it communicates to the iron: for it has
been declared above to be an effect of the percussion of two bodies,
that if they meet with velocities reciprocally proportional to the
respective bodies, they shall be stopped by the concourse, unless their
elasticity put them into fresh motion; but if they meet with any other
velocities, they shall retain some motion after meeting[245]. Amber,
glass, sealing-wax, and many other substances acquire by rubbing a
power, which from its having been remarkable, particularly in amber,
is called electrical. By this power they will for some time after
rubbing attract light bodies, that shall be brought within the sphere
of their activity. On the other hand Mr. BOYLE found, that if a piece
of amber be hung in a perpendicular position by a string, it shall be
drawn itself toward the body whereon it was rubbed, if that body be
brought near it. Both in the loadstone and in electrical bodies we
usually ascribe the power to the particular body, whose presence we
find necessary for producing the effect. The loadstone and any piece of
iron will draw each other, but in two pieces of iron no such effect is
ordinarily observed; therefore we call this attractive power the power
of the loadstone: though near a loadstone two pieces of iron will also
draw each other. In like manner the rubbing of amber, glass, or any
such body, till it is grown warm, being necessary to cause any action
between those bodies and other substances, we ascribe the electrical
power to those bodies. But in all these cases if we would speak more
correctly, and not extend the sense of our expressions beyond what
we see; we can only say that the neighbourhood of a loadstone and a
piece of iron is attended with a power, whereby the loadstone and
the iron are drawn toward each other; and the rubbing of electrical
bodies gives rise to a power, whereby those bodies and other substances
are mutually attracted. Thus we must also understand in the power of
gravity, that the two bodies are mutually made to approach by the
action of that power. When the sun draws any planet, that planet also
draws the sun; and the motion, which the planet receives from the
sun, bears the same proportion to the motion, which the sun it self
receives, as the quantity of solid matter in the sun bears to the
quantity of solid matter in the planet. Hitherto, for brevity sake
in speaking of these forces, we have generally ascribed them to the
body, which is least moved; as when we called the power, which exerts
itself between the sun and any planet, the attractive power of the sun;
but to speak more correctly, we should rather call this power in any
case the force, which acts between the sun and earth, between the sun
and Jupiter, between the earth and moon, &c. for both the bodies are
moved by the power acting between them, in the same manner, as when
two bodies are tied together by a rope, if that rope shrink by being
wet, or otherwise, and thereby cause the bodies to approach, by drawing
both, it will communicate to both the same degree of motion, and cause
them to approach with velocities reciprocally proportional to the
respective bodies. From this mutual action between the sun and planet
it follows, as has been observed above[246], that the sun and planet do
each move about their common center of gravity. Let A (in fig. 108.)
represent the sun, B a planet, C their common center of gravity. If
these bodies were once at rest, by their mutual attraction they would
directly approach each other with such velocities, that their common
center of gravity would remain at rest, and the two bodies would at
length meet in that point. If the planet B were to receive an impulse,
as in the direction of the line D E, this would prevent the two bodies
from falling together; but their common center of gravity would be
put into motion in the direction of the line C F equidistant from B E.
In this case Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ proves[247], that the sun and planet
would describe round their common center of gravity similar orbits,
while that center would proceed with an uniform motion in the line C
F; and so the system of the two bodies would move on with the center
of gravity without end. In order to keep the system in the same place,
it is necessary, that when the planet received its impulse in the
direction B E, the sun should also receive such an impulse the contrary
way, as might keep the center of gravity C without motion; for if these
began once to move without giving any motion to their common center of
gravity, that center would always remain fixed.

11. BY this may be understood in what manner the action between the sun
and planets is mutual. But farther, we have shewn above[248], that the
power, which acts between the sun and primary planets, is altogether of
the same nature with that, which acts between the earth and the bodies
at its surface, or between the earth and its parts, and with that which
acts between the primary planets and their secondary; therefore all
these actions must be ascribed to the same cause[249]. Again, it has
been already proved, that in different planets the force of the sun’s
action upon each at the same distance would be proportional to the
quantity of solid matter in the planet[250]; therefore the reaction
of each planet on the sun at the same distance, or the motion, which
the sun would receive from each planet, would also be proportional
to the quantity of matter in the planet; that is, these planets at
the same distance would act on the same body with degrees of strength
proportional to the quantity of solid matter in each.

[Illustration]

12. IN the next place, from what has been now proved, our great author
has deduced this farther consequence, no less surprizing than elegant;
that each of the particles, out of which the bodies of the sun and
planets are framed, exert their power of gravitation by the same law,
and in the same proportion to the distance, as the great bodies which
they compose. For this purpose he first demonstrates, that if a globe
were compounded of particles, which will attract the particles of any
other body reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of their distances,
the whole globe will attract the same in the reciprocal duplicate
proportion of their distances from the center of the globe; provided
the globe be of uniform density throughout[251]. And from this our
author deduces the reverse, that if a globe acts upon distant bodies by
the law just now specified, and the power of the globe is derived from
its being composed of attractive particles; each of those particles
will attract after the same proportion[252]. The manner of deducing
this is not set down at large by our author, but is as follows. The
globe is supposed to act upon the particles of a body without it
constantly in the reciprocal duplicate proportion of their distances
from its center; and therefore at the same distance from the globe, on
which side soever the body be placed, the globe will act equally upon
it. Now because, if the particles, of which the globe is composed,
acted upon those without in the reciprocal duplicate proportion of
their distances, the whole globe would act upon them in the same manner
as it does; therefore, if the particles of the globe have not all of
them that property, some must act stronger than in that proportion,
while others act weaker: and if this be the condition of the globe,
it is plain, that when the body attracted is in such a situation
in respect of the globe, that the greater number of the strongest
particles are nearest to it, the body will be more forcibly attracted;
than when by turning the globe about, the greater quantity of weak
particles should be nearest, though the distance of the body should
remain the same from the center of the globe. Which is contrary to what
was at first remarked, that the globe on all sides of it acts with the
same strength at the same distance. Whence it appears, that no other
constitution of the globe can agree to it.

13. FROM these propositions it is farther collected, that if all
the particles of one globe attract all the particles of another in
the proportion so often mentioned, the attracting globe will act
upon the other in the same proportion to the distance between the
center of the globe which attracts, and the center of that which is
attracted[253]: and farther, that this proportion holds true, though
either or both the globes be composed of dissimilar parts, some rarer
and some more dense; provided only, that all the parts in the same
globe equally distant from the center be homogeneous[254]. And also,
if both the globes attract each other[255]. All which place it beyond
contradiction, that this proportion obtains with as much exactness
near and contiguous to the surface of attracting globes, as at greater
distances from them.

14. THUS our author, without the pompous pretence of explaining the
cause of gravity, has made one very important step toward it, by
shewing that this power in the great bodies of the universe, is derived
from the same power being lodged in every particle of the matter which
composes them: and consequently, that this property is no less than
universal to all matter whatever, though the power be too minute to
produce any visible effects on the small bodies, wherewith we converse,
by their action on each other[256]. In the fixed stars indeed we have
no particular proof that they have this power; for we find no apperance
to demonstrate that they either act, or are acted upon by it. But
since this power is found to belong to all bodies, whereon we can make
observation; and we see that it is not to be altered by any change in
the form of bodies, but always accompanies them in every shape without
diminution, remaining ever proportional to the quantity of solid matter
in each; such a power must without doubt belong universally to all
matter.

15. THIS therefore is the universal law of matter; which recommends
it self no less for its great plainness and simplicity, than for the
surprizing discoveries it leads us to. By this principle we learn the
different weight, which the same body will have upon the surfaces
of the sun and of diverse planets; and by the same we can judge of
the composition of those celestial bodies, and know the density of
each; which is formed of the most compact, and which of the most rare
substance. Let the adversaries of this philosophy reflect here, whether
loading this principle with the appellation of an occult quality, or
perpetual miracle, or any other reproachful name, be sufficient to
dissuade us from cultivating it; since this quality, which they call
occult, leads to the knowledge of such things, that it would have
been reputed no less than madness for any one, before they had been
discovered, even to have conjectured that our faculties should ever
have reached so far.

16. SEE how all this naturally follows from the foregoing principles
in those planets, which have satellites moving about them. By the
times, in which these satellites perform their revolutions, compared
with their distances from their respective primary, the proportion
between the power, with which one primary attracts his satellites, and
the force with which any other attracts his will be known; and the
proportion of the power with which any planet attracts its secondary,
to the power with which it attracts a body at its surface is found,
by comparing the distance of the secondary planet from the center of
the primary, to the distance of the primary planet’s surface from the
same: and from hence is deduced the proportion between the power of
gravity upon the surface of one planet, to the gravity upon the surface
of another. By the like method of comparing the periodical time of a
primary planet about the sun, with the revolution of a satellite about
its primary, may be found the proportion of gravity, or of the weight
of any body upon the surface of the sun, to the gravity, or to the
weight of the same body upon the surface of the planet, which carries
about the satellite.

17. BY these kinds of computation it is found, that the weight of the
same body upon the surface of the sun will be about 23 times as great,
as here upon the surface of the earth; about 10⅗ times as great, as
upon the surface of Jupiter; and near 19 times as great, as upon the
surface of Saturn[257].

18. THE quantity of matter, which composes each of these bodies, is
proportional to the power it has upon a body at a given distance. By
this means it is found, that the sun contains 1067 times as much matter
as Jupiter; Jupiter 158⅔ times as much as the earth, and 2-5/6 times as
much as Saturn[258]. The diameter of the sun is about 92 times, that of
Jupiter about 9 times, and that of Saturn about 7 times the diameter of
the earth.

19. BY making a comparison between the quantity of matter in these
bodies and their magnitudes, to be found from their diameters, their
respective densities are readily deduced; the density of every body
being measured by the quantity of matter contained under the same bulk,
as has been above remarked[259]. Thus the earth is found 4¼ times
more dense than Jupiter; Saturn has between ⅔ and ¾ of the density of
Jupiter; but the sun has one fourth part only of the density of the
earth[260]. From which this observation is drawn by our author; that
the sun is rarified by its great heat, and that of the three planets
named, the more dense is nearer the sun than the more rare; as was
highly reasonable to expect, the densest bodies requiring the greatest
heat to agitate and put their parts in motion; as on the contrary, the
planets which are more rare, would be rendered unfit for their office,
by the intense heat to which the denser are exposed. Thus the waters
of our seas, if removed to the distance of Saturn from the sun, would
remain perpetually frozen; and if as near the sun as Mercury, would
constantly boil[261].

20. THE densities of the three planets Mercury, Venus, and Mars, which
have no satellites, cannot be expresly assigned; but from what is
found in the others, it is very probable, that they also are of such
different degrees of density, that universally the planet which is
nearest to the sun, is formed of the most compact substance.




~CHAP~. VI.

Of the FLUID PARTS of the PLANETS.


THIS globe, that we inhabit, is composed of two parts; the solid earth,
which affords us a foundation to dwell upon; and the seas and other
waters, that furnish rains and vapours necessary to render the earth
fruitful, and productive of what is requisite for the support of life.
And that the moon, though but a secondary planet, is composed in like
manner, is generally thought, from the different degrees of light
which appear on its surface; the parts of that planet, which reflect a
dim light, being supposed to be fluid, and to imbibe the sun’s rays,
while the solid parts reflect them more copiously. Some indeed do not
allow this to be a conclusive argument: but whether we can distinguish
the fluid part of the moon’s surface from the rest or not; yet it is
most probable that there are two such different parts, and with still
greater reason we may ascribe the like to the other primary planets,
which yet more nearly resemble our earth. The earth is also encompassed
by another fluid the air, and we have before remarked, that probably
the rest of the planets are surrounded by the like. These fluid parts
in particular engage our author’s attention, both by reason of some
remarkable appearances peculiar to them, and likewise of some effects
they have upon the whole bodies to which they belong.

2. FLUIDS have been already treated of in general, with respect to the
effect they have upon solid bodies moving in them[262]; now we must
consider them in reference to the operation of the power of gravity
upon them. By this power they are rendered weighty, like all other
bodies, in proportion to the quantity of matter, which is contained
in them. And in any quantity of a fluid the upper parts press upon
the lower as much, as any solid body would press on another, whereon
it should lie. But there is an effect of the pressure of fluids on
the bottom of the vessel, wherein they are contained, which I shall
particularly explain. The force supported by the bottom of such a
vessel is not simply the weight of the quantity of the fluid in the
vessel, but is equal to the weight of that quantity of the fluid, which
would be contained in a vessel of the same bottom and of equal width
throughout, when this vessel is filled up to the same height, as that
to which the vessel proposed is filled. Suppose water were contained
in the vessel A B C D (in fig. 109.) filled up to E F. Here it is
evident, that if a part of the bottom, as G H, which is directly under
any part of the space E F, be considered separately; it will appear
at once, that this part sustains the weight of as much of the fluid,
as stands perpendicularly over it up to the height of E F; that is,
the two perpendiculars G I and H K being drawn, the part G H of the
bottom will sustain the whole weight of the fluid included between
these two perpendiculars. Again, I say, every other part of the bottom
equally broad with this, will sustain as great a pressure. Let the
part L M be of the same breadth with G H. Here the perpendiculars
L O and M N being drawn, the quantity of water contained between
these perpendiculars is not so great, as that contained between the
perpendiculars G I and H K; yet, I say, the pressure on L M will be
equal to that on G H. This will appear by the following considerations.
It is evident, that if the part of the vessel between O and N were
removed, the water would immediately flow out, and the surface E F
would subside; for all parts of the water being equally heavy, it must
soon form itself to a level surface, if the form of the vessel, which
contains it, does not prevent. Therefore since the water is prevented
from rising by the side N O of the vessel, it is manifest, that it must
press against N O with some degree of force. In other words, the water
between the perpendiculars L O and M N endeavours to extend itself with
a certain degree of force; or more correctly, the ambient water presses
upon this, and endeavours to force this pillar or column of water into
a greater length. But since this column of water is sustained between
N O and L M, each of these parts of the vessel will be equally pressed
against by the power, wherewith this column endeavours to extend.
Consequently L M bears this force over and above the weight of the
column of water between L O and M N. To know what this expansive force
is, let the part O N of the vessel be removed, and the perpendiculars
L O and M N be prolonged; then by means of some pipe fixed over N O
let water be filled between these perpendiculars up to P Q an equal
height with E F. Here the water between the perpendiculars L P and M Q
is of an equal height with the highest part of the water in the vessel;
therefore the water in the vessel cannot by its pressure force it
up higher, nor can the water in this column subside; because, if it
should, it would raise the water in the vessel to a greater height than
itself. But it follows from hence, that the weight of water contained
between P O and Q N is a just balance to the force, wherewith the
column between L O and M N endeavours to extend. So the part L M of
the bottom, which sustains both this force and the weight of the water
between L O and M N, is pressed upon by a force equal to the united
weight of the water between L O and M N, and the weight of the water
between P O and Q N; that is, it is pressed on by a force equal to the
weight of all the water contained between L P and M Q. And this weight
is equal to that of the water contained between G I and H K, which is
the weight sustained by the part G H of the bottom. Now this being
true of every part of the bottom B C, it is evident, that if another
vessel R S T V be formed with a bottom R V equal to the bottom B C, and
be throughout its whole height of one and the same breadth; when this
vessel is filled with water to the same height, as the vessel A B C D
is filled, the bottoms of these two vessels shall be pressed upon with
equal force. If the vessel be broader at the top than at the bottom,
it is evident, that the bottom will bear the pressure of so much of
the fluid, as is perpendicularly over it, and the sides of the vessel
will support the rest. This property of fluids is a corollary from a
proposition of our author[263]; from whence also he deduces the effects
of the pressure of fluids on bodies resting in them. These are, that
any body heavier than a fluid will sink to the bottom of the vessel,
wherein the fluid is contained, and in the fluid will weigh as much as
its own weight exceeds the weight of an equal quantity of the fluid;
any body uncompressible of the same density with the fluid, will rest
any where in the fluid without suffering the least change either in
its place or figure from the pressure of such a fluid, but will remain
as undisturbed as the parts of the fluid themselves; but every body
of less density than the fluid will swim on its surface, a part only
being received within the fluid. Which part will be equal in bulk to
a quantity of the fluid, whose weight is equal to the weight of the
whole body; for by this means the parts of the fluid under the body
will suffer as great a pressure as any other parts of the fluid as much
below the surface as these.

3. IN the next place, in relation to the air, we have above made
mention, that the air surrounding the earth being an elastic fluid,
the power of gravity will have this effect on it, to make the lower
parts near the surface of the earth more compact and compressed
together by the weight of the air incumbent, than the higher parts,
which are pressed upon by a less quantity of the air, and therefore
sustain a less weight[264]. It has been also observed, that our author
has laid down a rule for computing the exact degree of density in
the air at all heights from the earth[265]. But there is a farther
effect from the air’s being compressed by the power of gravity, which
he has distinctly considered. The air being elastic and in a state
of compression, any tremulous body will propagate its motion to the
air, and excite therein vibrations, which will spread from the body
that occasions them to a great distance. This is the efficient cause
of sound: for that sensation is produced by the air, which, as it
vibrates, strikes against the organ of hearing. As this subject was
extremely difficult, so our great author’s success is surprizing.

4. OUR author’s doctrine upon this head I shall endeavour to explain
somewhat at large. But preliminary thereto must be shewn, what he has
delivered in general of pressure propagated through fluids; and also
what he has set down relating to that wave-like motion, which appears
upon the surface of water, when agitated by throwing any thing into it,
or by the reciprocal motion of the finger, &c.

5. CONCERNING the first, it is proved, that pressure is spread
through fluids, not only right forward in a streight line, but also
laterally, with almost the same ease and force. Of which a very obvious
exemplification by experiment is proposed: that is, to agitate the
surface of water by the reciprocal motion of the finger forwards and
backwards only; for though the finger have no circular motion given
it, yet the waves excited in the water will diffuse themselves on each
hand of the direction of the motion, and soon surround the finger. Nor
is what we observe in sounds unlike to this, which do not proceed in
straight lines only, but are heard though a mountain intervene, and
when they enter a room in any part of it, they spread themselves into
every corner; not by reflection from the walls, as some have imagined,
but as far as the sense can judge, directly from the place where they
enter.

6. HOW the waves are excited in the surface of stagnant water, may be
thus conceived. Suppose in any place, the water raised above the rest
in form of a small hillock; that water will immediately subside, and
raise the circumambient water above the level of the parts more remote,
to which the motion cannot be communicated under longer time. And
again, the water in subsiding will acquire, like all falling bodies, a
force, which will carry it below the level surface, till at length the
pressure of the ambient water prevailing, it will rise again, and even
with a force like to that wherewith it descended, which will carry it
again above the level. But in the mean time the ambient water before
raised will subside, as this did, sinking below the level; and in so
doing, will not only raise the water, which first subsided, but also
the water next without itself. So that now beside the first hillock, we
shall have a ring investing it, at some distance raised above the plain
surface likewise; and between them the water will be sunk below the
rest of the surface. After this, the first hillock, and the new made
annular rising, will descend; raising the water between them, which
was before depressed, and likewise the adjacent part of the surface
without. Thus will these annular waves be successively spread more
and more. For, as the hillock subsiding produces one ring, and that
ring subsiding raises again the hillock, and a second ring; so the
hillock and second ring subsiding together raise the first ring, and
a third; then this first and third ring subsiding together raise the
first hillock, the second ring, and a fourth; and so on continually,
till the motion by degrees ceases. Now it is demonstrated, that these
rings ascend and descend in the manner of a pendulum; descending with
a motion continually accelerated, till they become even with the plain
surface of the fluid, which is half the space they descend; and then
being retarded again by the same degrees as those, whereby they were
accelerated, till they are depressed below the plain surface, as much
as they were before raised above it: and that this augmentation and
diminution of their velocity proceeds by the same degrees, as that of
a pendulum vibrating in a cycloid, and whose length should be a fourth
part of the distance between any two adjacent waves: and farther, that
a new ring is produced every time a pendulum, whose length is four
times the former, that is, equal to the interval between the summits of
two waves, makes one oscillation or swing[266].

7. THIS now opens the way for understanding the motion consequent upon
the tremors of the air, excited by the vibrations of sonorous bodies:
which we must conceive to be performed in the following manner.

8. LET A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H (in fig. 110.) represent a series of
the particles of the air, at equal distances from each other. I K L
a musical chord, which I shall use for the tremulous and sonorous
body, to make the conception as simple as may be. Suppose this chord
stretched upon the points I and L, and forcibly drawn into the
situation I K L, so that it become contiguous to the particle A in its
middle point K: and let the chord from this situation begin to recoil,
pressing against the particle A, which will thereby be put into motion
towards B: but the particles A, B, C being equidistant, the elastic
power, by which B avoids A, is equal to, and balanced by the power, by
which it avoids C; therefore the elastic force, by which B is repelled
from A, will not put B into any degree of motion, till A is by the
motion of the chord brought nearer to B, than B is to C: but as soon as
that is done, the particle B will be moved towards C; and being made
to approach C, will in the next place move that; which will upon that
advance, put D likewise into motion, and so on: therefore the particle
A being moved by the chord, the following particles of the air B, C, D,
&c. will successively be moved. Farther, if the point K of the chord
moves forward with an accelerated velocity, so that the particle A
shall move against B with an advancing pace, and gain ground of it,
approaching nearer and nearer continually; A by approaching will press
more upon B, and give it a greater velocity likewise, by reason that as
the distance between the particles diminishes, the elastic power, by
which they fly each other, increases. Hence the particle B, as well as
A, will have its motion gradually accelerated, and by that means will
more and more approach to C. And from the same cause C will more and
more approach D; and so of the rest. Suppose now, since the agitation
of these particles has been shewn to be successive, and to follow one
another, that E be the remotest particle moved, while the chord is
moving from its curve situation I K L into that of a streight line, as
I k L; and F the first which remains unaffected, though just upon the
point of being put into motion. Then shall the particles A, B, C, D,
E, F, G, when the point K is moved into k, have acquired the rangement
represented by the adjacent points _a, b, c, d, e, f, g_: in which _a_
is nearer to _b_ than _b_ to _c_, and _b_ nearer to _c_ than _c_ to
_d_, and _c_ nearer to _d_ than _d_ to _e_ and _d_ nearer to _e_ than
_e_ to _f_, and lastly _e_ nearer to _f_ than _f_ to _g_.

9. BUT now the chord having recovered its rectilinear situation I k L,
the following motion will be changed, for the point K, which before
advanced with a motion more and more accelerated, though by the force
it has acquired it will go on to move the same way as before, till it
has advanced near as far forwards, as it was at first drawn backwards;
yet the motion of it will henceforth be gradually lessened. The effect
of which upon the particles _a, b, c, d, e, f, g_ will be, that by the
time the chord has made its utmost advance, and is upon the return,
these particles will be put into a contrary rangement; so that _f_
shall be nearer to _g_, than _e_ to _f_, and _e_ nearer to _f_ than _d_
to _e_; and the like of the rest, till you come to the first particles
_a_, _b_, whose distance will then be nearly or quite what it was at
first. All which will appear as follows. The present distance between
_a_ and _b_ is such, that the elastic power, by which _a_ repels _b_,
is strong enough to maintain that distance, though a advance with the
velocity, with which the string resumes its rectilinear figure; and
the motion of the particle _a_ being afterwards slower, the present
elasticity between _a_ and _b_ will be more than sufficient to preserve
the distance between them. Therefore while it accelerates _b_ it will
<DW44> _a_. The distance _b c_ will still diminish, till _b_ come about
as near to _c_, as it is from a at present; for after the distances
_a b_ and _b c_ are become equal, the particle _b_ will continue its
velocity superior to that of _c_ by its own power of inactivity, till
such time as the increase of elasticity between _b_ and _c_ more than
shall be between _a_ and _b_ shall suppress its motion: for as the
power of inactivity in _b_ made a greater elasticity necessary on the
side of a than on the side of _c_ to push _b_ forward, so what motion
_b_ has acquired it will retain by the same power of inactivity, till
it be suppressed by a greater elasticity on the side of _c_, than on
the side of _a_. But as soon as _b_ begins to slacken its pace the
distance of _b_ from c will widen as the distance _a b_ has already
done. Now as _a_ acts on _b_, so will _b_ on _c_, _c_ on _d_, &c. so
that the distances between all the particles _b, c, d, e, f, g_ will
be successively contracted into the distance of _a_ from _b_, and then
dilated again. Now because the time, in which the chord describes
this present half of its vibration, is about equal to that it took up
in describing the former; the particles _a_, _b_ will be as long in
dilating their distance, as before in contracting it, and will return
nearly to their original distance. And farther, the particles _b_, _c_,
which did not begin to approach so soon as _a_, _b_, are now about as
much longer, before they begin to recede; and likewise the particles
_c_, _d_, which began to approach after _b_, _c_, begin to separate
later. Whence it appears that the particles, whose distance began to be
lessened, when that of _a_, _b_ was first enlarged, viz. the particles
_f_, _g,_ should be about their nearest distance, when _a_ and _b_ have
recovered their prime interval. Thus will the particles _a, b, c, d, e,
f, g_ have changed their situation in the manner asserted. But farther,
as the particles _f_, _g_ or F, G gradually approach each other, they
will move by degrees the succeeding particles to as great a length, as
the particles A, B did by a like approach. So that, when the chord has
made its greatest advance, being arrived into the situation I ϰ L, the
particles moved by it will have the rangement noted by the points α, β,
γ, δ, ε, ζ, η, θ, λ, μ, ν, χ. Where α, β are at the original distance
of the particles in the line A H; ζ, η are the nearest of all, and the
distance ν χ is equal to that between α and β.

10. BY this time the chord I ϰ L begins to return, and the distance
between the particles α and β being enlarged to its original magnitude,
α has lost all that force it had acquired by its motion, being now at
rest; and therefore will return with the chord, making the distance
between α and β greater than the natural; for β will not return so
soon, because its motion forward is not yet quite suppressed, the
distance β γ not being already enlarged to its prime dimension: but the
recess of α, by diminishing the pressure upon β by its elasticity, will
occasion the motion of β to be stopt in a little time by the action of
γ, and then shall β begin to return: at which time the distance between
γ and δ shall by the superior action of δ above β be enlarged to the
dimension of the distance β γ, and therefore soon after to that of α β.
Thus it appears, that each of these particles goes on to move forward,
till its distance from the preceding one be equal to its original
distance; the whole chain α, β, γ, δ, ε, ζ, η, having an undulating
motion forward, which is stopt gradually by the excess of the expansive
power of the preceding parts above that of the hinder. Thus are these
parts successively stopt, as before they were moved; so that when the
chord has regained its rectilinear situation, the expansion of the
parts of the air will have advanced so far, that the interval between
ζ η, which at present is most contracted, will then be restored to its
natural size: the distances between η and θ, θ and λ, λ and μ, μ and ν,
ν and χ, being successively contracted into the present distance of ζ
from η, and again enlarged; so that the same effect shall be produced
upon the parts beyond ζ η, by the enlargement of the distance between
those two particles, as was occasioned upon the particles α, β, γ, δ,
ε, ζ, η, θ, λ, μ, ν, χ, by the enlargement of the distance α β to its
natural extent. And therefore the motion in the air will be extended
half as much farther as at present, and the distance between ν and χ
contracted into that, which is at present between ζ and η, all the
particles of the air in motion taking the rangement expressed in figure
111. by the points α, β, γ, δ, ε, ζ, η, θ, λ, μ, ν, χ, ϰ, ρ, σ, τ, φ
wherein the particles from α to χ have their distances from each other
gradually diminished, the distances between the particles ν, χ being
contracted the most from the natural distance between those particles,
and the distance between α, β as much augmented, and the distance
between the middle particles ζ, η becoming equal to the natural. The
particles π, ρ, ω τ, φ which follow χ, have their distances gradually
greater and greater, the particles ν, χ, π, ρ, σ, τ, φ being ranged
like the particles _a, b, c, d, e, f, g_, or like the particles ζ,
η, θ, λ, μ, ν, χ in the former figure. Here it will be understood,
by what has been before explained, that the particles ζ, η being at
their natural distance from each other, the particle ζ is at rest, the
particles ε, δ, λ, β, ϰ between them and the string being in motion
backward, and the rest of the particles η, θ, λ, μ, ν, χ, π, ρ, σ, τ
in motion forward: each of the particles between η and χ moving faster
than that, which immediately follows it; but of the particles from χ
to φ, on the contrary, those behind moving on faster than those, which
precede.

11. BUT now the string having recovered its rectilinear figure, though
it shall go on recoiling, till it return near to its first situation
I K L, yet there will be a change in its motion; so that whereas it
returned from the situation I ϰ L with an accelerated motion, its
motion shall from hence be retarded again by the same degrees, as
accelerated before. The effect of which change upon the particles of
the air will be this. As by the accelerated motion of the chord α
contiguous to it moved faster than β, γ, so as to make the interval α
β greater than the interval β γ, and from thence β was made likewise
to move faster than γ, and the distance between β and γ rendered
greater than the distance between γ and δ, and so of the rest; now the
motion of α being diminished, β shall overtake it, and the distance
between α and β be reduced into that, which is at present between β
and γ, the interval between β and γ being inlarged into the present
distance between α and β; but when the interval β γ is increased to
that, which is at present between α and β γ the distance between γ
and δ shall be enlarged to the present distance between γ and β,
and the distance between δ and ι inlarged into the present distance
between γ and δ; and the same of the rest. But the chord more and more
slackening its pace, the distance between α and β shall be more and
more diminished; and in consequence of that the distance between β and
γ shall be again contracted, first into its present dimension, and
afterwards into a narrower space; while the interval γ δ shall dilate
into that at present between α and β, and as soon as it is so much
enlarged, it shall contract again. Thus by the reciprocal expansion
and contraction of the air between α and ζ, by that time the chord is
got into the situation I K L, the interval ζ η shall be expanded into
the present distance between α and β; and by that time likewise the
present distance of α from β will be contracted into their natural
interval: for this distance will be about the same time in contracting
it self, as has been taken up in its dilatation; seeing the string will
be as long in returning from its rectilinear figure, as it has been in
recovering it from its situation I ϰ L. This is the change which will
be made in the particles between α and ζ. As for those between ζ and
χ, because each preceding particle advances faster than that, which
immediately follows it, their distances will successively be dilated
into that, which is at present between ζ and η. And as soon as any two
particles are arrived at their natural distance, the hindermost of them
shall be stopt, and immediately after return, the distances between
the returning particles being greater than the natural. And this
dilatation of these distances shall extend so far, by that time the
chord is returned into its first situation I K L, that the particles ι
χ shall be removed to their natural distance. But the dilatation of ν
χ shall contract the interval τ φ into that at present between ν and
χ, and the contraction of the distance between those two particles τ
and φ will agitate a part of the air beyond; so that when the chord is
returned into the situation I K L, having made an intire vibration, the
moved particles of the air will take the rangement expressed by the
points, _l, m, n, o, p, q, r, s, t, u, w, x, y, z_, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8: in which _l m_, are at the natural distance of the particles, the
distance _m n_ greater than _l m_ and _n o_ greater than _m n_, and so
on, till you come to _q r_, the widest of all: and then the distances
gradually diminish not only to the natural distance, as _w x_, but till
they are contracted as much as χ τ was before; which falls out in the
points 2, 3, from whence the distances augment again, till you come to
the part of the air untouched.

12. THIS is the motion, into which the air is put, while the chord
makes one vibration, and the whole length of air thus agitated in
the time of one vibration of the chord our author calls the length
of one pulse. When the chord goes on to make another vibration, it
will not only continue to agitate the air at present in motion, but
spread the pulsation of the air as much farther, and by the same
degrees, as before. For when the chord returns into its rectilinear
situation I _k_ L, _l m_ shall be brought into its most contracted
state, _q r_ now in the state of greatest dilatation shall be reduced
to its natural distance, the points _w_, _x_ now at their natural
distance shall be at their greatest distance, the points 2, 3 now most
contracted enlarged to their natural distance, and the points 7, 8
reduced to their most contracted state: and the contraction of them
will carry the agitation of the air as far beyond them, as that motion
was carried from the chord, when it first moved out of the situation
I K L into its rectilinear figure. When the chord is got into the
situation I ϰ L, _l m_ shall recover its natural dimensions, _q r_ be
reduced to its state of greatest contraction, _w x_ brought to its
natural dimension, the distance 2 3 enlarged to the utmost, and the
points 7, 8 shall have recovered their natural distance; and by thus
recovering themselves they shall agitate the air to as great a length
beyond them, as it was moved beyond the chord, when it first came into
the situation I ϰ L. When the chord is returned back again into its
rectilinear situation, _l m_ shall be in its utmost dilatation, _q r_
restored again to its natural distance, _w x_ reduced into its state of
greatest contraction, 2 3 shall recover its natural dimension, and 7 8
be in its state of greatest dilatation. By which means the air shall be
moved as far beyond the points 7, 8, as it was moved beyond the chord,
when it before made its return back to its rectilinear situation; for
the particles 7, 8 have been changed from their state of rest and
their natural distance into a state of contraction, and then have
proceeded to the recovery of their natural distance, and after that to
a dilatation of it, in the same manner as the particles contiguous to
the chord were agitated before. In the last place, when the chord is
returned into the situation I K L, the particles of air from _l_ to δ
shall acquire their present rangement, and the motion of the air be
extended as much farther. And the like will happen after every compleat
vibration of the string.

13. CONCERNING this motion of sound, our author shews how to compute
the velocity thereof, or in what time it will reach to any proposed
distance from the sonorous body. For this he requires to know the
height of air, having the same density with the parts here at the
surface of the earth, which we breath, that would be equivalent in
weight to the whole incumbent atmosphere. This is to be found by the
barometer, or common weatherglass. In that instrument quicksilver is
included in a hollow glass cane firmly closed at the top. The bottom is
open, but immerged into quicksilver contained in a vessel open to the
air. Care is taken when the lower end of the cane is immerged, that the
whole cane be full of quicksilver, and that no air insinuate itself.
When the instrument is thus fixed, the quicksilver in the cane being
higher than that in the vessel, if the top of the cane were open, the
fluid would soon sink out of the glass cane, till it came to a level
with that in the vessel. But the top of the cane being closed up, so
that the air, which has free liberty to press on the quicksilver in
the vessel, cannot bear at all on that, which is within the cane, the
quicksilver in the cane will be suspended to such a height, as to
balance the pressure of the air on the quicksilver in the vessel. Here
it is evident, that the weight of the quicksilver in the glass cane is
equivalent to the pressure of so much of the air, as is perpendicularly
over the hollow of the cane; for if the cane be opened that the air may
enter, there will be no farther use of the quicksilver to sustain the
pressure of the air without; for the quicksilver in the cane, as has
already been observed, will then subside to a level with that without.
Hence therefore if the proportion between the density of quicksilver
and of the air we breath be known, we may know what height of such air
would form a column equal in weight to the column of quicksilver within
the glass cane. When the quicksilver is sustained in the barometer
at the height of 30 inches, the height of such a column of air will
be about 29725 feet; for in this case the air has about 1/870 of the
density of water, and the density of quicksilver exceeds that of water
about 13⅔ times, so that the density of quicksilver exceeds that of the
air about 11890 times; and so many times 30 inches make 29725 feet. Now
Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ determines, that while a pendulum of the length of
this column should make one vibration or swing, the space, which any
sound will have moved, shall bear to this length the same proportion,
as the circumference of a circle bears to the diameter thereof;
that is, about the proportion of 355 to 113[267]. Only our author
here considers singly the gradual progress of sound in the air from
particle to particle in the manner we have explained, without taking
into consideration the magnitude of those particles. And though there
requires time for the motion to be propagated from one particle to
another, yet it is communicated to the whole of the same particle in an
instant: therefore whatever proportion the thickness of these particles
bears to their distance from each other, in the same proportion will
the motion of sound be swifter. Again the air we breath is not simply
composed of the elastic part, by which sound is conveyed, but partly of
vapours, which are of a different nature; and in the computation of the
motion of sound we ought to find the height of a column of this pure
air only, whose weight should be equal to the weight of the quicksilver
in the cane of the barometer, and this pure air being a part only of
that we breath, the column of this pure air will be higher than 29725
feet. On both these accounts the motion of sound is found to be about
1142 feet in one second of time, or near 13 miles in a minute, whereas
by the computation proposed above, it should move but 979 feet in one
second.

14. WE may observe here, that from these demonstrations of our author
it follows, that all sounds whether acute or grave move equally swift,
and that sound is swiftest, when the quicksilver stands highest in the
barometer.

15. THUS much of the appearances, which are caused in these fluids from
their gravitation toward the earth. They also gravitate toward the
moon; for in the last chapter it has been proved, that the gravitation
between the earth and moon is mutual, and that this gravitation of
the whole bodies arises from that power acting in all their parts; so
that every particle of the moon gravitates toward the earth, and every
particle of the earth toward the moon. But this gravitation of these
fluids toward the moon produces no sensible effect, except only in the
sea, where it causes the tides.

16. THAT the tides depend upon the influence of the moon has been the
receiv’d opinion of all antiquity; nor is there indeed the least shadow
of reason to suppose otherwise, considering how steadily they accompany
the moon’s course. Though how the moon caused them, and by what
principle it was enabled to produce so distinguish’d an appearance,
was a secret left for this philosophy to unfold: which teaches, that
the moon is not here alone concerned, but that the sun likewise has a
considerable share in their production; though they have been generally
ascribed to the other luminary, because its effect is greatest, and by
that means the tides more immediately suit themselves to its motion;
the sun discovering its influence more by enlarging or restraining the
moon’s power, than by any distinct effects. Our author finds the power
of the moon to bear to the power of the sun about the proportion of
4½ to 1. This he deduces from the observations made at the mouth of
the river Avon, three miles from Bristol, by Captain STURMEY, and at
Plymouth by Mr. COLEPRESSE, of the height to which the water is raised
in the conjunction and opposition of the luminaries, compared with the
elevation of it, when the moon is in either quarter; the first being
caused by the united actions of the sun and moon, and the other by the
difference of them, as shall hereafter be shewn.

17. THAT the sun should have a like effect on the sea, as the moon, is
very manifest; since the sun likewise attracts every single particle,
of which this earth is composed. And in both luminaries since the power
of gravity is reciprocally in the duplicate proportion of the distance,
they will not draw all the parts of the waters in the same manner;
but must act upon the nearest parts stronger, than upon the remotest,
producing by this inequality an irregular motion. We shall now attempt
to shew how the actions of the sun and moon on the waters, by being
combined together, produce all the appearances observed in the tides.

18. TO begin therefore, the reader will remember what has been said
above, that if the moon without the sun would have described an orbit
concentrical to the earth, the action of the sun would make the orbit
oval, and bring the moon nearer to the earth at the new and full,
than at the quarters[268]. Now our excellent author observes, that
if instead of one moon, we suppose a ring of moons, contiguous and
occupying the whole orbit of the moon, his demonstration would still
take place, and prove that the parts of this ring in passing from the
quarter to the conjunction or opposition would be accelerated, and be
retarded again in passing from the conjunction or opposition to the
next quarter. And as this effect does not depend on the magnitude of
the bodies, whereof the ring is composed, the same would hold, though
the magnitude of these moons were so far to be diminished, and their
number increased, till they should form a fluid[269]. Now the earth
turns round continually upon its own center, causing thereby the
alternate change of day and night, while by this revolution each part
of the earth is successively brought toward the sun, and carried off
again in the space of 24 hours. And as the sea revolves round along
with the earth itself in this diurnal motion, it will represent in some
sort such a fluid ring.

19. BUT as the water of the sea does not move round with so much
swiftness, as would carry it about the center of the earth in the
circle it now describes, without being supported by the body of the
earth; it will be necessary to consider the water under three distinct
cases. The first case shall suppose the water to move with the degree
of swiftness, required to carry a body round the center of the
earth disingaged from it in a circle at the distance of the earth’s
semidiameter, like another moon. The second case is, that the waters
make but one turn about the axis of the earth in the space of a month,
keeping pace with the moon; so that all parts of the water should
preserve continually the same situation in respect of the moon. The
third case shall be the real one of the waters moving with a velocity
between these two, neither so swift as the first case requires, nor so
slow as the second.

20. IN the first case the waters, like the body which they equalled
in velocity, by the action of the moon would be brought nearer the
center under and opposite to the moon, than in the parts in the middle
between these eastward or westward. That such a body would so alter
its distance by the moon’s action upon it, is clear from what has
been mentioned of the like changes in the moon’s motion caused by
the sun[270]. And computation shews, that the difference between the
greatest and least distance of such a body would not be much above 4½
feet. But in the second case, where all the parts of the water preserve
the same situation continually in respect of the moon, the weight of
those parts under and opposite to the moon will be diminished by the
moon’s action, and the parts in the middle between these will have
their weight increased: this being effected just in the same manner,
as the sun diminishes the attraction of the moon towards the earth in
the conjunction and opposition, but increases that attraction in the
quarters. For as the first of these consequences from the sun’s action
on the moon is occasioned by the moon’s being attracted by the sun in
the conjunction more than the earth, and in the opposition less than
it, and therefore in the common motion of the earth and moon, the moon
is made to advance toward the sun in one case too fast, and in the
other is left as it were behind; so the earth will not have its middle
parts drawn towards the moon so strongly as the nearer parts, and yet
more forcibly than the remotest: and therefore since the earth and
moon move each month round their common center of gravity[271], while
the earth moves round this center, the same effect will be produced,
on the parts of the water nearest to that center or to the moon, as
the moon feels from the sun when in conjunction, and the water on the
contrary side of the earth will be affected by the moon, as the moon is
by the sun, when in opposition[272]; that is, in both cases the weight
of the water, or its propensity towards the center of the earth, will
be diminished. The parts in the middle between these will have their
weight increased, by being pressed towards the center of the earth
through the obliquity of the moon’s action upon them to its action
upon the earth’s center, just as the sun increases the gravitation
of the moon in the quarters from the same cause[273]. But now it is
manifest, that where the weight of the same quantity of water is least,
there it will be accumulated; while the parts, which have the greatest
weight, will subside. Therefore in this case there would be no tide or
alternate rising and falling of the water, but the water would form it
self into an oblong figure, whose axis prolonged would pass through the
moon. By Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~’s computation the excess of this axis above
the diameters perpendicular to it, that is, the height of the waters
under and opposite to the moon above their height in the middle between
these places eastward or westward caused by the moon, is about 8⅔ feet.

21. THUS the difference of height in this latter supposition is little
short of twice that difference in the preceding. But the case of the
sea is a middle between these two: for a body, which should revolve
round the center of the earth at the distance of a semidiameter without
pressing on the earth’s surface, must perform its period in less than
an hour and half, whereas the earth turns round but once in a day; and
in the case of the waters keeping pace with the moon it should turn
round but once in a month: so that the real motion of the water is
between the motions required in these two cases. Again, if the waters
moved round as swiftly as the first case required, their weight would
be wholly taken off by their motion; for this case supposes the body
to move so, as to be kept revolving in a circle round the earth by
the power of gravity without pressing on the earth at all, so that
its motion just supports its weight. But if the power of gravity had
been only 1/289 part of what it is, the body could have moved thus
without pressing on the earth, and have been as long in moving round,
as the earth it self is. Consequently the motion of the earth takes off
from the weight of the water in the middle between the poles, where
its motion is swiftest, 1/289 part of its weight and no more. Since
therefore in the first case the weight of the waters must be intirely
taken off by their motion, and by the real motion of the earth they
lose only 1/289 part thereof, the motion of the water will so little
diminish their weight, that their figure will much nearer resemble
the case of their keeping pace with the moon than the other. Upon
the whole, if the waters moved with the velocity necessary to carry
a body round the center of the earth at the distance of the earth’s
semidiameter without bearing on its surface, the water would be lowest
under the moon, and rise gradually as it moved on with the earth
eastward, till it came half way toward the place opposite to the moon;
from thence it would subside again, till it came to the opposition,
where it would become as low as at first; afterwards it would rise
again, till it came half way to the place under the moon; and from
hence it would subside, till it came a second time under the moon. But
in case the water kept pace with the moon, it would be highest where
in the other case it is lowest, and lowest where in the other it is
highest; therefore the diurnal motion of the earth being between the
motions of these two cases, it will cause the highest place of the
water to fall between the places of the greatest height in these two
cases. The water as it passes from under the moon shall for some time
rise, but descend again before it arrives half way to the opposite
place, and shall come to its least height before it becomes opposite
to the moon; then it shall rise again, continuing so to do till it has
passed the place opposite to the moon, but subside before it comes
to the middle between the places opposite to and under the moon; and
lastly it shall come to its lowest, before it comes a second time
under the moon. If A (in fig. 112, 113, 114.) represent the moon, B
the center of the earth, the oval C D E F in fig. 112. will represent
the situation of the water in the first case; but if the water kept
pace with the moon, the line C D E F in fig. 113. would represent
the situation of the water; but the line C D E F in fig. 114. will
represent the same in the real motion of the water, as it accompanies
the earth in its diurnal rotation: in all these figures C and E being
the places where the water is lowest, and D and F the places where it
is highest. Pursuant to this determination it is found, that on the
shores, which lie exposed to the open sea, the high water usually falls
out about three hours after the moon has passed the meridian of each
place.

22. LET this suffice in general for explaining the manner, in which the
moon acts upon the seas. It is farther to be noted, that these effects
are greatest, when the moon is over the earth’s equator[274], that
is, when it shines perpendicularly upon the parts of the earth in the
middle between the poles. For if the moon were placed over either of
the poles, it could have no effect upon the water to make it ascend and
descend. So that when the moon declines from the equator toward either
pole, it’s action must be something diminished, and that the more, the
farther it declines. The tides likewise will be greatest, when the moon
is nearest to the earth, it’s action being then the strongest.

23. THUS much of the action of the moon. That the sun should produce
the very same effects, though in a less degree, is too obvious to
require a particular explanation: but as was remarked before, this
action of the sun being weaker than that of the moon, will cause the
tides to follow more nearly the moon’s course, and principally shew it
self by heightening or diminishing the effects of the other luminary.
Which is the occasion, that the highest tides are found about the
conjunction and opposition of the luminaries, being then produced by
their united action, and the weakest tides about the quarters of the
moon; because the moon in this case raising the water where the sun
depresses it, and depressing it where the sun raises it, the stronger
action of the moon is in part retunded and weakened by that of the sun.
Our author computes that the sun will add near two feet to the height
of the water in the first case, and in the other take from it as much.
However the tides in both comply with the same hour of the moon. But at
other times, between the conjunction or opposition and quarters, the
time deviates from that forementioned, towards the hour in which the
sun would make high water, though still it keeps much nearer to the
moon’s hour than to the sun’s.

24. AGAIN the tides have some farther varieties from the situation of
the places where they happen northward or southward. Let _p_ P (in fig.
115.) represent the axis, on which the earth daily revolves, let _h_
_p_ H P represent the figure of the water, and let _n_ B N D be a globe
inscribed within this figure. Suppose the moon to be advanced from the
equator toward the north pole, so that _h_ H the axis of the figure of
the water _p_ A H P E _h_ shall decline towards the north pole N; take
any place G nearer to the north pole than to the south, and from the
center of the earth C draw C G F; then will G F denote the altitude
to which the water is raised by the tide, when the moon is above the
horizon: in the space of twelve hours, the earth having turned half
round its axis, the place G will be removed to _g_; but the axis _h_
H will have kept its place preserving its situation in respect of the
moon, at least will have moved no more than the moon has done in that
time, which it is not necessary here to take into consideration. Now
in this case the height of the water will be equal to _g_ _f_, which
is not so great as G F. But whereas G F is the altitude at high water,
when the moon is above the horizon, _g_ _f_ will be the altitude of the
same, when the moon is under the horizon. The contrary happens toward
the south pole, for K L is less than _k_ _l_. Hence is proved, that
when the moon declines from the equator, in those places, which are on
the same side of the equator as the moon, the tides are greater, when
the moon is above the horizon, than when under it; and the contrary
happens on the other side of the equator.

25. NOW from these principles may be explained all the known
appearances in the tides; only by the assistance of this additional
remark, that the fluctuating motion, which the water has in flowing
and ebbing, is of a durable nature, and would continue for some time,
though the action of the luminaries should cease; for this prevents
the difference between the tide when the moon is above the horizon,
and the tide when the moon is below it from being so great, as the
rule laid down requires. This likewise makes the greatest tides not
exactly upon the new and full moon, but to be a tide or two after; as
at Bristol and Plymouth they are found the third after.

26. THIS doctrine farther shews us, why not only the spring tides fall
out about the new and full moon, and the neap tides about the quarters;
but likewise how it comes to pass, that the greatest spring tides
happen about the equinoxes; because the luminaries are then one of them
over the equator, and the other not far from it. It appears too, why
the neap tides, which accompany these, are the least of all, for the
sun still continuing over the equator continues to have the greatest
power of lessening the moon’s action, and the moon in the quarters
being far removed toward one of the poles, has its power thereby
weakned.

27. MOREOVER the action of the moon being stronger, when near the
earth, than when more remote; if the moon, when new suppose, be at its
nearest distance from the earth, it shall when at the full be farthest
off; whence it is, that two of the very largest spring tides do never
immediately succeed each other.

28. BECAUSE the sun in its passage from the winter solstice to the
summer recedes from the earth, and passing from the summer solstice
to the winter approaches it, and is therefore nearer the earth before
the vernal equinox than after, but nearer after the autumnal equinox
than before; the greatest tides oftner precede the vernal equinox than
follow it, and in the autumnal equinox on the contrary they oftner
follow it than come before it.

29. THE altitude, to which the water is raised in the open ocean,
corresponds very well to the forementioned calculations; for as it was
shewn, that the water in spring tides should rise to the height of 10
or 11 feet, and the neap tides to 6 or 7; accordingly in the Pacific,
Atlantic and Ethiopic oceans in the parts without the tropics, the
water is observed to rise about 6, 9, 12 or 15 feet. In the Pacific
ocean this elevation is said to be greater than in the other, as it
ought to be by reason of the wide extent of that sea. For the same
reason in the Ethiopic ocean between the tropics the ascent of the
water is less than without, by reason of the narrowness of the sea
between the coasts of Africa and the southern parts of America. And
islands in such narrow seas, if far from shore, have less tides than
the coasts. But now in those ports where the water flows in with great
violence upon fords and shoals, the force it acquires by that means
will carry it to a much greater height, so as to make it ascend and
descend to 30, 40 or even 50 feet and more; instances of which we have
at Plymouth, and in the Severn near Chepstow; at St. Michael’s and
Auranches in Normandy; at Cambay and Pegu in the East Indies.

30. AGAIN the tides take a considerable time in passing through long
straits, and shallow places. Thus the tide, which is made on the west
coast of Ireland and on the coast of Spain at the third hour after the
moon’s coming to the meridian, in the ports eastward toward the British
channel falls out later, and as the flood passes up that channel still
later and later, so that the tide takes up full twelve hours in coming
up to London bridge.

31. IN the last place tides may come to the same port from different
seas, and as they may interfere with each other, they will produce
particular effects. Suppose the tide from one sea come to a port at the
third hour after the moon’s passing the meridian of the place, but from
another sea to take up six hours more in its passage. Here one tide
will make high water, when by the other it should be lowest; so that
when the moon is over the equator, and the two tides are equal, there
will be no rising and falling of the water at all; for as much as the
water is carried off by one tide, it will be supplied by the other.
But when the moon declines from the equator, the same way as the port
is situated, we have shewn that of the two tides of the ocean, which
are made each day, that tide, which is made when the moon is above the
horizon, is greater than the other. Therefore in this case, as four
tides come to this port each day the two greatest will come on the
third, and on the ninth hour after the moon’s passing the meridian, and
the two least at the fifteenth and at the twenty first hour. Thus from
the third to the ninth hour more water will be in this port by the two
greatest tides than from the ninth to the fifteenth, or from the twenty
first to the following third hour, where the water is brought by one
great and one small tide; but yet there will be more water brought
by these tides, than what will be found between the two least tides,
that is, between the fifteenth and twenty first hour. Therefore in the
middle between the third and ninth hour, or about the moon’s setting,
the water will be at its greatest height; in the middle between the
ninth and fifteenth, as also between the twenty first and following
third hour it will have its mean height; and be lowest in the middle
between the fifteenth and twenty first hour, that is, at the moon’s
rising. Thus here the water will have but one flood and one ebb each
day. When the moon is on the other side of the equator, the flood will
be turned into ebb, and the ebb into flood; the high water falling
out at the rising of the moon, and the low water at the setting. Now
this is the case of the port of Batsham in the kingdom of Tunquin in
the East Indies; to which port there are two inlets, one between the
continent and the islands which are called the Manillas, and the other
between the continent and Borneo.

32. THE next thing to be considered is the effect, which these fluids
of the planets have upon the solid part of the bodies to which they
belong. And in the first place I shall shew, that it was necessary upon
account of these fluid parts to form the bodies of the planets into a
figure something different from that of a perfect globe. Because the
diurnal rotation, which our earth performs about its axis, and the
like motion we see in some of the other planets, (which is an ample
conviction that they all do the like) will diminish the force, with
which bodies are attracted upon all the parts of their surfaces, except
at the very poles, upon which they turn. Thus a stone or other weighty
substance resting upon the surface of the earth, by the force which it
receives from the motion communicated to it by the earth, if its weight
prevented not, would continue that motion in a straight line from the
point where it received it, and according to the direction, in which it
was given, that is, in a line which touches the surface at that point;
insomuch that it would move off from the earth in the same manner, as
a weight fasten’d to a string and whirled about endeavours continually
to recede from the center of motion, and would forthwith remove it self
to a greater distance from it, if loosed from the string which retains
it. And farther, as the centrifugal force, with which such a weight
presses from the center of its motion, is greater, by how much greater
the velocity is, with which it moves; so such a body, as I have been
supposing to lie on the earth, would recede from it with the greater
force, the greater the velocity is, with which the part of the earth’s
surface it rests upon is moved, that is, the farther distant it is from
the poles. But now the power of gravity is great enough to prevent
bodies in any part of the earth from being carried off from it by this
means; however it is plain that bodies having an effort contrary to
that of gravity, though much weaker than it, their weight, that is,
the degree of force, with which they are pressed to the earth, will
be diminished thereby, and be the more diminished, the greater this
contrary effort is; or in other words, the same body will weigh heavier
at either of the poles, than upon any other part of the earth; and if
any body be removed from the pole towards the equator, it will lose of
its weight more and more, and be lightest of all at the equator, that
is, in the middle between the poles.

33. THIS now is easily applied to the waters of the seas, and shews
that the water under the poles will press more forcibly to the earth,
than at or near the equator: and consequently that which presses
least, must give place, till by ascending it makes room for receiving
a greater quantity, which by its additional weight may place the whole
upon a ballance. To illustrate this more particularly I shall make
use of fig. 116 In which let A C B D be a circle, by whose revolution
about the diameter A B a globe should be formed, representing a globe
of solid earth. Suppose this globe covered on all sides with water to
the same height, suppose that of E A or B F, at which distance the
circle E G F H surrounds the circle A C B D; then it is evident, if the
globe of earth be at rest, the water which surrounds it will rest in
that situation. But if the globe be turned incessantly about its axis
A B, and the water have likewise the same motion, it is also evident,
from what has been explained, that the water between the circles E H
F G and A D B C will remain no longer in the present situation, the
parts of it between H and D, and between G and C being by this rotation
become lighter, than the parts between E and A and between B and F; so
that the water over the poles A and B must of necessity subside, and
the water be accumulated over D and C, till the greater quantity in
these latter places supply the defect of its weight. This would be the
case, were the globe all covered with water. And the same figure of the
surface would also be preserved, if some part of the water adjoining
to the globe in any part of it were turned into solid earth, as is too
evident to need any proof; because the parts of the water remaining
at rest, it is the same thing, whether they continue in the state of
being easily separable, which denominates them fluid, or were to be
consolidated together, so as to make a hard body: and this, though the
water should in some places be thus consolidated, even to the surface
of it. Which shews that the form of the solid part of the earth makes
no alteration in the figure the water will take: and by consequence in
order to the preventing some parts of the earth from being entirely
overflowed, and other parts quite deserted, the solid parts of the
earth must have given them much the same figure, as if the whole earth
were covered on all sides with water.

34. FARTHER, I say, this figure of the earth is the same, as it would
receive, were it entirely a globe of water, provided that water were of
the same density as the substance of the globe. For suppose the globe A
C B D to be liquified, and that the globe E H F G, now entirely water,
by its rotation about its axis should receive such a figure as we have
been describing, and then the globe A C B D should be consolidated
again, the figure of the water would plainly not be altered, by such a
consolidation.

35. BUT from this last observation our author is enabled to determine
the proportion between the axis of the earth drawn from pole to pole,
and the diameter of the equator, upon the supposition that all the
parts of the earth are of equal density; which he does by computing in
the first place the proportion of the centrifugal force of the parts
under the equator to the power of gravity; and then by considering
the earth as a spheroid, made by the revolution of an ellipsis about
its lesser axis, that is, supposing the line M I L K to be an exact
ellipsis, from which it can differ but little, by reason that the
difference between the lesser axis M L and the greater I K is but very
small. From this supposition, and what was proved before, that all the
particles which compose the earth have the attracting power explained
in the preceding chapter, he finds at what distance the parts under the
equator ought to be removed from the center, that the force, with which
they shall be attracted to the center, diminished by their centrifugal
force, shall be sufficient to keep those parts in a ballance with those
which lie under the poles. And upon the supposition of all the parts of
the earth having the same degree of density, the earth’s surface at the
equator must be above 17 miles more distant from the center, than at
the poles[275].

36. AFTER this it is shewn, from the proportion of the equatorial
diameter of the earth to its axis, how the same may be determined of
any other planet, whose density in comparison of the density of the
earth, and the time of its revolution about its axis, are known. And
by the rule delivered for this, it is found, that the diameter of the
equator in Jupiter should bear to its axis about the proportion of 10
to 9[276], and accordingly this planet appears of an oval form to the
astronomers. The most considerable effects of this spheroidical figure
our author takes likewise into consideration; one of which is that
bodies are not equally heavy in all distances from the poles; but near
the equator, where the distance from the center is greatest, they are
lighter than towards the poles: and nearly in this proportion, that
the actual power, by which they are drawn to the center, resulting
from the difference between their absolute gravity and centrifugal
force, is reciprocally as the distance from the center. That this may
not appear to contradict what has before been said of the alteration
of the power of gravity, in proportion to the change of the distance
from the center, it is proper carefully to remark, that our author
has demonstrated three things relating hereto: the first is, that
decrease of the power of gravity as we recede from the center, which
has been fully explained in the last chapter, upon supposition that
the earth and planets are perfect spheres, from which their difference
is by many degrees too little to require notice for the purposes there
intended: the next is, that whether they be perfect spheres, or exactly
such spheroids as have now been mentioned, the power of gravity, as
we descend in the same line to the center, is at all distances as the
distance from the center, the parts of the earth above the body by
drawing the body towards them lessening its gravitation towards the
center[277]; and both these assertions relate to gravity alone: the
third is what we mentioned in this place, that the actual force on
different parts of the surface, with which bodies are drawn to the
center, is in the proportion here assigned[278].

38. THE next effect of this figure of the earth is an obvious
consequence of the former: that pendulums of the same length do not in
different distances from the pole make their vibrations in the same
time; but towards the poles, where the gravity is strongest, they move
quicker than near the equator, where they are less impelled to the
center; and accordingly pendulums, that measure the same time by their
vibrations, must be shorter near the poles than at a greater distance.
Both which deductions are found true in fact; of which our author has
recounted particularly several experiments, in which it was found, that
clocks exactly adjusted to the true measure of time at Paris, when
transported nearer to the equator, became erroneous and moved too slow,
but were reduced to their true motion by contracting their pendulums.
Our author is particular in remarking, how much they lost of their
motion, while the pendulums remained unaltered; and what length the
observers are said to have shortened them, to bring them to time. And
the experiments, which appear to be most carefully made, shew the earth
to be raised in the middle between the poles, as much as our author
found it by his computation[279].

39. THESE experiments on the pendulum our author has been very exact
in examining, inquiring particularly how much the extension of the
rod of the pendulum by the great heats in the torrid zone might make
it necessary to shorten it. For by an experiment made by PICART, and
another made by DE LA HIRE, heat, though not very intense, was found
to increase the length of rods of iron. The experiment of PICART was
made with a rod one foot long, which in winter, at the time of frost,
was found to increase in length by being heated at the fire. In the
experiment of DE LA HIRE a rod of six foot in length was found, when
heated by the summer sun only, to grow to a greater length, than it
had in the aforesaid cold season. From which observations a doubt has
been raised, whether the rod of the pendulums in the aforementioned
experiments was not extended by the heat of those warm climates to all
that excess of length, the observers found themselves obliged to lessen
them by. But the experiments now mentioned shew the contrary. For in
the first of them the rod of a foot long was lengthened no more than
1/9 part of what the pendulum under the equator must be diminished;
and therefore a rod of the length of the pendulum would not have been
extended above ⅓ of that length. In the experiment of DE LA HIRE,
where the heat was less, the rod of six foot long was extended no more
than 3/10 of what the pendulum must be shortened; so that a rod of the
length of the pendulum would not have gained above 3/20 or 1/7 of that
length. And the heat in this latter experiment, though less than in
the former, was yet greater than the rod of a pendulum can ordinarily
contract in the hottest country; for metals receive a great heat when
exposed to the open sun, certainly much greater than that of a human
body. But pendulums are not usually so exposed, and without doubt in
these experiments were kept cool enough to appear so to the touch;
which they would do in the hottest place, if lodged in the shade. Our
author therefore thinks it enough to allow about 1/10 of the difference
observed upon account of the greater warmth of the pendulum.

40. THERE is a third effect, which the water has on the earth by
changing its figure, that is taken notice of by our author; for
the explaining of which we shall first prove, that bodies descend
perpendicularly to the surface of the earth in all places. The manner
of collecting this from observation, is as follows. The surfaces of
all fluids rest parallel to that part of the surface of the sea, which
is in the same place with them, to the figure of which, as has been
particularly shewn, the figure of the whole earth is formed. For if
any hollow vessel, open at the bottom, be immersed into the sea; it
is evident, that the surface of the sea within the vessel will retain
the same figure it had, before the vessel inclosed it; since its
communication with the external water is not cut off by the vessel.
But all the parts of the water being at rest, it is as clear, that if
the bottom of the vessel were closed, the figure of the water could
receive no change thereby, even though the vessel were raised out of
the sea; any more than from the insensible alteration of the power of
gravity, consequent upon the augmentation of the distance from the
center. But now it is clear, that bodies descend in lines perpendicular
to the surfaces of quiescent fluids; for if the power of gravity did
not act perpendicularly to the surface of fluids, bodies which swim on
them could not rest, as they are seen to do; because, if the power of
gravity drew such bodies in a direction oblique to the surface whereon
they lay, they would certainly be put in motion, and be carried to the
side of the vessel, in which the fluid was contained, that way the
action of gravity inclined.

41. HENCE it follows, that as we stand, our bodies are perpendicular
to the surface of the earth. Therefore in going from north to south
our bodies do not keep in a parallel direction. Now in all distances
from the pole the same length gone on the earth will not make the same
change in the position of our bodies, but the nearer we are to the
poles, we must go greater length to cause the same variation herein.
Let M I L K (in fig. 117) represent the figure of the earth, M, L the
poles, I, K two opposite points in the middle between these poles. Let
T V and P O be two arches, T V being most remote from the pole L; draw
T W, V X, P Q, O R, each perpendicular to the surface of the earth,
and let T W, V X meet in Y, and P Q, O R in S. Here it is evident,
that in passing from V to T the position of a man’s body would be
changed by the angle under T Y V, for at V he would stand in the line
Y V continued upward, and at T in the line Y T; but in passing from O
to P the position of his body would be changed by the angle under O
S P. Now I say, if these two angles are equal the arch O P is longer
than T V: for the figure M I L K being oblong, and I K longer than M L,
the figure will be more incurvated toward I than toward L; so that the
lines T W and V X will meet in Y before they are drawn out to so great
a length as the lines P Q and O R must be continued to, before they
will meet in S. Since therefore Y T and Y V are shorter than P S and S
V, T V must be less than O P. If these angles under T Y V and O S P are
each 1/90 part of the angle made by a perpendicular line, they are said
each to contain one degree. And the unequal length of these arches O P
and V T gives occasion to the assertion, that in passing from north to
south the degrees on the earth’s surface are not of an equal length,
but those near the pole longer than those toward the equator. For the
length of the arch on the earth lying between the two perpendiculars,
which make an angle of a degree with each other, is called the length
of a degree on the earth’s surface.

42. THIS figure of the earth has some effect on eclipses. It has been
observed above, that sometimes the nodes of the moon’s orbit lie in a
straight line drawn from the sun to the earth; in which case the moon
will cross the plane of the earth’s motion at the new and full. But
whenever the moon passes near the plane at the full, some part of the
earth will intercept the sun’s light, and the moon shining only with
light borrow’d from the sun, when that light is prevented from falling
on any part of the moon, so much of her body will be darkened. Also
when the moon at the new is near the plane of the earth’s motion, the
inhabitants on some part of the earth will see the moon come under
the sun, and the sun thereby be covered from them either wholly or in
part. Now the figure, which we have shewn to belong to the earth, will
occasion the shadow of the earth on the moon not to be perfectly round,
but cause the diameter from east to west to be somewhat longer than
the diameter from north to south. In eclipse of the sun this figure
of the earth will make some little difference in the place, where the
sun shall appear wholly or in any given part covered. Let A B C D (in
fig. 118.) represent the earth, A C the axis whereon it turns daily,
E the center. Let F A G C represent a perfect globe inscribed within
the earth. Let H I be a line drawn through the centers of the sun and
moon, crossing the surface of the earth in K, and the surface of the
globe inscribed in L. Draw E L, which will be perpendicular to the
surface of the globe in L: and draw likewise K M, so that it shall
be perpendicular to the surface of the earth in K. Now whereas the
eclipse would appear central at L, if the earth were the globe A G C
F, and does really appear so at K; I say, the latitude of the place K
on the real earth is different from the latitude of the place L on the
globe F A G C. What is called the latitude of any place is determined
by the angle which the line perpendicular to the surface of the earth
at that place makes with the axis; the difference between this angle,
and that made by a perpendicular line or square being called the
latitude of each place. But it might here be proved, that the angle
which K M makes with M C is less, than the angle made between L E and
E C: consequently the latitude of the place K is greater, than the
latitude, which the place L would have.

43. THE next effect, which follows from this figure of the earth,
is that gradual change in the distance of the fixed stars from the
equinoctial points, which astronomers observe. But before this can be
explained, it is necessary to say something more particular, than has
yet been done, concerning the manner of the earth’s motion round the
sun.

44. IT has already been said, that the earth turns round each day on
its own axis, while its whole body is carried round the sun once in a
year. How these two motions are joined together may be conceived in
some degree by the motion of a bowl on the ground, where the bowl in
rouling on continually turns upon its axis, and at the same time the
whole body thereof is carried straight on. But to be more express let
A (in fig. 119) represent the sun B C D E four different situations
of the earth in its orbit moving about the sun. In all these let F
G represent the axis, about which the earth daily turns. The points
F, G are called the poles of the earth; and this axis is supposed to
keep always parallel to it self in every situation of the earth; at
least that it would do so, were it not for a minute deviation, the
cause whereof will be explained in what follows. When the earth is in
B, the half H I K will be illuminated by the sun, and the other half
H L K will be in darkness. Now if on the globe any point be taken in
the middle between the poles, this point shall describe by the motion
of the globe the circle M N, half of which is in the enlightened part
of the globe, and half in the dark part. But the earth is supposed to
move round its axis with an equable motion; therefore on this point of
the globe the sun will be seen just half the day, and be invisible the
other half. And the same will happen to every point of this circle, in
all situations of the earth during its whole revolution round the sun.
This circle M N is called the equator, of which we have before made
mention.

45. NOW suppose any other point taken on the surface of the globe
toward the pole F, which in the diurnal revolution of the globe
shall describe the circle O P. Here it appears that more than half
this circle is enlightned by the sun, and consequently that in any
particular point of this circle the sun will be longer seen than
lie hid, that is the day will be longer than the night. Again if we
consider the same circle O P on the globe situated in D the opposite
part of the orbit from B, we shall see, that here in any place of this
circle the night will be as much longer than the day.

46. IN these situations of the globe of earth a line drawn from the
sun to the center of the earth will be obliquely inclined toward the
axis F G. Now suppose, that such a line drawn from the sun to the
center of the earth, when in C or E, would be perpendicular to the
axis F G; in which cases the sun will shine perpendicularly upon the
equator, and consequently the line drawn from the center of the earth
to the sun will cross the equator, as it passes through the surface
of the earth; whereas in all other situations of the globe this line
will pass through the surface of the globe at a distance from the
equator either northward or southward. Now in both these cases half the
circle O P will be in the light, and half in the dark; and therefore
to every place in this circle the day will be equal to the night. Thus
it appears, that in these two opposite situations of the earth the
day is equal to the night in all parts of the globe; but in all other
situations this equality will only be found in places situated in the
very middle between the poles, that is, on the equator.

47. THE times, wherein this universal equality between the day and
night happens, are called the equinoxes. Now it has been long observed
by astronomers, that after the earth hath set out from either equinox,
suppose from E (which will be the spring equinox, if F be the north
pole) the same equinox shall again return a little before the earth has
made a compleat revolution round the sun. This return of the equinox
preceding the intire revolution of the earth is called the precession
of the equinox, and is caused by the protuberant figure of the earth.

49. SINCE the sun shines perpendicularly upon the equator, when the
line drawn from the sun to the center of the earth is perpendicular to
the earth’s axis, in this case the plane, which should cut through
the earth at the equator, may be extended to pass through the sun;
but it will not do so in any other position of the earth. Now let us
consider the prominent part of the earth about the equator, as a solid
ring moving with the earth round the sun. At the time of the equinoxes,
this ring will have the same kind of situation in respect of the sun,
as the orbit of the moon has, when the line of the nodes is directed
to the sun; and at all other times will resemble the moon’s orbit in
other situations. Consequently this ring, which otherwise would keep
throughout its motion parallel to it self, will receive some change in
its position from the action of the sun upon it, except only at the
time of the equinox. The manner of this change may be understood as
follows. Let A B C D (in fig. 120) represent this ring, E the center of
the earth, S the sun, A F C G a circle described in the plane of the
earth’s motion to the center E. Here A and C are the two points, in
which the earth’s equator crosses the plane of the earth’s motion; and
the time of the equinox falls out, when the straight line A C continued
would pass through the sun. Now let us recollect what was said above
concerning the moon, when her orbit was in the same situation with this
ring. From thence it will be understood, if a body were supposed to
be moving in any part of this circle A B C D, what effect the action
of the sun on the body would have toward changing the position of the
line A C. In particular H I being drawn perpendicular to S E, if the
body be in any part of this circle between A and H, or between C and I,
the line A C would be so turned, that the point A shall move toward
B, and the point C toward D; but if it were in any other part of the
circle, either between H and C, or between I and A, the line A C would
be turned the contrary way. Hence it follows, that as this solid ring
turns round the center of the earth, the parts of this ring between A
and H, and between C and I, are so influenced by the sun, that they
will endeavour, so to change the situation of the line A C as to cause
the point A to move toward B, and the point C to move toward D; but all
the parts of the ring between H and C, and between I and A, will have
the opposite tendency, and dispose the line A C to move the contrary
way. And since these last named parts are larger than the other, they
will prevail over the other, so that by the action of the sun upon this
ring, the line A C will be so turned, that A shall continually be more
and more moving toward D, and C toward B. Thus no sooner shall the sun
in its visible motion have departed from A, but the motion of the line
A C shall hasten its meeting with C, and from thence the motion of this
line shall again hasten the sun’s second conjunction with A; for as
this line so turns, that A is continually moving toward D, so the sun’s
visible motion is the same way as from S toward T.

49. THE moon will have on this ring the like effect as the sun, and
operate on it more strongly, in the same proportion as its force on
the sea exceeded that of the sun on the same. But the effect of the
action of both luminaries will be greatly diminished by reason of this
ring’s being connected to the rest of the earth; for by this means the
sun and moon have not only this ring to move, but likewise the whole
globe of the earth, upon whose spherical part they have no immediate
influence. Beside the effect is also rendred less, by reason that the
prominent part of the earth is not collected all under the equator,
but spreads gradually from thence toward both poles. Upon the whole,
though the sun alone carries the nodes of the moon through an intire
revolution in about 19 years, the united force of both luminaries on
the prominent parts of the earth will hardly carry round the equinox in
a less space of time than 26000 years.

50. TO this motion of the equinox we must add another consequence of
this action of the sun and moon upon the elevated parts of the earth,
that this annular part of the earth about the equator, and consequently
the earth’s axis, will twice a year and twice a month change its
inclination to the plane of the earth’s motion, and be again restored,
just as the inclination of the moon’s orbit by the action of the sun
is annually twice diminished, and as often recovers its original
magnitude. But this change is very insensible.

51. I SHALL now finish the present chapter with our great author’s
inquiry into the figure of the secondary planets, particularly of our
moon, upon the figure of which its fluid parts will have an influence.
The moon turns always the same side towards the earth, and consequently
revolves but once round its axis in the space of an entire month; for
a spectator placed without the circle, in which the moon moves, would
in that time observe all the parts of the moon successively to pass
once before his view and no more, that is, that the whole globe of the
moon has turned once round. Now the great slowness of this motion will
render the centrifugal force of the parts of the waters very weak, so
that the figure of the moon cannot, as in the earth, be much affected
by this revolution upon its axis: but the figure of those waters are
made different from spherical by another cause, viz. the action of
the earth upon them; by which they will be reduced to an oblong oval
form, whose axis prolonged would pass through the earth; for the same
reason, as we have above observed, that the waters of the earth would
take the like figure, if they had moved so slowly, as to keep pace with
the moon. And the solid part of the moon must correspond with this
figure of the fluid part: but this elevation of the parts of the moon
is nothing near so great as is the protuberance of the earth at the
equator, for it will not exceed 93 english feet.

52. The waters of the moon will have no tide, except what will arise
from the motion of the moon round the earth. For the conversion of the
moon about her axis is equable, whereby the inequality in the motion
round the earth discovers to us at some times small parts of the moon’s
surface towards the east or west, which at other times lie hid; and
as the axis, whereon the moon turns, is oblique to her motion round
the earth, sometimes small parts of her surface toward the north, and
sometimes the like toward the south are visible, which at other times
are out of sight. These appearances make what is called the libration
of the moon, discovered by HEVELIUS. But now as the axis of the oval
figure of the waters will he pointed towards the earth, there must
arise from hence some fluctuation in them; and beside, by the change of
the moon’s distance from the earth, they will not always have the very
same height.

[Illustration]

[Illustration]




~BOOK III~.




~CHAP~ I.

Concerning the cause of COLOURS inherent in the LIGHT.


AFTER this view which has been taken of Sir ISAAC NEWTON’S mathematical
principles of philosophy, and the use he has made of them, in
explaining the system of the world, &c. the course of my design directs
us to turn our eyes to that other philosophical work, his treatise of
Optics, in which we shall find our great author’s inimitable genius
discovering it self no less, than in the former; nay perhaps even
more, since this work gives as many instances of his singular force
of reasoning, and of his unbounded invention, though unassisted in
great measure by those rules and general precepts, which facilitate
the invention of mathematical theorems. Nor yet is this work inferior
to the other in usefulness; for as that has made known to us one great
principle in nature, by which the celestial motions are continued, and
by which the frame of each globe is preserved; so does this point out
to us another principle no less universal, upon which depends all those
operations in the smaller parts of matter, for whose sake the greater
frame of the universe is erected; all those immense globes, with which
the whole heavens are filled, being without doubt only design’d as so
many convenient apartments for carrying on the more noble operations of
nature in vegetation and animal life. Which single consideration gives
abundant proof of the excellency of our author’s choice, in applying
himself carefully to examine the action between light and bodies, so
necessary in all the varieties of these productions, that none of them
can be successfully promoted without the concurrence of heat in a
greater or less degree.

2. ’TIS true, our author has not made so full a discovery of the
principle, by which this mutual action between light and bodies is
caused; as he has in relation to the power, by which the planets are
kept in their courses: yet he has led us to the very entrance upon it,
and pointed out the path so plainly which must be followed to reach it;
that one may be bold to say, whenever mankind shall be blessed with
this improvement of their knowledge, it will be derived so directly
from the principles laid down by our author in this book, that the
greatest share of the praise due to the discovery will belong to him.

3. IN speaking of the progress our author has made, I shall distinctly
pursue three things, the two first relating to the colours of natural
bodies: for in the first head shall be shewn, how those colours are
derived from the properties of the light itself; and in the second upon
what properties of the bodies they depend: but the third head of my
discourse shall treat of the action of bodies upon light in refracting,
reflecting, and inflecting it.

4. THE first of these, which shall be the business of the present
chapter, is contained in this one proposition: that the sun’s direct
light is not uniform in respect of colour, not being disposed in every
part of it to excite the idea of whiteness, which the whole raises; but
on the contrary is a composition of different kinds of rays, one sort
of which if alone would give the sense of red, another of orange, a
third of yellow, a fourth of green, a fifth of light blue, a sixth of
indigo, and a seventh of a violet purple; that all these rays together
by the mixture of their sensations impress upon the organ of sight
the sense of whiteness, though each ray always imprints there its own
colour; and all the difference between the colours of bodies when
viewed in open day light arises from this, that  bodies do not
reflect all the sorts of rays falling upon them in equal plenty, but
some sorts much more copiously than others; the body appearing of that
colour, of which the light coming from it is most composed.

5. THAT the light of the sun is compounded, as has been said, is proved
by refracting it with a prism. By a prism I here mean a glass or other
body of a triangular form, such as is represented in fig. 121. But
before we proceed to the illustration of the proposition we have just
now laid down, it will be necessary to spend a few words in explaining
what is meant by the refraction of light; as the design of our present
labour is to give some notion of the subject, we are engaged in, to
such as are not versed in the mathematics.

6. IT is well known, that when a ray of light passing through the air
falls obliquely upon the surface of any transparent body, suppose water
or glass, and enters it, the ray will not pass on in that body in the
same line it described through the air, but be turned off from the
surface, so as to be less inclined to it after passing it, than before.
Let A B C D (in fig. 122.) represent a portion of water, or glass, A
B the surface of it, upon which the ray of light E F falls obliquely;
this ray shall not go right on in the course delineated by the line
F G, but be turned off from the surface A B into the line F H, less
inclined to the surface A B than the line E F is, in which the ray is
incident upon that surface.

7. ON the other hand, when the light passes out of any such body into
the air, it is inflected the contrary way, being after its emergence
rendred more oblique to the surface it passes through, than before.
Thus the ray F H, when it goes out of the surface C D, will be turned
up towards that surface, going out into the air in the line H I.

8. THIS turning of the light out of its way, as it passes from one
transparent body into another is called its refraction. Both these
cases may be tried by an easy experiment with a bason and water. For
the first case set an empty bason in the sunshine or near a candle,
making a mark upon the bottom at the extremity of the shadow cast
by the brim of the bason, then by pouring water into the bason you
will observe the shadow to shrink, and leave the bottom of the bason
enlightned to a good distance from the mark. Let A B C (in fig. 123.)
denote the empty bason, E A D the light shining over the brim of it,
so that all the part A B D be shaded. Then a mark being made at D, if
water be poured into the bason (as in fig. 124.) to F G, you shall
observe the light, which before went on to D, now to come much short of
the mark D, falling on the bottom in the point H, and leaving the mark
D a good way within the enlightened part; which shews that the ray E A,
when it enters the water at I, goes no longer straight forwards, but is
at that place incurvated, and made to go nearer the perpendicular. The
other case may be tryed by putting any small body into an empty bason,
placed lower than your eye, and then receding from the bason, till you
can but just see the body over the brim. After which, if the bason be
filled with water, you shall presently observe the body to be visible,
though you go farther off from the bason. Let A B C (in fig. 125.)
denote the bason as before, D the body in it, E the place of your eye,
when the body is seen just over the edge A, while the bason is empty.
If it be then filled with water, you will observe the body still to be
visible, though you take your eye farther off. Suppose you see the body
in this case just over the brim A, when your eye is at F, it is plain
that the rays of light, which come from the body to your eye have not
come straight on, but are bent at A, being turned downwards, and more
inclined to the surface of the water, between A and your eye at F, than
they are between A and the body D.

9. THIS we hope is sufficient to make all our readers apprehend,
what the writers of optics mean, when they mention the refraction
of the light, or speak of the rays of light being refracted. We
shall therefore now go on to prove the assertion advanced in the
forementioned proposition, in relation to the different kinds of
colours, that the direct light of the sun exhibits to our sense: which
may be done in the following manner.

10. IF a room be darkened, and the sun permitted to shine into it
through a small hole in the window shutter, and be made immediately to
fall upon a glass prism, the beam of light shall in passing through
such a prism be parted into rays, which exhibit all the forementioned
colours. In this manner if A B (in fig. 126) represent the window
shutter; C the hole in it; D E F the prism; Z Y a beam of light coming
from the sun, which passes through the hole, and falls upon the prism
at Y, and if the prism were removed would go on to X, but in entring
the surface B F of the glass it shall be turned off, as has been
explained, into the course Y W falling upon the second surface of the
prism D F in W, going out of which into the air it shall be again
farther inflected. Let the light now, after it has passed the prism, be
received upon a sheet of paper held at a proper distance, and it shall
paint upon the paper the picture, image, or spectrum L M of an oblong
figure, whose length shall much exceed its breadth; though the figure
shall not be oval, the ends L and M being semicircular and the sides
straight. But now this figure will be variegated with colours in this
manner. From the extremity M to some length, suppose to the line _n
o_, it shall be of an intense red; from _n o_ to _p q_ it shall be an
orange; from _p q_ to _r s_ it shall be yellow; from thence to _t u_ it
shall be green; from thence to _w x_ blue; from thence to _y z_ indigo;
and from thence to the end violet.

11. THUS it appears that the sun’s white light by its passage through
the prism, is so changed as now to be divided into rays, which exhibit
all these several colours. The question is, whether the rays while
in the sun’s beam before this refraction possessed these properties
distinctly; so that some part of that beam would without the rest have
given a red colour, and another part alone have given an..orange,
&c. That this is possible to be the case, appears from hence; that if
a convex glass be placed between the paper and the prism, which may
collect all the rays proceeding out of the prism into its focus, as a
burning glass does the sun’s direct rays; and if that focus fall upon
the paper, the spot formed by such a glass upon the paper shall appear
white, just like the sun’s direct light.

[Illustration]

The rest remaining as before, let P Q. (in fig. 127.) be the convex
glass, causing the rays to meet upon the paper H G I K in the point N,
I say that point or rather spot of light shall appear white, without
the least tincture of any colour. But it is evident that into this
spot are now gathered all those rays, which before when separate gave
all those different colours; which shews that whiteness may be made by
mixing those colours: especially if we consider, it can be proved that
the glass P Q does not alter the colour of the rays which pass through
it. Which is done thus: if the paper be made to approach the glass P
Q, the colours will manifest themselves as far as the magnitude of the
spectrum, which the paper receives, will permit. Suppose it in the
situation _h g i k_, and that it then receive the spectrum _l m_, this
spectrum shall be much smaller, than if the glass P Q were removed,
and therefore the colours cannot be so much separated; but yet the
extremity _m_ shall manifestly appear red, and the other extremity _l_
shall be blue; and these colours as well as the intermediate ones shall
discover themselves more perfectly, the farther the paper is removed
from N, that is, the larger the spectrum is: the same thing happens,
if the paper be removed farther off from P Q than N. Suppose into the
position θ γ η ϰ, the spectrum λ μ painted upon it shall again discover
its colours, and that more distinctly, the farther the paper is
removed, but only in an inverted order: for as before, when the paper
was nearer the convex glass, than at N, the upper part of the image was
blue, and the under red; now the upper part shall be red, and the under
blue: because the rays cross at N.

12. NAY farther that the whiteness at the focus N, is made by the union
of the colours may be proved without removing the paper out of the
focus, by intercepting with any opake body part of the light near the
glass; for if the under part, that is the red, or more properly the
red-making rays, as they are styled by our author, are intercepted,
the spot shall take a bluish hue; and if more of the inferior rays are
cut off, so that neither the red-making nor orange-making rays, and if
you please the yellow-making rays likewise, shall fall upon the spot;
then shall the spot incline more and more to the remaining colours.
In like manner if you cut off the upper part of the rays, that is the
violet  or indigo-making rays, the spot shall turn reddish, and
become, more so, the more of those opposite colours are intercepted.

13. THIS I think abundantly proves that whiteness may be produced by a
mixture of all the colours of the spectrum. At least there is but one
way of evading the present arguments, which is, by asserting that the
rays of light after passing the prism have no different properties to
exhibit this or the other colour, but are in that respect perfectly
homogeneal, so that the rays which pass to the under and red part of
the image do not differ in any properties whatever from those, which
go to the upper and violet part of it; but that the colours of the
spectrum are produced only by some new modifications of the rays, made
at their incidence upon the paper by the different terminations of
light and shadow: if indeed this assertion can be allowed any place,
after what has been said; for it seems to be sufficiently obviated
by the latter part of the preceding experiment, that by intercepting
the inferior part of the light, which comes from the prism, the white
spot shall receive a bluish cast, and by stopping the upper part the
spot shall turn red, and in both cases recover its colour, when the
intercepted light is permitted to pass again; though in all these
trials there is the like termination of light and shadow. However our
author has contrived some experiments expresly to shew the absurdity of
this supposition; all which he has explained and enlarged upon in so
distinct and expressive a manner, that it would be wholly unnecessary
to repeat them in this place[280]. I shall only mention that of them,
which may be tried in the experiment before us. If you draw upon
the paper H G I K, and through the spot N, the straight line _w x_
parallel to the horizon, and then if the paper be much inclined into
the situation _r s v t_ the line _w x_ still remaining parallel to
the horizon, the spot N shall lose its whiteness and receive a blue
tincture; but if it be inclined as much the contrary way, the same
spot shall exchange its white colour for a reddish dye. All which can
never be accounted for by any difference in the termination of the
light and shadow, which here is none at all; but are easily explained
by supposing the upper part of the rays, whenever they enter the eye,
disposed to give the sensation of the dark colours blue, indigo and
violet; and that the under part is fitted to produce the bright colours
yellow, orange and red: for when the paper is in the situation _r s t
u_, it is plain that the upper part of the light falls more directly
upon it, than the under part, and therefore those rays will be most
plentifully reflected from it; and by their abounding in the reflected
light will cause it to incline to their colour. Just so when the paper
is inclined the contrary way, it will receive the inferior rays most
directly, and therefore ting the light it reflects with their colour.

14. IT is now to be proved that these dispositions of the rays of
light to produce some one colour and some another, which manifest
themselves after their being refracted, are not wrought by any action
of the prism upon them, but are originally inherent in those rays; and
that the prism only affords each species an occasion of shewing its
distinct quality by separating them one from another, which before,
while they were blended together in the direct beam of the sun’s light,
lay conceal’d. But that this is so, will be proved, if it can be shewn
that no prism has any power upon the rays, which after their passage
through one prism are rendered uncompounded and contain in them but one
colour, either to divide that colour into several, as the sun’s light
is divided, or so much as to change it into any other colour. This will
be proved by the following experiment[281]. The same thing remaining,
as in the first experiment, let another prism N O (in fig. 128.) be
placed either immediately, or at some distance after the first, in a
perpendicular posture, so that it shall refract the rays issuing from
the first sideways. Now if this prism could divide the light falling
upon it into  rays, as the first has done, it would divide the
spectrum breadthwise into colours, as before it was divided lengthwise;
but no such thing is observed. If L M were the spectrum, which the
first prism D E F would paint upon the paper H G I K; P Q lying in an
oblique posture shall be the spectrum projected by the second, and
shall be divided lengthwise into colours corresponding to the colours
of the spectrum L M, and occasioned like them by the refraction of the
first prism, but its breadth shall receive no such division; on the
contrary each colour shall be uniform from side to side, as much as in
the spectrum L M, which proves the whole assertion.

15. THE same is yet much farther confirmed by another experiment.
Our author teaches that the colours of the spectrum L M in the first
experiment are yet compounded, though not so much as in the sun’s
direct light. He shews therefore how, by placing the prism at a
distance from the hole, and by the use of a convex glass, to separate
the colours of the spectrum, and make them uncompounded to any degree
of exactness[282]. And he shews when this is done sufficiently, if
you make a small hole in the paper whereon the spectrum is received,
through which any one sort of rays may pass, and then let that 
ray fall so upon a prism, as to be refracted by it, it shall in no case
whatever change its colour; but shall always retain it perfectly as at
first, however it be refracted[283].

16. NOR yet will these colours after this full separation of them
suffer any change by reflection from bodies of different colours; on
the other hand they make all bodies placed in these colours appear of
the colour which falls upon them[284]: for minium in red light will
appear as in open day light; but in yellow light will appear yellow;
and which is more extraordinary, in green light will appear green, in
blue, blue; and in the violet-purple  light will appear of a
purple colour; in like manner verdigrease, or blue bise, will put on
the appearance of that colour, in which it is placed; so that neither
bise placed in the red light shall be able to give that light the least
blue tincture, or any other different from red; nor shall minium in
the indigo or violet light exhibit the least appearance of red, or any
other colour distinct from that it is placed in. The only difference
is, that each of these bodies appears most luminous and bright in the
colour, which corresponds with that it exhibits in the day light, and
dimmed in the colours most remote from that; that is, though minium and
bise placed in blue light shall both appear blue, yet the bise shall
appear of a bright blue, and the minium of a dusky and obscure blue:
but if minium and bise be compared together in red light, the minium
shall afford a brisk red, the bise a duller colour, though of the same
species.

17. AND this not only proves the immutability of all these simple
and uncompounded colours; but likewise unfolds the whole mystery,
why bodies appear in open day-light of such different colours, it
consisting in nothing more than this, that whereas the white light of
the day is composed of all sorts of colours, some bodies reflect the
rays of one sort in greater abundance than the rays of any other[285].
Though it appears by the fore-cited experiment, that almost all these
bodies reflect some portion of the rays of every colour, and give the
sense of particular colours only by the predominancy of some sorts of
rays above the rest. And what has before been explained of composing
white by mingling all the colours of the spectrum together shews
clearly, that nothing more is required to make bodies look white,
than a power to reflect indifferently rays of every colour. But this
will more fully appear by the following method: if near the 
spectrum in our first experiment a piece of white paper be so held, as
to be illuminated equally by all the parts of that spectrum, it shall
appear white; whereas if it be held nearer to the red end of the image,
than to the other, it shall turn reddish; if nearer the blue end, it
shall seem bluish[286].

18. OUR indefatigable and circumspect author farther examined his
theory by mixing the powders which painters use of several colours, in
order if possible to produce a white powder by such a composition[287].
But in this he found some difficulties for the following reasons. Each
of these  powders reflects but part of the light, which is
cast upon them; the red powders reflecting little green or blue, and
the blue powders reflecting very little red or yellow, nor the green
powders reflecting near so much of the red or indigo and purple, as
of the other colours: and besides, when any of these are examined in
homogeneal light, as our author calls the colours of the prism, when
well separated, though each appears more bright and luminous in its
own day-light colour, than in any other; yet white bodies, suppose
white paper for instance, in those very colours exceed these 
bodies themselves in brightness; so that white bodies reflect not only
more of the whole light than  bodies do in the day-light, but
even more of that very colour which they reflect most copiously. All
which considerations make it manifest that a mixture of these will not
reflect so great a quantity of light, as a white body of the same size;
and therefore will compose such a colour as would result from a mixture
of white and black, such as are all grey and dun colours, rather than a
strong white. Now such a colour he compounded of certain ingredients,
which he particularly sets down, in so much that when the composition
was strongly illuminated by the sun’s direct beams, it would appear
much whiter than even white paper, if considerably shaded. Nay he
found by trials how to proportion the degree of illumination of the
mixture and paper, so that to a spectator at a proper distance it
could not well be determined which was the more perfect colour; as he
experienced not only by himself, but by the concurrent opinion of a
friend, who chanced to visit him while he was trying this experiment.
I must not here omit another method of trying the whiteness of such a
mixture, proposed in one of our author’s letters on this subject[288]:
which is to enlighten the composition by a beam of the sun let into a
darkened room, and then to receive the light reflected from it upon a
piece of white paper, observing whether the paper appears white by that
reflection; for if it does, it gives proof of the composition’s being
white; because when the paper receives the reflection from any <DW52>
body, it looks of that colour. Agreeable to this is the trial he made
upon water impregnated with soap, and agitated into a froth[289]:
for when this froth after some short time exhibited upon the little
bubbles, which composed it, a great variety of colours, though these
colours to a spectator at a small distance discover’d themselves
distinctly; yet when the eye was so far removed, that each little
bubble could no longer be distinguished, the whole froth by the mixture
of all these colours appeared intensly white.

19. OUR author having fully satisfied himself by these and many other
experiments, what the result is of mixing together all the prismatic
colours; he proceeds in the next place to examine, whether this
appearance of whiteness be raised by the rays of these different kinds
acting so, when they meet, upon one another, as to cause each of them
to impress the sense of whiteness upon the optic nerve; or whether each
ray does not make upon the organ of sight the same impression, as when
separate and alone; so that the idea of whiteness is not excited by the
impression from any one part of the rays, but results from the mixture
of all those different sensations. And that the latter sentiment is the
true one, he evinces by undeniable experiments.

20. IN particular the foregoing experiment[290], wherein the convex
glass was used, furnishes proofs of this: in that when the paper is
brought into the situation θ γ η ϰ, beyond, beyond N the colours, that
at N disappeared, begin to emerge again; which shews that by mingling
at N they did not lose their colorific qualities, though for some
reason they lay concealed. This farther appears by that part of the
experiment, when the paper, while in the focus, was directed to be
enclined different ways; for when the paper was in such a situation,
that it must of necessity reflect the rays, which before their arrival
at the point N would have given a blue colour, those rays in this
very point itself by abounding in the reflected light tinged it with
the same colour; so when the paper reflects most copiously the rays,
which before they come to the point N exhibit redness, those same rays
tincture the light reflected by the paper from that very point with
their own proper colour.

21. THERE is a certain condition relating to sight, which affords an
opportunity of examining this still more fully: it is this, that the
impressions of light remain some short space upon the eye; as when a
burning coal is whirl’d about in a circle, if the motion be very quick,
the eye shall not be able to distinguish the coal, but shall see an
entire circle of fire. The reason of which appearance is, that the
impression made by the coal upon the eye in any one situation is not
worn out, before the coal returns again to the same place, and renews
the sensation. This gives our author the hint to try, whether these
colours might not be transmitted successively to the eye so quick,
that no one of the colours should be distinctly perceived, but the
mixture of the sensations should produce a uniform whiteness; when the
rays could not act upon each other, because they never should meet,
but come to the eye one after another. And this thought he executed
by the following expedient[291]. He made an instrument in shape like
a comb, which he applied near the convex glass, so that by moving it
up and down slowly the teeth of it might intercept sometimes one and
sometimes another colour; and accordingly the light reflected from the
paper, placed at N, should change colour continually. But now when the
comb-like instrument was moved very quick, the eye lost all preception
of the distinct colours, which came to it from time to time, a perfect
whiteness resulting from the mixture of all those distinct impressions
in the sensorium. Now in this case there can be no suspicion of the
several  rays acting upon one another, and making any change in
each other’s manner of affecting the eye, seeing they do not so much as
meet together there.

22. OUR author farther teaches us how to view the spectrum of colours
produced in the first experiment with another prism, so that it shall
appear to the eye under the shape of a round spot and perfectly
white[292]. And in this case if the comb be used to intercept
alternately some of the colours, which compose the spectrum, the round
spot shall change its colour according to the colours intercepted; but
if the comb be moved too swiftly for those changes to be distinctly
perceived, the spot shall seem always white, as before[293].

23. BESIDES this whiteness, which results from an universal composition
of all sorts of colours, our author particularly explains the effects
of other less compounded mixtures; some of which compound other colours
like some of the simple ones, but others produce colours different
from any of them. For instance, a mixture of red and yellow compound
a colour like in appearance to the orange, which in the spectrum lies
between them; as a composition of yellow and blue is made use of in all
dyes to make a green. But red and violet purple compounded make purples
unlike to any of the prismatic colours, and these joined with yellow
or blue make yet new colours. Besides one rule is here to be observed,
that when many different colours are mixed, the colour which arises
from the mixture grows languid and degenerates into whiteness. So when
yellow green and blue are mixed together, the compound will be green;
but if to this you add red and purple, the colour shall first grow dull
and less vivid, and at length by adding more of these colours it shall
turn to whiteness, or some other colour[294].

24. ONLY here is one thing remarkable of those compounded colours,
which are like in appearance to the simple ones; that the simple
ones when viewed through a prism shall still retain their colour,
but the compounded colours seen through such a glass shall be parted
into the simple ones of which they are the aggregate. And for this
reason any body illuminated by the simple light shall appear through
a prism distinctly, and have its minutest parts observable, as may
easily be tried with flies, or other such little bodies, which have
very small parts; but the same viewed in this manner when enlighten’d
with compounded colours shall appear confused, their smallest parts
not being distinguishable. How the prism separates these compounded
colours, as likewise how it divides the light of the sun into its
colours, has not yet been explained; but is reserved for our third
chapter.

25. IN the mean time what has been said, I hope, will suffice to
give a taste of our author’s way of arguing, and in some measure to
illustrate the proposition laid down in this chapter.

26. THERE are methods of separating the heterogeneous rays of the
sun’s light by reflection, which perfectly conspire with and confirm
this reasoning. One of which ways may be this. Let A B (in fig. 129)
represent the window shutter of a darkened room; C a hole to let in
the sun’s rays; D E F, G H I two prisms so applied together, that the
sides E F and G I be contiguous, and the sides D F, G H parallel; by
this means the light will pass through them without any separation
into colours: but if it be afterwards received by a third prism I K L,
it shall be divided so as to form upon any white body P Q the usual
colours, violet at _m_, blue at _n_, green at _o_, yellow at _r_, and
red at _s_. But because it never happens that the two adjacent surfaces
E F and G I perfectly touch, part only of the light incident upon the
surface E F shall be transmitted, and part shall be reflected. Let now
the reflected part be received by a fourth prism Δ Θ Λ, and passing
through it paint upon a white body Ζ Γ the colours of the prism, red
at _t_, yellow at _u_, green at _w_, blue at _x_, violet at _y_. If
the prisms D E F, G H I be slowly turned about while they remain
contiguous, the colours upon the body P Q shall not sensibly change
their situation, till such time as the rays become pretty oblique to
the surface E F; but then the light incident upon the surface E F shall
begin to be wholly reflected. And first of all the violet light shall
be wholly reflected, and thereupon will disappear at _m_, appearing
instead thereof at _y_, and increasing the violet light falling there,
the other colours remaining as before. If the prisms D E F, G H I be
turned a little farther about, that the incident rays become yet more
inclined to the surface E F, the blue shall be totally reflected, and
shall disappear in _n_, but appear at _x_ by making the colour there
more intense. And the same may be continued, till all the colours are
successively removed from the surface P Q to Ζ Γ. But in any case,
suppose when the violet and the blue have forsaken the surface P Q,
and appear upon the surface Ζ Γ, Ζ Γ, the green, yellow, and red only
remaining upon the surface P Q; if the light be received upon a paper
held any where in its whole passage between the light’s coming out of
the prisms D E F, G I H and its incidence upon the prism I K L, it
shall appear of the colour compounded of all the colours seen upon P
Q; and the reflected ray, received upon a piece of white paper held
any where between the prisms D E F and Δ Θ Σ shall exhibit the colour
compounded of those the surface P Q is deprived of mixed with the sun’s
light: whereas before any of the light was reflected from the surface
E F, the rays between the prisms G H I and I K L would appear white;
as will likewise the reflected ray both before and after the total
reflection, provided the difference of refraction by the surfaces D F
and D E be inconsiderable. I call here the sun’s light white, as I have
all along done; but it is more exact to ascribe to it something of a
yellowish tincture, occasioned by the brighter colours abounding in it;
which caution is necessary in examining the colours of the reflected
beam, when all the violet and blue are in it: for this yellowish turn
of the sun’s light causes the blue not to be quite so visible in it,
as it should be, were the light perfectly white; but makes the beam of
light incline rather towards a pale white.




~CHAP~. II.

Of the properties of BODIES, upon which their COLOURS depend.


AFTER having shewn in the last chapter, that the difference between
the colours of bodies viewed in open day-light is only this, that some
bodies are disposed to reflect rays of one colour in the greatest
plenty, and other bodies rays of some other colour; order now requires
us to examine more particularly into the property of bodies, which
gives them this difference. But this our author shews to be nothing
more, than the different magnitude of the particles, which compose each
body: this I question not will appear no small paradox. And indeed
this whole chapter will contain scarce any assertions, but what will
be almost incredible, though the arguments for them are so strong and
convincing, that they force our assent. In the former chapter have
been explained properties of light, not in the least thought of before
our author’s discovery of them; yet are they not difficult to admit,
as soon as experiments are known to give proof of their reality; but
some of the propositions to be stated here will, I fear, be accounted
almost past belief; notwithstanding that the arguments, by which they
are established are unanswerable. For it is proved by our author, that
bodies are rendered transparent by the minuteness of their pores, and
become opake by having them large; and more, that the most transparent
body by being reduced to a great thinness will become less pervious to
the light.

2. BUT whereas it had been the received opinion, and yet remains so
among all who have not studied this philosophy, that light is reflected
from bodies by its impinging against their solid parts, rebounding from
them, as a tennis ball or other elastic substance would do, when struck
against any hard and resisting surface; it will be proper to begin with
declaring our author’s sentiment concerning this, who shews by many
arguments that reflection cannot be caused by any such means[295]: some
few of his proofs I shall set down, referring the reader to our author
himself for the rest.

3. IT is well known, that when light falls upon any transparent body,
glass for instance, part of it is reflected and part transmitted;
for which it is ready to account, by saying that part of the light
enters the pores of the glass, and part impinges upon its solid
parts. But when the transmitted light arrives at the farther surface
of the glass, in passing out of glass into air there is as strong a
reflection caused, or rather something stronger. Now it is not to
be conceived, how the light should find as many solid parts in the
air to strike against as in the glass, or even a greater number of
them. And to augment the difficulty, if water be placed behind the
glass, the reflection becomes much weaker. Can we therefore say, that
water has fewer solid parts for the light to strike against, than the
air? And if we should, what reason can be given for the reflection’s
being stronger, when the air by the air-pump is removed from behind
the glass, than when the air receives the rays of light. Besides the
light may be so inclined to the hinder surface of the glass, that it
shall wholly be reflected, which happens when the angle which the
ray makes with the surface does not exceed about 49⅓ degrees; but if
the inclination be a very little increased, great part of the light
will be transmitted; and how the light in one case should meet with
nothing but the solid parts of the air, and by so small a change of
its inclination find pores in great plenty, is wholly inconceivable.
It cannot be said, that the light is reflected by striking against
the solid parts of the surface of the glass; because without making
any change in that surface, only by placing water contiguous to it
instead of air, great part of that light shall be transmitted, which
could find no passage through the air. Moreover in the last experiment
recited in the preceding chapter, when by turning the prisms D E F, G
H I, the blue light became wholly reflected, while the rest was mostly
transmitted, no possible reason can be assigned, why the blue-making
rays should meet with nothing but the solid parts of the air between
the prisms, and the rest of the light in the very same obliquity find
pores in abundance. Nay farther, when two glasses touch each other, no
reflection at all is made; though it does not in the least appear,
how the rays should avoid the solid parts of glass, when contiguous
to other glass, any more than when contiguous to air. But in the last
place upon this supposition it is not to be comprehended, how the most
polished substances could reflect the light in that regular manner we
find they do; for when a polished looking glass is covered over with
quicksilver, we cannot suppose the particles of light so much larger
than those of the quicksilver that they should not be scattered as
much in reflection, as a parcel of marbles thrown down upon a rugged
pavement. The only cause of so uniform and regular a reflection must be
some more secret cause, uniformly spread over the whole surface of the
glass.

4. BUT now, since the reflection of light from bodies does not depend
upon its impinging against their solid parts, some other reason must
be sought for. And first it is past doubt that the least parts of
almost all bodies are transparent, even the microscope shewing as
much[296]; besides that it may be experienced by this method. Take any
thin plate of the opakest body, and apply it to a small hole designed
for the admission of light into a darkened room; however opake that
body may seem in open day-light, it shall under these circumstances
sufficiently discover its transparency, provided only the body be very
thin. White metals indeed do not easily shew themselves transparent in
these trials, they reflecting almost all the light incident upon them
at their first superficies; the cause of which will appear in what
follows[297]. But yet these substances, when reduced into parts of
extraordinary minuteness by being dissolved in aqua fortis or the like
corroding liquors do also become transparent.

5. SINCE therefore the light finds free passage through the least
parts of bodies, let us consider the largeness of their pores, and
we shall find, that whenever a ray of light has passed through any
particle of a body, and is come to its farther surface, if it finds
there another particle contiguous, it will without interruption pass
into that particle; just as light will pass through one piece of glass
into another piece in contact with it without any impediment, or any
part being reflected: but as the light in passing out of glass, or any
other transparent body, shall part of it be reflected back, if it enter
into air or other transparent body of a different density from that
it passes out of; the same thing will happen in the light’s passage
through any particle of a body, whenever at its exit out of that
particle it meets no other particle contiguous, but must enter into a
pore, for in this case it shall not all pass through, but part of it
be reflected back. Thus will the light, every time it enters a pore,
be in part reflected; so that nothing more seems necessary to opacity,
than that the particles, which compose any body, touch but in very
few places, and that the pores of it are numerous and large, so that
the light may in part be reflected from it, and the other part, which
enters too deep to be returned out of the body, by numerous reflections
may be stifled and lost[298]; which in all probability happens, as
often as it impinges against the solid part of the body, all the light
which does so not being reflected back, but stopt, and deprived of any
farther motion[299].

6. THIS notion of opacity is greatly confirmed by the observation,
that opake bodies become transparent by filling up the pores with any
substance of near the same density with their parts. As when paper
is wet with water or oyl; when linnen cloth is either dipt in water,
oyled, or varnished; or the oculus mundi stone steeped in water[300].
All which experiments confirm both the first assertion, that light is
not reflected by striking upon the solid parts of bodies; and also
the second, that its passage is obstructed by the reflections it
undergoes in the pores; since we find it in these trials to pass in
greater abundance through bodies, when the number of their solid parts
is increased, only by taking away in great measure those reflections;
which filling the pores with a substance of near the same density
with the parts of the body will do. Besides as filling the pores of a
dark body makes it transparent; so on the other hand evacuating the
pores of a body transparent, or separating the parts of such a body,
renders it opake. As salts or wet paper by being dried, glass by being
reduced to powder or the surface made rough; and it is well known that
glass vessels discover cracks in them by their opacity. Just so water
itself becomes impervious to the light by being formed into many small
bubbles, whether in froth, or by being mixed and agitated with any
quantity of a liquor with which it will not incorporate, such as oyl
of turpentine, or oyl olive.

7. A CERTAIN electrical experiment made by Mr. HAUKSBEE may not perhaps
be useless to clear up the present speculation, by shewing that
something more is necessary besides mere porosity for transmitting
freely other fine substances. The experiment is this; that a glass cane
rubbed till it put forth its electric quality would agitate leaf brass
inclosed under a glass vessel, though not at so great a distance, as if
no body had intervened; yet the same cane would lose all its influence
on the leaf brass by the interposition of a piece of the finest muslin,
whose pores are immensely larger and more patent than those of glass.

8. THUS I have endeavoured to smooth my way, as much as I could, to
the unfolding yet greater secrets in nature; for I shall now proceed
to shew the reason why bodies appear of different colours. My reader
no doubt will be sufficiently surprized, when I inform him that the
knowledge of this is deduced from that ludicrous experiment, with which
children divert themselves in blowing bubbles of water made tenacious
by the solution of soap. And that these bubbles, as they gradually grow
thinner and thinner till they break, change successively their colours
from the same principle, as all natural bodies preserve theirs.

9. OUR author after preparing water with soap, so as to render it very
tenacious, blew it up into a bubble, and placing it under a glass,
that it might not be irregularly agitated by the air, observed as
the water by subsiding changed the thickness of the bubble, making
it gradually less and less till the bubble broke; there successively
appeared colours at the top of the bubble, which spread themselves
into rings surrounding the top and descending more and more, till they
vanished at the bottom in the same order in which they appeared[301].
The colours emerged in this order: first red, then blue; to which
succeeded red a second time, and blue immediately followed; after that
red a third time, succeeded by blue; to which followed a fourth red,
but succeeded by green; after this a more numerous order of colours,
first red, then yellow, next green, and after that blue, and at last
purple; then again red, yellow, green, blue, violet followed each other
in order; and in the last place red, yellow, white, blue; to which
succeeded a dark spot, which reflected scarce any light, though our
author found it did make some very obscure reflection, for the image of
the sun or a candle might be faintly discerned upon it; and this last
spot spread itself more and more, till the bubble at last broke. These
colours were not simple and uncompounded colours, like those which
are exhibited by the prism, when due care is taken to separate them;
but were made by a various mixture of those simple colours, as will
be shewn in the next chapter: whence these colours, to which I have
given the name of blue, green, or red, were not all alike, but differed
as follows. The blue, which appeared next the dark spot, was a pure
colour, but very faint, resembling the sky-colour; the white next to
it a very strong and intense white, brighter much than the white, which
the bubble reflected, before any of the colours appeared. The yellow
which preceded this was at first pretty good, but soon grew dilute;
and the red which went before the yellow at first gave a tincture of
scarlet inclining to violet, but soon changed into a brighter colour;
the violet of the next series was deep with little or no redness in
it; the blue a brisk colour, but came much short of the blue in the
next order; the green was but dilute and pale; the yellow and red were
very bright and full, the best of all the yellows which appeared among
any of the colours: in the preceding orders the purple was reddish,
but the blue, as was just now said, the brightest of all; the green
pretty lively better than in the order which appeared before it, though
that was a good willow green; the yellow but small in quantity, though
bright; the red of this order not very pure: those which appeared
before yet more obscure, being very dilute and dirty; as were likewise
the three first blues.

10. NOW it is evident, that these colours arose at the top of the
bubble, as it grew by degrees thinner and thinner: but what the express
thickness of the bubble was, where each of these colours appeared upon
it, could not be determined by these experiments; but was found by
another means, viz. by taking the object glass of a long telescope,
which is in a small degree convex, and placing it upon a flat glass,
so as to touch it in one point, and then water being put between them,
the same colours appeared as in the bubble, in the form of circles or
rings surrounding the point where the glasses touched, which appeared
black for want of any reflection from it, like the top of the bubble
when thinnest[302]: next to this spot lay a blue circle, and next
without that a white one; and so on in the same order as before,
reckoning from the dark spot. And henceforward I shall speak of each
colour, as being of the first, second, or any following order, as it is
the first, second, or any following one, counting from the black spot
in the center of these rings; which is contrary to the order in which
I must have mentioned them, if I should have reputed them the first,
second, or third, &c. in order, as they arise after one another upon
the top of the bubble.

11. But now by measuring the diameters of each of these rings, and
knowing the convexity of the telescope glass, the thickness of the
water at each of those rings may be determined with great exactness:
for instance the thickness of it, where the white light of the first
order is reflected, is about 3⅞ such parts, of which an inch contains
1000000[303]. And this measure gives the thickness of the bubble, where
it appeared of this white colour, as well as of the water between the
glasses; though the transparent body which surrounds the water in these
two cases be very different: for our author found, that the condition
of the ambient body would not alter the species of the colour at all,
though it might its strength and brightness; for pieces of Muscovy
glass, which were so thin as to appear  by being wet with
water, would have their colours faded and made less bright thereby; but
he could not observe their species at all to be changed. So that the
thickness of any transparent body determines its colour, whatever body
the light passes through in coming to it[304].

12. BUT it was found that different transparent bodies would not under
the same thicknesses exhibit the same colours: for if the forementioned
glasses were laid upon each other without any water between their
surfaces, the air itself would afford the same colours as the water,
but more expanded, insomuch that each ring had a larger diameter, and
all in the same proportion. So that the thickness of the air proper to
each colour was in the same proportion larger, than the thickness of
the water appropriated to the same[305].

13. IF we examine with care all the circumstances of these colours,
which will be enumerated in the next chapter, we shall not be
surprized, that our author takes them to bear a great analogy to the
colours of natural bodies[306]. For the regularity of those various and
strange appearances relating to them, which makes the most mysterious
part of the action between light and bodies, as the next chapter will
shew, is sufficient to convince us that the principle, from which
they flow, is of the greatest importance in the frame of nature; and
therefore without question is designed for no less a purpose than to
give bodies their various colours, to which end it seems very fitly
suited. For if any such transparent substance of the thickness
proper to produce any one colour should be cut into slender threads,
or broken into fragments, it does not appear but these should retain
the same colour; and a heap of such fragments should frame a body of
that colour. So that this is without dispute the cause why bodies are
of this or the other colour, that the particles of which they are
composed are of different sizes. Which is farther confirmed by the
analogy between the colours of thin plates, and the colours of many
bodies. For example, these plates do not look of the same colour when
viewed obliquely, as when seen direct; for if the rings and colours
between a convex and plane glass are viewed first in a direct manner,
and then at different degrees of obliquity, the rings will be observed
to dilate themselves more and more as the obliquity is increased[307];
which shews that the transparent substance between the glasses does
not exhibit the same colour at the same thickness in all situations of
the eye: just so the colours in the very same part of a peacock’s tail
change, as the tail changes posture in respect of the sight. Also the
colours of silks, cloths, and other substances, which water or oyl can
intimately penetrate, become faint and dull by the bodies being wet
with such fluids, and recover their brightness again when dry; just
as it was before said that plates of Muscovy glass grew faint and dim
by wetting. To this may be added, that the colours which painters use
will be a little changed by being ground very elaborately, without
question by the diminution of their parts. All which particulars, and
many more that might be extracted from our author, give abundant
proof of the present point. I shall only subjoin one more: these
transparent plates transmit through them all the light they do not
reflect; so that when looked through they exhibit those colours, which
result from the depriving white light of the colour reflected. This
may commodiously be tryed by the glasses so often mentioned; which if
looked through exhibit  rings as by reflected light, but in a
contrary order; for the middle spot, which in the other view appears
black for want of reflected light, now looks perfectly white, opposite
to the blue circle; next without this spot the light appears tinged
with a yellowish red; where the white circle appeared before, it now
seems dark; and so of the rest[308]. Now in the same manner, the light
transmitted through foliated gold into a darkened room appears greenish
by the loss of the yellow light, which gold reflects.

14. HENCE it follows, that the colours of bodies give a very probable
ground for making conjecture concerning the magnitude of their
constituent particles[309]. My reason for calling it a conjecture is,
its being difficult to fix certainly the order of any colour. The
green of vegetables our author judges to be of the third order, partly
because of the intenseness of their colour; and partly from the changes
they suffer when they wither, turning at first into a greenish or more
perfect yellow, and afterwards some of them to an orange or red; which
changes seem to be effected from their ringing particles growing denser
by the exhalation of their moisture, and perhaps augmented likewise
by the accretion of the earthy and oily parts of that moisture. How
the mentioned colours should arise from increasing the bulk of those
particles, is evident; seeing those colours lie without the ring
of green between the glasses, and are therefore formed where the
transparent substance which reflects them is thicker. And that the
augmentation of the density of the colorific particles will conspire
to the production of the same effect, will be evident; if we remember
what was said of the different size of the rings, when air was included
between the glasses, from their size when water was between them; which
shewed that a substance of a greater density than another gives the
same colour at a less thickness. Now the changes likely to be wrought
in the density or magnitude of the parts of vegetables by withering
seem not greater, than are sufficient to change their colour into those
of the same order; but the yellow and red of the fourth order are not
full enough to agree with those, into which these substances change,
nor is the green of the second sufficiently good to be the colour of
vegetables; so that their colour must of necessity be of the third
order.

15. THE blue colour of syrup of violets our author supposes to be of
the third order; for acids, as vinegar, with this syrup change it red,
and salt of tartar or other alcalies mixed therewith turn it green.
But if the blue colour of the syrup were of the second order, the red
colour, which acids by attenuating its parts give it, must be of the
first order, and the green given it by alcalies by incrassating its
particles should be of the second; whereas neither of those colours is
perfect enough, especially the green, to answer those produced by these
changes; but the red may well enough be allowed to be of the second
order, and the green of the third; in which case the blue must be
likewise of the third order.

16. THE azure colour of the skies our author takes to be of the
first order, which requires the smallest particles of any colour,
and therefore most like to be exhibited by vapours, before they have
sufficiently coalesced to produce clouds of other colours.

17. THE most intense and luminous white is of the first order, if
less strong it is a mixture of the colours of all the orders. Of
the latter sort he takes the colour of linnen, paper, and such like
substances to be; but white metals to be of the former sort. The
arguments for it are these. The opacity of all bodies has been shewn
to arise from the number and strength of the reflections made within
them; but all experiments shew, that the strongest reflection is made
at those surfaces, which intercede transparent bodies differing most
in density. Among other instances of this, the experiments before us
afford one; for when air only is included between the glasses, the
 rings are not only more dilated, as has before been said,
than when water is between them; but are likewise much more luminous
and bright. It follows therefore, that whatever medium pervades the
pores of bodies, if so be there is any, those substances must be most
opake, the density of whose parts differs most from the density of the
medium, which fills their pores. But it has been sufficiently proved
in the former part of this tract, that there is no very dense medium
lodging in, at least pervading at liberty the pores of bodies. And it
is farther proved by the present experiments. For when air is inclosed
by the denser substance of glass, the rings dilate themselves, as
has been said, by being viewed obliquely; this they do so very much,
that at different obliquities the same thickness of air will exhibit
all sorts of colours. The bubble of water, though surrounded with the
thinner substance of air, does likewise change its colour by being
viewed obliquely; but not any thing near so much, as in the other case;
for in that the same colour might be seen, when the rings were viewed
most obliquely, at more than twelve times the thickness it appeared
at under a direct view; whereas in this other case the thickness was
never found considerably above half as much again. Now the colours of
bodies not depending only on the light, that is incident upon them
perpendicularly, but likewise upon that, which falls on them in all
degrees of obliquity; if the medium surrounding their particles were
denser than those particles, all sorts of colours must of necessity
be reflected from them so copiously, as would make the colours of all
bodies white, or grey, or at best very dilute and imperfect. But on
the other hand, if the medium in the pores of bodies be much rarer
than their particles, the colour reflected will be so little changed
by the obliquity of the rays, that the colour produced by the rays,
which fall near the perpendicular, may so much abound in the reflected
light, as to give the body their colour with little allay. To this
may be added, that when the difference of the contiguous transparent
substances is the same, a colour reflected from the denser substance
reduced into a thin plate and surrounded by the rarer will be more
brisk, than the same colour will be, when reflected from a thin plate
formed of the rarer substance, and surrounded by the denser; as our
author experienced by blowing glass very thin at a lamp furnace,
which exhibited in the open air more vivid colours, than the air does
between two glasses. From these considerations it is manifest, that
if all other circumstances are alike, the densest bodies will be most
opake. But it was observed before, that these white metals can hardly
be made so thin, except by being dissolved in corroding liquors, as
to be rendred transparent; though none of them are so dense as gold,
which proves their great opacity to have some other cause besides their
density; and none is more fit to produce this, than such a size of
their particles, as qualifies them to reflect the white of the first
order.

18. FOR producing black the particles ought to be smaller than for
exhibiting any of the colours, viz. of a size answering to the
thickness of the bubble, where by reflecting little or no light it
appears colourless; but yet they must not be too small, for that will
make them transparent through deficiency of reflections in the inward
parts of the body, sufficient to stop the light from going through it;
but they must be of a size bordering upon that disposed to reflect
the faint blue of the first order, which affords an evident reason why
blacks usually partake a little of that colour. We see too, why bodies
dissolved by fire or putrefaction turn black: and why in grinding
glasses upon copper plates the dust of the glass, copper, and sand it
is ground with, become very black: and in the last place why these
black substances communicate so easily to others their hue; which is,
that their particles by reason of the great minuteness of them easily
overspread the grosser particles of others.

19. I SHALL now finish this chapter with one remark of the exceeding
great porosity in bodies necessarily required in all that has here
been said; which, when duly considered, must appear very surprizing;
but perhaps it will be matter of greater surprize, when I affirm that
the sagacity of our author has discovered a method, by which bodies
may easily become so; nay how any the least portion of matter may be
wrought into a body of any assigned dimensions how great so ever, and
yet the pores of that body none of them greater, than any the smallest
magnitude proposed at pleasure; notwithstanding which the parts of the
body shall so touch, that the body itself shall be hard and solid[310].
The manner is this: suppose the body be compounded of particles of
such figures, that when laid together the pores found between them
may be equal in bigness to the particles; how this may be effected,
and yet the body be hard and solid, is not difficult to understand;
and the pores of such a body may be made of any proposed degree of
smallness. But the solid matter of a body so framed will take up only
half the space occupied by the body; and if each constituent particle
be composed of other less particles according to the same rule, the
solid parts of such a body will be but a fourth part of its bulk; if
every one of these lesser particles again be compounded in the same
manner, the solid parts of the whole body shall be but one eighth of
its bulk; and thus by continuing the composition the solid parts of the
body may be made to bear as small a proportion to the whole magnitude
of the body, as shall be desired, notwithstanding the body will be by
the contiguity of its parts capable of being in any degree hard. Which
shews that this whole globe of earth, nay all the known bodies in the
universe together, as far as we know, may be compounded of no greater
a portion of solid matter, than might be reduced into a globe of one
inch only in diameter, or even less. We see therefore how by this means
bodies may easily be made rare enough to transmit light, with all
that freedom pellucid bodies are found to do. Though what is the real
structure of bodies we yet know not.




~CHAP. III.~

Of the REFRACTION, REFLECTION, and INFLECTION of LIGHT.


THUS much of the colours of natural bodies; our method now leads us
to speculations yet greater, no less than to lay open the causes of
all that has hitherto been related. For it must in this chapter be
explained, how the prism separates the colours of the sun’s light, as
we found in the first chapter; and why the thin transparent plates
discoursed of in the last chapter, and consequently the particles of
 bodies, reflect that diversity of colours only by being of
different thicknesses.

2. FOR the first it is proved by our author, that the colours of the
sun’s light are manifested by the prism, from the rays undergoing
different degrees of refraction; that the violet-making rays, which
go to the upper part of the  image in the first experiment
of the first chapter, are the most refracted; that the indigo-making
rays are refracted, or turned out of their course by passing through
the prism, something less than the violet-making rays, but more than
the blue-making rays; and the blue-making rays more than the green;
the green-making rays more than the yellow; the yellow more than the
orange; and the orange-making rays more than the red-making, which are
least of all refracted. The first proof of this, that rays of different
colours are refracted unequally is this. If you take any body, and
paint one half of it red and the other half blue, then upon viewing
it through a prism those two parts shall appear separated from each
other; which can be caused no otherwise than by the prism’s refracting
the light of one half more than the light of the other half. But the
blue half will be most refracted; for if the body be seen through the
prism in such a situation, that the body shall appear lifted upwards
by the refraction, as a body within a bason of water, in the experiment
mentioned in the first chapter, appeared to be lifted up by the
refraction of the water, so as to be seen at a greater distance than
when the bason is empty, then shall the blue part appear higher than
the red; but if the refraction of the prism be the contrary way, the
blue part shall be depressed more than the other. Again, after laying
fine threads of black silk across each of the colours, and the body
well inlightened, if the rays coming from it be received upon a convex
glass, so that it may by refracting the rays cast the image of the body
upon a piece of white paper held beyond the glass; then it will be seen
that the black threads upon the red part of the image, and those upon
the blue part, do not at the same time appear distinctly in the image
of the body projected by the glass; but if the paper be held so, that
the threads on the blue part may distinctly appear, the threads cannot
be seen distinct upon the red part; but the paper must be drawn farther
off from the convex glass to make the threads on this part visible; and
when the distance is great enough for the threads to be seen in this
red part, they become indistinct in the other. Whence it appears that
the rays proceeding from each point of the blue part of the body are
sooner united again by the convex glass than the rays which come from
each point of the red parts[311]. But both these experiments prove that
the blue-making rays, as well in the small refraction of the convex
glass, as in the greater refraction of the prism, are more bent, than
the red-making rays.

3. THIS seems already to explain the reason of the  spectrum
made by refracting the sun’s light with a prism, though our author
proceeds to examine that in particular, and proves that the different
 rays in that spectrum are in different degrees refracted; by
shewing how to place the prism in such a posture, that if all the rays
were refracted in the same manner, the spectrum should of necessity
be round: whereas in that case if the angle made by the two surfaces
of the prism, through which the light passes, that is the angle D F
E in fig. 126, be about 63 or 64 degrees, the image instead of being
round shall be near five times as long as broad; a difference enough
to shew a great inequality in the refractions of the rays, which
go to the opposite extremities of the image. To leave no scruple
unremoved, our author is very particular in shewing by a great number
of experiments, that this inequality of refraction is not casual, and
that it does not depend upon any irregularities of the glass; no nor
that the rays are in their passage through the prism each split and
divided; but on the contrary that every ray of the sun has its own
peculiar degree of refraction proper to it, according to which it is
more or less refracted in passing through pellucid substances always
in the same manner[312]. That the rays are not split and multiplied
by the refraction of the prism, the third of the experiments related
in our first chapter shews very clearly; for if they were, and the
length of the spectrum in the first refraction were thereby occasioned,
the breadth should be no less dilated by the cross refraction of the
second prism; whereas the breadth is not at all increased, but the
image is only thrown into an oblique posture by the upper part of the
rays which were at first more refracted than the under part, being
again turned farthest out of their course. But the experiment most
expressly adapted to prove this regular diversity of refraction is
this, which follows[313]. Two boards A B, C D (in fig. 130.) being
erected in a darkened room at a proper distance, one of them A B being
near the window-shutter E F, a space only being left for the prism G
H I to be placed between them; so that the rays entring at the hole M
of the window-shutter may after passing through the prism be trajected
through a smaller hole K made in the board A B, and passing on from
thence go out at another hole L made in the board C D of the same size
as the hole K, and small enough to transmit the rays of one colour
only at a time; let another prism N O P be placed after the board C
D to receive the rays passing through the holes K and L, and after
refraction by that prism let those rays fall upon the white surface
Q R. Suppose first the violet light to pass through the holes, and
to be refracted by the prism N O P to _s_, which if the prism N O P
were removed should have passed right onto W. If the prism G H I be
turned slowly about, while the boards and prism N O P remain fixed,
in a little time another colour will fall upon the hole L, which, if
the prism N O P were taken away, would proceed like the former rays
to the same point W; but the refraction of the prism N O P shall not
carry these rays to _s_, but to some place less distant from W as to
_t_. Suppose now the rays which go to _t_ to be the indigo-making rays.
It is manifest that the boards A B, C D, and prism N O P remaining
immoveable, both the violet-making and indigo-making rays are incident
alike upon the prism N O P, for they are equally inclined to its
surface O P, and enter it in the same part of that surface; which shews
that the indigo-making rays are less diverted out of their course by
the refraction of the prism, than the violet-making rays under an
exact parity of all circumstances. Farther, if the prism G H I be more
turned about, ’till the blue-making rays pass through the hole L, these
shall fall upon the surface Q R below I, as at _v_, and therefore are
subjected to a less refraction than the indigo-making rays. And thus
by proceeding it will be found that the green-making rays are less
refracted than the blue-making rays, and so of the rest, according to
the order in which they lie in the  spectrum.

4. THIS disposition of the different  rays to be refracted
some more than others our author calls their respective degrees of
refrangibility. And since this difference of refrangibility discovers
it self to be so regular, the next step is to find the rule it observes.

5. IT is a common principle in optics, that the sine of the angle of
incidence bears to the sine of the refracted angle a given proportion.
If A B (in fig. 131, 132) represent the surface of any refracting
substance, suppose of water or glass, and C D a ray of light incident
upon that face in the point D, let D E be the ray, after it has passed
the surface A B; if the ray pass out of the air into the substance
whose surface is A B (as in fig. 131) it shall be turned from the
surface, and if it pass out of that substance into air it shall be
bent towards it (as in fig. 132) But if F G be drawn through the point
D perpendicular to the surface A B, the angle under C D F made by the
incident ray and this perpendicular is called the angle of incidence;
and the angle under E D G, made by this perpendicular and the ray after
refraction, is called the refracted angle. And if the circle H F I G
be described with any interval cutting C D in H and D E in I, then
the perpendiculars H K, I L being let fall upon F G, H K is called
the sine of the angle under C D F the angle of incidence, and I L the
sine of the angle under E D G the refracted angle. The first of these
sines is called the sine of the angle of incidence, or more briefly the
sine of incidence, the latter is the sine of the refracted angle, or
the sine of refraction. And it has been found by numerous experiments
that whatever proportion the sine of incidence H K bears to the sine
of refraction I L in any one case, the same proportion shall hold in
all cases; that is, the proportion between these sines will remain
unalterably the same in the same refracting substance, whatever be the
magnitude of the angle under C D F.

6. BUT now because optical writers did not observe that every beam of
white light was divided by refraction, as has been here explained,
this rule collected by them can only be understood in the gross of the
whole beam after refraction, and not so much of any particular part
of it, or at most only of the middle part of the beam. It therefore
was incumbent upon our author to find by what law the rays were parted
from each other; whether each ray apart obtained this property, and
that the separation was made by the proportion between the sines of
incidence and refraction being in each species of rays different; or
whether the light was divided by some other rule. But he proves by a
certain experiment that each ray has its sine of incidence proportional
to its sine of refraction; and farther shews by mathematical reasoning,
that it must be so upon condition only that bodies refract the light
by acting upon it, in a direction perpendicular to the surface of the
refracting body, and upon the same sort of rays always in an equal
degree at the same distances[314].

7. OUR great author teaches in the next place how from the refraction
of the most refrangible and least refrangible rays to find the
refraction of all the intermediate ones[315]. The method is this:
if the sine of incidence be to the sine of refraction in the least
refrangible rays as A to B C, (in fig. 133) and to the sine of
refraction in the most refrangible as A to B D; if C E be taken equal
to C D, and then E D be so divided in F, G, H, I, K, L, that E D, E
F, E G, E H, E I, E K, E L, E C, shall be proportional to the eight
lengths of musical chords, which found the notes in an octave, E D
being the length of the key, E F the length of the tone above that
key, E G the length of the lesser third, E H of the fourth, E I of the
fifth, E K of the greater sixth, E L of the seventh, and E C of the
octave above that key; that is if the lines E D, E F, E G, E H, E I, E
K, E L, and E C bear the same proportion as the numbers, 1, 9/8, 5/6,
¾, ⅓, ¾, 9/61, ½, respectively then shall B D, B F, be the two limits
of the sines of refraction of the violet-making rays, that is the
violet-making rays shall not all of them have precisely the same sine
of refraction, but none of them shall have a greater sine than B D,
nor a less than B F, though there are violet-making rays which answer
to any sine of refraction that can be taken between these two. In the
same manner B F and B G are the limits of the sines of refraction
of the indigo-making rays; B G, B H are the limits belonging to the
blue-making rays; B H, B I the limits pertaining to the green-making
rays, B I, B K the limits for the yellow-making rays; B K, B L the
limits for the orange-making rays; and lastly, B L and B C the extreme
limits of the sines of refraction belonging to the red-making rays.
These are the proportions by which the heterogeneous rays of light are
separated from each other in refraction.

8. WHEN light passes out of glass into air, our author found A to B C
as 50 to 77, and the same A to B D as 50 to 78. And when it goes out
of any other refracting substance into air, the excess of the sine
of refraction of any one species of rays above its sine of incidence
bears a constant proportion, which holds the same in each species, to
the excess of the sine of refraction of the same sort of rays above
the sine of incidence into the air out of glass; provided the sines
of incidence both in glass and the other substance are equal. This
our author verified by transmitting the light through prisms of glass
included within a prismatic vessel of water; and draws from those
experiments the following observations: that whenever the light in
passing through so many surfaces parting diverse transparent substances
is by contrary refractions made to emerge into the air in a direction
parallel to that of its incidence, it will appear afterwards white at
any distance from the prisms, where you shall please to examine it;
but if the direction of its emergence be oblique to its incidence, in
receding from the place of emergence its edges shall appear tinged with
colours: which proves that in the first case there is no inequality
in the refractions of each species of rays, but that when any one
species is so refracted as to emerge parallel to the incident rays,
every sort of rays after refraction shall likewise be parallel to the
same incident rays, and to each other; whereas on the contrary, if the
rays of any one sort are oblique to the incident light, the several
species shall be oblique to each other, and be gradually separated by
that obliquity. From hence he deduces both the forementioned theorem,
and also this other; that in each sort of rays the proportion of the
sine of incidence to the sine of refraction, in the passage of the ray
out of any refracting substance into another, is compounded of the
proportion to which the sine of incidence would have to the sine of
refraction in the passage of that ray out of the first substance into
any third, and of the proportion which the sine of incidence would
have to the sine of refraction in the passage of the ray out of that
third substance into the second. From so simple and plain an experiment
has our most judicious author deduced these important theorems, by
which we may learn how very exact and circumspect he has been in this
whole work of his optics; that notwithstanding his great particularity
in explaining his doctrine, and the numerous collection of experiments
he has made to clear up every doubt which could arise, yet at the same
time he has used the greatest caution to make out every thing by the
simplest and easiest means possible.

9. OUR author adds but one remark more upon refraction, which is, that
if refraction be performed in the manner he has supposed from the
light’s being pressed by the refracting power perpendicularly toward
the surface of the refracting body, and consequently be made to move
swifter in the body than before its incidence; whether this power act
equally at all distances or otherwise, provided only its power in the
same body at the same distances remain without variation the same in
one inclination of the incident rays as well as another; he observes
that the refracting powers in different bodies will be in the duplicate
proportion of the tangents of the lead angles, which the refracted
light can make with the surfaces of the refracting bodies[316].
This observation may be explained thus. When the light passes into
any refracting substance, it has been shewn above that the sine of
incidence bears a constant proportion to the sine of refraction.
Suppose the light to pass to the refracting body A B C D (in fig.
134) in the line E F, and to fall upon it at the point F, and then to
proceed within the body in the line F G. Let H I be drawn through F
perpendicular to the surface A B, and any circle K L M N be described
to the center F. Then from the points O and P where this circle cuts
the incident and refracted ray, the perpendiculars O Q, P R being
drawn, the proportion of O Q to P R will remain the same in all the
different obliquities, in which the same ray of light can fall on the
surface A B. Now O Q is less than F L the semidiameter of the circle K
L M N, but the more the ray E F is inclined down toward the surface A
B, the greater will O Q be, and will approach nearer to the magnitude
of F L. But the proportion of O Q to P R remaining always the same,
when O Q, is largest, P R will also be greatest; so that the more the
incident ray E F is inclined toward the surface A B, the more the ray
F G after refraction will be inclined toward the same. Now if the line
F S T be so drawn, that S V being perpendicular to F I shall be to F L
the semidiameter of the circle in the constant proportion of P R to O
Q; then the angle under N F T is that which I meant by the least of all
that can be made by the refracted ray with this surface, for the ray
after refraction would proceed in this line, if it were to come to the
point F lying on the very surface A B; for if the incident ray came to
the point F in any line between A F and F H, the ray after refraction
would proceed forward in some line between F T and F I. Here if N W
be drawn perpendicular to F N, this line N W in the circle K L M N is
called the tangent of the angle under N F S. Thus much being premised,
the sense of the forementioned proposition is this. Let there be two
refracting substances (in fig. 135) A B C D, and E F G H. Take a point,
as I, in the surface A B, and to the center I with any semidiameter
describe the circle K L M. In like manner on the surface E F take
some point N, as a center, and describe with the same semidiameter
the circle O P Q. Let the angle under B I R be the least which the
refracted light can make with the surface A B, and the angle under F N
S the least which the refracted light can make with the surface E F.
Then if L T be drawn perpendicular to A B, and P V perpendicular to E
F; the whole power, wherewith the substance A B C D acts on the light,
will bear to the whole power wherewith the substance E F G H acts on,
the light, a proportion, which is duplicate of the proportion, which L
T bears to P V.

10. UPON comparing according to this rule the refractive powers of a
great many bodies it is found, that unctuous bodies which abound most
with sulphureous parts refract the light two or three times more in
proportion to their density than others: but that those bodies, which
seem to receive in their composition like proportions of sulphureous
parts, have their refractive powers proportional to their densities; as
appears beyond contradiction by comparing the refractive power of so
rare a substance as the air with that of common glass or rock crystal,
though these substances are 2000 times denser than air; nay the same
proportion is found to hold without sensible difference in comparing
air with pseudo-topar and glass of antimony, though the pseudo-topar
be 3500 times denser than air, and glass of antimony no less than
4400 times denser. This power in other substances, as salts, common
water, spirit of wine, &c. seems to bear a greater proportion to their
densities than these last named, according as they abound with sulphurs
more than these; which makes our author conclude it probable, that
bodies act upon the light chiefly, if not altogether, by means of the
sulphurs in them; which kind of substances it is likely enters in some
degree the composition of all bodies. Of all the substances examined
by our author, none has so great a refractive power, in respect of its
density, as a diamond.

11. OUR author finishes these remarks, and all he offers relating to
refraction, with observing, that the action between light and bodies is
mutual, since sulphureous bodies, which are most readily set on fire
by the sun’s light, when collected upon them with a burning glass, act
more upon light in refracting it, than other bodies of the same density
do. And farther, that the densest bodies, which have been now shewn to
act most upon light, contract the greatest heat by being exposed to the
summer sun.

12. HAVING thus dispatched what relates to refraction, we must address
ourselves to discourse of the other operation of bodies upon light
in reflecting it. When light passes through a surface, which divides
two transparent bodies differing in density, part of it only is
transmitted, another part being reflected. And if the light pass out
of the denser body into the rarer, by being much inclined to the
foresaid surface at length no part of it shall pass through, but be
totally reflected. Now that part of the light, which suffers the
greatest refraction, shall be wholly reflected with a less obliquity
of the rays, than the parts of the light which undergo a less degree
of refraction; as is evident from the last experiment recited in the
first chapter; where, as the prisms D E F, G H I, (in fig. 129.) were
turned about, the violet light was first totally reflected, and then
the blue, next to that the green, and so of the rest. In consequence
of which our author lays down this proportion; that the sun’s light
differs in reflexibility, those rays being most reflexible, which are
most refrangible. And collects from this, in conjunction with other
arguments, that the refraction and reflection, of light are produced
by the same cause, compassing those different effects only by the
difference of circumstances with which it is attended. Another proof
of this being taken by our author from what he has discovered of
the passage of light through thin transparent plates, viz. that any
particular species of light, suppose, for instance, the red-making
rays, will enter and pass out of such a plate, if that plate be of
some certain thicknesses; but if it be of other thicknesses, it will
not break through it, but be reflected back: in which is seen, that
the thickness of the plate determines whether the power, by which that
plate acts upon the light, shall reflect it, or suffer it to pass
through.

13. BUT this last mentioned surprising property of the action between
light and bodies affords the reason of all that has been said in the
preceding chapter concerning the colours of natural bodies; and must
therefore more particularly be illustrated and explained, as being what
will principally unfold the nature of the action of bodies upon light.

14. TO begin: The object glass of a long telescope being laid upon a
plane glass, as proposed in the foregoing chapter, in open day-light
there will be exhibited rings of various colours, as was there related;
but if in a darkened room the  spectrum be formed by the prism,
as in the first experiment of the first chapter, and the glasses be
illuminated by a reflection from the spectrum, the rings shall not
in this case exhibit the diversity of colours before described, but
appear all of the colour of the light which falls upon the glasses,
having dark rings between. Which shews that the thin plate of air
between the glasses at some thicknesses reflects the incident light,
at other places does not reflect it, but is found in those places to
give the light passage; for by holding the glasses in the light as
it passes from the prism to the spectrum, suppose at such a distance
from the prism that the several sorts of light must be sufficiently
separated from each other, when any particular sort of light falls
on the glasses, you will find by holding a piece of white paper at a
small distance beyond the glasses, that at those intervals, where the
dark lines appeared upon the glasses, the light is so transmitted,
as to paint upon the paper rings of light having that colour which
falls upon the glasses. This experiment therefore opens to us this
very strange property of reflection, that in these thin plates it
should bear such a relation to the thickness of the plate, as is here
shewn. Farther, by carefully measuring the diameters of each ring it
is found, that whereas the glasses touch where the dark spot appears
in the center of the rings made by reflexion, where the air is of
twice the thickness at which the light of the first ring is reflected,
there the light by being again transmitted makes the first dark ring;
where the plate has three times that thickness which exhibits the
first lucid ring, it again reflects the light forming the second lucid
ring; when the thickness is four times the first, the light is again
transmitted so as to make the second dark ring; where the air is five
times the first thickness, the third lucid ring is made; where it has
six times the thickness, the third dark ring appears, and so on: in
so much that the thicknesses, at which the light is reflected, are
in proportion to the numbers 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, &c. and the thicknesses,
where the light is transmitted, are in the proportion of the numbers
0, 2, 4, 6, 8, &c. And these proportions between the thicknesses which
reflect and transmit the light remain the same in all situations of the
eye, as well when the rings are viewed obliquely, as when looked on
perpendicularly. We must farther here observe, that the light, when it
is reflected, as well as when it is transmitted, enters the thin plate,
and is reflected from its farther surface; because, as was before
remarked, the altering the transparent body behind the farther surface
alters the degree of reflection as when a thin piece of Muscovy glass
has its farther surface wet with water, and the colour of the glass
made dimmer by being so wet; which shews that the light reaches to the
water, otherwise its reflection could not be influenced by it. But
yet this reflection depends upon some power propagated from the first
surface to the second; for though made at the second surface it depends
also upon the first, because it depends upon the distance between the
surfaces; and besides, the body through which the light passes to the
first surface influences the reflection: for in a plate of Muscovy
glass, wetting the surface, which first receives the light, diminishes
the reflection, though not quite so much as wetting the farther surface
will do. Since therefore the light in passing through these thin plates
at some thicknesses is reflected, but at others transmitted without
reflection, it is evident, that this reflection is caused by some
power propagated from the first surface, which intermits and returns
successively. Thus is every ray apart disposed to alternate reflections
and transmissions at equal intervals; the successive returns of which
disposition our author calls the fits of easy reflection, and of easy
transmission. But these fits, which observe the same law of returning
at equal intervals, whether the plates are viewed perpendicularly or
obliquely, in different situations of the eye change their magnitude.
For what was observed before in respect of those rings, which appear
in open day-light, holds likewise in these rings exhibited by simple
lights; namely, that these two alter in bigness according to the
different angle under which they are seen: and our author lays down a
rule whereby to determine the thicknesses of the plate of air, which
shall exhibit the same colour under different oblique views[317]. And
the thickness of the aereal plate, which in different inclinations of
the rays will exhibit to the eye in open day-light the same colour, is
also varied by the same rule[318]. He contrived farther a method of
comparing in the bubble of water the proportion between the thickness
of its coat, which exhibited any colour when seen perpendicularly,
to the thickness of it, where the same colour appeared by an oblique
view; and he found the same rule to obtain here likewise[319]. But
farther, if the glasses be enlightened successively by all the several
species of light, the rings will appear of different magnitudes; in
the red light they will be larger than in the orange colour, in that
larger than in the yellow, in the yellow larger than in the green,
less in the blue, less yet in the indigo, and least of all in the
violet: which shew that the same thickness of the aereal plate is not
fitted to reflect all colours, but that one colour is reflected where
another would have been transmitted; and as the rays which are most
strongly refracted form the least rings, a rule is laid down by our
author for determining the relation, which the degree of refraction of
each species of colour has to the thicknesses of the plate where it is
reflected.

15. FROM these observations our author shews the reason of that great
variety of colours, which appears in these thin plates in the open
white light of the day. For when this white light falls on the plate,
each part of the light forms rings of its own colour; and the rings
of the different colours not being of the same bigness are variously
intermixed, and form a great variety of tints[320].

16. IN certain experiments, which our author made with thick glasses,
he found, that these fits of easy reflection and transmission returned
for some thousands of times, and thereby farther confirmed his
reasoning concerning them[321].

17. UPON the whole, our great author concludes from some of the
experiments made by him, that the reason why all transparent bodies
refract part of the light incident upon them, and reflect another
part, is, because some of the light, when it comes to the surface of
the body, is in a fit of easy transmission, and some part of it in
a fit of easy reflection; and from the durableness of these fits he
thinks it probable, that the light is put into these fits from their
first emission out of the luminous body; and that these fits continue
to return at equal intervals without end, unless those intervals be
changed by the light’s entring into some refracting substance[322]. He
likewise has taught how to determine the change which is made of the
intervals of the fits of easy transmission and reflection, when the
light passes out of one transparent space or substance into another.
His rule is, that when the light passes perpendicularly to the surface,
which parts any two transparent substances, these intervals in the
substance, out of which the light passes, bear to the intervals in the
substance, whereinto the light enters, the same proportion, as the sine
of incidence bears to the sine of refraction[323]. It is farther to be
observed, that though the fits of easy reflection return at constant
intervals, yet the reflecting power never operates, but at or near a
surface where the light would suffer refraction; and if the thickness
of any transparent body shall be less than the intervals of the fits,
those intervals shall scarce be disturbed by such a body, but the light
shall pass through without any reflection[324].

18. WHAT the power in nature is, whereby this action between light and
bodies is caused, our author has not discovered. But the effects, which
he has discovered, of this power are very surprising, and altogether
wide from any conjectures that had ever been framed concerning it; and
from these discoveries of his no doubt this power is to be deduced,
if we ever can come to the knowledge of it. Sir ISAAC NEWTON has in
general hinted at his opinion concerning it; that probably it is
owing to some very subtle and elastic substance diffused through the
universe, in which such vibrations may be excited by the rays of
light, as they pass through it, that shall occasion it to operate so
differently upon the light in different places as to give rise to these
alternate fits of reflection and transmission, of which we have now
been speaking[325]. He is of opinion, that such a substance may produce
this and other effects also in nature, though it be so rare as not to
give any sensible resistance to bodies in motion[326]; and therefore
not inconsistent with what has been said above, that the planets move
in spaces free from resistance[327].

19. IN order for the more full discovery of this action between light
and bodies, our author began another set of experiments, wherein he
found the light to be acted on as it passes near the edges of solid
bodies; in particular all small bodies, such as the hairs of a man’s
head or the like, held in a very small beam of the sun’s light, cast
extremely broad shadows. And in one of these experiments the shadow
was 35 times the breadth of the body[328]. These shadows are also
observed to be bordered with colours[329]. This our author calls the
inflection of light; but as he informs us, that he was interrupted
from prosecuting these experiments to any length, I need not detain my
readers with a more particular account of them.




~CHAP. IV.~

Of OPTIC GLASSES.


SIR ~ISAAC NEWTON~ having deduced from his doctrine of light and
colours a surprising improvement of telescopes, of which I intend
here to give an account, I shall first premise something in general
concerning those instruments.

2. IT will be understood from what has been said above, that when light
falls upon the surface of glass obliquely, after its entrance into
the glass it is more inclined to the line drawn through the point of
incidence perpendicular to that surface, than before. Suppose a ray of
light issuing from the point A (in fig. 136) falls on a piece of glass
B C D E, whose surface B C, whereon the ray falls, is of a spherical
or globular figure, the center whereof is F. Let the ray proceed in
the line A G falling on the surface B C in the point G, and draw F G
H. Here the ray after its entrance into the glass will pass on in some
line, as G I, more inclined toward the line F G H that the line A G is
inclined thereto; for the line F G H is perpendicular to the surface B
C in the point G. By this means, if a number of rays proceeding from
any one point fall on a convex spherical surface of glass, they shall
be inflected (as is represented in fig. 137,) so as to be gathered
pretty close together about the line drawn through the center of the
glass from the point, whence the rays proceed; which line henceforward
we shall call the axis of the glass: or the point from whence the rays
proceed may be so near the glass, that the rays shall after entring the
glass still go on to spread themselves, but not so much as before; so
that if the rays were to be continued backward (as in fig. 138,) they
should gather together about the axis at a place more remote from the
glass, than the point is, whence they actually proceed. In these and
the following figures A denotes the point to which the rays are related
before refraction, B the point to which they are directed afterwards,
and C the center of the refracting surface. Here we may observe, that
it is possible to form the glass of such a figure, that all the rays
which proceed from one point shall after refraction be reduced again
exactly into one point on the axis of the glass. But in glasses of a
spherical form though this does not happen; yet the rays, which fall
within a moderate distance from the axis, will unite extremely near
together. If the light fall on a concave spherical surface, after
refraction it shall spread quicker than before (as in fig. 139,) unless
the rays proceed from a point between the center and the surface of the
glass. If we suppose the rays of light, which fall upon the glass, not
to proceed from any point, but to move so as to tend all to some point
in the axis of the glass beyond the surface; if the glass have a convex
surface, the rays shall unite about the axis sooner, than otherwise
they would do (as in fig. 140,) unless the point to which they tended
was between the surface and the center of that surface. But if the
surface be concave, they shall not meet so soon: nay perhaps converge.
(See fig. 141 and 142.)

5. FARTHER, because the light in passing out of glass into the air is
turned by the refraction farther off from the line drawn through the
point of incidence perpendicular to the refracting surface, than it was
before; the light which spreads from a point shall by parting through
a convex surface of glass into the air be made either to spread less
than before (as in fig. 143,) or to gather about the axis beyond the
glass (as in fig. 144.) But if the rays of light were proceeding to a
point in the axis of the glass, they should by the refraction be made
to unite sooner about that axis (as in fig. 145.) If the surface of
the glass be concave, rays which proceed from a point shall be made to
spread faster (as in fig 146,) but rays which are tending to a point in
the axis of the glass, shall be made to gather about the axis farther
from the glass (as in fig. 147) or even to diverge (as in fig. 148,)
unless the point, to which the rays are directed, lies between the
surface of the glass and its center.

4. THE rays, which spread themselves from a point, are called
diverging; and such as move toward a point, are called converging rays.
And the point in the axis of the glass, about which the rays gather
after refraction, is called the focus of those rays.

5. IF a glass be formed of two convex spherical surfaces (as in fig.
149,) where the glass AB is formed of the surfaces A C B and A D B, the
line drawn through the centers of the two surfaces, as the line E F, is
called the axis of the glass; and rays, which diverge from any point of
this axis, by the refraction of the glass will be caused to converge
toward some part of the axis, or at least to diverge as from a point
more remote from the glass, than that from whence they proceeded; for
the two surfaces both conspire to produce this effect upon the rays.
But converging rays will be caused by such a glass as this to converge
sooner. If a glass be formed of two concave surfaces, as the glass A
B (in fig. 150,) the line C D drawn through the centers, to which the
two surfaces are formed, is called the axis of the glass. Such a glass
shall cause diverging rays, which proceed from any point in the axis
of the glass, to diverge much more, as if they came from some place in
the axis of the glass nearer to it than the point, whence the rays
actually proceed. But converging rays will be made either to converge
less, or even to diverge.

[Illustration]

6. IN these glasses rays, which proceed from any point near the axis,
will be affected as it were in the same manner, as if they proceeded
from the very axis it self, and such as converge toward a point at a
small distance from the axis will suffer much the same effects from
the glass, as if they converged to some point in the very axis. By
this means any luminous body exposed to a convex glass may have an
image formed upon any white body held beyond the glass. This may be
easily tried with a common spectacle-glass. For if such a glass be held
between a candle and a piece of white paper, if the distances of the
candle, glass, and paper be properly adjusted, the image of the candle
will appear very distinctly upon the paper, but be seen inverted; the
reason whereof is this. Let A B (in fig. 151) be the glass, C D an
object placed cross the axis of the glass. Let the rays of light, which
issue from the point E, where the axis of the glass crosses the object,
be so refracted by the glass, as to meet again about the point F. The
rays, which diverge from the point C of the object, shall meet again
almost at the same distance from the glass, but on the other side of
the axis, as at G; for the rays at the glass cross the axis. In like
manner the rays, which proceed from the point D, will meet about H on
the other side of the axis. None of these rays, neither those which
proceed from the point E in the axis, nor those which issue from C or
D, will meet again exactly in one point; but yet in one place, as is
here supposed at F, G, and H, they will be crouded so close together,
as to make a distinct image of the object upon any body proper to
reflect it, which shall be held there.

7. IF the object be too near the glass for the rays to converge after
the refraction, the rays shall issue out of the glass, as if they
diverged from a point more distant from the glass, than that from
whence they really proceed (as in fig. 152,) where the rays coming from
the point E of the object, which lies on the axis of the glass A B,
issue out of the glass, as if they came from the point F more remote
from the glass than E; and the rays proceeding from the point C issue
out of the glass, as if they proceeded from the point G; likewise the
rays which issue from the point D emerge out of the glass, as if they
came from the point H. Here the point G is on the same side of the
axis, as the point C; and the point H on the same side, as the point
D. In this case to an eye placed beyond the glass the object should
appear, as if it were in the situation G F H.

8. IF the glass A B had been concave (as in, fig. 153,) to an eye
beyond the glass the object C D would appear in the situation G H,
nearer to the glass than really it is. Here also the object will not be
inverted; but the point G is on the same side the axe with the point C,
and H on the same side as D.

9. HENCE may be understood, why spectacles made with convex glasses
help the sight in old age: for the eye in that age becomes unfit to
see objects distinctly, except such as are remov’d to a very great
distance; whence all men, when they first stand in need of spectacles,
are observed to read at arm’s length, and to hold the object at a
greater distance, than they used to do before. But when an object is
removed at too great a distance from the sight, it cannot be seen
clearly, by reason that a less quantity of light from the object will
enter the eye, and the whole object will also appear smaller. Now by
help of a convex glass an object may be held near, and yet the rays of
light issuing from it will enter the eye, as if the object were farther
removed.

10. AFTER the same manner concave glasses assist such, as are short
sighted. For these require the object to be brought inconveniently near
to the eye, in order to their seeing it distinctly; but by such a glass
the object may be removed to a proper distance, and yet the rays of
light enter the eye, as if they came from a place much nearer.

11. WHENCE these defects of the sight arise, that in old age
objects cannot be seen distinct within a moderate distance, and in
short-sightedness not without being brought too near, will be easily
understood, when the manner of vision in general shall be explain’d;
which I shall now endeavour to do, in order to be better understood in
what follows. The eye is form’d, as is represented in fig. 154. It is
of a globular figure, the fore part whereof scarce more protuberant
than the rest is transparent. Underneath this transparent part is a
small collection of an humour in appearance like water, and it has also
the same refractive power as common water; this is called the aqueous
humour, and fills the space A B C D in the figure. Next beyond lies the
body D E F G; this is solid but transparent, it is composed with two
convex surfaces, the hinder surface E F G being more convex, than the
anterior E D G. Between the outer membrane A B C, and this body E D G
F is placed that membrane, which exhibits the colours, that are seen
round the sight of the eye; and the black spot, which is called the
sight or pupil, is a hole in this membrane, through which the light
enters, whereby we see. This membrane is fixed only by its outward
circuit, and has a muscular power, whereby it dilates the pupil in
a weak light, and contracts it in a strong one. The body D E F G is
called the crystalline humour, and has a greater refracting power than
water. Behind this the bulk of the eye is filled up with what is called
the vitreous humor, this has much the same refractive power with water.
At the bottom of the eye toward the inner side next the nose the optic
glass enters, as at H, and spreads it self all over the inside of the
eye, till within a small diftance from A and C. Now any object, as I K,
being placed before the eye, the rays of light issuing from each point
of this object are so refracted by the convex surface of the aqueous
humour, as to be caused to converge; after this being received by the
convex surface E D G of the crystalline humour, which has a greater
refractive power than the aqueous, the rays, when they are entered into
this surface, still more converge, and at going out of the surface E F
G into a humour of a less refractive power than the crystalline they
are made to converge yet farther. By all these successive refractions
they are brought to converge at the bottom of the eye, so that a
distinct image of the object as L M is impress’d on the nerve. And by
this means the object is seen.

11. IT has been made a difficulty, that the image of the object
impressed on the nerve is inverted, so that the upper part of the image
is impressed on the lower part of the eye. But this difficulty, I
think, can no longer remain, if we only consider, that upper and lower
are terms merely relative to the ordinary position of our bodies: and
our bodies, when view’d by the eye, have their image as much inverted
as other objects; so that the image of our own bodies, and of other
objects, are impressed on the eye in the same relation to one another,
as they really have.

12. THE eye can see objects equally distinct at very different
distances, but in one distance only at the same time. That the eye may
accomodate itself to different distances, some change in its humours
is requir’d. It is my opinion, that this change is made in the figure
of the crystalline humour, as I have indeavoured to prove in another
place.

13. IF any of the humours of the eye are too flat, they will refract
the light too little; which is the case in old age. If they are too
convex, they refract too much; as in those who are short-sighted.

14. THE manner of direct vision being thus explained, I proceed to give
some account of telescopes, by which we view more distinctly remote
objects; and also of microscopes, whereby we magnify the appearance of
small objects. In the first place, the most simple sort of telescope
is composed of two glasses, either both convex, or one convex, and the
other concave. (The first sort of these is represented in fig. 155, the
latter in fig. 156.)

15. IN fig. 155 let A B represent the convex glass next the object, C
D the other glass more convex near the eye. Suppose the object-glass A
B to form the image of the object at E F; so that if a sheet of white
paper were to be held in this place, the object would appear. Now
suppose the rays, which pass the glass A B, and are united about F, to
proceed to the eye glass C D, and be there refracted. Three only of
these rays are drawn in the figure, those which pass by the extremities
of the glass A B, and that which passes its middle. If the glass C D
be placed at such a distance from the image E F, that the rays, which
pass by the point F, after having proceeded through the glass diverge
so much, as the rays do that come from an object, which is at such a
distance from the eye as to be seen distinctly, these being received
by the eye will make on the bottom of the eye a distinct representation
of the point F. In like manner the rays, which pass through the object
glass A B to the point E after proceeding through the eye-glass C D
will on the bottom of the eye make a distinct representation of the
point E. But if the eye be placed where these rays, which proceed from
E, cross those, which proceed from F, the eye will receive the distinct
impression of both these points at the same time; and consequently
will also receive a distinct impression from all the intermediate
parts of the image E F, that is, the eye will see the object, to which
the telescope is directed, distinctly. The place of the eye is about
the point G, where the rays H E, H F cross, which pass through the
middle of the object-glass A B to the points E and F; or at the place
where the focus would be formed by rays coming from the point H, and
refracted by the glass C D. To judge how much this instrument magnifies
any object, we must first observe, that the angle under E H F, in which
the eye at the point H would see the image E F, is nearly the same as
the angle, under which the object appears by direct vision; but when
the eye is in G, and views the object through the telescope, it sees
the same under a greater angle; for the rays, which coming from E and F
cross in G, make a greater angle than the rays, which proceed from the
point H to these points E and F. The angle at G is greater than that at
H in the proportion, as the distance between the glasses A B and C D is
greater than the distance of the point G from the glass C D.

16. THIS telescope inverts the object; for the rays, which came from
the right-hand side of the object, go to the point E the left side of
the image; and the rays, which come from the left side of the object,
go to F the right side of the image. These rays cross again in G, so
that the rays, which come from the right side of the object, go to the
right side of the eye; and the rays from the left side of the object go
to the left side of the eye. Therefore in this telescope the image in
the eye has the same situation as the object; and seeing that in direct
vision the image in the eye has an inverted situation, here, where
the situation is not inverted, the object must appear so. This is no
inconvenience to astronomers in celestial observations; but for objects
here on the earth it is usual to add two other convex glasses, which
may turn the object again (as is represented in fig. 157,) or else to
use the other kind of telescope with a concave eye-glass.

17. IN this other kind of telescope the effect is founded on the same
principles, as in the former. The distinctness of the appearance is
procured in the same manner. But here the eye-glass C D (in fig. 156)
is placed between the image E F, and the object glass A B. By this
means the rays, which come from the right-hand side of the object,
and proceed toward E the left side of the image, being intercepted by
the eye-glass are carried to the left side of the eye; and the rays,
which come from the left side of the object, go to the right side of
the eye; so that the impression in the eye being inverted the object
appears in the same situation, as when view’d by the naked eye. The
eye must here be placed close to the glass. The degree of magnifying in
this instrument is thus to be found. Let the rays, which pass through
the glass A B at H, after the refraction of the eye-glass C D diverge,
as if they came from the point G; then the rays, which come from the
extremities of the object, enter the eye under the angle at G; so
that here also the object will be magnified in the proportion of the
distance between the glasses, to the distance of G from the eye-glass.

18. THE space, that can be taken in at one view in this telescope,
depends on the breadth of the pupil of the eye; for as the rays, which
go to the points E, F of the image, are something distant from each
other, when they come out of the glass C D, if they are wider asunder
than the pupil, it is evident, that they cannot both enter the eye
at once. In the other telescope the eye is placed in the point G,
where the rays that come from the points E or F cross each other, and
therefore must enter the eye together. On this account the telescope
with convex glasses takes in a larger view, than those with concave.
But in these also the extent of the view is limited, because the
eye-glass does not by the refraction towards its edges form so distinct
a representation of the object, as near the middle.

18. MICROSCOPES are of two sorts. One kind is only a very convex glass,
by the means of which the object may be brought very near the eye, and
yet be seen distinctly. This microscope magnifies in proportion, as
the object by being brought near the eye will form a broader impression
on the optic nerve. The other kind made with convex glasses produces
its effects in the same manner as the telescope. Let the object A B
(in fig. 158) be placed under the glass C D, and by this glass let an
image be formed of this object. Above this image let the glass G H be
placed. By this glass let the rays, which proceed from the points A and
B, be refracted, as is expressed in the figure. In particular, let the
rays, which from each of these points pass through the middle of the
glass C D, cross in I, and there let the eye be placed. Here the object
will appear larger, when seen through the microscope, than if that
instrument were removed, in proportion as the angle, in which these
rays cross in I, is greater than the angle, which the lines would make,
that should be drawn from I to A and B; that is, in the proportion made
up of the proportion of the distance of the object A B from I, to the
distance of I from the glass G H; and of the proportion of the distance
between the glasses, to the distance of the object A B from the glass C
D.


19. I SHALL now proceed to explain the imperfection in these
instruments, occasioned by the different refrangibility of the light
which comes from every object. This prevents the image of the object
from being formed in the focus of the object glass with perfect
distinctness; so that if the eye-glass magnify the image overmuch,
the imperfections of it must be visible, and make the whole appear
confused. Our author more fully to satisfy himself, that the different
refrangibility of the several sorts of rays is sufficient to produce
this irregularity, underwent the labour of a very nice and difficult
experiment, whose process he has at large set down, to prove, that the
rays of light are refracted as differently in the small refraction
of telescope glasses as in the larger of the prism; so exceeding
careful has he been in searching out the true cause of this effect.
And he used, I suppose, the greater caution, because another reason
had before been generally assigned for it. It was the opinion of all
mathematicians, that this defect in telescopes arose from the figure,
in which the glasses were formed; a spherical refracting surface not
collecting into an exact point all the rays which come from any one
point of an object, as has before been said[330]. But after our author
has proved, that in these small refractions, as well as in greater,
the sine of incidence into air out of glass, to the sine of refraction
in the red-making rays, is as 50 to 77, and in the blue-making rays 50
to 78; he proceeds to compare the inequalities of refraction arising
from this different refrangibility of the rays, with the inequalities,
which would follow from the figure of the glass, were light uniformly
refracted. For this purpose he observes, that if rays issuing from
a point so remote from the object glass of a telescope, as to be
esteemed parallel, which is the case of the rays, which come from the
heavenly bodies; then the distance from the glass of the point, in
which the least refrangible rays are united, will be to the distance,
at which the most refrangible rays unite, as 28 to 27; and therefore
that the least space, into which all the rays can be collected, will
not be less than the 55th part of the breadth of the glass. For if A
B (in fig. 159) be the glass, C D its axis, E A, F B two rays of the
light parallel to that axis entring the glass near its edges; after
refraction let the least refrangible part of these rays meet in G,
the most refrangible in H; then, as has been said, G I will be to I
H, as 28 to 27; that is, G H will be the 28th part of G I, and the
27th part of H I; whence if K L be drawn through G, and M N through H,
perpendicular to C D, M N will be the a 28th part of A B, the breadth
of the glass, and K L the 27th part of the same; so that O P the least
space, into which the rays are gathered, will be about half the mean
between these two, that is the 55th part of A B.

20. THIS is the error arising from the different refrangibility
of the rays of light, which our author finds vastly to exceed the
other, consequent upon the figure of the glass. In particular, if the
telescope glass be flat on one side, and convex on the other; when the
flat side is turned towards the object, by a theorem, which he has laid
down, the error from the figure comes out above 5000 times less than
the other. This other inequality is so great, that telescopes could
not perform so well as they do, were it not that the light does not
equally fill all the space O P, over which it is scattered, but is much
more dense toward the middle of that space than at the extremities. And
besides, all the kinds of rays affect not the sense equally strong, the
yellow and orange being the strongest, the red and green next to them,
the blue indigo and violet being much darker and fainter colours; and
it is shewn that all the yellow and orange, and three fifths of the
brighter half of the red next the orange, and as great a share of the
brighter half of the green next the yellow, will be collected into a
space whose breadth is not above the 250th part of the breadth of the
glass.

[Illustration]

And the remaining colours, which fall without this space, as they are
much more dull and obscure than these, so will they be likewise much
more diffused; and therefore call hardly affect the sense in comparison
of the other. And agreeable to this is the observation of astronomers,
that telescopes between twenty and sixty feet in length represent the
fixed stars, as being about 5 or 6, at most about 8 or 10 seconds in
diameter. Whereas other arguments shew us, that they do not really
appear to us of any sensible magnitude any otherwise than as their
light is dilated by refraction. One proof that the fixed stars do not
appear to us under any sensible angle is, that when the moon passes
over any of them, their light does not, like the planets on the same
occasion, disappear by degrees, but vanishes at once.

21. OUR author being thus convinced, that telescopes were not
capable of being brought to much greater perfection than at present
by refractions, contrived one by reflection, in which there is no
separation made of the different  light; for in every kind of
light the rays after reflection have the same degree of inclination
to the surface, from whence they are reflected, as they have at their
incidence, so that those rays which come to the surface in one line,
will go off also in one line without any parting from one another.
Accordingly in the attempt he succeeded so well, that a short one, not
much exceeding six inches in length, equalled an ordinary telescope
whose length was four feet. Instruments of this kind to greater
lengths, have of late been made, which fully answer expectation[331].




~CHAP. V.~

Of the RAINBOW.


I SHALL now explain the rainbow. The manner of its production was
understood, in the general, before Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ had discovered
his theory of colours; but what caused the diversity of colours in it
could not then be known, which obliges him to explain this appearance
particularly; whom we shall imitate as follows. The first person, who
expressly shewed the rainbow to be formed by the reflection of the
sun-beams from drops of falling rain, was ANTONIO DE DOMINIS. But this
was afterwards more fully and distinctly explained by DESCARTES.

2. THERE appears most frequently two rainbows; both of which are caused
by the foresaid reflection of the sun-beams from the drops of falling
rain, but are not produced by all the light which falls upon and are
reflected from the drops. The inner bow is produced by those rays only
which enter the drop, and at their entrance are so refracted as to
unite into a point, as it were, upon the farther surface of the drop,
as is represented in fig. 160; where the contiguous rays _a b_, _c d_,
_e f_, coming from the sun, and therefore to sense parallel, upon
their entrance into the drop in the points _b, d, f_, are so refracted
as to meet together in the point _g_, upon the farther surface of
the drop. Now these rays being reflected nearly from the same point
of the surface, the angle of incidence of each ray upon the point g
being equal to the angle of reflection, the rays will return in the
lines _g h, g k, g l_, in the same manner inclined to each other, as
they were before their incidence upon the point _g_, and will make
the same angles with the surface of the drop at the points _b, k,
l_, as at the points _b, d, f_, after their entrance; and therefore
after their emergence out of the drop each ray will be inclined to the
surface in the same angle, as when it first entered it; whence the
lines _b m, k n, l o_, in which the rays emerge, must be parallel to
each other, as well as the lines _a b, c d, e f_, in which they were
incident. But these emerging rays being parallel will not spread nor
diverge from each other in their passage from the drop, and therefore
will enter the eye conveniently situated in sufficient plenty to cause
a sensation. Whereas all the other rays, whether those nearer the
center of the drop, as _p q, r s_, or those farther off, as _t u, w
x_, will be reflected from other points in the hinder surface of the
drop; namely, the ray _p q_ from the point _y, r s_ from _z, t v_
from α, and _w x_ from β. And for this reason by their reflection and
succeeding refraction they will be scattered after their emergence from
the forementioned rays and from each other, and therefore cannot enter
the eye placed to receive them copious enough to excite any distinct
sensation.

3. THE external rainbow is formed by two reflections made between the
incidence and emergence of the rays; for it is to be noted, that the
rays _g h, g k, g l_, at the points _h, k, l_, do not wholly pass
out of the drop, but are in part reflected back; though the second
reflection of these particular rays does not form the outer bow. For
this bow is made by those rays, which after their entrance into the
drop are by the refraction of it united, before they arrive at the
farther surface, at such a distance from it, that when they fall
upon that surface, they may be reflected in parallel lines, as is
represented in fig. 161; where the rays _a b, c d, e f_, are collected
by the refraction of the drop into the point _g_, and passing on from
thence strike upon the surface of the drop in the points _h, k, l_, and
are thence reflected to _m, n, o_, passing from _h_ to _m_, from _k_
to _n_, and from _l_ to _o_ in parallel lines. For these rays after
reflection at _m, n, o_, will meet again in the point _p_, at the same
distance from these points of reflection _m, n, o_, as the point _g_ is
from the former points of reflection _h, k, l_. Therefore these rays
in passing from _p_ to the surface of the drop will fall upon that
surface in the points _q, r, s_ in the same angles, as these rays made
with the surface in _b, d, f_, after refraction. Consequently, when
these rays emerge out of the drop into the air, each ray will make
with the surface of the drop the same angle, as it made at its first
incidence; so that the lines _q t, r v, s w_, in which they come from
the drop, will be parallel to each other, as well as the lines _a b,
c d, e f_, in which they came to the drop. By this means these rays
to a spectator commodiously situated will become visible. But all the
other rays, as well those nearer the center of the drop _x y_, _z_
α, as those more remote from it β γ, δ ε, will be reflected in lines
not parallel to the lines _h m, k n, l o_; namely, the ray _x y_, in
the line ζ η, the ray ϰ α in the line θ ϰ, the ray β γ in the line
λ μ, and the ray δ ε in the line ν χ. Whence these rays after their
next reflection and subsequent refraction will be scattered from the
forementioned rays, and from one another, and by that means become
invisible.

4. IT is farther to be remarked, that if in the first case the incident
rays _a b, c d, e f_, and their correspondent emergent rays _h m, k
n, l o_, are produced till they meet, they will make with each other
a greater angle, than any other incident ray will make with its
corresponding emergent ray. And in the latter case, on the contrary,
the emergent rays _q t, r v, s w_ make with the incident rays an acuter
angle, than is made by any other of the emergent rays.

5. OUR author delivers a method of finding each of these extream angles
from the degree of refraction being given; by which method it appears,
that the first of these angles is the less, and the latter the greater,
by how much the refractive power of the drop, or the refrangibility of
the rays is greater. And this last consideration fully compleats the
doctrine of the rainbow, and shews, why the colours of each bow are
ranged in the order wherein they are seen.

6. SUPPOSE A (in fig. 162.) to be the eye, B, C, D, E, F, drops of
rain, M _n_, O _p_, Q _r_, S _t_, V _w_ parcels of rays of the sun,
which entring the drops B, C, D, E, F after one reflection pass out to
the eye in A. Now let M _n_ be produced to η till it meets with the
emergent ray likewise produced, let O _p_ produced meet its emergent
ray produced in ϰ, let Q _r_ meet its emergent ray in λ, let S _t_ meet
its emergent ray in μ, and let V _w_ meet its emergent ray produced
in ν. If the angle under M η A be that, which is derived from the
refraction of the violet-making rays by the method we have here spoken
of, it follows that the violet light will only enter the eye from
the drop B, all the other  rays passing below it, that is,
all those rays which are not scattered, but go out parallel so as to
cause a sensation. For the angle, which these parallel emergent rays
makes with the incident in the most refrangible or violet-making rays,
being less than this angle in any other sort of rays, none of the rays
which emerge parallel, except the violet-making, will enter the eye
under the angle M η A, but the rest making with the incident ray M η
a greater angle than this will pass below the eye. In like manner if
the angle under O ϰ A agrees to the blue-making rays, the blue rays
only shall enter the eye from the drop C, and all the other 
rays will pass by the eye, the violet- rays passing above, the
other colours below. Farther, the angle Q λ A corresponding to the
green-making rays, those only shall enter the eye from the drop D, the
violet and blue-making rays passing above, and the other colours, that
is the yellow and red, below. And if the angle S μ A answers to the
refraction of the yellow-making rays, they only shall come to the eye
from the drop E. And in the last place, if the angle V ν A belongs to
the red-making and least refrangible rays, they only shall enter the
eye from the drop F, all the other  rays passing above.

7. BUT now it is evident, that all the drops of water found in any of
the lines A ϰ, A λ, A μ, A ν, whether farther from the eye, or nearer
than the drops B, C, D, E, F, will give the same colours as these do,
all the drops upon each line giving the same colour; so that the light
reflected from a number of these drops will become copious enough to be
visible; whereas the reflection from one minute drop alone could not be
perceived. But besides, it is farther manifest, that if the line A Ξ be
drawn from the sun through the eye, that is, parallel to the lines M
_n_, O _p_, Q _r_, S _t_, V _w_, and if drops of water are placed all
round this line, the same colour will be exhibited by all the drops at
the same distance from this line. Hence it follows, that when the sun
is moderately elevated above the horizon, if it rains opposite to it,
and the sun shines upon the drops as they fall, a spectator with his
back turned to the sun must observe a  circular arch reaching
to the horizon, being red without, next to that yellow, then green,
blue, and on the inner edge violet; only this last colour appears faint
by being diluted with the white light of the clouds, and from another
cause to be mentioned hereafter[332].

8. THUS is caused the interior or primary bow. The drops of rain at
some distance without this bow will cause the exterior or secondary
bow by two reflections of the sun’s light. Let these drops be G, H, I,
K, L; X _y_, Z α, Γ β, Δ ι, Θ ζ denoting parcels of rays which enter
each drop. Now it has been remarked, that these rays make with the
visible refracted rays the greatest angle in those rays, which are
most refrangible. Suppose therefore the visible refracted rays, which
pass out from each drop after two reflections, and enter the eye in
A, to intersect the incident rays in π, ρ, σ, τ, φ respectively. It
is manifest, that the angle under Θ φ A is the greatest of all, next
to that the angle under Δ τ A, the next in bigness will be the angle
under Γ σ A, the next to this the angle under Z ρ A, and the least of
all the angle under X π A. From the drop L therefore will come to the
eye the violet-making, or most refrangible rays, from K the blue, from
I the green, from H the yellow, and from G the red-making rays; and
the like will happen to all the drops in the lines A π, A ρ, A τ, A φ,
and also to all the drops at the same distances from the line A Ξ all
round that line. Whence appears the reason of the secondary bow, which
is seen without the other, having its colours in a contrary order,
violet without and red within; though the colours are fainter than in
the other bow, as being made by two reflections, and two refractions;
whereas the other bow is made by two refractions, and one reflection
only.

9. THERE is a farther appearance in the rainbow particularly described
about five years ago[333], which is, that under the upper part or
the inner bow there appears often two or three orders of very faint
colours, making alternate arches of green, and a reddish purple. At the
time this appearance was taken notice of, I gave my thoughts concerning
the cause of it[334], which I shall here repeat. Sir ~ISAAC NEWTON~ has
observed, that in glass, which is polished and quick-silvered, there is
an irregular refraction made, whereby some small quantity of light is
scattered from the principal reflected beam[335]. If we allow the same
thing to happen in the reflection whereby the rainbow is caused, it
seems sufficient to produce the appearance now mentioned.

10. LET A B (in fig. 162.) represent a globule of water, B the point
from whence the rays of any determinate species being reflected to C,
and afterwards emerging in the line C D, would proceed to the eye, and
cause the appearance of that colour in the rainbow, which appertains to
this species. Here suppose, that besides what is reflected regularly,
some small part of the light is irregularly scattered every way; so
that from the point B, besides the rays that are regularly reflected
from B to C, some scattered rays will return in other lines, as
in B E, B F, B G, B H, on each side the line B C. Now it has been
observed above[336], that the rays of light in their passage from one
superficies of a refracting body to the other undergo alternate fits
of easy transmission and reflection, succeeding each other at equal
intervals; insomuch that if they reach the farther superficies in one
sort of those fits, they shall be transmitted; if in the other kind
of them, they shall rather be reflected back. Whence the rays that
proceed from B to C, and emerge in the line C D, being in a fit of
easy transmission, the scattered rays, that fall at a small distance
without these on either side (suppose the rays that pass in the lines
B E, B G) shall fall on the surface in a fit of easy reflection, and
shall not emerge; but the scattered rays, that pass at some distance
without these last, shall arrive at the surface of the globule in a fit
of easy transmission, and break through that surface. Suppose these
rays to pass in the lines B F, B H; the former of which rays shall have
had one fit more of easy transmission, and the latter one fit less,
than the rays that pass from B to C. Now both these rays, when they
go out of the globule, will proceed by the refraction of the water
In the lines F I, H K, that will be inclined almost equally to the
rays incident on the globule, which come from the sun; but the angles
of their inclination will be less than the angle, in which the rays
emerging in the line C D are inclined to those incident rays. And after
the same manner rays scattered from the point B at a certain distance
without these will emerge out of the globule, while the intermediate
rays are intercepted; and these emergent rays will be inclined to the
rays incident on the globule in angles still less than the angles, in
which the rays F I and H K are inclined to them; and without these rays
will emerge other rays, that shall be inclined to the incident rays in
angles yet less.

[Illustration]

Now by this means may be formed of every kind of rays, besides the
principal arch, which goes to the formation of the rainbow, other
arches within every one of the principal of the same colour, though
much more faint; and this for divers successions, as long as these weak
lights, which in every arch grow more and more obscure, shall continue
visible. Now as the arches produced by each colour will be variously
mixed together, the diversity of colours observ’d in these secondary
arches may very possibly arise from them.

11. IN the darker colours these arches may reach below the bow, and
be seen distinct. In the brighter colours these arches are lost in
the inferior part of the principal light of the rainbow; but in all
probability they contribute to the red tincture, which the purple of
the rainbow usually has, and is most remarkable when these secondary
colours appear strongest. However these secondary arches in the
brightest colours may possibly extend with a very faint light below the
bow, and tinge the purple of these secondary arches with a reddish hue.

12. THE precise distances between the principal arch and these fainter
arches depend on the magnitude of the drops, wherein they are formed.
To make them any degree separate it is necessary the drop be exceeding
small. It is most likely, that they are formed in the vapour of the
cloud, which the air being put in motion by the fall of the rain may
carry down along with the larger drops; and this may be the reason, why
these colours appear under the upper part of the bow only, this vapour
not descending very low. As a farther confirmation of this, these
colours are seen strongest, when the rain falls from very black clouds,
which cause the fiercest rains, by the fall whereof the air will be
most agitated.

13. TO the like alternate return of the fits of easy transmission and
reflection in the passage of light through the globules of water, which
compose the clouds, Sir ISAAC NEWTON ascribes some of those 
circles, which at times appear about the sun and moon[337].

[Illustration]

[Illustration]




CONCLUSION.


SIR ~ISAAC NEWTON~ having concluded each of his philosophical treatises
with some general reflections, I shall now take leave of my readers
with a short account of what he has there delivered. At the end of
his mathematical principles of natural philosophy he has given us his
thoughts concerning the Deity. Wherein he first observes, that the
similitude found in all parts of the universe makes it undoubted, that
the whole is governed by one supreme being, to whom the original is
owing of the frame of nature, which evidently is the effect of choice
and design. He then proceeds briefly to state the best metaphysical
notions concerning God. In short, we cannot conceive either of space
or time otherwise than as necessarily existing; this Being therefore,
on whom all others depend, must certainly exist by the same necessity
of nature. Consequently wherever space and time is found, there God
must also be. And as it appears impossible to us, that space should be
limited, or that time should have had a beginning, the Deity must be
both immense and eternal.

2. AT the end of his treatise of optics he has proposed some thoughts
concerning other parts of nature, which he had not distinctly searched
into. He begins with some farther reflections concerning light, which
he had not fully examined. In particular he declares his sentiments at
large concerning the power, whereby bodies and light act on each other.
In some parts of his book he had given short hints at his opinion
concerning this[338], but here he expressly declares his conjecture,
which we have already mentioned[339], that this power is lodged in
a very subtle spirit of a great elastic force diffused thro’ the
universe, producing not only this, but many other natural operations.
He thinks it not impossible, that the power of gravity itself should be
owing to it. On this occasion he enumerates many natural appearances,
the chief of which are produced by chymical experiments. From numerous
observations of this kind he makes no doubt, that the smallest parts of
matter, when near contact, act strongly on each other, sometimes being
mutually attracted, at other times repelled.

3. THE attractive power is more manifest than the other, for
the parts of all bodies adhere by this principle. And the name of
attraction, which our author has given to it, has been very freely
made use of by many writers, and as much objected to by others. He has
often complained to me of having been misunderstood in this matter.
What he lays upon this head was not intended by him as a philosophical
explanation of any appearances, but only to point out a power in nature
not hitherto distinctly observed, the cause of which, and the manner of
its acting, he thought was worthy of a diligent enquiry. To acquiesce
in the explanation of any appearance by asserting it to be a general
power of attraction, is not to improve our knowledge in philosophy, but
rather to put a stop to our farther search.

                                FINIS.

[Illustration]




                              FOOTNOTES:

[1] Philosoph. Nat. princ. math. L. iii. introduct.

[2] Nov. Org. Scient. L. i. Aphorism. 9.

[3] Nov. Org. L. i. Aph. 19.

[4] Ibid. Aph. 25.

[5] Aph. 30. Errores radicales & in prima digestione mentis ab
excellentia functionum & remediorum sequentium non curantur.

[6] Aph. 38.

[7] Ibid.

[8] Aph. 39.

[9] Aph. 41.

[10] Aph. 10, 24.

[11] Aph. 45.

[12] De Cartes Princ. Phil. Part. 3. §. 52.

[13] Fermat, in Oper. pag. 156, &c.

[14] Nov. Org. Aph. 46.

[15] Aph. 50.

[16] Ibid.

[17] Aph 53.

[18] Aph. 54.

[19] Aph. 56.

[20] Aph. 55.

[21] Locke, On human understanding, B. iii.

[22] Nov. Org. Aph. 59.

[23] In the conclusion.

[24] Nov. Org. L. i. Aph. 59.

[25] Ibid. Aph. 60.

[26] Ibid. Aph. 62.

[27] Aph. 63.

[28] Aph. 64.

[29] Aph. 65.

[30] See above, § 4, 5.

[31] Nov. Org. L. i. Aph. 69.

[32] Ibid.

[33] Ibid. Aph. 109.

[34] Book III. Chap. iv.

[35] Book I. Chap. 2. § 14.

[36] Ibid. § 85, &c.

[37] See Book II. Ch. 3. § 3, 4. of this treatise.

[38] See Book II. Ch. 3. of this treatise.

[39] See Chap. 4.

[40] At the end of his Optics. in Qu. 21.

[41] See the same treatise, in Advertisement 2.

[42] Nov. Org. Lib. i. Ax. 105.

[43] Princip. philos. pag. 13, 14.

[44] Princ. Philos. L. II. prop. 24. corol. 7. See also B. II. Ch. 5. §
3. of this treatise.

[45] How this degree of elasticity is to be found by experiment, will
be shewn below in § 74.

[46] In oper. posthum de Motu corpor. ex percussion. prop. 9.

[47] In the above-cited place.

[48] In the place above-cited.

[49] These experiments are described in § 73.

[50] Book II. Chap. 5.

[51] Chap. 1. § 25, 26, 27, compared with § 15, &c.

[52] Book II. Chap. 5. § 3.

[53] See Euclid’s Elements, Book XII. prop. 13.

[54] Archimed. de æquipond. prop. 11.

[55] Ibid. prop. 12.

[56] Lucas Valerius De centr. gravit. solid. L. I. prop. 2.

[57] Idem L. II. prop. 2.

[58] § 25.

[59] § 27.

[60] Pag. 65, 68.

[61] § 23.

[62] § 20

[63] § 17.

[64] § 27.

[65] Hugen. Horolog. oscillat. pag. 141, 142.

[66] See Hugen. Horolog. Oscillat. p. 142.

[67] Princip. Philos. pag. 22.

[68] Chap. 1. § 29.

[69] Princip. Philos. pag. 25.

[70] § 71.

[71] See Method. Increment. prop. 25.

[72] Lib. XI. Def.

[73] Chap. 2. § 17.

[74] See above Ch. 2. § 17.

[75] From B II. Ch. 3.

[76] Prin. Philos. pag. 7, &c.

[77] See Newton, princip. philos. pag. 9. lin. 30.

[78] Princip. Philos. pag. 10.

[79] Renat. Des Cart. Princ. Philos. Part. II. § 25.

[80] Ibid. § 30.

[81] § 85, &c.

[82] Princip. Philos. Lib. I. prop. 9.

[83] § 92.

[84] Ch. II. § 22.

[85] Viz. L. I. prop. 30, 29, & 26.

[86] Ch. II. § 21, 22.

[87] viz. His doctrine of prime and ultimate ratios.

[88] § 57

[89] § 3.

[90] Ch. 2. § 22.

[91] § 12.

[92] Ch. 1. sect. 21, 22.

[93] Elem. Book I. p. 37.

[94] § 12.

[95] Ch 1 § 24.

[96] Ch 2 select. 17.

[97] Newt. Princ. L. II. prop. 2; 5, 6, 7; 11, 12.

[98] Prop. 3; 8, 9; 13, 14.

[99] Prop. 4.

[100] Prælect. Geometr. pag. 123.

[101] Newton. Princ. Lib. II. prop. 10.

[102] Newton. Princ. Lib II. prop 10. in schol.

[103] Torricelli de motu gravium.

[104] Ch. 2 § 85, &c.

[105] Newt. Princ L. II. sect 6.

[106] L. II. sect. 4.

[107] See B. II. Ch 6. § 7. of this treatise.

[108] Lib. I. sect. 10.

[109] De la Pesanteur, pag. 169, and the following.

[110] Newton. Princ. L. II. prop 4. schol.

[111] See his Tract on the admirable rarifaction of the air.

[112] Book II. Ch. 6.

[113] Princ. philos. Lib. II. prop. 23.

[114] Book I. Ch. 2. § 30.

[115] Princ. philos. Lib. II. prop. 23, in schol.

[116] Princ. philos. Lib. II. prop. 33. coroll.

[117] Lib. II. Ch. 5.

[118] Ibid. Prop. 35. coroll. 2.

[119] Ibid. coroll. 3.

[120] Vid. ibid. coroll. 6.

[121] In § 2.

[122] Princ. philos. Lib. II. Prop. 35.

[123] Ibid.

[124] Id.

[125] h. 1. § 29.

[126] Princ. philos. Lib. II. Prop. 38, compared with coroll. 1 of
prop. 35.

[127] L. II. Lem. 7. schol. pag. 341.

[128] Lib. II. Prop. 34.

[129] Lib. II. Lem. 7. p. 341.

[130] Schol. to Lem. 7.

[131] Prop. 34. schol.

[132] Ibid.

[133] Ibid.

[134] Book II. Ch. I. § 6.

[135] Vid. Newt. princ. in schol. to Lem. 7, of Lib. II. pag. 341.

[136] Sect. 17. of this chapter.

[137] See Princ. philos. Lib. II. prop. 34.

[138] Vid. Princ. philos. Lib. II. Lem. 5. p. 314.

[139] Lemm. 6.

[140] Ibid. 7.

[141] Newt. Princ. Lib. II. prop. 40, in schol.

[142] Lib. II. in schol. post prop. 31.

[143] Book I. ch. 2 § 82.

[144] Book I. Ch. 3 § 29.

[145] Ch. 3. of this present book.

[146] Ch. 4.

[147] In Princ. philos. part. 3.

[148] Philos. princ. mathem. Lib. II. prop. 2. & schol.

[149] Ibid. prop 53.

[150] Philos. princ. prop. 52. coroll. 4.

[151] Ibid.

[152] Coroll. 11.

[153] See ibid. schol. post prop. 53.

[154] Princ. philos. pag. 316, 317.

[155] Ch. I. § 7.

[156] Book I. Ch. 3.

[157] Book I. Ch. 3. § 29.

[158] Ibid. Ch. 2. § 30, 17.

[159] Book I. Ch. 3.

[160] Ch. 1. § 7.

[161] Chap. 5. § 8.

[162] Princ. pag. 60.

[163] Street, in Astron. Carolin.

[164] See Chap. 5. §9, &c.

[165] In the foregoing page.

[166] See Newton. Princ. Lib. III. prop. 13.

[167] Chap. 5. § 10.

[168] Princ. Lib. I. prop. 60.

[169] Book I, Chap. 2. § 80.

[170] Princ. philos. Lib. I. prop. 58. coroll. 3.

[171] Newt. Optics. pag. 378.

[172] Newton. Princ. Lib. III. prop. 1.

[173] Newton, Princ. Lib. III. pag. 390,391. compared with pag. 393.

[174] Book I. Ch. 3. § 29.

[175] Princ. philos. Lib. I. prop. 4.

[176] Ibid. coroll.

[177] Newt. Princ. philos. Lib. III. pag. 390.

[178] Newt. Princ. philos. Lib. III. pag. 391, 392.

[179] Book III. Ch. 4.

[180] Newt. Princ. philos. Lib. III. pag. 391.

[181] Ibid. pag. 392.

[182] See Book I. Ch. 2. § 60, 64.

[183] Book I. Ch. 2. § 17.

[184] See Ch. II. § 6.

[185] The second of the laws of motion laid down in Book I. Ch. 1.

[186] Newton. Princ. philos. Lib. III. prop. 6. pag. 401.

[187] Newton’s Princ. philos. Lib. III. prop. 22, 23.

[188] Newton. Princ. Lib. I. prop. 66. coroll. 7.

[189] Menelai Sphaeric. Lib. I. prop. 10.

[190] Vid. Newt. Princ. Lib. I. prop. 66. coroll. 10.

[191] Vid. Newt. Princ. Lib. III prop. 30. p. 440.

[192] Ibid. Lib. I. prop. 66. coroll. 10.

[193] What this proportion is, may be known from Coroll. 2 prop. 44.
Lib. I. Princ. philos. Newton.

[194] Princ. Phil. Newt. Lib. I. prop. 45. Coroll. 1.

[195] Pr. Phil. Newt. Lib. I. prop. 66. Coroll. 7.

[196] See § 19 of this chapter.

[197] Phil. Nat. Pr. Math Lib. I. prop. 66. cor. 8.

[198] Ibid. Coroll. 8.

[199] Ibid.

[200] Ibid.

[201] Newt. Princ. Lib. III. prop. 29.

[202] Ibid. prop. 28.

[203] Ibid. prop. 31.

[204] Newt. Princ. pag. 459.

[205] In Princ. philos. part. 3. § 41.

[206] Chap. 1. § 11.

[207] Newton. Princ. philos. Lib. III. Lemm. 4. pag. 478.

[208] Princ. philos. Lib. III. prop. 40.

[209] Book I. chap. 2. § 82.

[210] Princ. philos. Lib. III. pag. 499, 500.

[211] Ibid. pag. 500, and 520, &c.

[212] Princ. Philos. Lib. III. prop. 40.

[213] Ibid. prop. 41.

[214] Ibid. pag. 522.

[215] Ibid. prop. 42.

[216] Newt. Princ. philos. edit. 2. p. 464, 465.

[217] Ibid. edit. 3. p 501, 502.

[218] Ibid. pag. 519.

[219] Ibid. pag. 524.

[220] Newt. Princ. philos. p. 525.

[221] Ibid.

[222] Ibid. pag. 508.

[223] Ibid.

[224] Ibid. pag. 484.

[225] Ibid. pag. 482, 483.

[226] Ibid. pag. 481.

[227] Ibid. pag. 509.

[228] See the fore-cited place.

[229] Ibid. and Cartes. Princ. Phil. part. 3. § 134, &c.

[230] Vid. Phil. Nat. princ. Math. p. 511.

[231] Book I. Ch. 4. § 11.

[232] Ch. 5.

[233] All these arguments are laid down in Philos. Nat. Princ. Lib.
III. from p. 509, to 517.

[234] Philos. Nat. Princ. Lib. III. p. 515.

[235] Ch. 5.

[236] See Ch. 1. § 11.

[237] Newt. Princ. Philos. pag. 525, 526. An account of all the stars
of both these kinds, which have appeared within the last 150 years may
be seen in the Philosophical transactions, vol. 29. numb. 346.

[238] Newt. Princ. Philos. Nat. Lib. III. prop. 6.

[239] Ch. 3. § 6.

[240] Book I. Ch. 2. § 24.

[241] Newt. Princ. Lib. III. prop. 6.

[242] Ch. 3. § 6.

[243] Newt. Princ. philos. Lib. III. prop. 7. cor. 1.

[244] See Book I. Ch. 1. § 15.

[245] Ibid. § 5, 6.

[246] Chap. 2. § 8.

[247] Newt. Princ. Lib. I. prop. 63.

[248] § 8.

[249] See Introd. § 23.

[250] § 4, 5.

[251] Newt. Princ. philos. Lib. I. prop. 74.

[252] Ibid. coroll. 3.

[253] Lib. I. Prop. 75. and Lib. III. prop. 8.

[254] Lib. I. Prop. 76.

[255] Ibid. cor. 5.

[256] Vid. Lib. III. Prop. 7. coroll. 1

[257] Newt. Princ. Lib. III. prop. 8. coroll. 1.

[258] Ibid. coroll. 2.

[259] Book I. Ch. 4. § 2.

[260] Newt. Princ. Lib. III. prop. 8. coroll. 3.

[261] Ibid. coroll. 4.

[262] Book I. Ch. 4.

[263] Lib. II. prop. 20. cor. 2.

[264] Chap. 4. § 17.

[265] Ibid.

[266] Vid. Newt. Princ. Lib. II. prop. 46.

[267] Princ. philos. Lib. II. prop. 49.

[268] Chap. 3. § 18.

[269] Newt. Princ. philos. Lib. I. prop. 66. coroll. 18.

[270] § 8.

[271] Ch. 3. § 5.

[272] Ch. 3 § 17.

[273] Ibid.

[274] See below § 44.

[275] Newton Princ. Lib. III. prop. 19.

[276] Lib. III. prop. 19.

[277] Lib. I. prop. 73.

[278] Lib. III. prop. 20.

[279] Ibid.

[280] Opt. B. I. part. 2. prop. 1.

[281] Newt. Opt. B. 1. part 1. experim. 5.

[282] Ibid. prop. 4.

[283] Newt. Opt. B. 1. part 2. exper. 5.

[284] Ibid exper. 6.

[285] Newton Opt. B. I. prop. 10.

[286] Ibid exp. 9.

[287] Newt. Opt. B. I. part 1. exp 15.

[288] Philos. Transact. N. 88, p. 5099.

[289] Opt B. I. par. 2. exp. 14.

[290] Ibid. exp. 10.

[291] Opt. pag. 122.

[292] Opt. B. I. part 2. exp. 11.

[293] Ibid prop. 4, 6.

[294] Opt. pag. 51.

[295] Opt. Book II. prop. 8.

[296] Opt. Book II. par. 3. prop. 2.

[297] § 17.

[298] Opt. Book II. par. 3. prop. 4.

[299] Opt. Book II. pag. 241.

[300] Ibid. pag. 224.

[301] Ibid. Obs. 17. &c.

[302] Ibid. Obs. 10.

[303] Ibid. pag. 206.

[304] Obser. 21.

[305] Observ. 5. compared with Observ. 10

[306] Ibid. prop. 5.

[307] Observ. 7.

[308] Observ. 9.

[309] Ibid prop. 7.

[310] Opt. pag. 243.

[311] Newt. Opt. B. I. part. 1. prop. I.

[312] Opt. B. I. part. 1. prop. 2.

[313] Opt. B. I. part 1. Expec. 6.

[314] Opt. pag. 67, 68, &c.

[315] Ibid. B. 1. par. 2. prop. 3.

[316] Opt. B. II. par. 3. prop. 10.

[317] Opt. B. II. par. 3. prop. 15.

[318] Ibid. par. 1. observ. 7.

[319] Ibid. Observ. 19.

[320] Opt. B. II. par. 2. pag. 199. &c.

[321] Ibid. par. 4

[322] Ibid. part. 3. prop. 13.

[323] Ibid. prop. 17.

[324] Ibid. prop. 13.

[325] Opt. Qu. 18, &c.

[326] See Concl. S. 2.

[327] B. II. Ch. 1.

[328] Opt. B. III. Obs. 1.

[329] Ibid. Obs. 2.

[330] § 2.

[331] Philos. Trans. No. 378.

[332] § 11.

[333] Philos. Transact No. 375.

[334] Ibid.

[335] Opt. B. II. part 4.

[336] Ch. 3. § 14.

[337] Opt. B. II. part 4. obs. 13.

[338] Opt. pag. 255.

[339] Ch. 3. § 18.






End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of A View of Sir Isaac Newton's Philosophy, by 
Anonymous

*** 